1 //===--- SemaDecl.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Declarations ----------------===// 2 // 3 // The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure 4 // 5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source 6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details. 7 // 8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9 // 10 // This file implements semantic analysis for declarations. 11 // 12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 13 14 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 15 #include "TypeLocBuilder.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h" 21 #include "clang/AST/CommentDiagnostic.h" 22 #include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h" 23 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 24 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h" 25 #include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h" 26 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 27 #include "clang/AST/StmtCXX.h" 28 #include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h" 29 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 30 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h" 31 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 32 #include "clang/Lex/HeaderSearch.h" // TODO: Sema shouldn't depend on Lex 33 #include "clang/Lex/Lexer.h" // TODO: Extract static functions to fix layering. 34 #include "clang/Lex/ModuleLoader.h" // TODO: Sema shouldn't depend on Lex 35 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h" // Included for isCodeCompletionEnabled() 36 #include "clang/Parse/ParseDiagnostic.h" 37 #include "clang/Sema/CXXFieldCollector.h" 38 #include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h" 39 #include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h" 40 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 41 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 42 #include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h" 43 #include "clang/Sema/Scope.h" 44 #include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h" 45 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 46 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h" 47 #include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h" 48 #include <algorithm> 49 #include <cstring> 50 #include <functional> 51 using namespace clang; 52 using namespace sema; 53 54 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy Sema::ConvertDeclToDeclGroup(Decl *Ptr, Decl *OwnedType) { 55 if (OwnedType) { 56 Decl *Group[2] = { OwnedType, Ptr }; 57 return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(DeclGroupRef::Create(Context, Group, 2)); 58 } 59 60 return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(DeclGroupRef(Ptr)); 61 } 62 63 namespace { 64 65 class TypeNameValidatorCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback { 66 public: 67 TypeNameValidatorCCC(bool AllowInvalid, bool WantClass=false, 68 bool AllowTemplates=false) 69 : AllowInvalidDecl(AllowInvalid), WantClassName(WantClass), 70 AllowClassTemplates(AllowTemplates) { 71 WantExpressionKeywords = false; 72 WantCXXNamedCasts = false; 73 WantRemainingKeywords = false; 74 } 75 76 bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override { 77 if (NamedDecl *ND = candidate.getCorrectionDecl()) { 78 bool IsType = isa<TypeDecl>(ND) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND); 79 bool AllowedTemplate = AllowClassTemplates && isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(ND); 80 return (IsType || AllowedTemplate) && 81 (AllowInvalidDecl || !ND->isInvalidDecl()); 82 } 83 return !WantClassName && candidate.isKeyword(); 84 } 85 86 private: 87 bool AllowInvalidDecl; 88 bool WantClassName; 89 bool AllowClassTemplates; 90 }; 91 92 } 93 94 /// \brief Determine whether the token kind starts a simple-type-specifier. 95 bool Sema::isSimpleTypeSpecifier(tok::TokenKind Kind) const { 96 switch (Kind) { 97 // FIXME: Take into account the current language when deciding whether a 98 // token kind is a valid type specifier 99 case tok::kw_short: 100 case tok::kw_long: 101 case tok::kw___int64: 102 case tok::kw___int128: 103 case tok::kw_signed: 104 case tok::kw_unsigned: 105 case tok::kw_void: 106 case tok::kw_char: 107 case tok::kw_int: 108 case tok::kw_half: 109 case tok::kw_float: 110 case tok::kw_double: 111 case tok::kw_wchar_t: 112 case tok::kw_bool: 113 case tok::kw___underlying_type: 114 return true; 115 116 case tok::annot_typename: 117 case tok::kw_char16_t: 118 case tok::kw_char32_t: 119 case tok::kw_typeof: 120 case tok::annot_decltype: 121 case tok::kw_decltype: 122 return getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 123 124 default: 125 break; 126 } 127 128 return false; 129 } 130 131 namespace { 132 enum class UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult { 133 NotFound, 134 FoundNonType, 135 FoundType 136 }; 137 } // namespace 138 139 /// \brief Tries to perform unqualified lookup of the type decls in bases for 140 /// dependent class. 141 /// \return \a NotFound if no any decls is found, \a FoundNotType if found not a 142 /// type decl, \a FoundType if only type decls are found. 143 static UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult 144 lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(Sema &S, const IdentifierInfo &II, 145 SourceLocation NameLoc, 146 const CXXRecordDecl *RD) { 147 if (!RD->hasDefinition()) 148 return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 149 // Look for type decls in base classes. 150 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult FoundTypeDecl = 151 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 152 for (const auto &Base : RD->bases()) { 153 const CXXRecordDecl *BaseRD = nullptr; 154 if (auto *BaseTT = Base.getType()->getAs<TagType>()) 155 BaseRD = BaseTT->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 156 else if (auto *TST = Base.getType()->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) { 157 // Look for type decls in dependent base classes that have known primary 158 // templates. 159 if (!TST || !TST->isDependentType()) 160 continue; 161 auto *TD = TST->getTemplateName().getAsTemplateDecl(); 162 if (!TD) 163 continue; 164 auto *BasePrimaryTemplate = 165 dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()); 166 if (!BasePrimaryTemplate) 167 continue; 168 BaseRD = BasePrimaryTemplate; 169 } 170 if (BaseRD) { 171 for (NamedDecl *ND : BaseRD->lookup(&II)) { 172 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(ND)) 173 return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType; 174 FoundTypeDecl = UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType; 175 } 176 if (FoundTypeDecl == UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound) { 177 switch (lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(S, II, NameLoc, BaseRD)) { 178 case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType: 179 return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType; 180 case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType: 181 FoundTypeDecl = UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType; 182 break; 183 case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound: 184 break; 185 } 186 } 187 } 188 } 189 190 return FoundTypeDecl; 191 } 192 193 static ParsedType recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(Sema &S, 194 const IdentifierInfo &II, 195 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 196 // Lookup in the parent class template context, if any. 197 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = nullptr; 198 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult FoundTypeDecl = 199 UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 200 for (DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext; 201 DC && FoundTypeDecl == UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound; 202 DC = DC->getParent()) { 203 // Look for type decls in dependent base classes that have known primary 204 // templates. 205 RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC); 206 if (RD && RD->getDescribedClassTemplate()) 207 FoundTypeDecl = lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(S, II, NameLoc, RD); 208 } 209 if (FoundTypeDecl != UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType) 210 return ParsedType(); 211 212 // We found some types in dependent base classes. Recover as if the user 213 // wrote 'typename MyClass::II' instead of 'II'. We'll fully resolve the 214 // lookup during template instantiation. 215 S.Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_found_via_dependent_bases_lookup) << &II; 216 217 ASTContext &Context = S.Context; 218 auto *NNS = NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, false, 219 cast<Type>(Context.getRecordType(RD))); 220 QualType T = Context.getDependentNameType(ETK_Typename, NNS, &II); 221 222 CXXScopeSpec SS; 223 SS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 224 225 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 226 DependentNameTypeLoc DepTL = Builder.push<DependentNameTypeLoc>(T); 227 DepTL.setNameLoc(NameLoc); 228 DepTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 229 DepTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 230 return S.CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 231 } 232 233 /// \brief If the identifier refers to a type name within this scope, 234 /// return the declaration of that type. 235 /// 236 /// This routine performs ordinary name lookup of the identifier II 237 /// within the given scope, with optional C++ scope specifier SS, to 238 /// determine whether the name refers to a type. If so, returns an 239 /// opaque pointer (actually a QualType) corresponding to that 240 /// type. Otherwise, returns NULL. 241 ParsedType Sema::getTypeName(const IdentifierInfo &II, SourceLocation NameLoc, 242 Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec *SS, 243 bool isClassName, bool HasTrailingDot, 244 ParsedType ObjectTypePtr, 245 bool IsCtorOrDtorName, 246 bool WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo, 247 IdentifierInfo **CorrectedII) { 248 // Determine where we will perform name lookup. 249 DeclContext *LookupCtx = nullptr; 250 if (ObjectTypePtr) { 251 QualType ObjectType = ObjectTypePtr.get(); 252 if (ObjectType->isRecordType()) 253 LookupCtx = computeDeclContext(ObjectType); 254 } else if (SS && SS->isNotEmpty()) { 255 LookupCtx = computeDeclContext(*SS, false); 256 257 if (!LookupCtx) { 258 if (isDependentScopeSpecifier(*SS)) { 259 // C++ [temp.res]p3: 260 // A qualified-id that refers to a type and in which the 261 // nested-name-specifier depends on a template-parameter (14.6.2) 262 // shall be prefixed by the keyword typename to indicate that the 263 // qualified-id denotes a type, forming an 264 // elaborated-type-specifier (7.1.5.3). 265 // 266 // We therefore do not perform any name lookup if the result would 267 // refer to a member of an unknown specialization. 268 if (!isClassName && !IsCtorOrDtorName) 269 return ParsedType(); 270 271 // We know from the grammar that this name refers to a type, 272 // so build a dependent node to describe the type. 273 if (WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo) 274 return ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), *SS, II, NameLoc).get(); 275 276 NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = SS->getWithLocInContext(Context); 277 QualType T = CheckTypenameType(ETK_None, SourceLocation(), QualifierLoc, 278 II, NameLoc); 279 return ParsedType::make(T); 280 } 281 282 return ParsedType(); 283 } 284 285 if (!LookupCtx->isDependentContext() && 286 RequireCompleteDeclContext(*SS, LookupCtx)) 287 return ParsedType(); 288 } 289 290 // FIXME: LookupNestedNameSpecifierName isn't the right kind of 291 // lookup for class-names. 292 LookupNameKind Kind = isClassName ? LookupNestedNameSpecifierName : 293 LookupOrdinaryName; 294 LookupResult Result(*this, &II, NameLoc, Kind); 295 if (LookupCtx) { 296 // Perform "qualified" name lookup into the declaration context we 297 // computed, which is either the type of the base of a member access 298 // expression or the declaration context associated with a prior 299 // nested-name-specifier. 300 LookupQualifiedName(Result, LookupCtx); 301 302 if (ObjectTypePtr && Result.empty()) { 303 // C++ [basic.lookup.classref]p3: 304 // If the unqualified-id is ~type-name, the type-name is looked up 305 // in the context of the entire postfix-expression. If the type T of 306 // the object expression is of a class type C, the type-name is also 307 // looked up in the scope of class C. At least one of the lookups shall 308 // find a name that refers to (possibly cv-qualified) T. 309 LookupName(Result, S); 310 } 311 } else { 312 // Perform unqualified name lookup. 313 LookupName(Result, S); 314 315 // For unqualified lookup in a class template in MSVC mode, look into 316 // dependent base classes where the primary class template is known. 317 if (Result.empty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && (!SS || SS->isEmpty())) { 318 if (ParsedType TypeInBase = 319 recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(*this, II, NameLoc)) 320 return TypeInBase; 321 } 322 } 323 324 NamedDecl *IIDecl = nullptr; 325 switch (Result.getResultKind()) { 326 case LookupResult::NotFound: 327 case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: 328 if (CorrectedII) { 329 TypoCorrection Correction = CorrectTypo( 330 Result.getLookupNameInfo(), Kind, S, SS, 331 llvm::make_unique<TypeNameValidatorCCC>(true, isClassName), 332 CTK_ErrorRecovery); 333 IdentifierInfo *NewII = Correction.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 334 TemplateTy Template; 335 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization; 336 UnqualifiedId TemplateName; 337 TemplateName.setIdentifier(NewII, NameLoc); 338 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = Correction.getCorrectionSpecifier(); 339 CXXScopeSpec NewSS, *NewSSPtr = SS; 340 if (SS && NNS) { 341 NewSS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 342 NewSSPtr = &NewSS; 343 } 344 if (Correction && (NNS || NewII != &II) && 345 // Ignore a correction to a template type as the to-be-corrected 346 // identifier is not a template (typo correction for template names 347 // is handled elsewhere). 348 !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewSSPtr && 349 isTemplateName(S, *NewSSPtr, false, TemplateName, ParsedType(), 350 false, Template, MemberOfUnknownSpecialization))) { 351 ParsedType Ty = getTypeName(*NewII, NameLoc, S, NewSSPtr, 352 isClassName, HasTrailingDot, ObjectTypePtr, 353 IsCtorOrDtorName, 354 WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo); 355 if (Ty) { 356 diagnoseTypo(Correction, 357 PDiag(diag::err_unknown_type_or_class_name_suggest) 358 << Result.getLookupName() << isClassName); 359 if (SS && NNS) 360 SS->MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 361 *CorrectedII = NewII; 362 return Ty; 363 } 364 } 365 } 366 // If typo correction failed or was not performed, fall through 367 case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded: 368 case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue: 369 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 370 return ParsedType(); 371 372 case LookupResult::Ambiguous: 373 // Recover from type-hiding ambiguities by hiding the type. We'll 374 // do the lookup again when looking for an object, and we can 375 // diagnose the error then. If we don't do this, then the error 376 // about hiding the type will be immediately followed by an error 377 // that only makes sense if the identifier was treated like a type. 378 if (Result.getAmbiguityKind() == LookupResult::AmbiguousTagHiding) { 379 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 380 return ParsedType(); 381 } 382 383 // Look to see if we have a type anywhere in the list of results. 384 for (LookupResult::iterator Res = Result.begin(), ResEnd = Result.end(); 385 Res != ResEnd; ++Res) { 386 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*Res) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*Res)) { 387 if (!IIDecl || 388 (*Res)->getLocation().getRawEncoding() < 389 IIDecl->getLocation().getRawEncoding()) 390 IIDecl = *Res; 391 } 392 } 393 394 if (!IIDecl) { 395 // None of the entities we found is a type, so there is no way 396 // to even assume that the result is a type. In this case, don't 397 // complain about the ambiguity. The parser will either try to 398 // perform this lookup again (e.g., as an object name), which 399 // will produce the ambiguity, or will complain that it expected 400 // a type name. 401 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 402 return ParsedType(); 403 } 404 405 // We found a type within the ambiguous lookup; diagnose the 406 // ambiguity and then return that type. This might be the right 407 // answer, or it might not be, but it suppresses any attempt to 408 // perform the name lookup again. 409 break; 410 411 case LookupResult::Found: 412 IIDecl = Result.getFoundDecl(); 413 break; 414 } 415 416 assert(IIDecl && "Didn't find decl"); 417 418 QualType T; 419 if (TypeDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypeDecl>(IIDecl)) { 420 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IIDecl, NameLoc); 421 422 T = Context.getTypeDeclType(TD); 423 MarkAnyDeclReferenced(TD->getLocation(), TD, /*OdrUse=*/false); 424 425 // NOTE: avoid constructing an ElaboratedType(Loc) if this is a 426 // constructor or destructor name (in such a case, the scope specifier 427 // will be attached to the enclosing Expr or Decl node). 428 if (SS && SS->isNotEmpty() && !IsCtorOrDtorName) { 429 if (WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo) { 430 // Construct a type with type-source information. 431 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 432 Builder.pushTypeSpec(T).setNameLoc(NameLoc); 433 434 T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, *SS, T); 435 ElaboratedTypeLoc ElabTL = Builder.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(T); 436 ElabTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 437 ElabTL.setQualifierLoc(SS->getWithLocInContext(Context)); 438 return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 439 } else { 440 T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, *SS, T); 441 } 442 } 443 } else if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(IIDecl)) { 444 (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IDecl, NameLoc); 445 if (!HasTrailingDot) 446 T = Context.getObjCInterfaceType(IDecl); 447 } 448 449 if (T.isNull()) { 450 // If it's not plausibly a type, suppress diagnostics. 451 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 452 return ParsedType(); 453 } 454 return ParsedType::make(T); 455 } 456 457 // Builds a fake NNS for the given decl context. 458 static NestedNameSpecifier * 459 synthesizeCurrentNestedNameSpecifier(ASTContext &Context, DeclContext *DC) { 460 for (;; DC = DC->getLookupParent()) { 461 DC = DC->getPrimaryContext(); 462 auto *ND = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(DC); 463 if (ND && !ND->isInline() && !ND->isAnonymousNamespace()) 464 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, ND); 465 else if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) 466 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, RD->isTemplateDecl(), 467 RD->getTypeForDecl()); 468 else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(DC)) 469 return NestedNameSpecifier::GlobalSpecifier(Context); 470 } 471 llvm_unreachable("something isn't in TU scope?"); 472 } 473 474 ParsedType Sema::ActOnDelayedDefaultTemplateArg(const IdentifierInfo &II, 475 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 476 // Accepting an undeclared identifier as a default argument for a template 477 // type parameter is a Microsoft extension. 478 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_ms_delayed_template_argument) << &II; 479 480 // Build a fake DependentNameType that will perform lookup into CurContext at 481 // instantiation time. The name specifier isn't dependent, so template 482 // instantiation won't transform it. It will retry the lookup, however. 483 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = 484 synthesizeCurrentNestedNameSpecifier(Context, CurContext); 485 QualType T = Context.getDependentNameType(ETK_None, NNS, &II); 486 487 // Build type location information. We synthesized the qualifier, so we have 488 // to build a fake NestedNameSpecifierLoc. 489 NestedNameSpecifierLocBuilder NNSLocBuilder; 490 NNSLocBuilder.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc)); 491 NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = NNSLocBuilder.getWithLocInContext(Context); 492 493 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 494 DependentNameTypeLoc DepTL = Builder.push<DependentNameTypeLoc>(T); 495 DepTL.setNameLoc(NameLoc); 496 DepTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 497 DepTL.setQualifierLoc(QualifierLoc); 498 return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 499 } 500 501 /// isTagName() - This method is called *for error recovery purposes only* 502 /// to determine if the specified name is a valid tag name ("struct foo"). If 503 /// so, this returns the TST for the tag corresponding to it (TST_enum, 504 /// TST_union, TST_struct, TST_interface, TST_class). This is used to diagnose 505 /// cases in C where the user forgot to specify the tag. 506 DeclSpec::TST Sema::isTagName(IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S) { 507 // Do a tag name lookup in this scope. 508 LookupResult R(*this, &II, SourceLocation(), LookupTagName); 509 LookupName(R, S, false); 510 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 511 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::Found) 512 if (const TagDecl *TD = R.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) { 513 switch (TD->getTagKind()) { 514 case TTK_Struct: return DeclSpec::TST_struct; 515 case TTK_Interface: return DeclSpec::TST_interface; 516 case TTK_Union: return DeclSpec::TST_union; 517 case TTK_Class: return DeclSpec::TST_class; 518 case TTK_Enum: return DeclSpec::TST_enum; 519 } 520 } 521 522 return DeclSpec::TST_unspecified; 523 } 524 525 /// isMicrosoftMissingTypename - In Microsoft mode, within class scope, 526 /// if a CXXScopeSpec's type is equal to the type of one of the base classes 527 /// then downgrade the missing typename error to a warning. 528 /// This is needed for MSVC compatibility; Example: 529 /// @code 530 /// template<class T> class A { 531 /// public: 532 /// typedef int TYPE; 533 /// }; 534 /// template<class T> class B : public A<T> { 535 /// public: 536 /// A<T>::TYPE a; // no typename required because A<T> is a base class. 537 /// }; 538 /// @endcode 539 bool Sema::isMicrosoftMissingTypename(const CXXScopeSpec *SS, Scope *S) { 540 if (CurContext->isRecord()) { 541 if (SS->getScopeRep()->getKind() == NestedNameSpecifier::Super) 542 return true; 543 544 const Type *Ty = SS->getScopeRep()->getAsType(); 545 546 CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext); 547 for (const auto &Base : RD->bases()) 548 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(Ty, 1), Base.getType())) 549 return true; 550 return S->isFunctionPrototypeScope(); 551 } 552 return CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() || S->isFunctionPrototypeScope(); 553 } 554 555 void Sema::DiagnoseUnknownTypeName(IdentifierInfo *&II, 556 SourceLocation IILoc, 557 Scope *S, 558 CXXScopeSpec *SS, 559 ParsedType &SuggestedType, 560 bool AllowClassTemplates) { 561 // We don't have anything to suggest (yet). 562 SuggestedType = ParsedType(); 563 564 // There may have been a typo in the name of the type. Look up typo 565 // results, in case we have something that we can suggest. 566 if (TypoCorrection Corrected = 567 CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(II, IILoc), LookupOrdinaryName, S, SS, 568 llvm::make_unique<TypeNameValidatorCCC>( 569 false, false, AllowClassTemplates), 570 CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 571 if (Corrected.isKeyword()) { 572 // We corrected to a keyword. 573 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest) << II); 574 II = Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 575 } else { 576 // We found a similarly-named type or interface; suggest that. 577 if (!SS || !SS->isSet()) { 578 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, 579 PDiag(diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest) << II); 580 } else if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(*SS, false)) { 581 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts())); 582 bool DroppedSpecifier = Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && 583 II->getName().equals(CorrectedStr); 584 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, 585 PDiag(diag::err_unknown_nested_typename_suggest) 586 << II << DC << DroppedSpecifier << SS->getRange()); 587 } else { 588 llvm_unreachable("could not have corrected a typo here"); 589 } 590 591 CXXScopeSpec tmpSS; 592 if (Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()) 593 tmpSS.MakeTrivial(Context, Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier(), 594 SourceRange(IILoc)); 595 SuggestedType = getTypeName(*Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(), 596 IILoc, S, tmpSS.isSet() ? &tmpSS : SS, false, 597 false, ParsedType(), 598 /*IsCtorOrDtorName=*/false, 599 /*NonTrivialTypeSourceInfo=*/true); 600 } 601 return; 602 } 603 604 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 605 // See if II is a class template that the user forgot to pass arguments to. 606 UnqualifiedId Name; 607 Name.setIdentifier(II, IILoc); 608 CXXScopeSpec EmptySS; 609 TemplateTy TemplateResult; 610 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization; 611 if (isTemplateName(S, SS ? *SS : EmptySS, /*hasTemplateKeyword=*/false, 612 Name, ParsedType(), true, TemplateResult, 613 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization) == TNK_Type_template) { 614 TemplateName TplName = TemplateResult.get(); 615 Diag(IILoc, diag::err_template_missing_args) << TplName; 616 if (TemplateDecl *TplDecl = TplName.getAsTemplateDecl()) { 617 Diag(TplDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here) 618 << TplDecl->getTemplateParameters()->getSourceRange(); 619 } 620 return; 621 } 622 } 623 624 // FIXME: Should we move the logic that tries to recover from a missing tag 625 // (struct, union, enum) from Parser::ParseImplicitInt here, instead? 626 627 if (!SS || (!SS->isSet() && !SS->isInvalid())) 628 Diag(IILoc, diag::err_unknown_typename) << II; 629 else if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(*SS, false)) 630 Diag(IILoc, diag::err_typename_nested_not_found) 631 << II << DC << SS->getRange(); 632 else if (isDependentScopeSpecifier(*SS)) { 633 unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typename_missing; 634 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && isMicrosoftMissingTypename(SS, S)) 635 DiagID = diag::ext_typename_missing; 636 637 Diag(SS->getRange().getBegin(), DiagID) 638 << SS->getScopeRep() << II->getName() 639 << SourceRange(SS->getRange().getBegin(), IILoc) 640 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SS->getRange().getBegin(), "typename "); 641 SuggestedType = ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), 642 *SS, *II, IILoc).get(); 643 } else { 644 assert(SS && SS->isInvalid() && 645 "Invalid scope specifier has already been diagnosed"); 646 } 647 } 648 649 /// \brief Determine whether the given result set contains either a type name 650 /// or 651 static bool isResultTypeOrTemplate(LookupResult &R, const Token &NextToken) { 652 bool CheckTemplate = R.getSema().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 653 NextToken.is(tok::less); 654 655 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), IEnd = R.end(); I != IEnd; ++I) { 656 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*I) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*I)) 657 return true; 658 659 if (CheckTemplate && isa<TemplateDecl>(*I)) 660 return true; 661 } 662 663 return false; 664 } 665 666 static bool isTagTypeWithMissingTag(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &Result, 667 Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 668 IdentifierInfo *&Name, 669 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 670 LookupResult R(SemaRef, Name, NameLoc, Sema::LookupTagName); 671 SemaRef.LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS); 672 if (TagDecl *Tag = R.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) { 673 StringRef FixItTagName; 674 switch (Tag->getTagKind()) { 675 case TTK_Class: 676 FixItTagName = "class "; 677 break; 678 679 case TTK_Enum: 680 FixItTagName = "enum "; 681 break; 682 683 case TTK_Struct: 684 FixItTagName = "struct "; 685 break; 686 687 case TTK_Interface: 688 FixItTagName = "__interface "; 689 break; 690 691 case TTK_Union: 692 FixItTagName = "union "; 693 break; 694 } 695 696 StringRef TagName = FixItTagName.drop_back(); 697 SemaRef.Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_use_of_tag_name_without_tag) 698 << Name << TagName << SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 699 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NameLoc, FixItTagName); 700 701 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Result.begin(), IEnd = Result.end(); 702 I != IEnd; ++I) 703 SemaRef.Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_decl_hiding_tag_type) 704 << Name << TagName; 705 706 // Replace lookup results with just the tag decl. 707 Result.clear(Sema::LookupTagName); 708 SemaRef.LookupParsedName(Result, S, &SS); 709 return true; 710 } 711 712 return false; 713 } 714 715 /// Build a ParsedType for a simple-type-specifier with a nested-name-specifier. 716 static ParsedType buildNestedType(Sema &S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 717 QualType T, SourceLocation NameLoc) { 718 ASTContext &Context = S.Context; 719 720 TypeLocBuilder Builder; 721 Builder.pushTypeSpec(T).setNameLoc(NameLoc); 722 723 T = S.getElaboratedType(ETK_None, SS, T); 724 ElaboratedTypeLoc ElabTL = Builder.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(T); 725 ElabTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 726 ElabTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 727 return S.CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T)); 728 } 729 730 Sema::NameClassification 731 Sema::ClassifyName(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, IdentifierInfo *&Name, 732 SourceLocation NameLoc, const Token &NextToken, 733 bool IsAddressOfOperand, 734 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> CCC) { 735 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(Name, NameLoc); 736 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl(); 737 738 if (NextToken.is(tok::coloncolon)) { 739 BuildCXXNestedNameSpecifier(S, *Name, NameLoc, NextToken.getLocation(), 740 QualType(), false, SS, nullptr, false); 741 } 742 743 LookupResult Result(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 744 LookupParsedName(Result, S, &SS, !CurMethod); 745 746 // For unqualified lookup in a class template in MSVC mode, look into 747 // dependent base classes where the primary class template is known. 748 if (Result.empty() && SS.isEmpty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) { 749 if (ParsedType TypeInBase = 750 recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(*this, *Name, NameLoc)) 751 return TypeInBase; 752 } 753 754 // Perform lookup for Objective-C instance variables (including automatically 755 // synthesized instance variables), if we're in an Objective-C method. 756 // FIXME: This lookup really, really needs to be folded in to the normal 757 // unqualified lookup mechanism. 758 if (!SS.isSet() && CurMethod && !isResultTypeOrTemplate(Result, NextToken)) { 759 ExprResult E = LookupInObjCMethod(Result, S, Name, true); 760 if (E.get() || E.isInvalid()) 761 return E; 762 } 763 764 bool SecondTry = false; 765 bool IsFilteredTemplateName = false; 766 767 Corrected: 768 switch (Result.getResultKind()) { 769 case LookupResult::NotFound: 770 // If an unqualified-id is followed by a '(', then we have a function 771 // call. 772 if (!SS.isSet() && NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)) { 773 // In C++, this is an ADL-only call. 774 // FIXME: Reference? 775 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 776 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, Result, /*ADL=*/true); 777 778 // C90 6.3.2.2: 779 // If the expression that precedes the parenthesized argument list in a 780 // function call consists solely of an identifier, and if no 781 // declaration is visible for this identifier, the identifier is 782 // implicitly declared exactly as if, in the innermost block containing 783 // the function call, the declaration 784 // 785 // extern int identifier (); 786 // 787 // appeared. 788 // 789 // We also allow this in C99 as an extension. 790 if (NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *Name, S)) { 791 Result.addDecl(D); 792 Result.resolveKind(); 793 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, Result, /*ADL=*/false); 794 } 795 } 796 797 // In C, we first see whether there is a tag type by the same name, in 798 // which case it's likely that the user just forget to write "enum", 799 // "struct", or "union". 800 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !SecondTry && 801 isTagTypeWithMissingTag(*this, Result, S, SS, Name, NameLoc)) { 802 break; 803 } 804 805 // Perform typo correction to determine if there is another name that is 806 // close to this name. 807 if (!SecondTry && CCC) { 808 SecondTry = true; 809 if (TypoCorrection Corrected = CorrectTypo(Result.getLookupNameInfo(), 810 Result.getLookupKind(), S, 811 &SS, std::move(CCC), 812 CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 813 unsigned UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest; 814 unsigned QualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_member_suggest; 815 816 NamedDecl *FirstDecl = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl(); 817 NamedDecl *UnderlyingFirstDecl 818 = FirstDecl? FirstDecl->getUnderlyingDecl() : nullptr; 819 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) && 820 UnderlyingFirstDecl && isa<TemplateDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl)) { 821 UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_template_suggest; 822 QualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_member_template_suggest; 823 } else if (UnderlyingFirstDecl && 824 (isa<TypeDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl) || 825 isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl) || 826 isa<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl))) { 827 UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest; 828 QualifiedDiag = diag::err_unknown_nested_typename_suggest; 829 } 830 831 if (SS.isEmpty()) { 832 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(UnqualifiedDiag) << Name); 833 } else {// FIXME: is this even reachable? Test it. 834 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts())); 835 bool DroppedSpecifier = Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && 836 Name->getName().equals(CorrectedStr); 837 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(QualifiedDiag) 838 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) 839 << DroppedSpecifier << SS.getRange()); 840 } 841 842 // Update the name, so that the caller has the new name. 843 Name = Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 844 845 // Typo correction corrected to a keyword. 846 if (Corrected.isKeyword()) 847 return Name; 848 849 // Also update the LookupResult... 850 // FIXME: This should probably go away at some point 851 Result.clear(); 852 Result.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection()); 853 if (FirstDecl) 854 Result.addDecl(FirstDecl); 855 856 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let 857 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to 858 // reference the ivar. 859 // FIXME: This is a gross hack. 860 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = Result.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) { 861 Result.clear(); 862 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(Result, S, Ivar->getIdentifier())); 863 return E; 864 } 865 866 goto Corrected; 867 } 868 } 869 870 // We failed to correct; just fall through and let the parser deal with it. 871 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 872 return NameClassification::Unknown(); 873 874 case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: { 875 // We performed name lookup into the current instantiation, and there were 876 // dependent bases, so we treat this result the same way as any other 877 // dependent nested-name-specifier. 878 879 // C++ [temp.res]p2: 880 // A name used in a template declaration or definition and that is 881 // dependent on a template-parameter is assumed not to name a type 882 // unless the applicable name lookup finds a type name or the name is 883 // qualified by the keyword typename. 884 // 885 // FIXME: If the next token is '<', we might want to ask the parser to 886 // perform some heroics to see if we actually have a 887 // template-argument-list, which would indicate a missing 'template' 888 // keyword here. 889 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 890 NameInfo, IsAddressOfOperand, 891 /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 892 } 893 894 case LookupResult::Found: 895 case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded: 896 case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue: 897 break; 898 899 case LookupResult::Ambiguous: 900 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) && 901 hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames(Result)) { 902 // C++ [temp.local]p3: 903 // A lookup that finds an injected-class-name (10.2) can result in an 904 // ambiguity in certain cases (for example, if it is found in more than 905 // one base class). If all of the injected-class-names that are found 906 // refer to specializations of the same class template, and if the name 907 // is followed by a template-argument-list, the reference refers to the 908 // class template itself and not a specialization thereof, and is not 909 // ambiguous. 910 // 911 // This filtering can make an ambiguous result into an unambiguous one, 912 // so try again after filtering out template names. 913 FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(Result); 914 if (!Result.isAmbiguous()) { 915 IsFilteredTemplateName = true; 916 break; 917 } 918 } 919 920 // Diagnose the ambiguity and return an error. 921 return NameClassification::Error(); 922 } 923 924 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) && 925 (IsFilteredTemplateName || hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames(Result))) { 926 // C++ [temp.names]p3: 927 // After name lookup (3.4) finds that a name is a template-name or that 928 // an operator-function-id or a literal- operator-id refers to a set of 929 // overloaded functions any member of which is a function template if 930 // this is followed by a <, the < is always taken as the delimiter of a 931 // template-argument-list and never as the less-than operator. 932 if (!IsFilteredTemplateName) 933 FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(Result); 934 935 if (!Result.empty()) { 936 bool IsFunctionTemplate; 937 bool IsVarTemplate; 938 TemplateName Template; 939 if (Result.end() - Result.begin() > 1) { 940 IsFunctionTemplate = true; 941 Template = Context.getOverloadedTemplateName(Result.begin(), 942 Result.end()); 943 } else { 944 TemplateDecl *TD 945 = cast<TemplateDecl>((*Result.begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()); 946 IsFunctionTemplate = isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(TD); 947 IsVarTemplate = isa<VarTemplateDecl>(TD); 948 949 if (SS.isSet() && !SS.isInvalid()) 950 Template = Context.getQualifiedTemplateName(SS.getScopeRep(), 951 /*TemplateKeyword=*/false, 952 TD); 953 else 954 Template = TemplateName(TD); 955 } 956 957 if (IsFunctionTemplate) { 958 // Function templates always go through overload resolution, at which 959 // point we'll perform the various checks (e.g., accessibility) we need 960 // to based on which function we selected. 961 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 962 963 return NameClassification::FunctionTemplate(Template); 964 } 965 966 return IsVarTemplate ? NameClassification::VarTemplate(Template) 967 : NameClassification::TypeTemplate(Template); 968 } 969 } 970 971 NamedDecl *FirstDecl = (*Result.begin())->getUnderlyingDecl(); 972 if (TypeDecl *Type = dyn_cast<TypeDecl>(FirstDecl)) { 973 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Type, NameLoc); 974 MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Type->getLocation(), Type, /*OdrUse=*/false); 975 QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(Type); 976 if (SS.isNotEmpty()) 977 return buildNestedType(*this, SS, T, NameLoc); 978 return ParsedType::make(T); 979 } 980 981 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Class = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(FirstDecl); 982 if (!Class) { 983 // FIXME: It's unfortunate that we don't have a Type node for handling this. 984 if (ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl *Alias = 985 dyn_cast<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(FirstDecl)) 986 Class = Alias->getClassInterface(); 987 } 988 989 if (Class) { 990 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Class, NameLoc); 991 992 if (NextToken.is(tok::period)) { 993 // Interface. <something> is parsed as a property reference expression. 994 // Just return "unknown" as a fall-through for now. 995 Result.suppressDiagnostics(); 996 return NameClassification::Unknown(); 997 } 998 999 QualType T = Context.getObjCInterfaceType(Class); 1000 return ParsedType::make(T); 1001 } 1002 1003 // We can have a type template here if we're classifying a template argument. 1004 if (isa<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl) && !isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(FirstDecl)) 1005 return NameClassification::TypeTemplate( 1006 TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl))); 1007 1008 // Check for a tag type hidden by a non-type decl in a few cases where it 1009 // seems likely a type is wanted instead of the non-type that was found. 1010 bool NextIsOp = NextToken.isOneOf(tok::amp, tok::star); 1011 if ((NextToken.is(tok::identifier) || 1012 (NextIsOp && 1013 FirstDecl->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate())) && 1014 isTagTypeWithMissingTag(*this, Result, S, SS, Name, NameLoc)) { 1015 TypeDecl *Type = Result.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>(); 1016 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Type, NameLoc); 1017 QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(Type); 1018 if (SS.isNotEmpty()) 1019 return buildNestedType(*this, SS, T, NameLoc); 1020 return ParsedType::make(T); 1021 } 1022 1023 if (FirstDecl->isCXXClassMember()) 1024 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, SourceLocation(), Result, 1025 nullptr); 1026 1027 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, Result, NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)); 1028 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, Result, ADL); 1029 } 1030 1031 // Determines the context to return to after temporarily entering a 1032 // context. This depends in an unnecessarily complicated way on the 1033 // exact ordering of callbacks from the parser. 1034 DeclContext *Sema::getContainingDC(DeclContext *DC) { 1035 1036 // Functions defined inline within classes aren't parsed until we've 1037 // finished parsing the top-level class, so the top-level class is 1038 // the context we'll need to return to. 1039 // A Lambda call operator whose parent is a class must not be treated 1040 // as an inline member function. A Lambda can be used legally 1041 // either as an in-class member initializer or a default argument. These 1042 // are parsed once the class has been marked complete and so the containing 1043 // context would be the nested class (when the lambda is defined in one); 1044 // If the class is not complete, then the lambda is being used in an 1045 // ill-formed fashion (such as to specify the width of a bit-field, or 1046 // in an array-bound) - in which case we still want to return the 1047 // lexically containing DC (which could be a nested class). 1048 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(DC) && !isLambdaCallOperator(DC)) { 1049 DC = DC->getLexicalParent(); 1050 1051 // A function not defined within a class will always return to its 1052 // lexical context. 1053 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) 1054 return DC; 1055 1056 // A C++ inline method/friend is parsed *after* the topmost class 1057 // it was declared in is fully parsed ("complete"); the topmost 1058 // class is the context we need to return to. 1059 while (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC->getLexicalParent())) 1060 DC = RD; 1061 1062 // Return the declaration context of the topmost class the inline method is 1063 // declared in. 1064 return DC; 1065 } 1066 1067 return DC->getLexicalParent(); 1068 } 1069 1070 void Sema::PushDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1071 assert(getContainingDC(DC) == CurContext && 1072 "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one."); 1073 CurContext = DC; 1074 S->setEntity(DC); 1075 } 1076 1077 void Sema::PopDeclContext() { 1078 assert(CurContext && "DeclContext imbalance!"); 1079 1080 CurContext = getContainingDC(CurContext); 1081 assert(CurContext && "Popped translation unit!"); 1082 } 1083 1084 Sema::SkippedDefinitionContext Sema::ActOnTagStartSkippedDefinition(Scope *S, 1085 Decl *D) { 1086 // Unlike PushDeclContext, the context to which we return is not necessarily 1087 // the containing DC of TD, because the new context will be some pre-existing 1088 // TagDecl definition instead of a fresh one. 1089 auto Result = static_cast<SkippedDefinitionContext>(CurContext); 1090 CurContext = cast<TagDecl>(D)->getDefinition(); 1091 assert(CurContext && "skipping definition of undefined tag"); 1092 S->setEntity(CurContext); 1093 return Result; 1094 } 1095 1096 void Sema::ActOnTagFinishSkippedDefinition(SkippedDefinitionContext Context) { 1097 CurContext = static_cast<decltype(CurContext)>(Context); 1098 } 1099 1100 /// EnterDeclaratorContext - Used when we must lookup names in the context 1101 /// of a declarator's nested name specifier. 1102 /// 1103 void Sema::EnterDeclaratorContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1104 // C++0x [basic.lookup.unqual]p13: 1105 // A name used in the definition of a static data member of class 1106 // X (after the qualified-id of the static member) is looked up as 1107 // if the name was used in a member function of X. 1108 // C++0x [basic.lookup.unqual]p14: 1109 // If a variable member of a namespace is defined outside of the 1110 // scope of its namespace then any name used in the definition of 1111 // the variable member (after the declarator-id) is looked up as 1112 // if the definition of the variable member occurred in its 1113 // namespace. 1114 // Both of these imply that we should push a scope whose context 1115 // is the semantic context of the declaration. We can't use 1116 // PushDeclContext here because that context is not necessarily 1117 // lexically contained in the current context. Fortunately, 1118 // the containing scope should have the appropriate information. 1119 1120 assert(!S->getEntity() && "scope already has entity"); 1121 1122 #ifndef NDEBUG 1123 Scope *Ancestor = S->getParent(); 1124 while (!Ancestor->getEntity()) Ancestor = Ancestor->getParent(); 1125 assert(Ancestor->getEntity() == CurContext && "ancestor context mismatch"); 1126 #endif 1127 1128 CurContext = DC; 1129 S->setEntity(DC); 1130 } 1131 1132 void Sema::ExitDeclaratorContext(Scope *S) { 1133 assert(S->getEntity() == CurContext && "Context imbalance!"); 1134 1135 // Switch back to the lexical context. The safety of this is 1136 // enforced by an assert in EnterDeclaratorContext. 1137 Scope *Ancestor = S->getParent(); 1138 while (!Ancestor->getEntity()) Ancestor = Ancestor->getParent(); 1139 CurContext = Ancestor->getEntity(); 1140 1141 // We don't need to do anything with the scope, which is going to 1142 // disappear. 1143 } 1144 1145 1146 void Sema::ActOnReenterFunctionContext(Scope* S, Decl *D) { 1147 // We assume that the caller has already called 1148 // ActOnReenterTemplateScope so getTemplatedDecl() works. 1149 FunctionDecl *FD = D->getAsFunction(); 1150 if (!FD) 1151 return; 1152 1153 // Same implementation as PushDeclContext, but enters the context 1154 // from the lexical parent, rather than the top-level class. 1155 assert(CurContext == FD->getLexicalParent() && 1156 "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one."); 1157 CurContext = FD; 1158 S->setEntity(CurContext); 1159 1160 for (unsigned P = 0, NumParams = FD->getNumParams(); P < NumParams; ++P) { 1161 ParmVarDecl *Param = FD->getParamDecl(P); 1162 // If the parameter has an identifier, then add it to the scope 1163 if (Param->getIdentifier()) { 1164 S->AddDecl(Param); 1165 IdResolver.AddDecl(Param); 1166 } 1167 } 1168 } 1169 1170 1171 void Sema::ActOnExitFunctionContext() { 1172 // Same implementation as PopDeclContext, but returns to the lexical parent, 1173 // rather than the top-level class. 1174 assert(CurContext && "DeclContext imbalance!"); 1175 CurContext = CurContext->getLexicalParent(); 1176 assert(CurContext && "Popped translation unit!"); 1177 } 1178 1179 1180 /// \brief Determine whether we allow overloading of the function 1181 /// PrevDecl with another declaration. 1182 /// 1183 /// This routine determines whether overloading is possible, not 1184 /// whether some new function is actually an overload. It will return 1185 /// true in C++ (where we can always provide overloads) or, as an 1186 /// extension, in C when the previous function is already an 1187 /// overloaded function declaration or has the "overloadable" 1188 /// attribute. 1189 static bool AllowOverloadingOfFunction(LookupResult &Previous, 1190 ASTContext &Context) { 1191 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 1192 return true; 1193 1194 if (Previous.getResultKind() == LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) 1195 return true; 1196 1197 return (Previous.getResultKind() == LookupResult::Found 1198 && Previous.getFoundDecl()->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()); 1199 } 1200 1201 /// Add this decl to the scope shadowed decl chains. 1202 void Sema::PushOnScopeChains(NamedDecl *D, Scope *S, bool AddToContext) { 1203 // Move up the scope chain until we find the nearest enclosing 1204 // non-transparent context. The declaration will be introduced into this 1205 // scope. 1206 while (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext()) 1207 S = S->getParent(); 1208 1209 // Add scoped declarations into their context, so that they can be 1210 // found later. Declarations without a context won't be inserted 1211 // into any context. 1212 if (AddToContext) 1213 CurContext->addDecl(D); 1214 1215 // Out-of-line definitions shouldn't be pushed into scope in C++, unless they 1216 // are function-local declarations. 1217 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && D->isOutOfLine() && 1218 !D->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals( 1219 D->getLexicalDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) && 1220 !D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 1221 return; 1222 1223 // Template instantiations should also not be pushed into scope. 1224 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 1225 cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 1226 return; 1227 1228 // If this replaces anything in the current scope, 1229 IdentifierResolver::iterator I = IdResolver.begin(D->getDeclName()), 1230 IEnd = IdResolver.end(); 1231 for (; I != IEnd; ++I) { 1232 if (S->isDeclScope(*I) && D->declarationReplaces(*I)) { 1233 S->RemoveDecl(*I); 1234 IdResolver.RemoveDecl(*I); 1235 1236 // Should only need to replace one decl. 1237 break; 1238 } 1239 } 1240 1241 S->AddDecl(D); 1242 1243 if (isa<LabelDecl>(D) && !cast<LabelDecl>(D)->isGnuLocal()) { 1244 // Implicitly-generated labels may end up getting generated in an order that 1245 // isn't strictly lexical, which breaks name lookup. Be careful to insert 1246 // the label at the appropriate place in the identifier chain. 1247 for (I = IdResolver.begin(D->getDeclName()); I != IEnd; ++I) { 1248 DeclContext *IDC = (*I)->getLexicalDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 1249 if (IDC == CurContext) { 1250 if (!S->isDeclScope(*I)) 1251 continue; 1252 } else if (IDC->Encloses(CurContext)) 1253 break; 1254 } 1255 1256 IdResolver.InsertDeclAfter(I, D); 1257 } else { 1258 IdResolver.AddDecl(D); 1259 } 1260 } 1261 1262 void Sema::pushExternalDeclIntoScope(NamedDecl *D, DeclarationName Name) { 1263 if (IdResolver.tryAddTopLevelDecl(D, Name) && TUScope) 1264 TUScope->AddDecl(D); 1265 } 1266 1267 bool Sema::isDeclInScope(NamedDecl *D, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S, 1268 bool AllowInlineNamespace) { 1269 return IdResolver.isDeclInScope(D, Ctx, S, AllowInlineNamespace); 1270 } 1271 1272 Scope *Sema::getScopeForDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) { 1273 DeclContext *TargetDC = DC->getPrimaryContext(); 1274 do { 1275 if (DeclContext *ScopeDC = S->getEntity()) 1276 if (ScopeDC->getPrimaryContext() == TargetDC) 1277 return S; 1278 } while ((S = S->getParent())); 1279 1280 return nullptr; 1281 } 1282 1283 static bool isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(NamedDecl *, 1284 DeclContext*, 1285 ASTContext&); 1286 1287 /// Filters out lookup results that don't fall within the given scope 1288 /// as determined by isDeclInScope. 1289 void Sema::FilterLookupForScope(LookupResult &R, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S, 1290 bool ConsiderLinkage, 1291 bool AllowInlineNamespace) { 1292 LookupResult::Filter F = R.makeFilter(); 1293 while (F.hasNext()) { 1294 NamedDecl *D = F.next(); 1295 1296 if (isDeclInScope(D, Ctx, S, AllowInlineNamespace)) 1297 continue; 1298 1299 if (ConsiderLinkage && isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(D, Ctx, Context)) 1300 continue; 1301 1302 F.erase(); 1303 } 1304 1305 F.done(); 1306 } 1307 1308 static bool isUsingDecl(NamedDecl *D) { 1309 return isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) || 1310 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(D) || 1311 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(D); 1312 } 1313 1314 /// Removes using shadow declarations from the lookup results. 1315 static void RemoveUsingDecls(LookupResult &R) { 1316 LookupResult::Filter F = R.makeFilter(); 1317 while (F.hasNext()) 1318 if (isUsingDecl(F.next())) 1319 F.erase(); 1320 1321 F.done(); 1322 } 1323 1324 /// \brief Check for this common pattern: 1325 /// @code 1326 /// class S { 1327 /// S(const S&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT 1328 /// void operator=(const S&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT 1329 /// }; 1330 /// @endcode 1331 static bool IsDisallowedCopyOrAssign(const CXXMethodDecl *D) { 1332 // FIXME: Should check for private access too but access is set after we get 1333 // the decl here. 1334 if (D->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody()) 1335 return false; 1336 1337 if (const CXXConstructorDecl *CD = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) 1338 return CD->isCopyConstructor(); 1339 if (const CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) 1340 return Method->isCopyAssignmentOperator(); 1341 return false; 1342 } 1343 1344 // We need this to handle 1345 // 1346 // typedef struct { 1347 // void *foo() { return 0; } 1348 // } A; 1349 // 1350 // When we see foo we don't know if after the typedef we will get 'A' or '*A' 1351 // for example. If 'A', foo will have external linkage. If we have '*A', 1352 // foo will have no linkage. Since we can't know until we get to the end 1353 // of the typedef, this function finds out if D might have non-external linkage. 1354 // Callers should verify at the end of the TU if it D has external linkage or 1355 // not. 1356 bool Sema::mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(const DeclaratorDecl *D) { 1357 const DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext(); 1358 while (!DC->isTranslationUnit()) { 1359 if (const RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(DC)){ 1360 if (!RD->hasNameForLinkage()) 1361 return true; 1362 } 1363 DC = DC->getParent(); 1364 } 1365 1366 return !D->isExternallyVisible(); 1367 } 1368 1369 // FIXME: This needs to be refactored; some other isInMainFile users want 1370 // these semantics. 1371 static bool isMainFileLoc(const Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) { 1372 if (S.TUKind != TU_Complete) 1373 return false; 1374 return S.SourceMgr.isInMainFile(Loc); 1375 } 1376 1377 bool Sema::ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) const { 1378 assert(D); 1379 1380 if (D->isInvalidDecl() || D->isUsed() || D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1381 return false; 1382 1383 // Ignore all entities declared within templates, and out-of-line definitions 1384 // of members of class templates. 1385 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext() || 1386 D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext()) 1387 return false; 1388 1389 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 1390 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 1391 return false; 1392 1393 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 1394 if (MD->isVirtual() || IsDisallowedCopyOrAssign(MD)) 1395 return false; 1396 } else { 1397 // 'static inline' functions are defined in headers; don't warn. 1398 if (FD->isInlined() && !isMainFileLoc(*this, FD->getLocation())) 1399 return false; 1400 } 1401 1402 if (FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody() && 1403 Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(FD)) 1404 return false; 1405 } else if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1406 // Constants and utility variables are defined in headers with internal 1407 // linkage; don't warn. (Unlike functions, there isn't a convenient marker 1408 // like "inline".) 1409 if (!isMainFileLoc(*this, VD->getLocation())) 1410 return false; 1411 1412 if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(VD)) 1413 return false; 1414 1415 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && 1416 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) 1417 return false; 1418 } else { 1419 return false; 1420 } 1421 1422 // Only warn for unused decls internal to the translation unit. 1423 // FIXME: This seems like a bogus check; it suppresses -Wunused-function 1424 // for inline functions defined in the main source file, for instance. 1425 return mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(D); 1426 } 1427 1428 void Sema::MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) { 1429 if (!D) 1430 return; 1431 1432 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 1433 const FunctionDecl *First = FD->getFirstDecl(); 1434 if (FD != First && ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(First)) 1435 return; // First should already be in the vector. 1436 } 1437 1438 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1439 const VarDecl *First = VD->getFirstDecl(); 1440 if (VD != First && ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(First)) 1441 return; // First should already be in the vector. 1442 } 1443 1444 if (ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(D)) 1445 UnusedFileScopedDecls.push_back(D); 1446 } 1447 1448 static bool ShouldDiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D) { 1449 if (D->isInvalidDecl()) 1450 return false; 1451 1452 if (D->isReferenced() || D->isUsed() || D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>() || 1453 D->hasAttr<ObjCPreciseLifetimeAttr>()) 1454 return false; 1455 1456 if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) 1457 return true; 1458 1459 // Except for labels, we only care about unused decls that are local to 1460 // functions. 1461 bool WithinFunction = D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod(); 1462 if (const auto *R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext())) 1463 // For dependent types, the diagnostic is deferred. 1464 WithinFunction = 1465 WithinFunction || (R->isLocalClass() && !R->isDependentType()); 1466 if (!WithinFunction) 1467 return false; 1468 1469 if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) 1470 return true; 1471 1472 // White-list anything that isn't a local variable. 1473 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) || isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) || isa<ImplicitParamDecl>(D)) 1474 return false; 1475 1476 // Types of valid local variables should be complete, so this should succeed. 1477 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1478 1479 // White-list anything with an __attribute__((unused)) type. 1480 QualType Ty = VD->getType(); 1481 1482 // Only look at the outermost level of typedef. 1483 if (const TypedefType *TT = Ty->getAs<TypedefType>()) { 1484 if (TT->getDecl()->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1485 return false; 1486 } 1487 1488 // If we failed to complete the type for some reason, or if the type is 1489 // dependent, don't diagnose the variable. 1490 if (Ty->isIncompleteType() || Ty->isDependentType()) 1491 return false; 1492 1493 if (const TagType *TT = Ty->getAs<TagType>()) { 1494 const TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl(); 1495 if (Tag->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 1496 return false; 1497 1498 if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) { 1499 if (!RD->hasTrivialDestructor() && !RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>()) 1500 return false; 1501 1502 if (const Expr *Init = VD->getInit()) { 1503 if (const ExprWithCleanups *Cleanups = 1504 dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init)) 1505 Init = Cleanups->getSubExpr(); 1506 const CXXConstructExpr *Construct = 1507 dyn_cast<CXXConstructExpr>(Init); 1508 if (Construct && !Construct->isElidable()) { 1509 CXXConstructorDecl *CD = Construct->getConstructor(); 1510 if (!CD->isTrivial() && !RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>()) 1511 return false; 1512 } 1513 } 1514 } 1515 } 1516 1517 // TODO: __attribute__((unused)) templates? 1518 } 1519 1520 return true; 1521 } 1522 1523 static void GenerateFixForUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D, ASTContext &Ctx, 1524 FixItHint &Hint) { 1525 if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) { 1526 SourceLocation AfterColon = Lexer::findLocationAfterToken(D->getLocEnd(), 1527 tok::colon, Ctx.getSourceManager(), Ctx.getLangOpts(), true); 1528 if (AfterColon.isInvalid()) 1529 return; 1530 Hint = FixItHint::CreateRemoval(CharSourceRange:: 1531 getCharRange(D->getLocStart(), AfterColon)); 1532 } 1533 return; 1534 } 1535 1536 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(const RecordDecl *D) { 1537 if (D->getTypeForDecl()->isDependentType()) 1538 return; 1539 1540 for (auto *TmpD : D->decls()) { 1541 if (const auto *T = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(TmpD)) 1542 DiagnoseUnusedDecl(T); 1543 else if(const auto *R = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(TmpD)) 1544 DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(R); 1545 } 1546 } 1547 1548 /// DiagnoseUnusedDecl - Emit warnings about declarations that are not used 1549 /// unless they are marked attr(unused). 1550 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D) { 1551 if (!ShouldDiagnoseUnusedDecl(D)) 1552 return; 1553 1554 if (auto *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) { 1555 // typedefs can be referenced later on, so the diagnostics are emitted 1556 // at end-of-translation-unit. 1557 UnusedLocalTypedefNameCandidates.insert(TD); 1558 return; 1559 } 1560 1561 FixItHint Hint; 1562 GenerateFixForUnusedDecl(D, Context, Hint); 1563 1564 unsigned DiagID; 1565 if (isa<VarDecl>(D) && cast<VarDecl>(D)->isExceptionVariable()) 1566 DiagID = diag::warn_unused_exception_param; 1567 else if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) 1568 DiagID = diag::warn_unused_label; 1569 else 1570 DiagID = diag::warn_unused_variable; 1571 1572 Diag(D->getLocation(), DiagID) << D->getDeclName() << Hint; 1573 } 1574 1575 static void CheckPoppedLabel(LabelDecl *L, Sema &S) { 1576 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto 1577 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it. Label fwd 1578 // definitions are indicated with a null substmt which is also not a resolved 1579 // MS inline assembly label name. 1580 bool Diagnose = false; 1581 if (L->isMSAsmLabel()) 1582 Diagnose = !L->isResolvedMSAsmLabel(); 1583 else 1584 Diagnose = L->getStmt() == nullptr; 1585 if (Diagnose) 1586 S.Diag(L->getLocation(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) <<L->getDeclName(); 1587 } 1588 1589 void Sema::ActOnPopScope(SourceLocation Loc, Scope *S) { 1590 S->mergeNRVOIntoParent(); 1591 1592 if (S->decl_empty()) return; 1593 assert((S->getFlags() & (Scope::DeclScope | Scope::TemplateParamScope)) && 1594 "Scope shouldn't contain decls!"); 1595 1596 for (auto *TmpD : S->decls()) { 1597 assert(TmpD && "This decl didn't get pushed??"); 1598 1599 assert(isa<NamedDecl>(TmpD) && "Decl isn't NamedDecl?"); 1600 NamedDecl *D = cast<NamedDecl>(TmpD); 1601 1602 if (!D->getDeclName()) continue; 1603 1604 // Diagnose unused variables in this scope. 1605 if (!S->hasUnrecoverableErrorOccurred()) { 1606 DiagnoseUnusedDecl(D); 1607 if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(D)) 1608 DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(RD); 1609 } 1610 1611 // If this was a forward reference to a label, verify it was defined. 1612 if (LabelDecl *LD = dyn_cast<LabelDecl>(D)) 1613 CheckPoppedLabel(LD, *this); 1614 1615 // Remove this name from our lexical scope. 1616 IdResolver.RemoveDecl(D); 1617 } 1618 } 1619 1620 /// \brief Look for an Objective-C class in the translation unit. 1621 /// 1622 /// \param Id The name of the Objective-C class we're looking for. If 1623 /// typo-correction fixes this name, the Id will be updated 1624 /// to the fixed name. 1625 /// 1626 /// \param IdLoc The location of the name in the translation unit. 1627 /// 1628 /// \param DoTypoCorrection If true, this routine will attempt typo correction 1629 /// if there is no class with the given name. 1630 /// 1631 /// \returns The declaration of the named Objective-C class, or NULL if the 1632 /// class could not be found. 1633 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Sema::getObjCInterfaceDecl(IdentifierInfo *&Id, 1634 SourceLocation IdLoc, 1635 bool DoTypoCorrection) { 1636 // The third "scope" argument is 0 since we aren't enabling lazy built-in 1637 // creation from this context. 1638 NamedDecl *IDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Id, IdLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 1639 1640 if (!IDecl && DoTypoCorrection) { 1641 // Perform typo correction at the given location, but only if we 1642 // find an Objective-C class name. 1643 if (TypoCorrection C = CorrectTypo( 1644 DeclarationNameInfo(Id, IdLoc), LookupOrdinaryName, TUScope, nullptr, 1645 llvm::make_unique<DeclFilterCCC<ObjCInterfaceDecl>>(), 1646 CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 1647 diagnoseTypo(C, PDiag(diag::err_undef_interface_suggest) << Id); 1648 IDecl = C.getCorrectionDeclAs<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(); 1649 Id = IDecl->getIdentifier(); 1650 } 1651 } 1652 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(IDecl); 1653 // This routine must always return a class definition, if any. 1654 if (Def && Def->getDefinition()) 1655 Def = Def->getDefinition(); 1656 return Def; 1657 } 1658 1659 /// getNonFieldDeclScope - Retrieves the innermost scope, starting 1660 /// from S, where a non-field would be declared. This routine copes 1661 /// with the difference between C and C++ scoping rules in structs and 1662 /// unions. For example, the following code is well-formed in C but 1663 /// ill-formed in C++: 1664 /// @code 1665 /// struct S6 { 1666 /// enum { BAR } e; 1667 /// }; 1668 /// 1669 /// void test_S6() { 1670 /// struct S6 a; 1671 /// a.e = BAR; 1672 /// } 1673 /// @endcode 1674 /// For the declaration of BAR, this routine will return a different 1675 /// scope. The scope S will be the scope of the unnamed enumeration 1676 /// within S6. In C++, this routine will return the scope associated 1677 /// with S6, because the enumeration's scope is a transparent 1678 /// context but structures can contain non-field names. In C, this 1679 /// routine will return the translation unit scope, since the 1680 /// enumeration's scope is a transparent context and structures cannot 1681 /// contain non-field names. 1682 Scope *Sema::getNonFieldDeclScope(Scope *S) { 1683 while (((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0) || 1684 (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext()) || 1685 (S->isClassScope() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)) 1686 S = S->getParent(); 1687 return S; 1688 } 1689 1690 /// \brief Looks up the declaration of "struct objc_super" and 1691 /// saves it for later use in building builtin declaration of 1692 /// objc_msgSendSuper and objc_msgSendSuper_stret. If no such 1693 /// pre-existing declaration exists no action takes place. 1694 static void LookupPredefedObjCSuperType(Sema &ThisSema, Scope *S, 1695 IdentifierInfo *II) { 1696 if (!II->isStr("objc_msgSendSuper")) 1697 return; 1698 ASTContext &Context = ThisSema.Context; 1699 1700 LookupResult Result(ThisSema, &Context.Idents.get("objc_super"), 1701 SourceLocation(), Sema::LookupTagName); 1702 ThisSema.LookupName(Result, S); 1703 if (Result.getResultKind() == LookupResult::Found) 1704 if (const TagDecl *TD = Result.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) 1705 Context.setObjCSuperType(Context.getTagDeclType(TD)); 1706 } 1707 1708 static StringRef getHeaderName(ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error) { 1709 switch (Error) { 1710 case ASTContext::GE_None: 1711 return ""; 1712 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio: 1713 return "stdio.h"; 1714 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp: 1715 return "setjmp.h"; 1716 case ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext: 1717 return "ucontext.h"; 1718 } 1719 llvm_unreachable("unhandled error kind"); 1720 } 1721 1722 /// LazilyCreateBuiltin - The specified Builtin-ID was first used at 1723 /// file scope. lazily create a decl for it. ForRedeclaration is true 1724 /// if we're creating this built-in in anticipation of redeclaring the 1725 /// built-in. 1726 NamedDecl *Sema::LazilyCreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, unsigned ID, 1727 Scope *S, bool ForRedeclaration, 1728 SourceLocation Loc) { 1729 LookupPredefedObjCSuperType(*this, S, II); 1730 1731 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error; 1732 QualType R = Context.GetBuiltinType(ID, Error); 1733 if (Error) { 1734 if (ForRedeclaration) 1735 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicit_decl_requires_sysheader) 1736 << getHeaderName(Error) 1737 << Context.BuiltinInfo.GetName(ID); 1738 return nullptr; 1739 } 1740 1741 if (!ForRedeclaration && Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(ID)) { 1742 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_implicit_lib_function_decl) 1743 << Context.BuiltinInfo.GetName(ID) 1744 << R; 1745 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.getHeaderName(ID) && 1746 !Diags.isIgnored(diag::ext_implicit_lib_function_decl, Loc)) 1747 Diag(Loc, diag::note_include_header_or_declare) 1748 << Context.BuiltinInfo.getHeaderName(ID) 1749 << Context.BuiltinInfo.GetName(ID); 1750 } 1751 1752 DeclContext *Parent = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(); 1753 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 1754 LinkageSpecDecl *CLinkageDecl = 1755 LinkageSpecDecl::Create(Context, Parent, Loc, Loc, 1756 LinkageSpecDecl::lang_c, false); 1757 CLinkageDecl->setImplicit(); 1758 Parent->addDecl(CLinkageDecl); 1759 Parent = CLinkageDecl; 1760 } 1761 1762 FunctionDecl *New = FunctionDecl::Create(Context, 1763 Parent, 1764 Loc, Loc, II, R, /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 1765 SC_Extern, 1766 false, 1767 R->isFunctionProtoType()); 1768 New->setImplicit(); 1769 1770 // Create Decl objects for each parameter, adding them to the 1771 // FunctionDecl. 1772 if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(R)) { 1773 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params; 1774 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FT->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 1775 ParmVarDecl *parm = 1776 ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, New, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), 1777 nullptr, FT->getParamType(i), /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 1778 SC_None, nullptr); 1779 parm->setScopeInfo(0, i); 1780 Params.push_back(parm); 1781 } 1782 New->setParams(Params); 1783 } 1784 1785 AddKnownFunctionAttributes(New); 1786 RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(New, S); 1787 1788 // TUScope is the translation-unit scope to insert this function into. 1789 // FIXME: This is hideous. We need to teach PushOnScopeChains to 1790 // relate Scopes to DeclContexts, and probably eliminate CurContext 1791 // entirely, but we're not there yet. 1792 DeclContext *SavedContext = CurContext; 1793 CurContext = Parent; 1794 PushOnScopeChains(New, TUScope); 1795 CurContext = SavedContext; 1796 return New; 1797 } 1798 1799 /// \brief Filter out any previous declarations that the given declaration 1800 /// should not consider because they are not permitted to conflict, e.g., 1801 /// because they come from hidden sub-modules and do not refer to the same 1802 /// entity. 1803 static void filterNonConflictingPreviousDecls(Sema &S, 1804 NamedDecl *decl, 1805 LookupResult &previous){ 1806 // This is only interesting when modules are enabled. 1807 if ((!S.getLangOpts().Modules && !S.getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) || 1808 !S.getLangOpts().ModulesHideInternalLinkage) 1809 return; 1810 1811 // Empty sets are uninteresting. 1812 if (previous.empty()) 1813 return; 1814 1815 LookupResult::Filter filter = previous.makeFilter(); 1816 while (filter.hasNext()) { 1817 NamedDecl *old = filter.next(); 1818 1819 // Non-hidden declarations are never ignored. 1820 if (S.isVisible(old)) 1821 continue; 1822 1823 if (!old->isExternallyVisible()) 1824 filter.erase(); 1825 } 1826 1827 filter.done(); 1828 } 1829 1830 /// Typedef declarations don't have linkage, but they still denote the same 1831 /// entity if their types are the same. 1832 /// FIXME: This is notionally doing the same thing as ASTReaderDecl's 1833 /// isSameEntity. 1834 static void filterNonConflictingPreviousTypedefDecls(Sema &S, 1835 TypedefNameDecl *Decl, 1836 LookupResult &Previous) { 1837 // This is only interesting when modules are enabled. 1838 if (!S.getLangOpts().Modules && !S.getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) 1839 return; 1840 1841 // Empty sets are uninteresting. 1842 if (Previous.empty()) 1843 return; 1844 1845 LookupResult::Filter Filter = Previous.makeFilter(); 1846 while (Filter.hasNext()) { 1847 NamedDecl *Old = Filter.next(); 1848 1849 // Non-hidden declarations are never ignored. 1850 if (S.isVisible(Old)) 1851 continue; 1852 1853 // Declarations of the same entity are not ignored, even if they have 1854 // different linkages. 1855 if (auto *OldTD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) { 1856 if (S.Context.hasSameType(OldTD->getUnderlyingType(), 1857 Decl->getUnderlyingType())) 1858 continue; 1859 1860 // If both declarations give a tag declaration a typedef name for linkage 1861 // purposes, then they declare the same entity. 1862 if (OldTD->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(/*AnyRedecl*/true) && 1863 Decl->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName()) 1864 continue; 1865 } 1866 1867 if (!Old->isExternallyVisible()) 1868 Filter.erase(); 1869 } 1870 1871 Filter.done(); 1872 } 1873 1874 bool Sema::isIncompatibleTypedef(TypeDecl *Old, TypedefNameDecl *New) { 1875 QualType OldType; 1876 if (TypedefNameDecl *OldTypedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) 1877 OldType = OldTypedef->getUnderlyingType(); 1878 else 1879 OldType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Old); 1880 QualType NewType = New->getUnderlyingType(); 1881 1882 if (NewType->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 1883 // Must not redefine a typedef with a variably-modified type. 1884 int Kind = isa<TypeAliasDecl>(Old) ? 1 : 0; 1885 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_variably_modified_typedef) 1886 << Kind << NewType; 1887 if (Old->getLocation().isValid()) 1888 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 1889 New->setInvalidDecl(); 1890 return true; 1891 } 1892 1893 if (OldType != NewType && 1894 !OldType->isDependentType() && 1895 !NewType->isDependentType() && 1896 !Context.hasSameType(OldType, NewType)) { 1897 int Kind = isa<TypeAliasDecl>(Old) ? 1 : 0; 1898 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_typedef) 1899 << Kind << NewType << OldType; 1900 if (Old->getLocation().isValid()) 1901 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 1902 New->setInvalidDecl(); 1903 return true; 1904 } 1905 return false; 1906 } 1907 1908 /// MergeTypedefNameDecl - We just parsed a typedef 'New' which has the 1909 /// same name and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out 1910 /// how to resolve this situation, merging decls or emitting 1911 /// diagnostics as appropriate. If there was an error, set New to be invalid. 1912 /// 1913 void Sema::MergeTypedefNameDecl(TypedefNameDecl *New, LookupResult &OldDecls) { 1914 // If the new decl is known invalid already, don't bother doing any 1915 // merging checks. 1916 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) return; 1917 1918 // Allow multiple definitions for ObjC built-in typedefs. 1919 // FIXME: Verify the underlying types are equivalent! 1920 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) { 1921 const IdentifierInfo *TypeID = New->getIdentifier(); 1922 switch (TypeID->getLength()) { 1923 default: break; 1924 case 2: 1925 { 1926 if (!TypeID->isStr("id")) 1927 break; 1928 QualType T = New->getUnderlyingType(); 1929 if (!T->isPointerType()) 1930 break; 1931 if (!T->isVoidPointerType()) { 1932 QualType PT = T->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1933 if (!PT->isStructureType()) 1934 break; 1935 } 1936 Context.setObjCIdRedefinitionType(T); 1937 // Install the built-in type for 'id', ignoring the current definition. 1938 New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCIdType().getTypePtr()); 1939 return; 1940 } 1941 case 5: 1942 if (!TypeID->isStr("Class")) 1943 break; 1944 Context.setObjCClassRedefinitionType(New->getUnderlyingType()); 1945 // Install the built-in type for 'Class', ignoring the current definition. 1946 New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCClassType().getTypePtr()); 1947 return; 1948 case 3: 1949 if (!TypeID->isStr("SEL")) 1950 break; 1951 Context.setObjCSelRedefinitionType(New->getUnderlyingType()); 1952 // Install the built-in type for 'SEL', ignoring the current definition. 1953 New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCSelType().getTypePtr()); 1954 return; 1955 } 1956 // Fall through - the typedef name was not a builtin type. 1957 } 1958 1959 // Verify the old decl was also a type. 1960 TypeDecl *Old = OldDecls.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>(); 1961 if (!Old) { 1962 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) 1963 << New->getDeclName(); 1964 1965 NamedDecl *OldD = OldDecls.getRepresentativeDecl(); 1966 if (OldD->getLocation().isValid()) 1967 Diag(OldD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 1968 1969 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 1970 } 1971 1972 // If the old declaration is invalid, just give up here. 1973 if (Old->isInvalidDecl()) 1974 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 1975 1976 if (auto *OldTD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) { 1977 auto *OldTag = OldTD->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(/*AnyRedecl*/true); 1978 auto *NewTag = New->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(); 1979 NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr; 1980 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && OldTag && NewTag && 1981 OldTag->getCanonicalDecl() != NewTag->getCanonicalDecl() && 1982 !hasVisibleDefinition(OldTag, &Hidden)) { 1983 // There is a definition of this tag, but it is not visible. Use it 1984 // instead of our tag. 1985 New->setTypeForDecl(OldTD->getTypeForDecl()); 1986 if (OldTD->isModed()) 1987 New->setModedTypeSourceInfo(OldTD->getTypeSourceInfo(), 1988 OldTD->getUnderlyingType()); 1989 else 1990 New->setTypeSourceInfo(OldTD->getTypeSourceInfo()); 1991 1992 // Make the old tag definition visible. 1993 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Hidden, NewTag->getLocation()); 1994 } 1995 } 1996 1997 // If the typedef types are not identical, reject them in all languages and 1998 // with any extensions enabled. 1999 if (isIncompatibleTypedef(Old, New)) 2000 return; 2001 2002 // The types match. Link up the redeclaration chain and merge attributes if 2003 // the old declaration was a typedef. 2004 if (TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) { 2005 New->setPreviousDecl(Typedef); 2006 mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old); 2007 } 2008 2009 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) 2010 return; 2011 2012 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2013 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p2: 2014 // In a given non-class scope, a typedef specifier can be used to 2015 // redefine the name of any type declared in that scope to refer 2016 // to the type to which it already refers. 2017 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext)) 2018 return; 2019 2020 // C++0x [dcl.typedef]p4: 2021 // In a given class scope, a typedef specifier can be used to redefine 2022 // any class-name declared in that scope that is not also a typedef-name 2023 // to refer to the type to which it already refers. 2024 // 2025 // This wording came in via DR424, which was a correction to the 2026 // wording in DR56, which accidentally banned code like: 2027 // 2028 // struct S { 2029 // typedef struct A { } A; 2030 // }; 2031 // 2032 // in the C++03 standard. We implement the C++0x semantics, which 2033 // allow the above but disallow 2034 // 2035 // struct S { 2036 // typedef int I; 2037 // typedef int I; 2038 // }; 2039 // 2040 // since that was the intent of DR56. 2041 if (!isa<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) 2042 return; 2043 2044 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) 2045 << New->getDeclName(); 2046 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 2047 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 2048 } 2049 2050 // Modules always permit redefinition of typedefs, as does C11. 2051 if (getLangOpts().Modules || getLangOpts().C11) 2052 return; 2053 2054 // If we have a redefinition of a typedef in C, emit a warning. This warning 2055 // is normally mapped to an error, but can be controlled with 2056 // -Wtypedef-redefinition. If either the original or the redefinition is 2057 // in a system header, don't emit this for compatibility with GCC. 2058 if (getDiagnostics().getSuppressSystemWarnings() && 2059 (Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(Old->getLocation()) || 2060 Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(New->getLocation()))) 2061 return; 2062 2063 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_redefinition_of_typedef) 2064 << New->getDeclName(); 2065 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 2066 } 2067 2068 /// DeclhasAttr - returns true if decl Declaration already has the target 2069 /// attribute. 2070 static bool DeclHasAttr(const Decl *D, const Attr *A) { 2071 const OwnershipAttr *OA = dyn_cast<OwnershipAttr>(A); 2072 const AnnotateAttr *Ann = dyn_cast<AnnotateAttr>(A); 2073 for (const auto *i : D->attrs()) 2074 if (i->getKind() == A->getKind()) { 2075 if (Ann) { 2076 if (Ann->getAnnotation() == cast<AnnotateAttr>(i)->getAnnotation()) 2077 return true; 2078 continue; 2079 } 2080 // FIXME: Don't hardcode this check 2081 if (OA && isa<OwnershipAttr>(i)) 2082 return OA->getOwnKind() == cast<OwnershipAttr>(i)->getOwnKind(); 2083 return true; 2084 } 2085 2086 return false; 2087 } 2088 2089 static bool isAttributeTargetADefinition(Decl *D) { 2090 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) 2091 return VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition(); 2092 if (TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) 2093 return TD->isCompleteDefinition() || TD->isBeingDefined(); 2094 return true; 2095 } 2096 2097 /// Merge alignment attributes from \p Old to \p New, taking into account the 2098 /// special semantics of C11's _Alignas specifier and C++11's alignas attribute. 2099 /// 2100 /// \return \c true if any attributes were added to \p New. 2101 static bool mergeAlignedAttrs(Sema &S, NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old) { 2102 // Look for alignas attributes on Old, and pick out whichever attribute 2103 // specifies the strictest alignment requirement. 2104 AlignedAttr *OldAlignasAttr = nullptr; 2105 AlignedAttr *OldStrictestAlignAttr = nullptr; 2106 unsigned OldAlign = 0; 2107 for (auto *I : Old->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) { 2108 // FIXME: We have no way of representing inherited dependent alignments 2109 // in a case like: 2110 // template<int A, int B> struct alignas(A) X; 2111 // template<int A, int B> struct alignas(B) X {}; 2112 // For now, we just ignore any alignas attributes which are not on the 2113 // definition in such a case. 2114 if (I->isAlignmentDependent()) 2115 return false; 2116 2117 if (I->isAlignas()) 2118 OldAlignasAttr = I; 2119 2120 unsigned Align = I->getAlignment(S.Context); 2121 if (Align > OldAlign) { 2122 OldAlign = Align; 2123 OldStrictestAlignAttr = I; 2124 } 2125 } 2126 2127 // Look for alignas attributes on New. 2128 AlignedAttr *NewAlignasAttr = nullptr; 2129 unsigned NewAlign = 0; 2130 for (auto *I : New->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) { 2131 if (I->isAlignmentDependent()) 2132 return false; 2133 2134 if (I->isAlignas()) 2135 NewAlignasAttr = I; 2136 2137 unsigned Align = I->getAlignment(S.Context); 2138 if (Align > NewAlign) 2139 NewAlign = Align; 2140 } 2141 2142 if (OldAlignasAttr && NewAlignasAttr && OldAlign != NewAlign) { 2143 // Both declarations have 'alignas' attributes. We require them to match. 2144 // C++11 [dcl.align]p6 and C11 6.7.5/7 both come close to saying this, but 2145 // fall short. (If two declarations both have alignas, they must both match 2146 // every definition, and so must match each other if there is a definition.) 2147 2148 // If either declaration only contains 'alignas(0)' specifiers, then it 2149 // specifies the natural alignment for the type. 2150 if (OldAlign == 0 || NewAlign == 0) { 2151 QualType Ty; 2152 if (ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(New)) 2153 Ty = VD->getType(); 2154 else 2155 Ty = S.Context.getTagDeclType(cast<TagDecl>(New)); 2156 2157 if (OldAlign == 0) 2158 OldAlign = S.Context.getTypeAlign(Ty); 2159 if (NewAlign == 0) 2160 NewAlign = S.Context.getTypeAlign(Ty); 2161 } 2162 2163 if (OldAlign != NewAlign) { 2164 S.Diag(NewAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_mismatch) 2165 << (unsigned)S.Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(OldAlign).getQuantity() 2166 << (unsigned)S.Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(NewAlign).getQuantity(); 2167 S.Diag(OldAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2168 } 2169 } 2170 2171 if (OldAlignasAttr && !NewAlignasAttr && isAttributeTargetADefinition(New)) { 2172 // C++11 [dcl.align]p6: 2173 // if any declaration of an entity has an alignment-specifier, 2174 // every defining declaration of that entity shall specify an 2175 // equivalent alignment. 2176 // C11 6.7.5/7: 2177 // If the definition of an object does not have an alignment 2178 // specifier, any other declaration of that object shall also 2179 // have no alignment specifier. 2180 S.Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_missing_on_definition) 2181 << OldAlignasAttr; 2182 S.Diag(OldAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_alignas_on_declaration) 2183 << OldAlignasAttr; 2184 } 2185 2186 bool AnyAdded = false; 2187 2188 // Ensure we have an attribute representing the strictest alignment. 2189 if (OldAlign > NewAlign) { 2190 AlignedAttr *Clone = OldStrictestAlignAttr->clone(S.Context); 2191 Clone->setInherited(true); 2192 New->addAttr(Clone); 2193 AnyAdded = true; 2194 } 2195 2196 // Ensure we have an alignas attribute if the old declaration had one. 2197 if (OldAlignasAttr && !NewAlignasAttr && 2198 !(AnyAdded && OldStrictestAlignAttr->isAlignas())) { 2199 AlignedAttr *Clone = OldAlignasAttr->clone(S.Context); 2200 Clone->setInherited(true); 2201 New->addAttr(Clone); 2202 AnyAdded = true; 2203 } 2204 2205 return AnyAdded; 2206 } 2207 2208 static bool mergeDeclAttribute(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D, 2209 const InheritableAttr *Attr, bool Override) { 2210 InheritableAttr *NewAttr = nullptr; 2211 unsigned AttrSpellingListIndex = Attr->getSpellingListIndex(); 2212 if (const auto *AA = dyn_cast<AvailabilityAttr>(Attr)) 2213 NewAttr = S.mergeAvailabilityAttr(D, AA->getRange(), AA->getPlatform(), 2214 AA->getIntroduced(), AA->getDeprecated(), 2215 AA->getObsoleted(), AA->getUnavailable(), 2216 AA->getMessage(), Override, 2217 AttrSpellingListIndex); 2218 else if (const auto *VA = dyn_cast<VisibilityAttr>(Attr)) 2219 NewAttr = S.mergeVisibilityAttr(D, VA->getRange(), VA->getVisibility(), 2220 AttrSpellingListIndex); 2221 else if (const auto *VA = dyn_cast<TypeVisibilityAttr>(Attr)) 2222 NewAttr = S.mergeTypeVisibilityAttr(D, VA->getRange(), VA->getVisibility(), 2223 AttrSpellingListIndex); 2224 else if (const auto *ImportA = dyn_cast<DLLImportAttr>(Attr)) 2225 NewAttr = S.mergeDLLImportAttr(D, ImportA->getRange(), 2226 AttrSpellingListIndex); 2227 else if (const auto *ExportA = dyn_cast<DLLExportAttr>(Attr)) 2228 NewAttr = S.mergeDLLExportAttr(D, ExportA->getRange(), 2229 AttrSpellingListIndex); 2230 else if (const auto *FA = dyn_cast<FormatAttr>(Attr)) 2231 NewAttr = S.mergeFormatAttr(D, FA->getRange(), FA->getType(), 2232 FA->getFormatIdx(), FA->getFirstArg(), 2233 AttrSpellingListIndex); 2234 else if (const auto *SA = dyn_cast<SectionAttr>(Attr)) 2235 NewAttr = S.mergeSectionAttr(D, SA->getRange(), SA->getName(), 2236 AttrSpellingListIndex); 2237 else if (const auto *IA = dyn_cast<MSInheritanceAttr>(Attr)) 2238 NewAttr = S.mergeMSInheritanceAttr(D, IA->getRange(), IA->getBestCase(), 2239 AttrSpellingListIndex, 2240 IA->getSemanticSpelling()); 2241 else if (const auto *AA = dyn_cast<AlwaysInlineAttr>(Attr)) 2242 NewAttr = S.mergeAlwaysInlineAttr(D, AA->getRange(), 2243 &S.Context.Idents.get(AA->getSpelling()), 2244 AttrSpellingListIndex); 2245 else if (const auto *MA = dyn_cast<MinSizeAttr>(Attr)) 2246 NewAttr = S.mergeMinSizeAttr(D, MA->getRange(), AttrSpellingListIndex); 2247 else if (const auto *OA = dyn_cast<OptimizeNoneAttr>(Attr)) 2248 NewAttr = S.mergeOptimizeNoneAttr(D, OA->getRange(), AttrSpellingListIndex); 2249 else if (isa<AlignedAttr>(Attr)) 2250 // AlignedAttrs are handled separately, because we need to handle all 2251 // such attributes on a declaration at the same time. 2252 NewAttr = nullptr; 2253 else if (isa<DeprecatedAttr>(Attr) && Override) 2254 NewAttr = nullptr; 2255 else if (Attr->duplicatesAllowed() || !DeclHasAttr(D, Attr)) 2256 NewAttr = cast<InheritableAttr>(Attr->clone(S.Context)); 2257 2258 if (NewAttr) { 2259 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 2260 D->addAttr(NewAttr); 2261 return true; 2262 } 2263 2264 return false; 2265 } 2266 2267 static const Decl *getDefinition(const Decl *D) { 2268 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) 2269 return TD->getDefinition(); 2270 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 2271 const VarDecl *Def = VD->getDefinition(); 2272 if (Def) 2273 return Def; 2274 return VD->getActingDefinition(); 2275 } 2276 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 2277 const FunctionDecl* Def; 2278 if (FD->isDefined(Def)) 2279 return Def; 2280 } 2281 return nullptr; 2282 } 2283 2284 static bool hasAttribute(const Decl *D, attr::Kind Kind) { 2285 for (const auto *Attribute : D->attrs()) 2286 if (Attribute->getKind() == Kind) 2287 return true; 2288 return false; 2289 } 2290 2291 /// checkNewAttributesAfterDef - If we already have a definition, check that 2292 /// there are no new attributes in this declaration. 2293 static void checkNewAttributesAfterDef(Sema &S, Decl *New, const Decl *Old) { 2294 if (!New->hasAttrs()) 2295 return; 2296 2297 const Decl *Def = getDefinition(Old); 2298 if (!Def || Def == New) 2299 return; 2300 2301 AttrVec &NewAttributes = New->getAttrs(); 2302 for (unsigned I = 0, E = NewAttributes.size(); I != E;) { 2303 const Attr *NewAttribute = NewAttributes[I]; 2304 2305 if (isa<AliasAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2306 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(New)) 2307 S.CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FD, cast<FunctionDecl>(Def)); 2308 else { 2309 VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(New); 2310 unsigned Diag = cast<VarDecl>(Def)->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == 2311 VarDecl::TentativeDefinition 2312 ? diag::err_alias_after_tentative 2313 : diag::err_redefinition; 2314 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), Diag) << VD->getDeclName(); 2315 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 2316 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 2317 } 2318 ++I; 2319 continue; 2320 } 2321 2322 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Def)) { 2323 // Tentative definitions are only interesting for the alias check above. 2324 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() != VarDecl::Definition) { 2325 ++I; 2326 continue; 2327 } 2328 } 2329 2330 if (hasAttribute(Def, NewAttribute->getKind())) { 2331 ++I; 2332 continue; // regular attr merging will take care of validating this. 2333 } 2334 2335 if (isa<C11NoReturnAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2336 // C's _Noreturn is allowed to be added to a function after it is defined. 2337 ++I; 2338 continue; 2339 } else if (const AlignedAttr *AA = dyn_cast<AlignedAttr>(NewAttribute)) { 2340 if (AA->isAlignas()) { 2341 // C++11 [dcl.align]p6: 2342 // if any declaration of an entity has an alignment-specifier, 2343 // every defining declaration of that entity shall specify an 2344 // equivalent alignment. 2345 // C11 6.7.5/7: 2346 // If the definition of an object does not have an alignment 2347 // specifier, any other declaration of that object shall also 2348 // have no alignment specifier. 2349 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_missing_on_definition) 2350 << AA; 2351 S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), diag::note_alignas_on_declaration) 2352 << AA; 2353 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2354 --E; 2355 continue; 2356 } 2357 } 2358 2359 S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), 2360 diag::warn_attribute_precede_definition); 2361 S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 2362 NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I); 2363 --E; 2364 } 2365 } 2366 2367 /// mergeDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the Old decl to the New one. 2368 void Sema::mergeDeclAttributes(NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old, 2369 AvailabilityMergeKind AMK) { 2370 if (UsedAttr *OldAttr = Old->getMostRecentDecl()->getAttr<UsedAttr>()) { 2371 UsedAttr *NewAttr = OldAttr->clone(Context); 2372 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 2373 New->addAttr(NewAttr); 2374 } 2375 2376 if (!Old->hasAttrs() && !New->hasAttrs()) 2377 return; 2378 2379 // attributes declared post-definition are currently ignored 2380 checkNewAttributesAfterDef(*this, New, Old); 2381 2382 if (!Old->hasAttrs()) 2383 return; 2384 2385 bool foundAny = New->hasAttrs(); 2386 2387 // Ensure that any moving of objects within the allocated map is done before 2388 // we process them. 2389 if (!foundAny) New->setAttrs(AttrVec()); 2390 2391 for (auto *I : Old->specific_attrs<InheritableAttr>()) { 2392 bool Override = false; 2393 // Ignore deprecated/unavailable/availability attributes if requested. 2394 if (isa<DeprecatedAttr>(I) || 2395 isa<UnavailableAttr>(I) || 2396 isa<AvailabilityAttr>(I)) { 2397 switch (AMK) { 2398 case AMK_None: 2399 continue; 2400 2401 case AMK_Redeclaration: 2402 break; 2403 2404 case AMK_Override: 2405 Override = true; 2406 break; 2407 } 2408 } 2409 2410 // Already handled. 2411 if (isa<UsedAttr>(I)) 2412 continue; 2413 2414 if (mergeDeclAttribute(*this, New, I, Override)) 2415 foundAny = true; 2416 } 2417 2418 if (mergeAlignedAttrs(*this, New, Old)) 2419 foundAny = true; 2420 2421 if (!foundAny) New->dropAttrs(); 2422 } 2423 2424 /// mergeParamDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the old parameter 2425 /// to the new one. 2426 static void mergeParamDeclAttributes(ParmVarDecl *newDecl, 2427 const ParmVarDecl *oldDecl, 2428 Sema &S) { 2429 // C++11 [dcl.attr.depend]p2: 2430 // The first declaration of a function shall specify the 2431 // carries_dependency attribute for its declarator-id if any declaration 2432 // of the function specifies the carries_dependency attribute. 2433 const CarriesDependencyAttr *CDA = newDecl->getAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>(); 2434 if (CDA && !oldDecl->hasAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>()) { 2435 S.Diag(CDA->getLocation(), 2436 diag::err_carries_dependency_missing_on_first_decl) << 1/*Param*/; 2437 // Find the first declaration of the parameter. 2438 // FIXME: Should we build redeclaration chains for function parameters? 2439 const FunctionDecl *FirstFD = 2440 cast<FunctionDecl>(oldDecl->getDeclContext())->getFirstDecl(); 2441 const ParmVarDecl *FirstVD = 2442 FirstFD->getParamDecl(oldDecl->getFunctionScopeIndex()); 2443 S.Diag(FirstVD->getLocation(), 2444 diag::note_carries_dependency_missing_first_decl) << 1/*Param*/; 2445 } 2446 2447 if (!oldDecl->hasAttrs()) 2448 return; 2449 2450 bool foundAny = newDecl->hasAttrs(); 2451 2452 // Ensure that any moving of objects within the allocated map is 2453 // done before we process them. 2454 if (!foundAny) newDecl->setAttrs(AttrVec()); 2455 2456 for (const auto *I : oldDecl->specific_attrs<InheritableParamAttr>()) { 2457 if (!DeclHasAttr(newDecl, I)) { 2458 InheritableAttr *newAttr = 2459 cast<InheritableParamAttr>(I->clone(S.Context)); 2460 newAttr->setInherited(true); 2461 newDecl->addAttr(newAttr); 2462 foundAny = true; 2463 } 2464 } 2465 2466 if (!foundAny) newDecl->dropAttrs(); 2467 } 2468 2469 static void mergeParamDeclTypes(ParmVarDecl *NewParam, 2470 const ParmVarDecl *OldParam, 2471 Sema &S) { 2472 if (auto Oldnullability = OldParam->getType()->getNullability(S.Context)) { 2473 if (auto Newnullability = NewParam->getType()->getNullability(S.Context)) { 2474 if (*Oldnullability != *Newnullability) { 2475 S.Diag(NewParam->getLocation(), diag::warn_mismatched_nullability_attr) 2476 << DiagNullabilityKind( 2477 *Newnullability, 2478 ((NewParam->getObjCDeclQualifier() & Decl::OBJC_TQ_CSNullability) 2479 != 0)) 2480 << DiagNullabilityKind( 2481 *Oldnullability, 2482 ((OldParam->getObjCDeclQualifier() & Decl::OBJC_TQ_CSNullability) 2483 != 0)); 2484 S.Diag(OldParam->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2485 } 2486 } else { 2487 QualType NewT = NewParam->getType(); 2488 NewT = S.Context.getAttributedType( 2489 AttributedType::getNullabilityAttrKind(*Oldnullability), 2490 NewT, NewT); 2491 NewParam->setType(NewT); 2492 } 2493 } 2494 } 2495 2496 namespace { 2497 2498 /// Used in MergeFunctionDecl to keep track of function parameters in 2499 /// C. 2500 struct GNUCompatibleParamWarning { 2501 ParmVarDecl *OldParm; 2502 ParmVarDecl *NewParm; 2503 QualType PromotedType; 2504 }; 2505 2506 } 2507 2508 /// getSpecialMember - get the special member enum for a method. 2509 Sema::CXXSpecialMember Sema::getSpecialMember(const CXXMethodDecl *MD) { 2510 if (const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD)) { 2511 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor()) 2512 return Sema::CXXDefaultConstructor; 2513 2514 if (Ctor->isCopyConstructor()) 2515 return Sema::CXXCopyConstructor; 2516 2517 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor()) 2518 return Sema::CXXMoveConstructor; 2519 } else if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD)) { 2520 return Sema::CXXDestructor; 2521 } else if (MD->isCopyAssignmentOperator()) { 2522 return Sema::CXXCopyAssignment; 2523 } else if (MD->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) { 2524 return Sema::CXXMoveAssignment; 2525 } 2526 2527 return Sema::CXXInvalid; 2528 } 2529 2530 // Determine whether the previous declaration was a definition, implicit 2531 // declaration, or a declaration. 2532 template <typename T> 2533 static std::pair<diag::kind, SourceLocation> 2534 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(const T *Old, const T *New) { 2535 diag::kind PrevDiag; 2536 SourceLocation OldLocation = Old->getLocation(); 2537 if (Old->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 2538 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_definition; 2539 else if (Old->isImplicit()) { 2540 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_implicit_declaration; 2541 if (OldLocation.isInvalid()) 2542 OldLocation = New->getLocation(); 2543 } else 2544 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_declaration; 2545 return std::make_pair(PrevDiag, OldLocation); 2546 } 2547 2548 /// canRedefineFunction - checks if a function can be redefined. Currently, 2549 /// only extern inline functions can be redefined, and even then only in 2550 /// GNU89 mode. 2551 static bool canRedefineFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD, 2552 const LangOptions& LangOpts) { 2553 return ((FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() || LangOpts.GNUInline) && 2554 !LangOpts.CPlusPlus && 2555 FD->isInlineSpecified() && 2556 FD->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern); 2557 } 2558 2559 const AttributedType *Sema::getCallingConvAttributedType(QualType T) const { 2560 const AttributedType *AT = T->getAs<AttributedType>(); 2561 while (AT && !AT->isCallingConv()) 2562 AT = AT->getModifiedType()->getAs<AttributedType>(); 2563 return AT; 2564 } 2565 2566 template <typename T> 2567 static bool haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(const T *Old, const T *New) { 2568 const DeclContext *DC = Old->getDeclContext(); 2569 if (DC->isRecord()) 2570 return false; 2571 2572 LanguageLinkage OldLinkage = Old->getLanguageLinkage(); 2573 if (OldLinkage == CXXLanguageLinkage && New->isInExternCContext()) 2574 return true; 2575 if (OldLinkage == CLanguageLinkage && New->isInExternCXXContext()) 2576 return true; 2577 return false; 2578 } 2579 2580 template<typename T> static bool isExternC(T *D) { return D->isExternC(); } 2581 static bool isExternC(VarTemplateDecl *) { return false; } 2582 2583 /// \brief Check whether a redeclaration of an entity introduced by a 2584 /// using-declaration is valid, given that we know it's not an overload 2585 /// (nor a hidden tag declaration). 2586 template<typename ExpectedDecl> 2587 static bool checkUsingShadowRedecl(Sema &S, UsingShadowDecl *OldS, 2588 ExpectedDecl *New) { 2589 // C++11 [basic.scope.declarative]p4: 2590 // Given a set of declarations in a single declarative region, each of 2591 // which specifies the same unqualified name, 2592 // -- they shall all refer to the same entity, or all refer to functions 2593 // and function templates; or 2594 // -- exactly one declaration shall declare a class name or enumeration 2595 // name that is not a typedef name and the other declarations shall all 2596 // refer to the same variable or enumerator, or all refer to functions 2597 // and function templates; in this case the class name or enumeration 2598 // name is hidden (3.3.10). 2599 2600 // C++11 [namespace.udecl]p14: 2601 // If a function declaration in namespace scope or block scope has the 2602 // same name and the same parameter-type-list as a function introduced 2603 // by a using-declaration, and the declarations do not declare the same 2604 // function, the program is ill-formed. 2605 2606 auto *Old = dyn_cast<ExpectedDecl>(OldS->getTargetDecl()); 2607 if (Old && 2608 !Old->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals( 2609 New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) && 2610 !(isExternC(Old) && isExternC(New))) 2611 Old = nullptr; 2612 2613 if (!Old) { 2614 S.Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_using_decl_conflict_reverse); 2615 S.Diag(OldS->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl_target); 2616 S.Diag(OldS->getUsingDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) << 0; 2617 return true; 2618 } 2619 return false; 2620 } 2621 2622 /// MergeFunctionDecl - We just parsed a function 'New' from 2623 /// declarator D which has the same name and scope as a previous 2624 /// declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to resolve this situation, 2625 /// merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate. 2626 /// 2627 /// In C++, New and Old must be declarations that are not 2628 /// overloaded. Use IsOverload to determine whether New and Old are 2629 /// overloaded, and to select the Old declaration that New should be 2630 /// merged with. 2631 /// 2632 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise. 2633 bool Sema::MergeFunctionDecl(FunctionDecl *New, NamedDecl *&OldD, 2634 Scope *S, bool MergeTypeWithOld) { 2635 // Verify the old decl was also a function. 2636 FunctionDecl *Old = OldD->getAsFunction(); 2637 if (!Old) { 2638 if (UsingShadowDecl *Shadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) { 2639 if (New->getFriendObjectKind()) { 2640 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_using_decl_friend); 2641 Diag(Shadow->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), 2642 diag::note_using_decl_target); 2643 Diag(Shadow->getUsingDecl()->getLocation(), 2644 diag::note_using_decl) << 0; 2645 return true; 2646 } 2647 2648 // Check whether the two declarations might declare the same function. 2649 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<FunctionDecl>(*this, Shadow, New)) 2650 return true; 2651 OldD = Old = cast<FunctionDecl>(Shadow->getTargetDecl()); 2652 } else { 2653 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) 2654 << New->getDeclName(); 2655 Diag(OldD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 2656 return true; 2657 } 2658 } 2659 2660 // If the old declaration is invalid, just give up here. 2661 if (Old->isInvalidDecl()) 2662 return true; 2663 2664 diag::kind PrevDiag; 2665 SourceLocation OldLocation; 2666 std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) = 2667 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New); 2668 2669 // Don't complain about this if we're in GNU89 mode and the old function 2670 // is an extern inline function. 2671 // Don't complain about specializations. They are not supposed to have 2672 // storage classes. 2673 if (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(New) && !isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Old) && 2674 New->getStorageClass() == SC_Static && 2675 Old->hasExternalFormalLinkage() && 2676 !New->getTemplateSpecializationInfo() && 2677 !canRedefineFunction(Old, getLangOpts())) { 2678 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) { 2679 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_static_non_static) << New; 2680 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 2681 } else { 2682 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_static_non_static) << New; 2683 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 2684 return true; 2685 } 2686 } 2687 2688 2689 // If a function is first declared with a calling convention, but is later 2690 // declared or defined without one, all following decls assume the calling 2691 // convention of the first. 2692 // 2693 // It's OK if a function is first declared without a calling convention, 2694 // but is later declared or defined with the default calling convention. 2695 // 2696 // To test if either decl has an explicit calling convention, we look for 2697 // AttributedType sugar nodes on the type as written. If they are missing or 2698 // were canonicalized away, we assume the calling convention was implicit. 2699 // 2700 // Note also that we DO NOT return at this point, because we still have 2701 // other tests to run. 2702 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 2703 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 2704 const FunctionType *OldType = cast<FunctionType>(OldQType); 2705 const FunctionType *NewType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType); 2706 FunctionType::ExtInfo OldTypeInfo = OldType->getExtInfo(); 2707 FunctionType::ExtInfo NewTypeInfo = NewType->getExtInfo(); 2708 bool RequiresAdjustment = false; 2709 2710 if (OldTypeInfo.getCC() != NewTypeInfo.getCC()) { 2711 FunctionDecl *First = Old->getFirstDecl(); 2712 const FunctionType *FT = 2713 First->getType().getCanonicalType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 2714 FunctionType::ExtInfo FI = FT->getExtInfo(); 2715 bool NewCCExplicit = getCallingConvAttributedType(New->getType()); 2716 if (!NewCCExplicit) { 2717 // Inherit the CC from the previous declaration if it was specified 2718 // there but not here. 2719 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withCallingConv(OldTypeInfo.getCC()); 2720 RequiresAdjustment = true; 2721 } else { 2722 // Calling conventions aren't compatible, so complain. 2723 bool FirstCCExplicit = getCallingConvAttributedType(First->getType()); 2724 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_cconv_change) 2725 << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(NewTypeInfo.getCC()) 2726 << !FirstCCExplicit 2727 << (!FirstCCExplicit ? "" : 2728 FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(FI.getCC())); 2729 2730 // Put the note on the first decl, since it is the one that matters. 2731 Diag(First->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 2732 return true; 2733 } 2734 } 2735 2736 // FIXME: diagnose the other way around? 2737 if (OldTypeInfo.getNoReturn() && !NewTypeInfo.getNoReturn()) { 2738 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withNoReturn(true); 2739 RequiresAdjustment = true; 2740 } 2741 2742 // Merge regparm attribute. 2743 if (OldTypeInfo.getHasRegParm() != NewTypeInfo.getHasRegParm() || 2744 OldTypeInfo.getRegParm() != NewTypeInfo.getRegParm()) { 2745 if (NewTypeInfo.getHasRegParm()) { 2746 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_regparm_mismatch) 2747 << NewType->getRegParmType() 2748 << OldType->getRegParmType(); 2749 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration); 2750 return true; 2751 } 2752 2753 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withRegParm(OldTypeInfo.getRegParm()); 2754 RequiresAdjustment = true; 2755 } 2756 2757 // Merge ns_returns_retained attribute. 2758 if (OldTypeInfo.getProducesResult() != NewTypeInfo.getProducesResult()) { 2759 if (NewTypeInfo.getProducesResult()) { 2760 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_returns_retained_mismatch); 2761 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration); 2762 return true; 2763 } 2764 2765 NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withProducesResult(true); 2766 RequiresAdjustment = true; 2767 } 2768 2769 if (RequiresAdjustment) { 2770 const FunctionType *AdjustedType = New->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 2771 AdjustedType = Context.adjustFunctionType(AdjustedType, NewTypeInfo); 2772 New->setType(QualType(AdjustedType, 0)); 2773 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 2774 NewType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType); 2775 } 2776 2777 // If this redeclaration makes the function inline, we may need to add it to 2778 // UndefinedButUsed. 2779 if (!Old->isInlined() && New->isInlined() && 2780 !New->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() && 2781 !getLangOpts().GNUInline && 2782 Old->isUsed(false) && 2783 !Old->isDefined() && !New->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 2784 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Old->getCanonicalDecl(), 2785 SourceLocation())); 2786 2787 // If this redeclaration makes it newly gnu_inline, we don't want to warn 2788 // about it. 2789 if (New->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() && 2790 Old->isInlined() && !Old->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) { 2791 UndefinedButUsed.erase(Old->getCanonicalDecl()); 2792 } 2793 2794 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2795 // (C++98 13.1p2): 2796 // Certain function declarations cannot be overloaded: 2797 // -- Function declarations that differ only in the return type 2798 // cannot be overloaded. 2799 2800 // Go back to the type source info to compare the declared return types, 2801 // per C++1y [dcl.type.auto]p13: 2802 // Redeclarations or specializations of a function or function template 2803 // with a declared return type that uses a placeholder type shall also 2804 // use that placeholder, not a deduced type. 2805 QualType OldDeclaredReturnType = 2806 (Old->getTypeSourceInfo() 2807 ? Old->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>() 2808 : OldType)->getReturnType(); 2809 QualType NewDeclaredReturnType = 2810 (New->getTypeSourceInfo() 2811 ? New->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>() 2812 : NewType)->getReturnType(); 2813 QualType ResQT; 2814 if (!Context.hasSameType(OldDeclaredReturnType, NewDeclaredReturnType) && 2815 !((NewQType->isDependentType() || OldQType->isDependentType()) && 2816 New->isLocalExternDecl())) { 2817 if (NewDeclaredReturnType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 2818 OldDeclaredReturnType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 2819 ResQT = Context.mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewQType, OldQType); 2820 if (ResQT.isNull()) { 2821 if (New->isCXXClassMember() && New->isOutOfLine()) 2822 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_member_def_does_not_match_ret_type) 2823 << New << New->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 2824 else 2825 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_ovl_diff_return_type) 2826 << New->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 2827 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType() 2828 << Old->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 2829 return true; 2830 } 2831 else 2832 NewQType = ResQT; 2833 } 2834 2835 QualType OldReturnType = OldType->getReturnType(); 2836 QualType NewReturnType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType)->getReturnType(); 2837 if (OldReturnType != NewReturnType) { 2838 // If this function has a deduced return type and has already been 2839 // defined, copy the deduced value from the old declaration. 2840 AutoType *OldAT = Old->getReturnType()->getContainedAutoType(); 2841 if (OldAT && OldAT->isDeduced()) { 2842 New->setType( 2843 SubstAutoType(New->getType(), 2844 OldAT->isDependentType() ? Context.DependentTy 2845 : OldAT->getDeducedType())); 2846 NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType( 2847 SubstAutoType(NewQType, 2848 OldAT->isDependentType() ? Context.DependentTy 2849 : OldAT->getDeducedType())); 2850 } 2851 } 2852 2853 const CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old); 2854 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New); 2855 if (OldMethod && NewMethod) { 2856 // Preserve triviality. 2857 NewMethod->setTrivial(OldMethod->isTrivial()); 2858 2859 // MSVC allows explicit template specialization at class scope: 2860 // 2 CXXMethodDecls referring to the same function will be injected. 2861 // We don't want a redeclaration error. 2862 bool IsClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = 2863 OldMethod->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization() && 2864 NewMethod->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization(); 2865 bool isFriend = NewMethod->getFriendObjectKind(); 2866 2867 if (!isFriend && NewMethod->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord() && 2868 !IsClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) { 2869 // -- Member function declarations with the same name and the 2870 // same parameter types cannot be overloaded if any of them 2871 // is a static member function declaration. 2872 if (OldMethod->isStatic() != NewMethod->isStatic()) { 2873 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_ovl_static_nonstatic_member); 2874 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 2875 return true; 2876 } 2877 2878 // C++ [class.mem]p1: 2879 // [...] A member shall not be declared twice in the 2880 // member-specification, except that a nested class or member 2881 // class template can be declared and then later defined. 2882 if (ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) { 2883 unsigned NewDiag; 2884 if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(OldMethod)) 2885 NewDiag = diag::err_constructor_redeclared; 2886 else if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewMethod)) 2887 NewDiag = diag::err_destructor_redeclared; 2888 else if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(NewMethod)) 2889 NewDiag = diag::err_conv_function_redeclared; 2890 else 2891 NewDiag = diag::err_member_redeclared; 2892 2893 Diag(New->getLocation(), NewDiag); 2894 } else { 2895 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_member_redeclared_in_instantiation) 2896 << New << New->getType(); 2897 } 2898 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 2899 return true; 2900 2901 // Complain if this is an explicit declaration of a special 2902 // member that was initially declared implicitly. 2903 // 2904 // As an exception, it's okay to befriend such methods in order 2905 // to permit the implicit constructor/destructor/operator calls. 2906 } else if (OldMethod->isImplicit()) { 2907 if (isFriend) { 2908 NewMethod->setImplicit(); 2909 } else { 2910 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), 2911 diag::err_definition_of_implicitly_declared_member) 2912 << New << getSpecialMember(OldMethod); 2913 return true; 2914 } 2915 } else if (OldMethod->isExplicitlyDefaulted() && !isFriend) { 2916 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), 2917 diag::err_definition_of_explicitly_defaulted_member) 2918 << getSpecialMember(OldMethod); 2919 return true; 2920 } 2921 } 2922 2923 // C++11 [dcl.attr.noreturn]p1: 2924 // The first declaration of a function shall specify the noreturn 2925 // attribute if any declaration of that function specifies the noreturn 2926 // attribute. 2927 const CXX11NoReturnAttr *NRA = New->getAttr<CXX11NoReturnAttr>(); 2928 if (NRA && !Old->hasAttr<CXX11NoReturnAttr>()) { 2929 Diag(NRA->getLocation(), diag::err_noreturn_missing_on_first_decl); 2930 Diag(Old->getFirstDecl()->getLocation(), 2931 diag::note_noreturn_missing_first_decl); 2932 } 2933 2934 // C++11 [dcl.attr.depend]p2: 2935 // The first declaration of a function shall specify the 2936 // carries_dependency attribute for its declarator-id if any declaration 2937 // of the function specifies the carries_dependency attribute. 2938 const CarriesDependencyAttr *CDA = New->getAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>(); 2939 if (CDA && !Old->hasAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>()) { 2940 Diag(CDA->getLocation(), 2941 diag::err_carries_dependency_missing_on_first_decl) << 0/*Function*/; 2942 Diag(Old->getFirstDecl()->getLocation(), 2943 diag::note_carries_dependency_missing_first_decl) << 0/*Function*/; 2944 } 2945 2946 // (C++98 8.3.5p3): 2947 // All declarations for a function shall agree exactly in both the 2948 // return type and the parameter-type-list. 2949 // We also want to respect all the extended bits except noreturn. 2950 2951 // noreturn should now match unless the old type info didn't have it. 2952 QualType OldQTypeForComparison = OldQType; 2953 if (!OldTypeInfo.getNoReturn() && NewTypeInfo.getNoReturn()) { 2954 assert(OldQType == QualType(OldType, 0)); 2955 const FunctionType *OldTypeForComparison 2956 = Context.adjustFunctionType(OldType, OldTypeInfo.withNoReturn(true)); 2957 OldQTypeForComparison = QualType(OldTypeForComparison, 0); 2958 assert(OldQTypeForComparison.isCanonical()); 2959 } 2960 2961 if (haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(Old, New)) { 2962 // As a special case, retain the language linkage from previous 2963 // declarations of a friend function as an extension. 2964 // 2965 // This liberal interpretation of C++ [class.friend]p3 matches GCC/MSVC 2966 // and is useful because there's otherwise no way to specify language 2967 // linkage within class scope. 2968 // 2969 // Check cautiously as the friend object kind isn't yet complete. 2970 if (New->getFriendObjectKind() != Decl::FOK_None) { 2971 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_retained_language_linkage) << New; 2972 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 2973 } else { 2974 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_language_linkage) << New; 2975 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 2976 return true; 2977 } 2978 } 2979 2980 if (OldQTypeForComparison == NewQType) 2981 return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld); 2982 2983 if ((NewQType->isDependentType() || OldQType->isDependentType()) && 2984 New->isLocalExternDecl()) { 2985 // It's OK if we couldn't merge types for a local function declaraton 2986 // if either the old or new type is dependent. We'll merge the types 2987 // when we instantiate the function. 2988 return false; 2989 } 2990 2991 // Fall through for conflicting redeclarations and redefinitions. 2992 } 2993 2994 // C: Function types need to be compatible, not identical. This handles 2995 // duplicate function decls like "void f(int); void f(enum X);" properly. 2996 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2997 Context.typesAreCompatible(OldQType, NewQType)) { 2998 const FunctionType *OldFuncType = OldQType->getAs<FunctionType>(); 2999 const FunctionType *NewFuncType = NewQType->getAs<FunctionType>(); 3000 const FunctionProtoType *OldProto = nullptr; 3001 if (MergeTypeWithOld && isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewFuncType) && 3002 (OldProto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldFuncType))) { 3003 // The old declaration provided a function prototype, but the 3004 // new declaration does not. Merge in the prototype. 3005 assert(!OldProto->hasExceptionSpec() && "Exception spec in C"); 3006 SmallVector<QualType, 16> ParamTypes(OldProto->param_types()); 3007 NewQType = 3008 Context.getFunctionType(NewFuncType->getReturnType(), ParamTypes, 3009 OldProto->getExtProtoInfo()); 3010 New->setType(NewQType); 3011 New->setHasInheritedPrototype(); 3012 3013 // Synthesize parameters with the same types. 3014 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params; 3015 for (const auto &ParamType : OldProto->param_types()) { 3016 ParmVarDecl *Param = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, New, SourceLocation(), 3017 SourceLocation(), nullptr, 3018 ParamType, /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 3019 SC_None, nullptr); 3020 Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size()); 3021 Param->setImplicit(); 3022 Params.push_back(Param); 3023 } 3024 3025 New->setParams(Params); 3026 } 3027 3028 return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld); 3029 } 3030 3031 // GNU C permits a K&R definition to follow a prototype declaration 3032 // if the declared types of the parameters in the K&R definition 3033 // match the types in the prototype declaration, even when the 3034 // promoted types of the parameters from the K&R definition differ 3035 // from the types in the prototype. GCC then keeps the types from 3036 // the prototype. 3037 // 3038 // If a variadic prototype is followed by a non-variadic K&R definition, 3039 // the K&R definition becomes variadic. This is sort of an edge case, but 3040 // it's legal per the standard depending on how you read C99 6.7.5.3p15 and 3041 // C99 6.9.1p8. 3042 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 3043 Old->hasPrototype() && !New->hasPrototype() && 3044 New->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>() && 3045 Old->getNumParams() == New->getNumParams()) { 3046 SmallVector<QualType, 16> ArgTypes; 3047 SmallVector<GNUCompatibleParamWarning, 16> Warnings; 3048 const FunctionProtoType *OldProto 3049 = Old->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3050 const FunctionProtoType *NewProto 3051 = New->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3052 3053 // Determine whether this is the GNU C extension. 3054 QualType MergedReturn = Context.mergeTypes(OldProto->getReturnType(), 3055 NewProto->getReturnType()); 3056 bool LooseCompatible = !MergedReturn.isNull(); 3057 for (unsigned Idx = 0, End = Old->getNumParams(); 3058 LooseCompatible && Idx != End; ++Idx) { 3059 ParmVarDecl *OldParm = Old->getParamDecl(Idx); 3060 ParmVarDecl *NewParm = New->getParamDecl(Idx); 3061 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldParm->getType(), 3062 NewProto->getParamType(Idx))) { 3063 ArgTypes.push_back(NewParm->getType()); 3064 } else if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldParm->getType(), 3065 NewParm->getType(), 3066 /*CompareUnqualified=*/true)) { 3067 GNUCompatibleParamWarning Warn = { OldParm, NewParm, 3068 NewProto->getParamType(Idx) }; 3069 Warnings.push_back(Warn); 3070 ArgTypes.push_back(NewParm->getType()); 3071 } else 3072 LooseCompatible = false; 3073 } 3074 3075 if (LooseCompatible) { 3076 for (unsigned Warn = 0; Warn < Warnings.size(); ++Warn) { 3077 Diag(Warnings[Warn].NewParm->getLocation(), 3078 diag::ext_param_promoted_not_compatible_with_prototype) 3079 << Warnings[Warn].PromotedType 3080 << Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getType(); 3081 if (Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getLocation().isValid()) 3082 Diag(Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getLocation(), 3083 diag::note_previous_declaration); 3084 } 3085 3086 if (MergeTypeWithOld) 3087 New->setType(Context.getFunctionType(MergedReturn, ArgTypes, 3088 OldProto->getExtProtoInfo())); 3089 return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld); 3090 } 3091 3092 // Fall through to diagnose conflicting types. 3093 } 3094 3095 // A function that has already been declared has been redeclared or 3096 // defined with a different type; show an appropriate diagnostic. 3097 3098 // If the previous declaration was an implicitly-generated builtin 3099 // declaration, then at the very least we should use a specialized note. 3100 unsigned BuiltinID; 3101 if (Old->isImplicit() && (BuiltinID = Old->getBuiltinID())) { 3102 // If it's actually a library-defined builtin function like 'malloc' 3103 // or 'printf', just warn about the incompatible redeclaration. 3104 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID)) { 3105 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_redecl_library_builtin) << New; 3106 Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration) 3107 << Old << Old->getType(); 3108 3109 // If this is a global redeclaration, just forget hereafter 3110 // about the "builtin-ness" of the function. 3111 // 3112 // Doing this for local extern declarations is problematic. If 3113 // the builtin declaration remains visible, a second invalid 3114 // local declaration will produce a hard error; if it doesn't 3115 // remain visible, a single bogus local redeclaration (which is 3116 // actually only a warning) could break all the downstream code. 3117 if (!New->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 3118 New->getIdentifier()->setBuiltinID(Builtin::NotBuiltin); 3119 3120 return false; 3121 } 3122 3123 PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration; 3124 } 3125 3126 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_conflicting_types) << New->getDeclName(); 3127 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType(); 3128 return true; 3129 } 3130 3131 /// \brief Completes the merge of two function declarations that are 3132 /// known to be compatible. 3133 /// 3134 /// This routine handles the merging of attributes and other 3135 /// properties of function declarations from the old declaration to 3136 /// the new declaration, once we know that New is in fact a 3137 /// redeclaration of Old. 3138 /// 3139 /// \returns false 3140 bool Sema::MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old, 3141 Scope *S, bool MergeTypeWithOld) { 3142 // Merge the attributes 3143 mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old); 3144 3145 // Merge "pure" flag. 3146 if (Old->isPure()) 3147 New->setPure(); 3148 3149 // Merge "used" flag. 3150 if (Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isUsed(false)) 3151 New->setIsUsed(); 3152 3153 // Merge attributes from the parameters. These can mismatch with K&R 3154 // declarations. 3155 if (New->getNumParams() == Old->getNumParams()) 3156 for (unsigned i = 0, e = New->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 3157 ParmVarDecl *NewParam = New->getParamDecl(i); 3158 ParmVarDecl *OldParam = Old->getParamDecl(i); 3159 mergeParamDeclAttributes(NewParam, OldParam, *this); 3160 mergeParamDeclTypes(NewParam, OldParam, *this); 3161 } 3162 3163 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 3164 return MergeCXXFunctionDecl(New, Old, S); 3165 3166 // Merge the function types so the we get the composite types for the return 3167 // and argument types. Per C11 6.2.7/4, only update the type if the old decl 3168 // was visible. 3169 QualType Merged = Context.mergeTypes(Old->getType(), New->getType()); 3170 if (!Merged.isNull() && MergeTypeWithOld) 3171 New->setType(Merged); 3172 3173 return false; 3174 } 3175 3176 3177 void Sema::mergeObjCMethodDecls(ObjCMethodDecl *newMethod, 3178 ObjCMethodDecl *oldMethod) { 3179 3180 // Merge the attributes, including deprecated/unavailable 3181 AvailabilityMergeKind MergeKind = 3182 isa<ObjCImplDecl>(newMethod->getDeclContext()) ? AMK_Redeclaration 3183 : AMK_Override; 3184 mergeDeclAttributes(newMethod, oldMethod, MergeKind); 3185 3186 // Merge attributes from the parameters. 3187 ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator oi = oldMethod->param_begin(), 3188 oe = oldMethod->param_end(); 3189 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator 3190 ni = newMethod->param_begin(), ne = newMethod->param_end(); 3191 ni != ne && oi != oe; ++ni, ++oi) 3192 mergeParamDeclAttributes(*ni, *oi, *this); 3193 3194 CheckObjCMethodOverride(newMethod, oldMethod); 3195 } 3196 3197 /// MergeVarDeclTypes - We parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name and 3198 /// scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to merge their types, 3199 /// emitting diagnostics as appropriate. 3200 /// 3201 /// Declarations using the auto type specifier (C++ [decl.spec.auto]) call back 3202 /// to here in AddInitializerToDecl. We can't check them before the initializer 3203 /// is attached. 3204 void Sema::MergeVarDeclTypes(VarDecl *New, VarDecl *Old, 3205 bool MergeTypeWithOld) { 3206 if (New->isInvalidDecl() || Old->isInvalidDecl()) 3207 return; 3208 3209 QualType MergedT; 3210 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3211 if (New->getType()->isUndeducedType()) { 3212 // We don't know what the new type is until the initializer is attached. 3213 return; 3214 } else if (Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), Old->getType())) { 3215 // These could still be something that needs exception specs checked. 3216 return MergeVarDeclExceptionSpecs(New, Old); 3217 } 3218 // C++ [basic.link]p10: 3219 // [...] the types specified by all declarations referring to a given 3220 // object or function shall be identical, except that declarations for an 3221 // array object can specify array types that differ by the presence or 3222 // absence of a major array bound (8.3.4). 3223 else if (Old->getType()->isIncompleteArrayType() && 3224 New->getType()->isArrayType()) { 3225 const ArrayType *OldArray = Context.getAsArrayType(Old->getType()); 3226 const ArrayType *NewArray = Context.getAsArrayType(New->getType()); 3227 if (Context.hasSameType(OldArray->getElementType(), 3228 NewArray->getElementType())) 3229 MergedT = New->getType(); 3230 } else if (Old->getType()->isArrayType() && 3231 New->getType()->isIncompleteArrayType()) { 3232 const ArrayType *OldArray = Context.getAsArrayType(Old->getType()); 3233 const ArrayType *NewArray = Context.getAsArrayType(New->getType()); 3234 if (Context.hasSameType(OldArray->getElementType(), 3235 NewArray->getElementType())) 3236 MergedT = Old->getType(); 3237 } else if (New->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 3238 Old->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 3239 MergedT = Context.mergeObjCGCQualifiers(New->getType(), 3240 Old->getType()); 3241 } 3242 } else { 3243 // C 6.2.7p2: 3244 // All declarations that refer to the same object or function shall have 3245 // compatible type. 3246 MergedT = Context.mergeTypes(New->getType(), Old->getType()); 3247 } 3248 if (MergedT.isNull()) { 3249 // It's OK if we couldn't merge types if either type is dependent, for a 3250 // block-scope variable. In other cases (static data members of class 3251 // templates, variable templates, ...), we require the types to be 3252 // equivalent. 3253 // FIXME: The C++ standard doesn't say anything about this. 3254 if ((New->getType()->isDependentType() || 3255 Old->getType()->isDependentType()) && New->isLocalVarDecl()) { 3256 // If the old type was dependent, we can't merge with it, so the new type 3257 // becomes dependent for now. We'll reproduce the original type when we 3258 // instantiate the TypeSourceInfo for the variable. 3259 if (!New->getType()->isDependentType() && MergeTypeWithOld) 3260 New->setType(Context.DependentTy); 3261 return; 3262 } 3263 3264 // FIXME: Even if this merging succeeds, some other non-visible declaration 3265 // of this variable might have an incompatible type. For instance: 3266 // 3267 // extern int arr[]; 3268 // void f() { extern int arr[2]; } 3269 // void g() { extern int arr[3]; } 3270 // 3271 // Neither C nor C++ requires a diagnostic for this, but we should still try 3272 // to diagnose it. 3273 Diag(New->getLocation(), New->isThisDeclarationADefinition() 3274 ? diag::err_redefinition_different_type 3275 : diag::err_redeclaration_different_type) 3276 << New->getDeclName() << New->getType() << Old->getType(); 3277 3278 diag::kind PrevDiag; 3279 SourceLocation OldLocation; 3280 std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) = 3281 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New); 3282 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3283 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 3284 } 3285 3286 // Don't actually update the type on the new declaration if the old 3287 // declaration was an extern declaration in a different scope. 3288 if (MergeTypeWithOld) 3289 New->setType(MergedT); 3290 } 3291 3292 static bool mergeTypeWithPrevious(Sema &S, VarDecl *NewVD, VarDecl *OldVD, 3293 LookupResult &Previous) { 3294 // C11 6.2.7p4: 3295 // For an identifier with internal or external linkage declared 3296 // in a scope in which a prior declaration of that identifier is 3297 // visible, if the prior declaration specifies internal or 3298 // external linkage, the type of the identifier at the later 3299 // declaration becomes the composite type. 3300 // 3301 // If the variable isn't visible, we do not merge with its type. 3302 if (Previous.isShadowed()) 3303 return false; 3304 3305 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3306 // C++11 [dcl.array]p3: 3307 // If there is a preceding declaration of the entity in the same 3308 // scope in which the bound was specified, an omitted array bound 3309 // is taken to be the same as in that earlier declaration. 3310 return NewVD->isPreviousDeclInSameBlockScope() || 3311 (!OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() && 3312 !NewVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()); 3313 } else { 3314 // If the old declaration was function-local, don't merge with its 3315 // type unless we're in the same function. 3316 return !OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() || 3317 OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext() == NewVD->getLexicalDeclContext(); 3318 } 3319 } 3320 3321 /// MergeVarDecl - We just parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name 3322 /// and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to resolve this 3323 /// situation, merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate. 3324 /// 3325 /// Tentative definition rules (C99 6.9.2p2) are checked by 3326 /// FinalizeDeclaratorGroup. Unfortunately, we can't analyze tentative 3327 /// definitions here, since the initializer hasn't been attached. 3328 /// 3329 void Sema::MergeVarDecl(VarDecl *New, LookupResult &Previous) { 3330 // If the new decl is already invalid, don't do any other checking. 3331 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) 3332 return; 3333 3334 VarTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedVarTemplate(); 3335 3336 // Verify the old decl was also a variable or variable template. 3337 VarDecl *Old = nullptr; 3338 VarTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = nullptr; 3339 if (Previous.isSingleResult()) { 3340 if (NewTemplate) { 3341 OldTemplate = dyn_cast<VarTemplateDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()); 3342 Old = OldTemplate ? OldTemplate->getTemplatedDecl() : nullptr; 3343 3344 if (auto *Shadow = 3345 dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl())) 3346 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<VarTemplateDecl>(*this, Shadow, NewTemplate)) 3347 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 3348 } else { 3349 Old = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()); 3350 3351 if (auto *Shadow = 3352 dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl())) 3353 if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<VarDecl>(*this, Shadow, New)) 3354 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 3355 } 3356 } 3357 if (!Old) { 3358 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) 3359 << New->getDeclName(); 3360 Diag(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl()->getLocation(), 3361 diag::note_previous_definition); 3362 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 3363 } 3364 3365 if (!shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(Old, New)) 3366 return; 3367 3368 // Ensure the template parameters are compatible. 3369 if (NewTemplate && 3370 !TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 3371 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 3372 /*Complain=*/true, TPL_TemplateMatch)) 3373 return; 3374 3375 // C++ [class.mem]p1: 3376 // A member shall not be declared twice in the member-specification [...] 3377 // 3378 // Here, we need only consider static data members. 3379 if (Old->isStaticDataMember() && !New->isOutOfLine()) { 3380 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_duplicate_member) 3381 << New->getIdentifier(); 3382 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3383 New->setInvalidDecl(); 3384 } 3385 3386 mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old); 3387 // Warn if an already-declared variable is made a weak_import in a subsequent 3388 // declaration 3389 if (New->hasAttr<WeakImportAttr>() && 3390 Old->getStorageClass() == SC_None && 3391 !Old->hasAttr<WeakImportAttr>()) { 3392 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_weak_import) << New->getDeclName(); 3393 Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 3394 // Remove weak_import attribute on new declaration. 3395 New->dropAttr<WeakImportAttr>(); 3396 } 3397 3398 // Merge the types. 3399 VarDecl *MostRecent = Old->getMostRecentDecl(); 3400 if (MostRecent != Old) { 3401 MergeVarDeclTypes(New, MostRecent, 3402 mergeTypeWithPrevious(*this, New, MostRecent, Previous)); 3403 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) 3404 return; 3405 } 3406 3407 MergeVarDeclTypes(New, Old, mergeTypeWithPrevious(*this, New, Old, Previous)); 3408 if (New->isInvalidDecl()) 3409 return; 3410 3411 diag::kind PrevDiag; 3412 SourceLocation OldLocation; 3413 std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) = 3414 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New); 3415 3416 // [dcl.stc]p8: Check if we have a non-static decl followed by a static. 3417 if (New->getStorageClass() == SC_Static && 3418 !New->isStaticDataMember() && 3419 Old->hasExternalFormalLinkage()) { 3420 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) { 3421 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_static_non_static) 3422 << New->getDeclName(); 3423 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3424 } else { 3425 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_static_non_static) 3426 << New->getDeclName(); 3427 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3428 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 3429 } 3430 } 3431 // C99 6.2.2p4: 3432 // For an identifier declared with the storage-class specifier 3433 // extern in a scope in which a prior declaration of that 3434 // identifier is visible,23) if the prior declaration specifies 3435 // internal or external linkage, the linkage of the identifier at 3436 // the later declaration is the same as the linkage specified at 3437 // the prior declaration. If no prior declaration is visible, or 3438 // if the prior declaration specifies no linkage, then the 3439 // identifier has external linkage. 3440 if (New->hasExternalStorage() && Old->hasLinkage()) 3441 /* Okay */; 3442 else if (New->getCanonicalDecl()->getStorageClass() != SC_Static && 3443 !New->isStaticDataMember() && 3444 Old->getCanonicalDecl()->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) { 3445 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_static_static) << New->getDeclName(); 3446 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3447 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 3448 } 3449 3450 // Check if extern is followed by non-extern and vice-versa. 3451 if (New->hasExternalStorage() && 3452 !Old->hasLinkage() && Old->isLocalVarDeclOrParm()) { 3453 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_extern_non_extern) << New->getDeclName(); 3454 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3455 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 3456 } 3457 if (Old->hasLinkage() && New->isLocalVarDeclOrParm() && 3458 !New->hasExternalStorage()) { 3459 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_extern_extern) << New->getDeclName(); 3460 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3461 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 3462 } 3463 3464 // Variables with external linkage are analyzed in FinalizeDeclaratorGroup. 3465 3466 // FIXME: The test for external storage here seems wrong? We still 3467 // need to check for mismatches. 3468 if (!New->hasExternalStorage() && !New->isFileVarDecl() && 3469 // Don't complain about out-of-line definitions of static members. 3470 !(Old->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord() && 3471 !New->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord())) { 3472 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << New->getDeclName(); 3473 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3474 return New->setInvalidDecl(); 3475 } 3476 3477 if (New->getTLSKind() != Old->getTLSKind()) { 3478 if (!Old->getTLSKind()) { 3479 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_non_thread) << New->getDeclName(); 3480 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3481 } else if (!New->getTLSKind()) { 3482 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_thread_thread) << New->getDeclName(); 3483 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3484 } else { 3485 // Do not allow redeclaration to change the variable between requiring 3486 // static and dynamic initialization. 3487 // FIXME: GCC allows this, but uses the TLS keyword on the first 3488 // declaration to determine the kind. Do we need to be compatible here? 3489 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_thread_different_kind) 3490 << New->getDeclName() << (New->getTLSKind() == VarDecl::TLS_Dynamic); 3491 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3492 } 3493 } 3494 3495 // C++ doesn't have tentative definitions, so go right ahead and check here. 3496 VarDecl *Def; 3497 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 3498 New->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::Definition && 3499 (Def = Old->getDefinition())) { 3500 NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr; 3501 if (!hasVisibleDefinition(Def, &Hidden) && 3502 (New->getFormalLinkage() == InternalLinkage || 3503 New->getDescribedVarTemplate() || 3504 New->getNumTemplateParameterLists() || 3505 New->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())) { 3506 // The previous definition is hidden, and multiple definitions are 3507 // permitted (in separate TUs). Form another definition of it. 3508 } else { 3509 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << New; 3510 Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 3511 New->setInvalidDecl(); 3512 return; 3513 } 3514 } 3515 3516 if (haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(Old, New)) { 3517 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_language_linkage) << New; 3518 Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag); 3519 New->setInvalidDecl(); 3520 return; 3521 } 3522 3523 // Merge "used" flag. 3524 if (Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isUsed(false)) 3525 New->setIsUsed(); 3526 3527 // Keep a chain of previous declarations. 3528 New->setPreviousDecl(Old); 3529 if (NewTemplate) 3530 NewTemplate->setPreviousDecl(OldTemplate); 3531 3532 // Inherit access appropriately. 3533 New->setAccess(Old->getAccess()); 3534 if (NewTemplate) 3535 NewTemplate->setAccess(New->getAccess()); 3536 } 3537 3538 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with 3539 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed. 3540 Decl *Sema::ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, 3541 DeclSpec &DS) { 3542 return ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(S, AS, DS, MultiTemplateParamsArg()); 3543 } 3544 3545 // The MS ABI changed between VS2013 and VS2015 with regard to numbers used to 3546 // disambiguate entities defined in different scopes. 3547 // While the VS2015 ABI fixes potential miscompiles, it is also breaks 3548 // compatibility. 3549 // We will pick our mangling number depending on which version of MSVC is being 3550 // targeted. 3551 static unsigned getMSManglingNumber(const LangOptions &LO, Scope *S) { 3552 return LO.isCompatibleWithMSVC(LangOptions::MSVC2015) 3553 ? S->getMSCurManglingNumber() 3554 : S->getMSLastManglingNumber(); 3555 } 3556 3557 void Sema::handleTagNumbering(const TagDecl *Tag, Scope *TagScope) { 3558 if (!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 3559 return; 3560 3561 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag->getParent())) { 3562 // If this tag is the direct child of a class, number it if 3563 // it is anonymous. 3564 if (!Tag->getName().empty() || Tag->getTypedefNameForAnonDecl()) 3565 return; 3566 MangleNumberingContext &MCtx = 3567 Context.getManglingNumberContext(Tag->getParent()); 3568 Context.setManglingNumber( 3569 Tag, MCtx.getManglingNumber( 3570 Tag, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), TagScope))); 3571 return; 3572 } 3573 3574 // If this tag isn't a direct child of a class, number it if it is local. 3575 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 3576 if (MangleNumberingContext *MCtx = getCurrentMangleNumberContext( 3577 Tag->getDeclContext(), ManglingContextDecl)) { 3578 Context.setManglingNumber( 3579 Tag, MCtx->getManglingNumber( 3580 Tag, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), TagScope))); 3581 } 3582 } 3583 3584 void Sema::setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(TagDecl *TagFromDeclSpec, 3585 TypedefNameDecl *NewTD) { 3586 // Do nothing if the tag is not anonymous or already has an 3587 // associated typedef (from an earlier typedef in this decl group). 3588 if (TagFromDeclSpec->getIdentifier()) 3589 return; 3590 if (TagFromDeclSpec->getTypedefNameForAnonDecl()) 3591 return; 3592 3593 // A well-formed anonymous tag must always be a TUK_Definition. 3594 assert(TagFromDeclSpec->isThisDeclarationADefinition()); 3595 3596 // The type must match the tag exactly; no qualifiers allowed. 3597 if (!Context.hasSameType(NewTD->getUnderlyingType(), 3598 Context.getTagDeclType(TagFromDeclSpec))) 3599 return; 3600 3601 // If we've already computed linkage for the anonymous tag, then 3602 // adding a typedef name for the anonymous decl can change that 3603 // linkage, which might be a serious problem. Diagnose this as 3604 // unsupported and ignore the typedef name. TODO: we should 3605 // pursue this as a language defect and establish a formal rule 3606 // for how to handle it. 3607 if (TagFromDeclSpec->hasLinkageBeenComputed()) { 3608 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_typedef_changes_linkage); 3609 3610 SourceLocation tagLoc = TagFromDeclSpec->getInnerLocStart(); 3611 tagLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(tagLoc); 3612 3613 llvm::SmallString<40> textToInsert; 3614 textToInsert += ' '; 3615 textToInsert += NewTD->getIdentifier()->getName(); 3616 Diag(tagLoc, diag::note_typedef_changes_linkage) 3617 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(tagLoc, textToInsert); 3618 return; 3619 } 3620 3621 // Otherwise, set this is the anon-decl typedef for the tag. 3622 TagFromDeclSpec->setTypedefNameForAnonDecl(NewTD); 3623 } 3624 3625 static unsigned GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DeclSpec::TST T) { 3626 switch (T) { 3627 case DeclSpec::TST_class: 3628 return 0; 3629 case DeclSpec::TST_struct: 3630 return 1; 3631 case DeclSpec::TST_interface: 3632 return 2; 3633 case DeclSpec::TST_union: 3634 return 3; 3635 case DeclSpec::TST_enum: 3636 return 4; 3637 default: 3638 llvm_unreachable("unexpected type specifier"); 3639 } 3640 } 3641 3642 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with 3643 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed. It also accepts template 3644 /// parameters to cope with template friend declarations. 3645 Decl *Sema::ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, 3646 DeclSpec &DS, 3647 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParams, 3648 bool IsExplicitInstantiation) { 3649 Decl *TagD = nullptr; 3650 TagDecl *Tag = nullptr; 3651 if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_class || 3652 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_struct || 3653 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_interface || 3654 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_union || 3655 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_enum) { 3656 TagD = DS.getRepAsDecl(); 3657 3658 if (!TagD) // We probably had an error 3659 return nullptr; 3660 3661 // Note that the above type specs guarantee that the 3662 // type rep is a Decl, whereas in many of the others 3663 // it's a Type. 3664 if (isa<TagDecl>(TagD)) 3665 Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 3666 else if (ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(TagD)) 3667 Tag = CTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 3668 } 3669 3670 if (Tag) { 3671 handleTagNumbering(Tag, S); 3672 Tag->setFreeStanding(); 3673 if (Tag->isInvalidDecl()) 3674 return Tag; 3675 } 3676 3677 if (unsigned TypeQuals = DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { 3678 // Enforce C99 6.7.3p2: "Types other than pointer types derived from object 3679 // or incomplete types shall not be restrict-qualified." 3680 if (TypeQuals & DeclSpec::TQ_restrict) 3681 Diag(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc(), 3682 diag::err_typecheck_invalid_restrict_not_pointer_noarg) 3683 << DS.getSourceRange(); 3684 } 3685 3686 if (DS.isConstexprSpecified()) { 3687 // C++0x [dcl.constexpr]p1: constexpr can only be applied to declarations 3688 // and definitions of functions and variables. 3689 if (Tag) 3690 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_tag) 3691 << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DS.getTypeSpecType()); 3692 else 3693 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_no_declarators); 3694 // Don't emit warnings after this error. 3695 return TagD; 3696 } 3697 3698 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(DS); 3699 3700 if (DS.isFriendSpecified()) { 3701 // If we're dealing with a decl but not a TagDecl, assume that 3702 // whatever routines created it handled the friendship aspect. 3703 if (TagD && !Tag) 3704 return nullptr; 3705 return ActOnFriendTypeDecl(S, DS, TemplateParams); 3706 } 3707 3708 const CXXScopeSpec &SS = DS.getTypeSpecScope(); 3709 bool IsExplicitSpecialization = 3710 !TemplateParams.empty() && TemplateParams.back()->size() == 0; 3711 if (Tag && SS.isNotEmpty() && !Tag->isCompleteDefinition() && 3712 !IsExplicitInstantiation && !IsExplicitSpecialization) { 3713 // Per C++ [dcl.type.elab]p1, a class declaration cannot have a 3714 // nested-name-specifier unless it is an explicit instantiation 3715 // or an explicit specialization. 3716 // Per C++ [dcl.enum]p1, an opaque-enum-declaration can't either. 3717 Diag(SS.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_standalone_class_nested_name_specifier) 3718 << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DS.getTypeSpecType()) << SS.getRange(); 3719 return nullptr; 3720 } 3721 3722 // Track whether this decl-specifier declares anything. 3723 bool DeclaresAnything = true; 3724 3725 // Handle anonymous struct definitions. 3726 if (RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(Tag)) { 3727 if (!Record->getDeclName() && Record->isCompleteDefinition() && 3728 DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) { 3729 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || 3730 Record->getDeclContext()->isRecord()) 3731 return BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(S, DS, AS, Record, 3732 Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 3733 3734 DeclaresAnything = false; 3735 } 3736 } 3737 3738 // C11 6.7.2.1p2: 3739 // A struct-declaration that does not declare an anonymous structure or 3740 // anonymous union shall contain a struct-declarator-list. 3741 // 3742 // This rule also existed in C89 and C99; the grammar for struct-declaration 3743 // did not permit a struct-declaration without a struct-declarator-list. 3744 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && CurContext->isRecord() && 3745 DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified) { 3746 // Check for Microsoft C extension: anonymous struct/union member. 3747 // Handle 2 kinds of anonymous struct/union: 3748 // struct STRUCT; 3749 // union UNION; 3750 // and 3751 // STRUCT_TYPE; <- where STRUCT_TYPE is a typedef struct. 3752 // UNION_TYPE; <- where UNION_TYPE is a typedef union. 3753 if ((Tag && Tag->getDeclName()) || 3754 DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_typename) { 3755 RecordDecl *Record = nullptr; 3756 if (Tag) 3757 Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag); 3758 else if (const RecordType *RT = 3759 DS.getRepAsType().get()->getAsStructureType()) 3760 Record = RT->getDecl(); 3761 else if (const RecordType *UT = DS.getRepAsType().get()->getAsUnionType()) 3762 Record = UT->getDecl(); 3763 3764 if (Record && getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) { 3765 Diag(DS.getLocStart(), diag::ext_ms_anonymous_record) 3766 << Record->isUnion() << DS.getSourceRange(); 3767 return BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(S, DS, Record); 3768 } 3769 3770 DeclaresAnything = false; 3771 } 3772 } 3773 3774 // Skip all the checks below if we have a type error. 3775 if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_error || 3776 (TagD && TagD->isInvalidDecl())) 3777 return TagD; 3778 3779 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 3780 DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 3781 if (EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(Tag)) 3782 if (Enum->enumerator_begin() == Enum->enumerator_end() && 3783 !Enum->getIdentifier() && !Enum->isInvalidDecl()) 3784 DeclaresAnything = false; 3785 3786 if (!DS.isMissingDeclaratorOk()) { 3787 // Customize diagnostic for a typedef missing a name. 3788 if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 3789 Diag(DS.getLocStart(), diag::ext_typedef_without_a_name) 3790 << DS.getSourceRange(); 3791 else 3792 DeclaresAnything = false; 3793 } 3794 3795 if (DS.isModulePrivateSpecified() && 3796 Tag && Tag->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 3797 Diag(DS.getModulePrivateSpecLoc(), diag::err_module_private_local_class) 3798 << Tag->getTagKind() 3799 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 3800 3801 ActOnDocumentableDecl(TagD); 3802 3803 // C 6.7/2: 3804 // A declaration [...] shall declare at least a declarator [...], a tag, 3805 // or the members of an enumeration. 3806 // C++ [dcl.dcl]p3: 3807 // [If there are no declarators], and except for the declaration of an 3808 // unnamed bit-field, the decl-specifier-seq shall introduce one or more 3809 // names into the program, or shall redeclare a name introduced by a 3810 // previous declaration. 3811 if (!DeclaresAnything) { 3812 // In C, we allow this as a (popular) extension / bug. Don't bother 3813 // producing further diagnostics for redundant qualifiers after this. 3814 Diag(DS.getLocStart(), diag::ext_no_declarators) << DS.getSourceRange(); 3815 return TagD; 3816 } 3817 3818 // C++ [dcl.stc]p1: 3819 // If a storage-class-specifier appears in a decl-specifier-seq, [...] the 3820 // init-declarator-list of the declaration shall not be empty. 3821 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p1: 3822 // If a cv-qualifier appears in a decl-specifier-seq, the 3823 // init-declarator-list of the declaration shall not be empty. 3824 // 3825 // Spurious qualifiers here appear to be valid in C. 3826 unsigned DiagID = diag::warn_standalone_specifier; 3827 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 3828 DiagID = diag::ext_standalone_specifier; 3829 3830 // Note that a linkage-specification sets a storage class, but 3831 // 'extern "C" struct foo;' is actually valid and not theoretically 3832 // useless. 3833 if (DeclSpec::SCS SCS = DS.getStorageClassSpec()) { 3834 if (SCS == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) 3835 // Since mutable is not a viable storage class specifier in C, there is 3836 // no reason to treat it as an extension. Instead, diagnose as an error. 3837 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember); 3838 else if (!DS.isExternInLinkageSpec() && SCS != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 3839 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), DiagID) 3840 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(SCS); 3841 } 3842 3843 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = DS.getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 3844 Diag(DS.getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), DiagID) 3845 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 3846 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { 3847 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_const) 3848 Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "const"; 3849 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_volatile) 3850 Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "volatile"; 3851 // Restrict is covered above. 3852 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_atomic) 3853 Diag(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "_Atomic"; 3854 } 3855 3856 // Warn about ignored type attributes, for example: 3857 // __attribute__((aligned)) struct A; 3858 // Attributes should be placed after tag to apply to type declaration. 3859 if (!DS.getAttributes().empty()) { 3860 DeclSpec::TST TypeSpecType = DS.getTypeSpecType(); 3861 if (TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_class || 3862 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_struct || 3863 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_interface || 3864 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_union || 3865 TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_enum) { 3866 for (AttributeList* attrs = DS.getAttributes().getList(); attrs; 3867 attrs = attrs->getNext()) 3868 Diag(attrs->getLoc(), diag::warn_declspec_attribute_ignored) 3869 << attrs->getName() << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(TypeSpecType); 3870 } 3871 } 3872 3873 return TagD; 3874 } 3875 3876 /// We are trying to inject an anonymous member into the given scope; 3877 /// check if there's an existing declaration that can't be overloaded. 3878 /// 3879 /// \return true if this is a forbidden redeclaration 3880 static bool CheckAnonMemberRedeclaration(Sema &SemaRef, 3881 Scope *S, 3882 DeclContext *Owner, 3883 DeclarationName Name, 3884 SourceLocation NameLoc, 3885 unsigned diagnostic) { 3886 LookupResult R(SemaRef, Name, NameLoc, Sema::LookupMemberName, 3887 Sema::ForRedeclaration); 3888 if (!SemaRef.LookupName(R, S)) return false; 3889 3890 if (R.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) 3891 return false; 3892 3893 // Pick a representative declaration. 3894 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getRepresentativeDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 3895 assert(PrevDecl && "Expected a non-null Decl"); 3896 3897 if (!SemaRef.isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, Owner, S)) 3898 return false; 3899 3900 SemaRef.Diag(NameLoc, diagnostic) << Name; 3901 SemaRef.Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 3902 3903 return true; 3904 } 3905 3906 /// InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers - Inject the members of the 3907 /// anonymous struct or union AnonRecord into the owning context Owner 3908 /// and scope S. This routine will be invoked just after we realize 3909 /// that an unnamed union or struct is actually an anonymous union or 3910 /// struct, e.g., 3911 /// 3912 /// @code 3913 /// union { 3914 /// int i; 3915 /// float f; 3916 /// }; // InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers called here to inject i and 3917 /// // f into the surrounding scope.x 3918 /// @endcode 3919 /// 3920 /// This routine is recursive, injecting the names of nested anonymous 3921 /// structs/unions into the owning context and scope as well. 3922 static bool InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, 3923 DeclContext *Owner, 3924 RecordDecl *AnonRecord, 3925 AccessSpecifier AS, 3926 SmallVectorImpl<NamedDecl *> &Chaining, 3927 bool MSAnonStruct) { 3928 unsigned diagKind 3929 = AnonRecord->isUnion() ? diag::err_anonymous_union_member_redecl 3930 : diag::err_anonymous_struct_member_redecl; 3931 3932 bool Invalid = false; 3933 3934 // Look every FieldDecl and IndirectFieldDecl with a name. 3935 for (auto *D : AnonRecord->decls()) { 3936 if ((isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(D)) && 3937 cast<NamedDecl>(D)->getDeclName()) { 3938 ValueDecl *VD = cast<ValueDecl>(D); 3939 if (CheckAnonMemberRedeclaration(SemaRef, S, Owner, VD->getDeclName(), 3940 VD->getLocation(), diagKind)) { 3941 // C++ [class.union]p2: 3942 // The names of the members of an anonymous union shall be 3943 // distinct from the names of any other entity in the 3944 // scope in which the anonymous union is declared. 3945 Invalid = true; 3946 } else { 3947 // C++ [class.union]p2: 3948 // For the purpose of name lookup, after the anonymous union 3949 // definition, the members of the anonymous union are 3950 // considered to have been defined in the scope in which the 3951 // anonymous union is declared. 3952 unsigned OldChainingSize = Chaining.size(); 3953 if (IndirectFieldDecl *IF = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD)) 3954 Chaining.append(IF->chain_begin(), IF->chain_end()); 3955 else 3956 Chaining.push_back(VD); 3957 3958 assert(Chaining.size() >= 2); 3959 NamedDecl **NamedChain = 3960 new (SemaRef.Context)NamedDecl*[Chaining.size()]; 3961 for (unsigned i = 0; i < Chaining.size(); i++) 3962 NamedChain[i] = Chaining[i]; 3963 3964 IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectField = IndirectFieldDecl::Create( 3965 SemaRef.Context, Owner, VD->getLocation(), VD->getIdentifier(), 3966 VD->getType(), NamedChain, Chaining.size()); 3967 3968 for (const auto *Attr : VD->attrs()) 3969 IndirectField->addAttr(Attr->clone(SemaRef.Context)); 3970 3971 IndirectField->setAccess(AS); 3972 IndirectField->setImplicit(); 3973 SemaRef.PushOnScopeChains(IndirectField, S); 3974 3975 // That includes picking up the appropriate access specifier. 3976 if (AS != AS_none) IndirectField->setAccess(AS); 3977 3978 Chaining.resize(OldChainingSize); 3979 } 3980 } 3981 } 3982 3983 return Invalid; 3984 } 3985 3986 /// StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass - Maps a DeclSpec::SCS to 3987 /// a VarDecl::StorageClass. Any error reporting is up to the caller: 3988 /// illegal input values are mapped to SC_None. 3989 static StorageClass 3990 StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(const DeclSpec &DS) { 3991 DeclSpec::SCS StorageClassSpec = DS.getStorageClassSpec(); 3992 assert(StorageClassSpec != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef && 3993 "Parser allowed 'typedef' as storage class VarDecl."); 3994 switch (StorageClassSpec) { 3995 case DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified: return SC_None; 3996 case DeclSpec::SCS_extern: 3997 if (DS.isExternInLinkageSpec()) 3998 return SC_None; 3999 return SC_Extern; 4000 case DeclSpec::SCS_static: return SC_Static; 4001 case DeclSpec::SCS_auto: return SC_Auto; 4002 case DeclSpec::SCS_register: return SC_Register; 4003 case DeclSpec::SCS_private_extern: return SC_PrivateExtern; 4004 // Illegal SCSs map to None: error reporting is up to the caller. 4005 case DeclSpec::SCS_mutable: // Fall through. 4006 case DeclSpec::SCS_typedef: return SC_None; 4007 } 4008 llvm_unreachable("unknown storage class specifier"); 4009 } 4010 4011 static SourceLocation findDefaultInitializer(const CXXRecordDecl *Record) { 4012 assert(Record->hasInClassInitializer()); 4013 4014 for (const auto *I : Record->decls()) { 4015 const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(I); 4016 if (const auto *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(I)) 4017 FD = IFD->getAnonField(); 4018 if (FD && FD->hasInClassInitializer()) 4019 return FD->getLocation(); 4020 } 4021 4022 llvm_unreachable("couldn't find in-class initializer"); 4023 } 4024 4025 static void checkDuplicateDefaultInit(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Parent, 4026 SourceLocation DefaultInitLoc) { 4027 if (!Parent->isUnion() || !Parent->hasInClassInitializer()) 4028 return; 4029 4030 S.Diag(DefaultInitLoc, diag::err_multiple_mem_union_initialization); 4031 S.Diag(findDefaultInitializer(Parent), diag::note_previous_initializer) << 0; 4032 } 4033 4034 static void checkDuplicateDefaultInit(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Parent, 4035 CXXRecordDecl *AnonUnion) { 4036 if (!Parent->isUnion() || !Parent->hasInClassInitializer()) 4037 return; 4038 4039 checkDuplicateDefaultInit(S, Parent, findDefaultInitializer(AnonUnion)); 4040 } 4041 4042 /// BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion - Handle the declaration of an 4043 /// anonymous structure or union. Anonymous unions are a C++ feature 4044 /// (C++ [class.union]) and a C11 feature; anonymous structures 4045 /// are a C11 feature and GNU C++ extension. 4046 Decl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS, 4047 AccessSpecifier AS, 4048 RecordDecl *Record, 4049 const PrintingPolicy &Policy) { 4050 DeclContext *Owner = Record->getDeclContext(); 4051 4052 // Diagnose whether this anonymous struct/union is an extension. 4053 if (Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !getLangOpts().C11) 4054 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_union); 4055 else if (!Record->isUnion() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4056 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_gnu_anonymous_struct); 4057 else if (!Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().C11) 4058 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_c11_anonymous_struct); 4059 4060 // C and C++ require different kinds of checks for anonymous 4061 // structs/unions. 4062 bool Invalid = false; 4063 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4064 const char *PrevSpec = nullptr; 4065 unsigned DiagID; 4066 if (Record->isUnion()) { 4067 // C++ [class.union]p6: 4068 // Anonymous unions declared in a named namespace or in the 4069 // global namespace shall be declared static. 4070 if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_static && 4071 (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(Owner) || 4072 (isa<NamespaceDecl>(Owner) && 4073 cast<NamespaceDecl>(Owner)->getDeclName()))) { 4074 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_union_not_static) 4075 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Record->getLocation(), "static "); 4076 4077 // Recover by adding 'static'. 4078 DS.SetStorageClassSpec(*this, DeclSpec::SCS_static, SourceLocation(), 4079 PrevSpec, DiagID, Policy); 4080 } 4081 // C++ [class.union]p6: 4082 // A storage class is not allowed in a declaration of an 4083 // anonymous union in a class scope. 4084 else if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified && 4085 isa<RecordDecl>(Owner)) { 4086 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 4087 diag::err_anonymous_union_with_storage_spec) 4088 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 4089 4090 // Recover by removing the storage specifier. 4091 DS.SetStorageClassSpec(*this, DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified, 4092 SourceLocation(), 4093 PrevSpec, DiagID, Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 4094 } 4095 } 4096 4097 // Ignore const/volatile/restrict qualifiers. 4098 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers()) { 4099 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_const) 4100 Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 4101 << Record->isUnion() << "const" 4102 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getConstSpecLoc()); 4103 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_volatile) 4104 Diag(DS.getVolatileSpecLoc(), 4105 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 4106 << Record->isUnion() << "volatile" 4107 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getVolatileSpecLoc()); 4108 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_restrict) 4109 Diag(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc(), 4110 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 4111 << Record->isUnion() << "restrict" 4112 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc()); 4113 if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_atomic) 4114 Diag(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc(), 4115 diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified) 4116 << Record->isUnion() << "_Atomic" 4117 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc()); 4118 4119 DS.ClearTypeQualifiers(); 4120 } 4121 4122 // C++ [class.union]p2: 4123 // The member-specification of an anonymous union shall only 4124 // define non-static data members. [Note: nested types and 4125 // functions cannot be declared within an anonymous union. ] 4126 for (auto *Mem : Record->decls()) { 4127 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(Mem)) { 4128 // C++ [class.union]p3: 4129 // An anonymous union shall not have private or protected 4130 // members (clause 11). 4131 assert(FD->getAccess() != AS_none); 4132 if (FD->getAccess() != AS_public) { 4133 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_record_nonpublic_member) 4134 << (int)Record->isUnion() << (int)(FD->getAccess() == AS_protected); 4135 Invalid = true; 4136 } 4137 4138 // C++ [class.union]p1 4139 // An object of a class with a non-trivial constructor, a non-trivial 4140 // copy constructor, a non-trivial destructor, or a non-trivial copy 4141 // assignment operator cannot be a member of a union, nor can an 4142 // array of such objects. 4143 if (CheckNontrivialField(FD)) 4144 Invalid = true; 4145 } else if (Mem->isImplicit()) { 4146 // Any implicit members are fine. 4147 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(Mem) && Mem->getDeclContext() != Record) { 4148 // This is a type that showed up in an 4149 // elaborated-type-specifier inside the anonymous struct or 4150 // union, but which actually declares a type outside of the 4151 // anonymous struct or union. It's okay. 4152 } else if (auto *MemRecord = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Mem)) { 4153 if (!MemRecord->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() && 4154 MemRecord->getDeclName()) { 4155 // Visual C++ allows type definition in anonymous struct or union. 4156 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) 4157 Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_type) 4158 << (int)Record->isUnion(); 4159 else { 4160 // This is a nested type declaration. 4161 Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type) 4162 << (int)Record->isUnion(); 4163 Invalid = true; 4164 } 4165 } else { 4166 // This is an anonymous type definition within another anonymous type. 4167 // This is a popular extension, provided by Plan9, MSVC and GCC, but 4168 // not part of standard C++. 4169 Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), 4170 diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_anonymous_type) 4171 << (int)Record->isUnion(); 4172 } 4173 } else if (isa<AccessSpecDecl>(Mem)) { 4174 // Any access specifier is fine. 4175 } else if (isa<StaticAssertDecl>(Mem)) { 4176 // In C++1z, static_assert declarations are also fine. 4177 } else { 4178 // We have something that isn't a non-static data 4179 // member. Complain about it. 4180 unsigned DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_bad_member; 4181 if (isa<TypeDecl>(Mem)) 4182 DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type; 4183 else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(Mem)) 4184 DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_function; 4185 else if (isa<VarDecl>(Mem)) 4186 DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_static; 4187 4188 // Visual C++ allows type definition in anonymous struct or union. 4189 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && 4190 DK == diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type) 4191 Diag(Mem->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_type) 4192 << (int)Record->isUnion(); 4193 else { 4194 Diag(Mem->getLocation(), DK) 4195 << (int)Record->isUnion(); 4196 Invalid = true; 4197 } 4198 } 4199 } 4200 4201 // C++11 [class.union]p8 (DR1460): 4202 // At most one variant member of a union may have a 4203 // brace-or-equal-initializer. 4204 if (cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record)->hasInClassInitializer() && 4205 Owner->isRecord()) 4206 checkDuplicateDefaultInit(*this, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Owner), 4207 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record)); 4208 } 4209 4210 if (!Record->isUnion() && !Owner->isRecord()) { 4211 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_struct_not_member) 4212 << (int)getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 4213 Invalid = true; 4214 } 4215 4216 // Mock up a declarator. 4217 Declarator Dc(DS, Declarator::MemberContext); 4218 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(Dc, S); 4219 assert(TInfo && "couldn't build declarator info for anonymous struct/union"); 4220 4221 // Create a declaration for this anonymous struct/union. 4222 NamedDecl *Anon = nullptr; 4223 if (RecordDecl *OwningClass = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Owner)) { 4224 Anon = FieldDecl::Create(Context, OwningClass, 4225 DS.getLocStart(), 4226 Record->getLocation(), 4227 /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, 4228 Context.getTypeDeclType(Record), 4229 TInfo, 4230 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, 4231 /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit); 4232 Anon->setAccess(AS); 4233 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4234 FieldCollector->Add(cast<FieldDecl>(Anon)); 4235 } else { 4236 DeclSpec::SCS SCSpec = DS.getStorageClassSpec(); 4237 StorageClass SC = StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(DS); 4238 if (SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) { 4239 // mutable can only appear on non-static class members, so it's always 4240 // an error here 4241 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember); 4242 Invalid = true; 4243 SC = SC_None; 4244 } 4245 4246 Anon = VarDecl::Create(Context, Owner, 4247 DS.getLocStart(), 4248 Record->getLocation(), /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, 4249 Context.getTypeDeclType(Record), 4250 TInfo, SC); 4251 4252 // Default-initialize the implicit variable. This initialization will be 4253 // trivial in almost all cases, except if a union member has an in-class 4254 // initializer: 4255 // union { int n = 0; }; 4256 ActOnUninitializedDecl(Anon, /*TypeMayContainAuto=*/false); 4257 } 4258 Anon->setImplicit(); 4259 4260 // Mark this as an anonymous struct/union type. 4261 Record->setAnonymousStructOrUnion(true); 4262 4263 // Add the anonymous struct/union object to the current 4264 // context. We'll be referencing this object when we refer to one of 4265 // its members. 4266 Owner->addDecl(Anon); 4267 4268 // Inject the members of the anonymous struct/union into the owning 4269 // context and into the identifier resolver chain for name lookup 4270 // purposes. 4271 SmallVector<NamedDecl*, 2> Chain; 4272 Chain.push_back(Anon); 4273 4274 if (InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(*this, S, Owner, Record, AS, 4275 Chain, false)) 4276 Invalid = true; 4277 4278 if (VarDecl *NewVD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Anon)) { 4279 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 4280 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 4281 if (MangleNumberingContext *MCtx = getCurrentMangleNumberContext( 4282 NewVD->getDeclContext(), ManglingContextDecl)) { 4283 Context.setManglingNumber( 4284 NewVD, MCtx->getManglingNumber( 4285 NewVD, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), S))); 4286 Context.setStaticLocalNumber(NewVD, MCtx->getStaticLocalNumber(NewVD)); 4287 } 4288 } 4289 } 4290 4291 if (Invalid) 4292 Anon->setInvalidDecl(); 4293 4294 return Anon; 4295 } 4296 4297 /// BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct - Handle the declaration of an 4298 /// Microsoft C anonymous structure. 4299 /// Ref: http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/z2cx9y4f.aspx 4300 /// Example: 4301 /// 4302 /// struct A { int a; }; 4303 /// struct B { struct A; int b; }; 4304 /// 4305 /// void foo() { 4306 /// B var; 4307 /// var.a = 3; 4308 /// } 4309 /// 4310 Decl *Sema::BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS, 4311 RecordDecl *Record) { 4312 assert(Record && "expected a record!"); 4313 4314 // Mock up a declarator. 4315 Declarator Dc(DS, Declarator::TypeNameContext); 4316 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(Dc, S); 4317 assert(TInfo && "couldn't build declarator info for anonymous struct"); 4318 4319 auto *ParentDecl = cast<RecordDecl>(CurContext); 4320 QualType RecTy = Context.getTypeDeclType(Record); 4321 4322 // Create a declaration for this anonymous struct. 4323 NamedDecl *Anon = FieldDecl::Create(Context, 4324 ParentDecl, 4325 DS.getLocStart(), 4326 DS.getLocStart(), 4327 /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, 4328 RecTy, 4329 TInfo, 4330 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, 4331 /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit); 4332 Anon->setImplicit(); 4333 4334 // Add the anonymous struct object to the current context. 4335 CurContext->addDecl(Anon); 4336 4337 // Inject the members of the anonymous struct into the current 4338 // context and into the identifier resolver chain for name lookup 4339 // purposes. 4340 SmallVector<NamedDecl*, 2> Chain; 4341 Chain.push_back(Anon); 4342 4343 RecordDecl *RecordDef = Record->getDefinition(); 4344 if (RequireCompleteType(Anon->getLocation(), RecTy, 4345 diag::err_field_incomplete) || 4346 InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(*this, S, CurContext, RecordDef, 4347 AS_none, Chain, true)) { 4348 Anon->setInvalidDecl(); 4349 ParentDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 4350 } 4351 4352 return Anon; 4353 } 4354 4355 /// GetNameForDeclarator - Determine the full declaration name for the 4356 /// given Declarator. 4357 DeclarationNameInfo Sema::GetNameForDeclarator(Declarator &D) { 4358 return GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(D.getName()); 4359 } 4360 4361 /// \brief Retrieves the declaration name from a parsed unqualified-id. 4362 DeclarationNameInfo 4363 Sema::GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Name) { 4364 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo; 4365 NameInfo.setLoc(Name.StartLocation); 4366 4367 switch (Name.getKind()) { 4368 4369 case UnqualifiedId::IK_ImplicitSelfParam: 4370 case UnqualifiedId::IK_Identifier: 4371 NameInfo.setName(Name.Identifier); 4372 NameInfo.setLoc(Name.StartLocation); 4373 return NameInfo; 4374 4375 case UnqualifiedId::IK_OperatorFunctionId: 4376 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName( 4377 Name.OperatorFunctionId.Operator)); 4378 NameInfo.setLoc(Name.StartLocation); 4379 NameInfo.getInfo().CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc 4380 = Name.OperatorFunctionId.SymbolLocations[0]; 4381 NameInfo.getInfo().CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc 4382 = Name.EndLocation.getRawEncoding(); 4383 return NameInfo; 4384 4385 case UnqualifiedId::IK_LiteralOperatorId: 4386 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName( 4387 Name.Identifier)); 4388 NameInfo.setLoc(Name.StartLocation); 4389 NameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(Name.EndLocation); 4390 return NameInfo; 4391 4392 case UnqualifiedId::IK_ConversionFunctionId: { 4393 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 4394 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.ConversionFunctionId, &TInfo); 4395 if (Ty.isNull()) 4396 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 4397 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConversionFunctionName( 4398 Context.getCanonicalType(Ty))); 4399 NameInfo.setLoc(Name.StartLocation); 4400 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo); 4401 return NameInfo; 4402 } 4403 4404 case UnqualifiedId::IK_ConstructorName: { 4405 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 4406 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.ConstructorName, &TInfo); 4407 if (Ty.isNull()) 4408 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 4409 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConstructorName( 4410 Context.getCanonicalType(Ty))); 4411 NameInfo.setLoc(Name.StartLocation); 4412 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo); 4413 return NameInfo; 4414 } 4415 4416 case UnqualifiedId::IK_ConstructorTemplateId: { 4417 // In well-formed code, we can only have a constructor 4418 // template-id that refers to the current context, so go there 4419 // to find the actual type being constructed. 4420 CXXRecordDecl *CurClass = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext); 4421 if (!CurClass || CurClass->getIdentifier() != Name.TemplateId->Name) 4422 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 4423 4424 // Determine the type of the class being constructed. 4425 QualType CurClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(CurClass); 4426 4427 // FIXME: Check two things: that the template-id names the same type as 4428 // CurClassType, and that the template-id does not occur when the name 4429 // was qualified. 4430 4431 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConstructorName( 4432 Context.getCanonicalType(CurClassType))); 4433 NameInfo.setLoc(Name.StartLocation); 4434 // FIXME: should we retrieve TypeSourceInfo? 4435 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(nullptr); 4436 return NameInfo; 4437 } 4438 4439 case UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName: { 4440 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 4441 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.DestructorName, &TInfo); 4442 if (Ty.isNull()) 4443 return DeclarationNameInfo(); 4444 NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName( 4445 Context.getCanonicalType(Ty))); 4446 NameInfo.setLoc(Name.StartLocation); 4447 NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo); 4448 return NameInfo; 4449 } 4450 4451 case UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId: { 4452 TemplateName TName = Name.TemplateId->Template.get(); 4453 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Name.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc; 4454 return Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc); 4455 } 4456 4457 } // switch (Name.getKind()) 4458 4459 llvm_unreachable("Unknown name kind"); 4460 } 4461 4462 static QualType getCoreType(QualType Ty) { 4463 do { 4464 if (Ty->isPointerType() || Ty->isReferenceType()) 4465 Ty = Ty->getPointeeType(); 4466 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) 4467 Ty = Ty->castAsArrayTypeUnsafe()->getElementType(); 4468 else 4469 return Ty.withoutLocalFastQualifiers(); 4470 } while (true); 4471 } 4472 4473 /// hasSimilarParameters - Determine whether the C++ functions Declaration 4474 /// and Definition have "nearly" matching parameters. This heuristic is 4475 /// used to improve diagnostics in the case where an out-of-line function 4476 /// definition doesn't match any declaration within the class or namespace. 4477 /// Also sets Params to the list of indices to the parameters that differ 4478 /// between the declaration and the definition. If hasSimilarParameters 4479 /// returns true and Params is empty, then all of the parameters match. 4480 static bool hasSimilarParameters(ASTContext &Context, 4481 FunctionDecl *Declaration, 4482 FunctionDecl *Definition, 4483 SmallVectorImpl<unsigned> &Params) { 4484 Params.clear(); 4485 if (Declaration->param_size() != Definition->param_size()) 4486 return false; 4487 for (unsigned Idx = 0; Idx < Declaration->param_size(); ++Idx) { 4488 QualType DeclParamTy = Declaration->getParamDecl(Idx)->getType(); 4489 QualType DefParamTy = Definition->getParamDecl(Idx)->getType(); 4490 4491 // The parameter types are identical 4492 if (Context.hasSameType(DefParamTy, DeclParamTy)) 4493 continue; 4494 4495 QualType DeclParamBaseTy = getCoreType(DeclParamTy); 4496 QualType DefParamBaseTy = getCoreType(DefParamTy); 4497 const IdentifierInfo *DeclTyName = DeclParamBaseTy.getBaseTypeIdentifier(); 4498 const IdentifierInfo *DefTyName = DefParamBaseTy.getBaseTypeIdentifier(); 4499 4500 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DeclParamBaseTy, DefParamBaseTy) || 4501 (DeclTyName && DeclTyName == DefTyName)) 4502 Params.push_back(Idx); 4503 else // The two parameters aren't even close 4504 return false; 4505 } 4506 4507 return true; 4508 } 4509 4510 /// NeedsRebuildingInCurrentInstantiation - Checks whether the given 4511 /// declarator needs to be rebuilt in the current instantiation. 4512 /// Any bits of declarator which appear before the name are valid for 4513 /// consideration here. That's specifically the type in the decl spec 4514 /// and the base type in any member-pointer chunks. 4515 static bool RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation(Sema &S, Declarator &D, 4516 DeclarationName Name) { 4517 // The types we specifically need to rebuild are: 4518 // - typenames, typeofs, and decltypes 4519 // - types which will become injected class names 4520 // Of course, we also need to rebuild any type referencing such a 4521 // type. It's safest to just say "dependent", but we call out a 4522 // few cases here. 4523 4524 DeclSpec &DS = D.getMutableDeclSpec(); 4525 switch (DS.getTypeSpecType()) { 4526 case DeclSpec::TST_typename: 4527 case DeclSpec::TST_typeofType: 4528 case DeclSpec::TST_underlyingType: 4529 case DeclSpec::TST_atomic: { 4530 // Grab the type from the parser. 4531 TypeSourceInfo *TSI = nullptr; 4532 QualType T = S.GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType(), &TSI); 4533 if (T.isNull() || !T->isDependentType()) break; 4534 4535 // Make sure there's a type source info. This isn't really much 4536 // of a waste; most dependent types should have type source info 4537 // attached already. 4538 if (!TSI) 4539 TSI = S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc()); 4540 4541 // Rebuild the type in the current instantiation. 4542 TSI = S.RebuildTypeInCurrentInstantiation(TSI, D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name); 4543 if (!TSI) return true; 4544 4545 // Store the new type back in the decl spec. 4546 ParsedType LocType = S.CreateParsedType(TSI->getType(), TSI); 4547 DS.UpdateTypeRep(LocType); 4548 break; 4549 } 4550 4551 case DeclSpec::TST_decltype: 4552 case DeclSpec::TST_typeofExpr: { 4553 Expr *E = DS.getRepAsExpr(); 4554 ExprResult Result = S.RebuildExprInCurrentInstantiation(E); 4555 if (Result.isInvalid()) return true; 4556 DS.UpdateExprRep(Result.get()); 4557 break; 4558 } 4559 4560 default: 4561 // Nothing to do for these decl specs. 4562 break; 4563 } 4564 4565 // It doesn't matter what order we do this in. 4566 for (unsigned I = 0, E = D.getNumTypeObjects(); I != E; ++I) { 4567 DeclaratorChunk &Chunk = D.getTypeObject(I); 4568 4569 // The only type information in the declarator which can come 4570 // before the declaration name is the base type of a member 4571 // pointer. 4572 if (Chunk.Kind != DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer) 4573 continue; 4574 4575 // Rebuild the scope specifier in-place. 4576 CXXScopeSpec &SS = Chunk.Mem.Scope(); 4577 if (S.RebuildNestedNameSpecifierInCurrentInstantiation(SS)) 4578 return true; 4579 } 4580 4581 return false; 4582 } 4583 4584 Decl *Sema::ActOnDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) { 4585 D.setFunctionDefinitionKind(FDK_Declaration); 4586 Decl *Dcl = HandleDeclarator(S, D, MultiTemplateParamsArg()); 4587 4588 if (OriginalLexicalContext && OriginalLexicalContext->isObjCContainer() && 4589 Dcl && Dcl->getDeclContext()->isFileContext()) 4590 Dcl->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer(); 4591 4592 return Dcl; 4593 } 4594 4595 /// DiagnoseClassNameShadow - Implement C++ [class.mem]p13: 4596 /// If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a 4597 /// name different from T: 4598 /// - every static data member of class T; 4599 /// - every member function of class T 4600 /// - every member of class T that is itself a type; 4601 /// \returns true if the declaration name violates these rules. 4602 bool Sema::DiagnoseClassNameShadow(DeclContext *DC, 4603 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo) { 4604 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 4605 4606 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) 4607 if (Record->getIdentifier() && Record->getDeclName() == Name) { 4608 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_member_name_of_class) << Name; 4609 return true; 4610 } 4611 4612 return false; 4613 } 4614 4615 /// \brief Diagnose a declaration whose declarator-id has the given 4616 /// nested-name-specifier. 4617 /// 4618 /// \param SS The nested-name-specifier of the declarator-id. 4619 /// 4620 /// \param DC The declaration context to which the nested-name-specifier 4621 /// resolves. 4622 /// 4623 /// \param Name The name of the entity being declared. 4624 /// 4625 /// \param Loc The location of the name of the entity being declared. 4626 /// 4627 /// \returns true if we cannot safely recover from this error, false otherwise. 4628 bool Sema::diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(CXXScopeSpec &SS, DeclContext *DC, 4629 DeclarationName Name, 4630 SourceLocation Loc) { 4631 DeclContext *Cur = CurContext; 4632 while (isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(Cur) || isa<CapturedDecl>(Cur)) 4633 Cur = Cur->getParent(); 4634 4635 // If the user provided a superfluous scope specifier that refers back to the 4636 // class in which the entity is already declared, diagnose and ignore it. 4637 // 4638 // class X { 4639 // void X::f(); 4640 // }; 4641 // 4642 // Note, it was once ill-formed to give redundant qualification in all 4643 // contexts, but that rule was removed by DR482. 4644 if (Cur->Equals(DC)) { 4645 if (Cur->isRecord()) { 4646 Diag(Loc, LangOpts.MicrosoftExt ? diag::warn_member_extra_qualification 4647 : diag::err_member_extra_qualification) 4648 << Name << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(SS.getRange()); 4649 SS.clear(); 4650 } else { 4651 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_namespace_member_extra_qualification) << Name; 4652 } 4653 return false; 4654 } 4655 4656 // Check whether the qualifying scope encloses the scope of the original 4657 // declaration. 4658 if (!Cur->Encloses(DC)) { 4659 if (Cur->isRecord()) 4660 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_qualification) 4661 << Name << SS.getRange(); 4662 else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(DC)) 4663 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_global_scope) 4664 << Name << SS.getRange(); 4665 else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(Cur)) 4666 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_in_function) 4667 << Name << SS.getRange(); 4668 else if (isa<BlockDecl>(Cur)) 4669 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_in_block) 4670 << Name << SS.getRange(); 4671 else 4672 Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_scope) 4673 << Name << cast<NamedDecl>(Cur) << cast<NamedDecl>(DC) << SS.getRange(); 4674 4675 return true; 4676 } 4677 4678 if (Cur->isRecord()) { 4679 // Cannot qualify members within a class. 4680 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_qualification) 4681 << Name << SS.getRange(); 4682 SS.clear(); 4683 4684 // C++ constructors and destructors with incorrect scopes can break 4685 // our AST invariants by having the wrong underlying types. If 4686 // that's the case, then drop this declaration entirely. 4687 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName || 4688 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) && 4689 !Context.hasSameType(Name.getCXXNameType(), 4690 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cur)))) 4691 return true; 4692 4693 return false; 4694 } 4695 4696 // C++11 [dcl.meaning]p1: 4697 // [...] "The nested-name-specifier of the qualified declarator-id shall 4698 // not begin with a decltype-specifer" 4699 NestedNameSpecifierLoc SpecLoc(SS.getScopeRep(), SS.location_data()); 4700 while (SpecLoc.getPrefix()) 4701 SpecLoc = SpecLoc.getPrefix(); 4702 if (dyn_cast_or_null<DecltypeType>( 4703 SpecLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier()->getAsType())) 4704 Diag(Loc, diag::err_decltype_in_declarator) 4705 << SpecLoc.getTypeLoc().getSourceRange(); 4706 4707 return false; 4708 } 4709 4710 NamedDecl *Sema::HandleDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, 4711 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists) { 4712 // TODO: consider using NameInfo for diagnostic. 4713 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = GetNameForDeclarator(D); 4714 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 4715 4716 // All of these full declarators require an identifier. If it doesn't have 4717 // one, the ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec action should be used. 4718 if (!Name) { 4719 if (!D.isInvalidType()) // Reject this if we think it is valid. 4720 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getLocStart(), 4721 diag::err_declarator_need_ident) 4722 << D.getDeclSpec().getSourceRange() << D.getSourceRange(); 4723 return nullptr; 4724 } else if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(NameInfo, UPPC_DeclarationType)) 4725 return nullptr; 4726 4727 // The scope passed in may not be a decl scope. Zip up the scope tree until 4728 // we find one that is. 4729 while ((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0 || 4730 (S->getFlags() & Scope::TemplateParamScope) != 0) 4731 S = S->getParent(); 4732 4733 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 4734 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isInvalid()) 4735 D.setInvalidType(); 4736 else if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 4737 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 4738 UPPC_DeclarationQualifier)) 4739 return nullptr; 4740 4741 bool EnteringContext = !D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified(); 4742 DC = computeDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), EnteringContext); 4743 if (!DC || isa<EnumDecl>(DC)) { 4744 // If we could not compute the declaration context, it's because the 4745 // declaration context is dependent but does not refer to a class, 4746 // class template, or class template partial specialization. Complain 4747 // and return early, to avoid the coming semantic disaster. 4748 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 4749 diag::err_template_qualified_declarator_no_match) 4750 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getScopeRep() 4751 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 4752 return nullptr; 4753 } 4754 bool IsDependentContext = DC->isDependentContext(); 4755 4756 if (!IsDependentContext && 4757 RequireCompleteDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), DC)) 4758 return nullptr; 4759 4760 // If a class is incomplete, do not parse entities inside it. 4761 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC) && !cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->hasDefinition()) { 4762 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 4763 diag::err_member_def_undefined_record) 4764 << Name << DC << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 4765 return nullptr; 4766 } 4767 if (!D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) { 4768 if (diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), DC, 4769 Name, D.getIdentifierLoc())) { 4770 if (DC->isRecord()) 4771 return nullptr; 4772 4773 D.setInvalidType(); 4774 } 4775 } 4776 4777 // Check whether we need to rebuild the type of the given 4778 // declaration in the current instantiation. 4779 if (EnteringContext && IsDependentContext && 4780 TemplateParamLists.size() != 0) { 4781 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, DC); 4782 if (RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation(*this, D, Name)) 4783 D.setInvalidType(); 4784 } 4785 } 4786 4787 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 4788 QualType R = TInfo->getType(); 4789 4790 if (!R->isFunctionType() && DiagnoseClassNameShadow(DC, NameInfo)) 4791 // If this is a typedef, we'll end up spewing multiple diagnostics. 4792 // Just return early; it's safer. If this is a function, let the 4793 // "constructor cannot have a return type" diagnostic handle it. 4794 if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 4795 return nullptr; 4796 4797 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getIdentifierLoc(), TInfo, 4798 UPPC_DeclarationType)) 4799 D.setInvalidType(); 4800 4801 LookupResult Previous(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName, 4802 ForRedeclaration); 4803 4804 // See if this is a redefinition of a variable in the same scope. 4805 if (!D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 4806 bool IsLinkageLookup = false; 4807 bool CreateBuiltins = false; 4808 4809 // If the declaration we're planning to build will be a function 4810 // or object with linkage, then look for another declaration with 4811 // linkage (C99 6.2.2p4-5 and C++ [basic.link]p6). 4812 // 4813 // If the declaration we're planning to build will be declared with 4814 // external linkage in the translation unit, create any builtin with 4815 // the same name. 4816 if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 4817 /* Do nothing*/; 4818 else if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() && 4819 (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_extern || 4820 R->isFunctionType())) { 4821 IsLinkageLookup = true; 4822 CreateBuiltins = 4823 CurContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext()->isTranslationUnit(); 4824 } else if (CurContext->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() && 4825 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_static) 4826 CreateBuiltins = true; 4827 4828 if (IsLinkageLookup) 4829 Previous.clear(LookupRedeclarationWithLinkage); 4830 4831 LookupName(Previous, S, CreateBuiltins); 4832 } else { // Something like "int foo::x;" 4833 LookupQualifiedName(Previous, DC); 4834 4835 // C++ [dcl.meaning]p1: 4836 // When the declarator-id is qualified, the declaration shall refer to a 4837 // previously declared member of the class or namespace to which the 4838 // qualifier refers (or, in the case of a namespace, of an element of the 4839 // inline namespace set of that namespace (7.3.1)) or to a specialization 4840 // thereof; [...] 4841 // 4842 // Note that we already checked the context above, and that we do not have 4843 // enough information to make sure that Previous contains the declaration 4844 // we want to match. For example, given: 4845 // 4846 // class X { 4847 // void f(); 4848 // void f(float); 4849 // }; 4850 // 4851 // void X::f(int) { } // ill-formed 4852 // 4853 // In this case, Previous will point to the overload set 4854 // containing the two f's declared in X, but neither of them 4855 // matches. 4856 4857 // C++ [dcl.meaning]p1: 4858 // [...] the member shall not merely have been introduced by a 4859 // using-declaration in the scope of the class or namespace nominated by 4860 // the nested-name-specifier of the declarator-id. 4861 RemoveUsingDecls(Previous); 4862 } 4863 4864 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && 4865 Previous.getFoundDecl()->isTemplateParameter()) { 4866 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 4867 if (!D.isInvalidType()) 4868 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 4869 Previous.getFoundDecl()); 4870 4871 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 4872 Previous.clear(); 4873 } 4874 4875 // In C++, the previous declaration we find might be a tag type 4876 // (class or enum). In this case, the new declaration will hide the 4877 // tag type. Note that this does does not apply if we're declaring a 4878 // typedef (C++ [dcl.typedef]p4). 4879 if (Previous.isSingleTagDecl() && 4880 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) 4881 Previous.clear(); 4882 4883 // Check that there are no default arguments other than in the parameters 4884 // of a function declaration (C++ only). 4885 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4886 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 4887 4888 NamedDecl *New; 4889 4890 bool AddToScope = true; 4891 if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) { 4892 if (TemplateParamLists.size()) { 4893 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_typedef); 4894 return nullptr; 4895 } 4896 4897 New = ActOnTypedefDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous); 4898 } else if (R->isFunctionType()) { 4899 New = ActOnFunctionDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous, 4900 TemplateParamLists, 4901 AddToScope); 4902 } else { 4903 New = ActOnVariableDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous, TemplateParamLists, 4904 AddToScope); 4905 } 4906 4907 if (!New) 4908 return nullptr; 4909 4910 // If this has an identifier and is not an invalid redeclaration or 4911 // function template specialization, add it to the scope stack. 4912 if (New->getDeclName() && AddToScope && 4913 !(D.isRedeclaration() && New->isInvalidDecl())) { 4914 // Only make a locally-scoped extern declaration visible if it is the first 4915 // declaration of this entity. Qualified lookup for such an entity should 4916 // only find this declaration if there is no visible declaration of it. 4917 bool AddToContext = !D.isRedeclaration() || !New->isLocalExternDecl(); 4918 PushOnScopeChains(New, S, AddToContext); 4919 if (!AddToContext) 4920 CurContext->addHiddenDecl(New); 4921 } 4922 4923 return New; 4924 } 4925 4926 /// Helper method to turn variable array types into constant array 4927 /// types in certain situations which would otherwise be errors (for 4928 /// GCC compatibility). 4929 static QualType TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(QualType T, 4930 ASTContext &Context, 4931 bool &SizeIsNegative, 4932 llvm::APSInt &Oversized) { 4933 // This method tries to turn a variable array into a constant 4934 // array even when the size isn't an ICE. This is necessary 4935 // for compatibility with code that depends on gcc's buggy 4936 // constant expression folding, like struct {char x[(int)(char*)2];} 4937 SizeIsNegative = false; 4938 Oversized = 0; 4939 4940 if (T->isDependentType()) 4941 return QualType(); 4942 4943 QualifierCollector Qs; 4944 const Type *Ty = Qs.strip(T); 4945 4946 if (const PointerType* PTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(Ty)) { 4947 QualType Pointee = PTy->getPointeeType(); 4948 QualType FixedType = 4949 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(Pointee, Context, SizeIsNegative, 4950 Oversized); 4951 if (FixedType.isNull()) return FixedType; 4952 FixedType = Context.getPointerType(FixedType); 4953 return Qs.apply(Context, FixedType); 4954 } 4955 if (const ParenType* PTy = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Ty)) { 4956 QualType Inner = PTy->getInnerType(); 4957 QualType FixedType = 4958 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(Inner, Context, SizeIsNegative, 4959 Oversized); 4960 if (FixedType.isNull()) return FixedType; 4961 FixedType = Context.getParenType(FixedType); 4962 return Qs.apply(Context, FixedType); 4963 } 4964 4965 const VariableArrayType* VLATy = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(T); 4966 if (!VLATy) 4967 return QualType(); 4968 // FIXME: We should probably handle this case 4969 if (VLATy->getElementType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) 4970 return QualType(); 4971 4972 llvm::APSInt Res; 4973 if (!VLATy->getSizeExpr() || 4974 !VLATy->getSizeExpr()->EvaluateAsInt(Res, Context)) 4975 return QualType(); 4976 4977 // Check whether the array size is negative. 4978 if (Res.isSigned() && Res.isNegative()) { 4979 SizeIsNegative = true; 4980 return QualType(); 4981 } 4982 4983 // Check whether the array is too large to be addressed. 4984 unsigned ActiveSizeBits 4985 = ConstantArrayType::getNumAddressingBits(Context, VLATy->getElementType(), 4986 Res); 4987 if (ActiveSizeBits > ConstantArrayType::getMaxSizeBits(Context)) { 4988 Oversized = Res; 4989 return QualType(); 4990 } 4991 4992 return Context.getConstantArrayType(VLATy->getElementType(), 4993 Res, ArrayType::Normal, 0); 4994 } 4995 4996 static void 4997 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(TypeLoc SrcTL, TypeLoc DstTL) { 4998 SrcTL = SrcTL.getUnqualifiedLoc(); 4999 DstTL = DstTL.getUnqualifiedLoc(); 5000 if (PointerTypeLoc SrcPTL = SrcTL.getAs<PointerTypeLoc>()) { 5001 PointerTypeLoc DstPTL = DstTL.castAs<PointerTypeLoc>(); 5002 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcPTL.getPointeeLoc(), 5003 DstPTL.getPointeeLoc()); 5004 DstPTL.setStarLoc(SrcPTL.getStarLoc()); 5005 return; 5006 } 5007 if (ParenTypeLoc SrcPTL = SrcTL.getAs<ParenTypeLoc>()) { 5008 ParenTypeLoc DstPTL = DstTL.castAs<ParenTypeLoc>(); 5009 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcPTL.getInnerLoc(), 5010 DstPTL.getInnerLoc()); 5011 DstPTL.setLParenLoc(SrcPTL.getLParenLoc()); 5012 DstPTL.setRParenLoc(SrcPTL.getRParenLoc()); 5013 return; 5014 } 5015 ArrayTypeLoc SrcATL = SrcTL.castAs<ArrayTypeLoc>(); 5016 ArrayTypeLoc DstATL = DstTL.castAs<ArrayTypeLoc>(); 5017 TypeLoc SrcElemTL = SrcATL.getElementLoc(); 5018 TypeLoc DstElemTL = DstATL.getElementLoc(); 5019 DstElemTL.initializeFullCopy(SrcElemTL); 5020 DstATL.setLBracketLoc(SrcATL.getLBracketLoc()); 5021 DstATL.setSizeExpr(SrcATL.getSizeExpr()); 5022 DstATL.setRBracketLoc(SrcATL.getRBracketLoc()); 5023 } 5024 5025 /// Helper method to turn variable array types into constant array 5026 /// types in certain situations which would otherwise be errors (for 5027 /// GCC compatibility). 5028 static TypeSourceInfo* 5029 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 5030 ASTContext &Context, 5031 bool &SizeIsNegative, 5032 llvm::APSInt &Oversized) { 5033 QualType FixedTy 5034 = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(TInfo->getType(), Context, 5035 SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 5036 if (FixedTy.isNull()) 5037 return nullptr; 5038 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(FixedTy); 5039 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(TInfo->getTypeLoc(), 5040 FixedTInfo->getTypeLoc()); 5041 return FixedTInfo; 5042 } 5043 5044 /// \brief Register the given locally-scoped extern "C" declaration so 5045 /// that it can be found later for redeclarations. We include any extern "C" 5046 /// declaration that is not visible in the translation unit here, not just 5047 /// function-scope declarations. 5048 void 5049 Sema::RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NamedDecl *ND, Scope *S) { 5050 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 5051 ND->getLexicalDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) 5052 // Don't need to track declarations in the TU in C. 5053 return; 5054 5055 // Note that we have a locally-scoped external with this name. 5056 Context.getExternCContextDecl()->makeDeclVisibleInContext(ND); 5057 } 5058 5059 NamedDecl *Sema::findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(DeclarationName Name) { 5060 // FIXME: We can have multiple results via __attribute__((overloadable)). 5061 auto Result = Context.getExternCContextDecl()->lookup(Name); 5062 return Result.empty() ? nullptr : *Result.begin(); 5063 } 5064 5065 /// \brief Diagnose function specifiers on a declaration of an identifier that 5066 /// does not identify a function. 5067 void Sema::DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(const DeclSpec &DS) { 5068 // FIXME: We should probably indicate the identifier in question to avoid 5069 // confusion for constructs like "inline int a(), b;" 5070 if (DS.isInlineSpecified()) 5071 Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), 5072 diag::err_inline_non_function); 5073 5074 if (DS.isVirtualSpecified()) 5075 Diag(DS.getVirtualSpecLoc(), 5076 diag::err_virtual_non_function); 5077 5078 if (DS.isExplicitSpecified()) 5079 Diag(DS.getExplicitSpecLoc(), 5080 diag::err_explicit_non_function); 5081 5082 if (DS.isNoreturnSpecified()) 5083 Diag(DS.getNoreturnSpecLoc(), 5084 diag::err_noreturn_non_function); 5085 } 5086 5087 NamedDecl* 5088 Sema::ActOnTypedefDeclarator(Scope* S, Declarator& D, DeclContext* DC, 5089 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous) { 5090 // Typedef declarators cannot be qualified (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1). 5091 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 5092 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_qualified_typedef_declarator) 5093 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 5094 D.setInvalidType(); 5095 // Pretend we didn't see the scope specifier. 5096 DC = CurContext; 5097 Previous.clear(); 5098 } 5099 5100 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec()); 5101 5102 if (D.getDeclSpec().isConstexprSpecified()) 5103 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr) 5104 << 1; 5105 5106 if (D.getName().Kind != UnqualifiedId::IK_Identifier) { 5107 Diag(D.getName().StartLocation, diag::err_typedef_not_identifier) 5108 << D.getName().getSourceRange(); 5109 return nullptr; 5110 } 5111 5112 TypedefDecl *NewTD = ParseTypedefDecl(S, D, TInfo->getType(), TInfo); 5113 if (!NewTD) return nullptr; 5114 5115 // Handle attributes prior to checking for duplicates in MergeVarDecl 5116 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewTD, D); 5117 5118 CheckTypedefForVariablyModifiedType(S, NewTD); 5119 5120 bool Redeclaration = D.isRedeclaration(); 5121 NamedDecl *ND = ActOnTypedefNameDecl(S, DC, NewTD, Previous, Redeclaration); 5122 D.setRedeclaration(Redeclaration); 5123 return ND; 5124 } 5125 5126 void 5127 Sema::CheckTypedefForVariablyModifiedType(Scope *S, TypedefNameDecl *NewTD) { 5128 // C99 6.7.7p2: If a typedef name specifies a variably modified type 5129 // then it shall have block scope. 5130 // Note that variably modified types must be fixed before merging the decl so 5131 // that redeclarations will match. 5132 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = NewTD->getTypeSourceInfo(); 5133 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 5134 if (T->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 5135 getCurFunction()->setHasBranchProtectedScope(); 5136 5137 if (S->getFnParent() == nullptr) { 5138 bool SizeIsNegative; 5139 llvm::APSInt Oversized; 5140 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = 5141 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TInfo, Context, 5142 SizeIsNegative, 5143 Oversized); 5144 if (FixedTInfo) { 5145 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::warn_illegal_constant_array_size); 5146 NewTD->setTypeSourceInfo(FixedTInfo); 5147 } else { 5148 if (SizeIsNegative) 5149 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_typecheck_negative_array_size); 5150 else if (T->isVariableArrayType()) 5151 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_in_file_scope); 5152 else if (Oversized.getBoolValue()) 5153 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_array_too_large) 5154 << Oversized.toString(10); 5155 else 5156 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_in_file_scope); 5157 NewTD->setInvalidDecl(); 5158 } 5159 } 5160 } 5161 } 5162 5163 5164 /// ActOnTypedefNameDecl - Perform semantic checking for a declaration which 5165 /// declares a typedef-name, either using the 'typedef' type specifier or via 5166 /// a C++0x [dcl.typedef]p2 alias-declaration: 'using T = A;'. 5167 NamedDecl* 5168 Sema::ActOnTypedefNameDecl(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC, TypedefNameDecl *NewTD, 5169 LookupResult &Previous, bool &Redeclaration) { 5170 // Merge the decl with the existing one if appropriate. If the decl is 5171 // in an outer scope, it isn't the same thing. 5172 FilterLookupForScope(Previous, DC, S, /*ConsiderLinkage*/false, 5173 /*AllowInlineNamespace*/false); 5174 filterNonConflictingPreviousTypedefDecls(*this, NewTD, Previous); 5175 if (!Previous.empty()) { 5176 Redeclaration = true; 5177 MergeTypedefNameDecl(NewTD, Previous); 5178 } 5179 5180 // If this is the C FILE type, notify the AST context. 5181 if (IdentifierInfo *II = NewTD->getIdentifier()) 5182 if (!NewTD->isInvalidDecl() && 5183 NewTD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) { 5184 if (II->isStr("FILE")) 5185 Context.setFILEDecl(NewTD); 5186 else if (II->isStr("jmp_buf")) 5187 Context.setjmp_bufDecl(NewTD); 5188 else if (II->isStr("sigjmp_buf")) 5189 Context.setsigjmp_bufDecl(NewTD); 5190 else if (II->isStr("ucontext_t")) 5191 Context.setucontext_tDecl(NewTD); 5192 } 5193 5194 return NewTD; 5195 } 5196 5197 /// \brief Determines whether the given declaration is an out-of-scope 5198 /// previous declaration. 5199 /// 5200 /// This routine should be invoked when name lookup has found a 5201 /// previous declaration (PrevDecl) that is not in the scope where a 5202 /// new declaration by the same name is being introduced. If the new 5203 /// declaration occurs in a local scope, previous declarations with 5204 /// linkage may still be considered previous declarations (C99 5205 /// 6.2.2p4-5, C++ [basic.link]p6). 5206 /// 5207 /// \param PrevDecl the previous declaration found by name 5208 /// lookup 5209 /// 5210 /// \param DC the context in which the new declaration is being 5211 /// declared. 5212 /// 5213 /// \returns true if PrevDecl is an out-of-scope previous declaration 5214 /// for a new delcaration with the same name. 5215 static bool 5216 isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(NamedDecl *PrevDecl, DeclContext *DC, 5217 ASTContext &Context) { 5218 if (!PrevDecl) 5219 return false; 5220 5221 if (!PrevDecl->hasLinkage()) 5222 return false; 5223 5224 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5225 // C++ [basic.link]p6: 5226 // If there is a visible declaration of an entity with linkage 5227 // having the same name and type, ignoring entities declared 5228 // outside the innermost enclosing namespace scope, the block 5229 // scope declaration declares that same entity and receives the 5230 // linkage of the previous declaration. 5231 DeclContext *OuterContext = DC->getRedeclContext(); 5232 if (!OuterContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 5233 // This rule only applies to block-scope declarations. 5234 return false; 5235 5236 DeclContext *PrevOuterContext = PrevDecl->getDeclContext(); 5237 if (PrevOuterContext->isRecord()) 5238 // We found a member function: ignore it. 5239 return false; 5240 5241 // Find the innermost enclosing namespace for the new and 5242 // previous declarations. 5243 OuterContext = OuterContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 5244 PrevOuterContext = PrevOuterContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 5245 5246 // The previous declaration is in a different namespace, so it 5247 // isn't the same function. 5248 if (!OuterContext->Equals(PrevOuterContext)) 5249 return false; 5250 } 5251 5252 return true; 5253 } 5254 5255 static void SetNestedNameSpecifier(DeclaratorDecl *DD, Declarator &D) { 5256 CXXScopeSpec &SS = D.getCXXScopeSpec(); 5257 if (!SS.isSet()) return; 5258 DD->setQualifierInfo(SS.getWithLocInContext(DD->getASTContext())); 5259 } 5260 5261 bool Sema::inferObjCARCLifetime(ValueDecl *decl) { 5262 QualType type = decl->getType(); 5263 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = type.getObjCLifetime(); 5264 if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) { 5265 // Various kinds of declaration aren't allowed to be __autoreleasing. 5266 unsigned kind = -1U; 5267 if (VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(decl)) { 5268 if (var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 5269 kind = 0; // __block 5270 else if (!var->hasLocalStorage()) 5271 kind = 1; // global 5272 } else if (isa<ObjCIvarDecl>(decl)) { 5273 kind = 3; // ivar 5274 } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(decl)) { 5275 kind = 2; // field 5276 } 5277 5278 if (kind != -1U) { 5279 Diag(decl->getLocation(), diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_var) 5280 << kind; 5281 } 5282 } else if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_None) { 5283 // Try to infer lifetime. 5284 if (!type->isObjCLifetimeType()) 5285 return false; 5286 5287 lifetime = type->getObjCARCImplicitLifetime(); 5288 type = Context.getLifetimeQualifiedType(type, lifetime); 5289 decl->setType(type); 5290 } 5291 5292 if (VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(decl)) { 5293 // Thread-local variables cannot have lifetime. 5294 if (lifetime && lifetime != Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone && 5295 var->getTLSKind()) { 5296 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_arc_thread_ownership) 5297 << var->getType(); 5298 return true; 5299 } 5300 } 5301 5302 return false; 5303 } 5304 5305 static void checkAttributesAfterMerging(Sema &S, NamedDecl &ND) { 5306 // Ensure that an auto decl is deduced otherwise the checks below might cache 5307 // the wrong linkage. 5308 assert(S.ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(&ND) == 0); 5309 5310 // 'weak' only applies to declarations with external linkage. 5311 if (WeakAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<WeakAttr>()) { 5312 if (!ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 5313 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_weak_static); 5314 ND.dropAttr<WeakAttr>(); 5315 } 5316 } 5317 if (WeakRefAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<WeakRefAttr>()) { 5318 if (ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 5319 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_weakref_not_static); 5320 ND.dropAttr<WeakRefAttr>(); 5321 ND.dropAttr<AliasAttr>(); 5322 } 5323 } 5324 5325 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(&ND)) { 5326 if (VD->hasInit()) { 5327 if (const auto *Attr = VD->getAttr<AliasAttr>()) { 5328 assert(VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 5329 !VD->isExternallyVisible() && "Broken AliasAttr handled late!"); 5330 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << VD; 5331 VD->dropAttr<AliasAttr>(); 5332 } 5333 } 5334 } 5335 5336 // 'selectany' only applies to externally visible variable declarations. 5337 // It does not apply to functions. 5338 if (SelectAnyAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<SelectAnyAttr>()) { 5339 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(ND) || !ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 5340 S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), 5341 diag::err_attribute_selectany_non_extern_data); 5342 ND.dropAttr<SelectAnyAttr>(); 5343 } 5344 } 5345 5346 // dll attributes require external linkage. 5347 if (const InheritableAttr *Attr = getDLLAttr(&ND)) { 5348 if (!ND.isExternallyVisible()) { 5349 S.Diag(ND.getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dll_not_extern) 5350 << &ND << Attr; 5351 ND.setInvalidDecl(); 5352 } 5353 } 5354 } 5355 5356 static void checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(Sema &S, NamedDecl *OldDecl, 5357 NamedDecl *NewDecl, 5358 bool IsSpecialization) { 5359 if (TemplateDecl *OldTD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(OldDecl)) 5360 OldDecl = OldTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 5361 if (TemplateDecl *NewTD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(NewDecl)) 5362 NewDecl = NewTD->getTemplatedDecl(); 5363 5364 if (!OldDecl || !NewDecl) 5365 return; 5366 5367 const DLLImportAttr *OldImportAttr = OldDecl->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 5368 const DLLExportAttr *OldExportAttr = OldDecl->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>(); 5369 const DLLImportAttr *NewImportAttr = NewDecl->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 5370 const DLLExportAttr *NewExportAttr = NewDecl->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>(); 5371 5372 // dllimport and dllexport are inheritable attributes so we have to exclude 5373 // inherited attribute instances. 5374 bool HasNewAttr = (NewImportAttr && !NewImportAttr->isInherited()) || 5375 (NewExportAttr && !NewExportAttr->isInherited()); 5376 5377 // A redeclaration is not allowed to add a dllimport or dllexport attribute, 5378 // the only exception being explicit specializations. 5379 // Implicitly generated declarations are also excluded for now because there 5380 // is no other way to switch these to use dllimport or dllexport. 5381 bool AddsAttr = !(OldImportAttr || OldExportAttr) && HasNewAttr; 5382 5383 if (AddsAttr && !IsSpecialization && !OldDecl->isImplicit()) { 5384 // If the declaration hasn't been used yet, allow with a warning for 5385 // free functions and global variables. 5386 bool JustWarn = false; 5387 if (!OldDecl->isUsed() && !OldDecl->isCXXClassMember()) { 5388 auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(OldDecl); 5389 if (VD && !VD->getDescribedVarTemplate()) 5390 JustWarn = true; 5391 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl); 5392 if (FD && FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_NonTemplate) 5393 JustWarn = true; 5394 } 5395 5396 unsigned DiagID = JustWarn ? diag::warn_attribute_dll_redeclaration 5397 : diag::err_attribute_dll_redeclaration; 5398 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), DiagID) 5399 << NewDecl 5400 << (NewImportAttr ? (const Attr *)NewImportAttr : NewExportAttr); 5401 S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 5402 if (!JustWarn) { 5403 NewDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 5404 return; 5405 } 5406 } 5407 5408 // A redeclaration is not allowed to drop a dllimport attribute, the only 5409 // exceptions being inline function definitions, local extern declarations, 5410 // and qualified friend declarations. 5411 // NB: MSVC converts such a declaration to dllexport. 5412 bool IsInline = false, IsStaticDataMember = false, IsQualifiedFriend = false; 5413 if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(NewDecl)) 5414 // Ignore static data because out-of-line definitions are diagnosed 5415 // separately. 5416 IsStaticDataMember = VD->isStaticDataMember(); 5417 else if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NewDecl)) { 5418 IsInline = FD->isInlined(); 5419 IsQualifiedFriend = FD->getQualifier() && 5420 FD->getFriendObjectKind() == Decl::FOK_Declared; 5421 } 5422 5423 if (OldImportAttr && !HasNewAttr && !IsInline && !IsStaticDataMember && 5424 !NewDecl->isLocalExternDecl() && !IsQualifiedFriend) { 5425 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), 5426 diag::warn_redeclaration_without_attribute_prev_attribute_ignored) 5427 << NewDecl << OldImportAttr; 5428 S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 5429 S.Diag(OldImportAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_attribute); 5430 OldDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 5431 NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 5432 } else if (IsInline && OldImportAttr && 5433 !S.Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) { 5434 // In MinGW, seeing a function declared inline drops the dllimport attribute. 5435 OldDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 5436 NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>(); 5437 S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), 5438 diag::warn_dllimport_dropped_from_inline_function) 5439 << NewDecl << OldImportAttr; 5440 } 5441 } 5442 5443 /// Given that we are within the definition of the given function, 5444 /// will that definition behave like C99's 'inline', where the 5445 /// definition is discarded except for optimization purposes? 5446 static bool isFunctionDefinitionDiscarded(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD) { 5447 // Try to avoid calling GetGVALinkageForFunction. 5448 5449 // All cases of this require the 'inline' keyword. 5450 if (!FD->isInlined()) return false; 5451 5452 // This is only possible in C++ with the gnu_inline attribute. 5453 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) 5454 return false; 5455 5456 // Okay, go ahead and call the relatively-more-expensive function. 5457 5458 #ifndef NDEBUG 5459 // AST quite reasonably asserts that it's working on a function 5460 // definition. We don't really have a way to tell it that we're 5461 // currently defining the function, so just lie to it in +Asserts 5462 // builds. This is an awful hack. 5463 FD->setLazyBody(1); 5464 #endif 5465 5466 bool isC99Inline = 5467 S.Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD) == GVA_AvailableExternally; 5468 5469 #ifndef NDEBUG 5470 FD->setLazyBody(0); 5471 #endif 5472 5473 return isC99Inline; 5474 } 5475 5476 /// Determine whether a variable is extern "C" prior to attaching 5477 /// an initializer. We can't just call isExternC() here, because that 5478 /// will also compute and cache whether the declaration is externally 5479 /// visible, which might change when we attach the initializer. 5480 /// 5481 /// This can only be used if the declaration is known to not be a 5482 /// redeclaration of an internal linkage declaration. 5483 /// 5484 /// For instance: 5485 /// 5486 /// auto x = []{}; 5487 /// 5488 /// Attaching the initializer here makes this declaration not externally 5489 /// visible, because its type has internal linkage. 5490 /// 5491 /// FIXME: This is a hack. 5492 template<typename T> 5493 static bool isIncompleteDeclExternC(Sema &S, const T *D) { 5494 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5495 // In C++, the overloadable attribute negates the effects of extern "C". 5496 if (!D->isInExternCContext() || D->template hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) 5497 return false; 5498 } 5499 return D->isExternC(); 5500 } 5501 5502 static bool shouldConsiderLinkage(const VarDecl *VD) { 5503 const DeclContext *DC = VD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 5504 if (DC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 5505 return VD->hasExternalStorage(); 5506 if (DC->isFileContext()) 5507 return true; 5508 if (DC->isRecord()) 5509 return false; 5510 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected context"); 5511 } 5512 5513 static bool shouldConsiderLinkage(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 5514 const DeclContext *DC = FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 5515 if (DC->isFileContext() || DC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 5516 return true; 5517 if (DC->isRecord()) 5518 return false; 5519 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected context"); 5520 } 5521 5522 static bool hasParsedAttr(Scope *S, const AttributeList *AttrList, 5523 AttributeList::Kind Kind) { 5524 for (const AttributeList *L = AttrList; L; L = L->getNext()) 5525 if (L->getKind() == Kind) 5526 return true; 5527 return false; 5528 } 5529 5530 static bool hasParsedAttr(Scope *S, const Declarator &PD, 5531 AttributeList::Kind Kind) { 5532 // Check decl attributes on the DeclSpec. 5533 if (hasParsedAttr(S, PD.getDeclSpec().getAttributes().getList(), Kind)) 5534 return true; 5535 5536 // Walk the declarator structure, checking decl attributes that were in a type 5537 // position to the decl itself. 5538 for (unsigned I = 0, E = PD.getNumTypeObjects(); I != E; ++I) { 5539 if (hasParsedAttr(S, PD.getTypeObject(I).getAttrs(), Kind)) 5540 return true; 5541 } 5542 5543 // Finally, check attributes on the decl itself. 5544 return hasParsedAttr(S, PD.getAttributes(), Kind); 5545 } 5546 5547 /// Adjust the \c DeclContext for a function or variable that might be a 5548 /// function-local external declaration. 5549 bool Sema::adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DeclContext *&DC) { 5550 if (!DC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 5551 return false; 5552 5553 // If this is a local extern function or variable declared within a function 5554 // template, don't add it into the enclosing namespace scope until it is 5555 // instantiated; it might have a dependent type right now. 5556 if (DC->isDependentContext()) 5557 return true; 5558 5559 // C++11 [basic.link]p7: 5560 // When a block scope declaration of an entity with linkage is not found to 5561 // refer to some other declaration, then that entity is a member of the 5562 // innermost enclosing namespace. 5563 // 5564 // Per C++11 [namespace.def]p6, the innermost enclosing namespace is a 5565 // semantically-enclosing namespace, not a lexically-enclosing one. 5566 while (!DC->isFileContext() && !isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(DC)) 5567 DC = DC->getParent(); 5568 return true; 5569 } 5570 5571 /// \brief Returns true if given declaration is TU-scoped and externally 5572 /// visible. 5573 static bool isDeclTUScopedExternallyVisible(const Decl *D) { 5574 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) 5575 return (FD->getDeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() || FD->isExternC()) && 5576 FD->hasExternalFormalLinkage(); 5577 else if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) 5578 return (VD->getDeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() || VD->isExternC()) && 5579 VD->hasExternalFormalLinkage(); 5580 5581 llvm_unreachable("Unknown type of decl!"); 5582 } 5583 5584 NamedDecl * 5585 Sema::ActOnVariableDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC, 5586 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous, 5587 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists, 5588 bool &AddToScope) { 5589 QualType R = TInfo->getType(); 5590 DeclarationName Name = GetNameForDeclarator(D).getName(); 5591 5592 DeclSpec::SCS SCSpec = D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec(); 5593 StorageClass SC = StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(D.getDeclSpec()); 5594 5595 // dllimport globals without explicit storage class are treated as extern. We 5596 // have to change the storage class this early to get the right DeclContext. 5597 if (SC == SC_None && !DC->isRecord() && 5598 hasParsedAttr(S, D, AttributeList::AT_DLLImport) && 5599 !hasParsedAttr(S, D, AttributeList::AT_DLLExport)) 5600 SC = SC_Extern; 5601 5602 DeclContext *OriginalDC = DC; 5603 bool IsLocalExternDecl = SC == SC_Extern && 5604 adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DC); 5605 5606 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 5607 // OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3: Pointers to functions are not allowed. 5608 QualType NR = R; 5609 while (NR->isPointerType()) { 5610 if (NR->isFunctionPointerType()) { 5611 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_opencl_function_pointer_variable); 5612 D.setInvalidType(); 5613 break; 5614 } 5615 NR = NR->getPointeeType(); 5616 } 5617 5618 if (!getOpenCLOptions().cl_khr_fp16) { 5619 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.1.1.1: reject declaring variables of the half and 5620 // half array type (unless the cl_khr_fp16 extension is enabled). 5621 if (Context.getBaseElementType(R)->isHalfType()) { 5622 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_opencl_half_declaration) << R; 5623 D.setInvalidType(); 5624 } 5625 } 5626 } 5627 5628 if (SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) { 5629 // mutable can only appear on non-static class members, so it's always 5630 // an error here 5631 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember); 5632 D.setInvalidType(); 5633 SC = SC_None; 5634 } 5635 5636 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_register && 5637 !D.getAsmLabel() && !getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro( 5638 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc())) { 5639 // In C++11, the 'register' storage class specifier is deprecated. 5640 // Suppress the warning in system macros, it's used in macros in some 5641 // popular C system headers, such as in glibc's htonl() macro. 5642 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 5643 diag::warn_deprecated_register) 5644 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 5645 } 5646 5647 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 5648 if (!II) { 5649 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_variable_name) 5650 << Name; 5651 return nullptr; 5652 } 5653 5654 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec()); 5655 5656 if (!DC->isRecord() && S->getFnParent() == nullptr) { 5657 // C99 6.9p2: The storage-class specifiers auto and register shall not 5658 // appear in the declaration specifiers in an external declaration. 5659 // Global Register+Asm is a GNU extension we support. 5660 if (SC == SC_Auto || (SC == SC_Register && !D.getAsmLabel())) { 5661 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_sclass_fscope); 5662 D.setInvalidType(); 5663 } 5664 } 5665 5666 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 5667 // Set up the special work-group-local storage class for variables in the 5668 // OpenCL __local address space. 5669 if (R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) { 5670 SC = SC_OpenCLWorkGroupLocal; 5671 } 5672 5673 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.b p4: 5674 // The sampler type cannot be used with the __local and __global address 5675 // space qualifiers. 5676 if (R->isSamplerT() && (R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local || 5677 R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global)) { 5678 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_wrong_sampler_addressspace); 5679 } 5680 5681 // OpenCL 1.2 spec, p6.9 r: 5682 // The event type cannot be used to declare a program scope variable. 5683 // The event type cannot be used with the __local, __constant and __global 5684 // address space qualifiers. 5685 if (R->isEventT()) { 5686 if (S->getParent() == nullptr) { 5687 Diag(D.getLocStart(), diag::err_event_t_global_var); 5688 D.setInvalidType(); 5689 } 5690 5691 if (R.getAddressSpace()) { 5692 Diag(D.getLocStart(), diag::err_event_t_addr_space_qual); 5693 D.setInvalidType(); 5694 } 5695 } 5696 } 5697 5698 bool IsExplicitSpecialization = false; 5699 bool IsVariableTemplateSpecialization = false; 5700 bool IsPartialSpecialization = false; 5701 bool IsVariableTemplate = false; 5702 VarDecl *NewVD = nullptr; 5703 VarTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = nullptr; 5704 TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = nullptr; 5705 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5706 NewVD = VarDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getLocStart(), 5707 D.getIdentifierLoc(), II, 5708 R, TInfo, SC); 5709 5710 if (D.isInvalidType()) 5711 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 5712 } else { 5713 bool Invalid = false; 5714 5715 if (DC->isRecord() && !CurContext->isRecord()) { 5716 // This is an out-of-line definition of a static data member. 5717 switch (SC) { 5718 case SC_None: 5719 break; 5720 case SC_Static: 5721 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 5722 diag::err_static_out_of_line) 5723 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 5724 break; 5725 case SC_Auto: 5726 case SC_Register: 5727 case SC_Extern: 5728 // [dcl.stc] p2: The auto or register specifiers shall be applied only 5729 // to names of variables declared in a block or to function parameters. 5730 // [dcl.stc] p6: The extern specifier cannot be used in the declaration 5731 // of class members 5732 5733 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 5734 diag::err_storage_class_for_static_member) 5735 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 5736 break; 5737 case SC_PrivateExtern: 5738 llvm_unreachable("C storage class in c++!"); 5739 case SC_OpenCLWorkGroupLocal: 5740 llvm_unreachable("OpenCL storage class in c++!"); 5741 } 5742 } 5743 5744 if (SC == SC_Static && CurContext->isRecord()) { 5745 if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 5746 if (RD->isLocalClass()) 5747 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 5748 diag::err_static_data_member_not_allowed_in_local_class) 5749 << Name << RD->getDeclName(); 5750 5751 // C++98 [class.union]p1: If a union contains a static data member, 5752 // the program is ill-formed. C++11 drops this restriction. 5753 if (RD->isUnion()) 5754 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 5755 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 5756 ? diag::warn_cxx98_compat_static_data_member_in_union 5757 : diag::ext_static_data_member_in_union) << Name; 5758 // We conservatively disallow static data members in anonymous structs. 5759 else if (!RD->getDeclName()) 5760 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 5761 diag::err_static_data_member_not_allowed_in_anon_struct) 5762 << Name << RD->isUnion(); 5763 } 5764 } 5765 5766 // Match up the template parameter lists with the scope specifier, then 5767 // determine whether we have a template or a template specialization. 5768 TemplateParams = MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier( 5769 D.getDeclSpec().getLocStart(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), 5770 D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 5771 D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId 5772 ? D.getName().TemplateId 5773 : nullptr, 5774 TemplateParamLists, 5775 /*never a friend*/ false, IsExplicitSpecialization, Invalid); 5776 5777 if (TemplateParams) { 5778 if (!TemplateParams->size() && 5779 D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) { 5780 // There is an extraneous 'template<>' for this variable. Complain 5781 // about it, but allow the declaration of the variable. 5782 Diag(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), 5783 diag::err_template_variable_noparams) 5784 << II 5785 << SourceRange(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), 5786 TemplateParams->getRAngleLoc()); 5787 TemplateParams = nullptr; 5788 } else { 5789 if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) { 5790 // This is an explicit specialization or a partial specialization. 5791 // FIXME: Check that we can declare a specialization here. 5792 IsVariableTemplateSpecialization = true; 5793 IsPartialSpecialization = TemplateParams->size() > 0; 5794 } else { // if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) 5795 // This is a template declaration. 5796 IsVariableTemplate = true; 5797 5798 // Check that we can declare a template here. 5799 if (CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParams)) 5800 return nullptr; 5801 5802 // Only C++1y supports variable templates (N3651). 5803 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 5804 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 5805 ? diag::warn_cxx11_compat_variable_template 5806 : diag::ext_variable_template); 5807 } 5808 } 5809 } else { 5810 assert( 5811 (Invalid || D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) && 5812 "should have a 'template<>' for this decl"); 5813 } 5814 5815 if (IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) { 5816 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = 5817 TemplateParamLists.size() > 0 5818 ? TemplateParamLists[0]->getTemplateLoc() 5819 : SourceLocation(); 5820 DeclResult Res = ActOnVarTemplateSpecialization( 5821 S, D, TInfo, TemplateKWLoc, TemplateParams, SC, 5822 IsPartialSpecialization); 5823 if (Res.isInvalid()) 5824 return nullptr; 5825 NewVD = cast<VarDecl>(Res.get()); 5826 AddToScope = false; 5827 } else 5828 NewVD = VarDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getLocStart(), 5829 D.getIdentifierLoc(), II, R, TInfo, SC); 5830 5831 // If this is supposed to be a variable template, create it as such. 5832 if (IsVariableTemplate) { 5833 NewTemplate = 5834 VarTemplateDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name, 5835 TemplateParams, NewVD); 5836 NewVD->setDescribedVarTemplate(NewTemplate); 5837 } 5838 5839 // If this decl has an auto type in need of deduction, make a note of the 5840 // Decl so we can diagnose uses of it in its own initializer. 5841 if (D.getDeclSpec().containsPlaceholderType() && R->getContainedAutoType()) 5842 ParsingInitForAutoVars.insert(NewVD); 5843 5844 if (D.isInvalidType() || Invalid) { 5845 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 5846 if (NewTemplate) 5847 NewTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 5848 } 5849 5850 SetNestedNameSpecifier(NewVD, D); 5851 5852 // If we have any template parameter lists that don't directly belong to 5853 // the variable (matching the scope specifier), store them. 5854 unsigned VDTemplateParamLists = TemplateParams ? 1 : 0; 5855 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > VDTemplateParamLists) 5856 NewVD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo( 5857 Context, TemplateParamLists.size() - VDTemplateParamLists, 5858 TemplateParamLists.data()); 5859 5860 if (D.getDeclSpec().isConstexprSpecified()) 5861 NewVD->setConstexpr(true); 5862 } 5863 5864 // Set the lexical context. If the declarator has a C++ scope specifier, the 5865 // lexical context will be different from the semantic context. 5866 NewVD->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 5867 if (NewTemplate) 5868 NewTemplate->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 5869 5870 if (IsLocalExternDecl) 5871 NewVD->setLocalExternDecl(); 5872 5873 bool EmitTLSUnsupportedError = false; 5874 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) { 5875 // C++11 [dcl.stc]p4: 5876 // When thread_local is applied to a variable of block scope the 5877 // storage-class-specifier static is implied if it does not appear 5878 // explicitly. 5879 // Core issue: 'static' is not implied if the variable is declared 5880 // 'extern'. 5881 if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && 5882 (SCSpec != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified || 5883 TSCS != DeclSpec::TSCS_thread_local || 5884 !DC->isFunctionOrMethod())) 5885 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 5886 diag::err_thread_non_global) 5887 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 5888 else if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isTLSSupported()) { 5889 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) { 5890 // Postpone error emission until we've collected attributes required to 5891 // figure out whether it's a host or device variable and whether the 5892 // error should be ignored. 5893 EmitTLSUnsupportedError = true; 5894 // We still need to mark the variable as TLS so it shows up in AST with 5895 // proper storage class for other tools to use even if we're not going 5896 // to emit any code for it. 5897 NewVD->setTSCSpec(TSCS); 5898 } else 5899 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 5900 diag::err_thread_unsupported); 5901 } else 5902 NewVD->setTSCSpec(TSCS); 5903 } 5904 5905 // C99 6.7.4p3 5906 // An inline definition of a function with external linkage shall 5907 // not contain a definition of a modifiable object with static or 5908 // thread storage duration... 5909 // We only apply this when the function is required to be defined 5910 // elsewhere, i.e. when the function is not 'extern inline'. Note 5911 // that a local variable with thread storage duration still has to 5912 // be marked 'static'. Also note that it's possible to get these 5913 // semantics in C++ using __attribute__((gnu_inline)). 5914 if (SC == SC_Static && S->getFnParent() != nullptr && 5915 !NewVD->getType().isConstQualified()) { 5916 FunctionDecl *CurFD = getCurFunctionDecl(); 5917 if (CurFD && isFunctionDefinitionDiscarded(*this, CurFD)) { 5918 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 5919 diag::warn_static_local_in_extern_inline); 5920 MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(CurFD); 5921 } 5922 } 5923 5924 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) { 5925 if (IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) 5926 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization) 5927 << (IsPartialSpecialization ? 1 : 0) 5928 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 5929 D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 5930 else if (IsExplicitSpecialization) 5931 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization) 5932 << 2 5933 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 5934 else if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage()) 5935 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local) 5936 << 0 << NewVD->getDeclName() 5937 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()) 5938 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 5939 else { 5940 NewVD->setModulePrivate(); 5941 if (NewTemplate) 5942 NewTemplate->setModulePrivate(); 5943 } 5944 } 5945 5946 // Handle attributes prior to checking for duplicates in MergeVarDecl 5947 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewVD, D); 5948 5949 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) { 5950 if (EmitTLSUnsupportedError && DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), NewVD)) 5951 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 5952 diag::err_thread_unsupported); 5953 // CUDA B.2.5: "__shared__ and __constant__ variables have implied static 5954 // storage [duration]." 5955 if (SC == SC_None && S->getFnParent() != nullptr && 5956 (NewVD->hasAttr<CUDASharedAttr>() || 5957 NewVD->hasAttr<CUDAConstantAttr>())) { 5958 NewVD->setStorageClass(SC_Static); 5959 } 5960 } 5961 5962 // Ensure that dllimport globals without explicit storage class are treated as 5963 // extern. The storage class is set above using parsed attributes. Now we can 5964 // check the VarDecl itself. 5965 assert(!NewVD->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() || 5966 NewVD->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>()->isInherited() || 5967 NewVD->isStaticDataMember() || NewVD->getStorageClass() != SC_None); 5968 5969 // In auto-retain/release, infer strong retension for variables of 5970 // retainable type. 5971 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewVD)) 5972 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 5973 5974 // Handle GNU asm-label extension (encoded as an attribute). 5975 if (Expr *E = (Expr*)D.getAsmLabel()) { 5976 // The parser guarantees this is a string. 5977 StringLiteral *SE = cast<StringLiteral>(E); 5978 StringRef Label = SE->getString(); 5979 if (S->getFnParent() != nullptr) { 5980 switch (SC) { 5981 case SC_None: 5982 case SC_Auto: 5983 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_asm_label_on_auto_decl) << Label; 5984 break; 5985 case SC_Register: 5986 // Local Named register 5987 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isValidGCCRegisterName(Label)) 5988 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_unknown_register_name) << Label; 5989 break; 5990 case SC_Static: 5991 case SC_Extern: 5992 case SC_PrivateExtern: 5993 case SC_OpenCLWorkGroupLocal: 5994 break; 5995 } 5996 } else if (SC == SC_Register) { 5997 // Global Named register 5998 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isValidGCCRegisterName(Label)) 5999 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_unknown_register_name) << Label; 6000 if (!R->isIntegralType(Context) && !R->isPointerType()) { 6001 Diag(D.getLocStart(), diag::err_asm_bad_register_type); 6002 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(true); 6003 } 6004 } 6005 6006 NewVD->addAttr(::new (Context) AsmLabelAttr(SE->getStrTokenLoc(0), 6007 Context, Label, 0)); 6008 } else if (!ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.empty() && 6009 isDeclTUScopedExternallyVisible(NewVD)) { 6010 llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*,AsmLabelAttr*>::iterator I = 6011 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.find(NewVD->getIdentifier()); 6012 if (I != ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.end()) { 6013 NewVD->addAttr(I->second); 6014 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.erase(I); 6015 } 6016 } 6017 6018 // Diagnose shadowed variables before filtering for scope. 6019 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isEmpty()) 6020 CheckShadow(S, NewVD, Previous); 6021 6022 // Don't consider existing declarations that are in a different 6023 // scope and are out-of-semantic-context declarations (if the new 6024 // declaration has linkage). 6025 FilterLookupForScope(Previous, OriginalDC, S, shouldConsiderLinkage(NewVD), 6026 D.getCXXScopeSpec().isNotEmpty() || 6027 IsExplicitSpecialization || 6028 IsVariableTemplateSpecialization); 6029 6030 // Check whether the previous declaration is in the same block scope. This 6031 // affects whether we merge types with it, per C++11 [dcl.array]p3. 6032 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 6033 NewVD->isLocalVarDecl() && NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) 6034 NewVD->setPreviousDeclInSameBlockScope( 6035 Previous.isSingleResult() && !Previous.isShadowed() && 6036 isDeclInScope(Previous.getFoundDecl(), OriginalDC, S, false)); 6037 6038 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6039 D.setRedeclaration(CheckVariableDeclaration(NewVD, Previous)); 6040 } else { 6041 // If this is an explicit specialization of a static data member, check it. 6042 if (IsExplicitSpecialization && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl() && 6043 CheckMemberSpecialization(NewVD, Previous)) 6044 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 6045 6046 // Merge the decl with the existing one if appropriate. 6047 if (!Previous.empty()) { 6048 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && 6049 isa<FieldDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()) && 6050 D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 6051 // The user tried to define a non-static data member 6052 // out-of-line (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1). 6053 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_nonstatic_member_out_of_line) 6054 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 6055 Previous.clear(); 6056 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 6057 } 6058 } else if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 6059 // No previous declaration in the qualifying scope. 6060 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_no_member) 6061 << Name << computeDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), true) 6062 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 6063 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 6064 } 6065 6066 if (!IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) 6067 D.setRedeclaration(CheckVariableDeclaration(NewVD, Previous)); 6068 6069 if (NewTemplate) { 6070 VarTemplateDecl *PrevVarTemplate = 6071 NewVD->getPreviousDecl() 6072 ? NewVD->getPreviousDecl()->getDescribedVarTemplate() 6073 : nullptr; 6074 6075 // Check the template parameter list of this declaration, possibly 6076 // merging in the template parameter list from the previous variable 6077 // template declaration. 6078 if (CheckTemplateParameterList( 6079 TemplateParams, 6080 PrevVarTemplate ? PrevVarTemplate->getTemplateParameters() 6081 : nullptr, 6082 (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet() && DC && DC->isRecord() && 6083 DC->isDependentContext()) 6084 ? TPC_ClassTemplateMember 6085 : TPC_VarTemplate)) 6086 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 6087 6088 // If we are providing an explicit specialization of a static variable 6089 // template, make a note of that. 6090 if (PrevVarTemplate && 6091 PrevVarTemplate->getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()) 6092 PrevVarTemplate->setMemberSpecialization(); 6093 } 6094 } 6095 6096 ProcessPragmaWeak(S, NewVD); 6097 6098 // If this is the first declaration of an extern C variable, update 6099 // the map of such variables. 6100 if (NewVD->isFirstDecl() && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl() && 6101 isIncompleteDeclExternC(*this, NewVD)) 6102 RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NewVD, S); 6103 6104 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 6105 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 6106 if (MangleNumberingContext *MCtx = getCurrentMangleNumberContext( 6107 NewVD->getDeclContext(), ManglingContextDecl)) { 6108 Context.setManglingNumber( 6109 NewVD, MCtx->getManglingNumber( 6110 NewVD, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), S))); 6111 Context.setStaticLocalNumber(NewVD, MCtx->getStaticLocalNumber(NewVD)); 6112 } 6113 } 6114 6115 if (D.isRedeclaration() && !Previous.empty()) { 6116 checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration( 6117 *this, dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl()), NewVD, 6118 IsExplicitSpecialization); 6119 } 6120 6121 if (NewTemplate) { 6122 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 6123 NewTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 6124 ActOnDocumentableDecl(NewTemplate); 6125 return NewTemplate; 6126 } 6127 6128 return NewVD; 6129 } 6130 6131 /// \brief Diagnose variable or built-in function shadowing. Implements 6132 /// -Wshadow. 6133 /// 6134 /// This method is called whenever a VarDecl is added to a "useful" 6135 /// scope. 6136 /// 6137 /// \param S the scope in which the shadowing name is being declared 6138 /// \param R the lookup of the name 6139 /// 6140 void Sema::CheckShadow(Scope *S, VarDecl *D, const LookupResult& R) { 6141 // Return if warning is ignored. 6142 if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_decl_shadow, R.getNameLoc())) 6143 return; 6144 6145 // Don't diagnose declarations at file scope. 6146 if (D->hasGlobalStorage()) 6147 return; 6148 6149 DeclContext *NewDC = D->getDeclContext(); 6150 6151 // Only diagnose if we're shadowing an unambiguous field or variable. 6152 if (R.getResultKind() != LookupResult::Found) 6153 return; 6154 6155 NamedDecl* ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 6156 if (!isa<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl) && !isa<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 6157 return; 6158 6159 // Fields are not shadowed by variables in C++ static methods. 6160 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 6161 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDC)) 6162 if (MD->isStatic()) 6163 return; 6164 6165 if (VarDecl *shadowedVar = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 6166 if (shadowedVar->isExternC()) { 6167 // For shadowing external vars, make sure that we point to the global 6168 // declaration, not a locally scoped extern declaration. 6169 for (auto I : shadowedVar->redecls()) 6170 if (I->isFileVarDecl()) { 6171 ShadowedDecl = I; 6172 break; 6173 } 6174 } 6175 6176 DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext(); 6177 6178 // Only warn about certain kinds of shadowing for class members. 6179 if (NewDC && NewDC->isRecord()) { 6180 // In particular, don't warn about shadowing non-class members. 6181 if (!OldDC->isRecord()) 6182 return; 6183 6184 // TODO: should we warn about static data members shadowing 6185 // static data members from base classes? 6186 6187 // TODO: don't diagnose for inaccessible shadowed members. 6188 // This is hard to do perfectly because we might friend the 6189 // shadowing context, but that's just a false negative. 6190 } 6191 6192 // Determine what kind of declaration we're shadowing. 6193 unsigned Kind; 6194 if (isa<RecordDecl>(OldDC)) { 6195 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) 6196 Kind = 3; // field 6197 else 6198 Kind = 2; // static data member 6199 } else if (OldDC->isFileContext()) 6200 Kind = 1; // global 6201 else 6202 Kind = 0; // local 6203 6204 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName(); 6205 6206 // Emit warning and note. 6207 if (getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro(R.getNameLoc())) 6208 return; 6209 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::warn_decl_shadow) << Name << Kind << OldDC; 6210 Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 6211 } 6212 6213 /// \brief Check -Wshadow without the advantage of a previous lookup. 6214 void Sema::CheckShadow(Scope *S, VarDecl *D) { 6215 if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_decl_shadow, D->getLocation())) 6216 return; 6217 6218 LookupResult R(*this, D->getDeclName(), D->getLocation(), 6219 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, Sema::ForRedeclaration); 6220 LookupName(R, S); 6221 CheckShadow(S, D, R); 6222 } 6223 6224 /// Check for conflict between this global or extern "C" declaration and 6225 /// previous global or extern "C" declarations. This is only used in C++. 6226 template<typename T> 6227 static bool checkGlobalOrExternCConflict( 6228 Sema &S, const T *ND, bool IsGlobal, LookupResult &Previous) { 6229 assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "only C++ has extern \"C\""); 6230 NamedDecl *Prev = S.findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(ND->getDeclName()); 6231 6232 if (!Prev && IsGlobal && !isIncompleteDeclExternC(S, ND)) { 6233 // The common case: this global doesn't conflict with any extern "C" 6234 // declaration. 6235 return false; 6236 } 6237 6238 if (Prev) { 6239 if (!IsGlobal || isIncompleteDeclExternC(S, ND)) { 6240 // Both the old and new declarations have C language linkage. This is a 6241 // redeclaration. 6242 Previous.clear(); 6243 Previous.addDecl(Prev); 6244 return true; 6245 } 6246 6247 // This is a global, non-extern "C" declaration, and there is a previous 6248 // non-global extern "C" declaration. Diagnose if this is a variable 6249 // declaration. 6250 if (!isa<VarDecl>(ND)) 6251 return false; 6252 } else { 6253 // The declaration is extern "C". Check for any declaration in the 6254 // translation unit which might conflict. 6255 if (IsGlobal) { 6256 // We have already performed the lookup into the translation unit. 6257 IsGlobal = false; 6258 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Previous.begin(), E = Previous.end(); 6259 I != E; ++I) { 6260 if (isa<VarDecl>(*I)) { 6261 Prev = *I; 6262 break; 6263 } 6264 } 6265 } else { 6266 DeclContext::lookup_result R = 6267 S.Context.getTranslationUnitDecl()->lookup(ND->getDeclName()); 6268 for (DeclContext::lookup_result::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); 6269 I != E; ++I) { 6270 if (isa<VarDecl>(*I)) { 6271 Prev = *I; 6272 break; 6273 } 6274 // FIXME: If we have any other entity with this name in global scope, 6275 // the declaration is ill-formed, but that is a defect: it breaks the 6276 // 'stat' hack, for instance. Only variables can have mangled name 6277 // clashes with extern "C" declarations, so only they deserve a 6278 // diagnostic. 6279 } 6280 } 6281 6282 if (!Prev) 6283 return false; 6284 } 6285 6286 // Use the first declaration's location to ensure we point at something which 6287 // is lexically inside an extern "C" linkage-spec. 6288 assert(Prev && "should have found a previous declaration to diagnose"); 6289 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Prev)) 6290 Prev = FD->getFirstDecl(); 6291 else 6292 Prev = cast<VarDecl>(Prev)->getFirstDecl(); 6293 6294 S.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::err_extern_c_global_conflict) 6295 << IsGlobal << ND; 6296 S.Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_extern_c_global_conflict) 6297 << IsGlobal; 6298 return false; 6299 } 6300 6301 /// Apply special rules for handling extern "C" declarations. Returns \c true 6302 /// if we have found that this is a redeclaration of some prior entity. 6303 /// 6304 /// Per C++ [dcl.link]p6: 6305 /// Two declarations [for a function or variable] with C language linkage 6306 /// with the same name that appear in different scopes refer to the same 6307 /// [entity]. An entity with C language linkage shall not be declared with 6308 /// the same name as an entity in global scope. 6309 template<typename T> 6310 static bool checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(Sema &S, const T *ND, 6311 LookupResult &Previous) { 6312 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6313 // In C, when declaring a global variable, look for a corresponding 'extern' 6314 // variable declared in function scope. We don't need this in C++, because 6315 // we find local extern decls in the surrounding file-scope DeclContext. 6316 if (ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) { 6317 if (NamedDecl *Prev = S.findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(ND->getDeclName())) { 6318 Previous.clear(); 6319 Previous.addDecl(Prev); 6320 return true; 6321 } 6322 } 6323 return false; 6324 } 6325 6326 // A declaration in the translation unit can conflict with an extern "C" 6327 // declaration. 6328 if (ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) 6329 return checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(S, ND, /*IsGlobal*/true, Previous); 6330 6331 // An extern "C" declaration can conflict with a declaration in the 6332 // translation unit or can be a redeclaration of an extern "C" declaration 6333 // in another scope. 6334 if (isIncompleteDeclExternC(S,ND)) 6335 return checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(S, ND, /*IsGlobal*/false, Previous); 6336 6337 // Neither global nor extern "C": nothing to do. 6338 return false; 6339 } 6340 6341 void Sema::CheckVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *NewVD) { 6342 // If the decl is already known invalid, don't check it. 6343 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 6344 return; 6345 6346 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = NewVD->getTypeSourceInfo(); 6347 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 6348 6349 // Defer checking an 'auto' type until its initializer is attached. 6350 if (T->isUndeducedType()) 6351 return; 6352 6353 if (NewVD->hasAttrs()) 6354 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(NewVD); 6355 6356 if (T->isObjCObjectType()) { 6357 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_statically_allocated_object) 6358 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NewVD->getLocation(), "*"); 6359 T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T); 6360 NewVD->setType(T); 6361 } 6362 6363 // Emit an error if an address space was applied to decl with local storage. 6364 // This includes arrays of objects with address space qualifiers, but not 6365 // automatic variables that point to other address spaces. 6366 // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S5.1.2 6367 if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && T.getAddressSpace() != 0) { 6368 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_as_qualified_auto_decl); 6369 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 6370 return; 6371 } 6372 6373 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.5 - All program scope variables must be declared in the 6374 // __constant address space. 6375 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && NewVD->isFileVarDecl() 6376 && T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_constant 6377 && !T->isSamplerT()){ 6378 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_global_invalid_addr_space); 6379 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 6380 return; 6381 } 6382 6383 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 -- The static qualifier is valid only in program 6384 // scope. 6385 if ((getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion >= 120) 6386 && NewVD->isStaticLocal()) { 6387 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_static_function_scope); 6388 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 6389 return; 6390 } 6391 6392 if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && T.isObjCGCWeak() 6393 && !NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 6394 if (getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC) 6395 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_gc_attribute_weak_on_local); 6396 else { 6397 assert(!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 6398 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_weak_on_local); 6399 } 6400 } 6401 6402 bool isVM = T->isVariablyModifiedType(); 6403 if (isVM || NewVD->hasAttr<CleanupAttr>() || 6404 NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 6405 getCurFunction()->setHasBranchProtectedScope(); 6406 6407 if ((isVM && NewVD->hasLinkage()) || 6408 (T->isVariableArrayType() && NewVD->hasGlobalStorage())) { 6409 bool SizeIsNegative; 6410 llvm::APSInt Oversized; 6411 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = 6412 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TInfo, Context, 6413 SizeIsNegative, Oversized); 6414 if (!FixedTInfo && T->isVariableArrayType()) { 6415 const VariableArrayType *VAT = Context.getAsVariableArrayType(T); 6416 // FIXME: This won't give the correct result for 6417 // int a[10][n]; 6418 SourceRange SizeRange = VAT->getSizeExpr()->getSourceRange(); 6419 6420 if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl()) 6421 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_in_file_scope) 6422 << SizeRange; 6423 else if (NewVD->isStaticLocal()) 6424 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_has_static_storage) 6425 << SizeRange; 6426 else 6427 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_has_extern_linkage) 6428 << SizeRange; 6429 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 6430 return; 6431 } 6432 6433 if (!FixedTInfo) { 6434 if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl()) 6435 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_in_file_scope); 6436 else 6437 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_has_extern_linkage); 6438 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 6439 return; 6440 } 6441 6442 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_illegal_constant_array_size); 6443 NewVD->setType(FixedTInfo->getType()); 6444 NewVD->setTypeSourceInfo(FixedTInfo); 6445 } 6446 6447 if (T->isVoidType()) { 6448 // C++98 [dcl.stc]p5: The extern specifier can be applied only to the names 6449 // of objects and functions. 6450 if (NewVD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6451 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type) 6452 << T; 6453 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 6454 return; 6455 } 6456 } 6457 6458 if (!NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 6459 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_nonlocal); 6460 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 6461 return; 6462 } 6463 6464 if (isVM && NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 6465 Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_vm); 6466 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 6467 return; 6468 } 6469 6470 if (NewVD->isConstexpr() && !T->isDependentType() && 6471 RequireLiteralType(NewVD->getLocation(), T, 6472 diag::err_constexpr_var_non_literal)) { 6473 NewVD->setInvalidDecl(); 6474 return; 6475 } 6476 } 6477 6478 /// \brief Perform semantic checking on a newly-created variable 6479 /// declaration. 6480 /// 6481 /// This routine performs all of the type-checking required for a 6482 /// variable declaration once it has been built. It is used both to 6483 /// check variables after they have been parsed and their declarators 6484 /// have been translated into a declaration, and to check variables 6485 /// that have been instantiated from a template. 6486 /// 6487 /// Sets NewVD->isInvalidDecl() if an error was encountered. 6488 /// 6489 /// Returns true if the variable declaration is a redeclaration. 6490 bool Sema::CheckVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *NewVD, LookupResult &Previous) { 6491 CheckVariableDeclarationType(NewVD); 6492 6493 // If the decl is already known invalid, don't check it. 6494 if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl()) 6495 return false; 6496 6497 // If we did not find anything by this name, look for a non-visible 6498 // extern "C" declaration with the same name. 6499 if (Previous.empty() && 6500 checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(*this, NewVD, Previous)) 6501 Previous.setShadowed(); 6502 6503 // Filter out any non-conflicting previous declarations. 6504 filterNonConflictingPreviousDecls(*this, NewVD, Previous); 6505 6506 if (!Previous.empty()) { 6507 MergeVarDecl(NewVD, Previous); 6508 return true; 6509 } 6510 return false; 6511 } 6512 6513 /// \brief Data used with FindOverriddenMethod 6514 struct FindOverriddenMethodData { 6515 Sema *S; 6516 CXXMethodDecl *Method; 6517 }; 6518 6519 /// \brief Member lookup function that determines whether a given C++ 6520 /// method overrides a method in a base class, to be used with 6521 /// CXXRecordDecl::lookupInBases(). 6522 static bool FindOverriddenMethod(const CXXBaseSpecifier *Specifier, 6523 CXXBasePath &Path, 6524 void *UserData) { 6525 RecordDecl *BaseRecord = Specifier->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 6526 6527 FindOverriddenMethodData *Data 6528 = reinterpret_cast<FindOverriddenMethodData*>(UserData); 6529 6530 DeclarationName Name = Data->Method->getDeclName(); 6531 6532 // FIXME: Do we care about other names here too? 6533 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) { 6534 // We really want to find the base class destructor here. 6535 QualType T = Data->S->Context.getTypeDeclType(BaseRecord); 6536 CanQualType CT = Data->S->Context.getCanonicalType(T); 6537 6538 Name = Data->S->Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName(CT); 6539 } 6540 6541 for (Path.Decls = BaseRecord->lookup(Name); 6542 !Path.Decls.empty(); 6543 Path.Decls = Path.Decls.slice(1)) { 6544 NamedDecl *D = Path.Decls.front(); 6545 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) { 6546 if (MD->isVirtual() && !Data->S->IsOverload(Data->Method, MD, false)) 6547 return true; 6548 } 6549 } 6550 6551 return false; 6552 } 6553 6554 namespace { 6555 enum OverrideErrorKind { OEK_All, OEK_NonDeleted, OEK_Deleted }; 6556 } 6557 /// \brief Report an error regarding overriding, along with any relevant 6558 /// overriden methods. 6559 /// 6560 /// \param DiagID the primary error to report. 6561 /// \param MD the overriding method. 6562 /// \param OEK which overrides to include as notes. 6563 static void ReportOverrides(Sema& S, unsigned DiagID, const CXXMethodDecl *MD, 6564 OverrideErrorKind OEK = OEK_All) { 6565 S.Diag(MD->getLocation(), DiagID) << MD->getDeclName(); 6566 for (CXXMethodDecl::method_iterator I = MD->begin_overridden_methods(), 6567 E = MD->end_overridden_methods(); 6568 I != E; ++I) { 6569 // This check (& the OEK parameter) could be replaced by a predicate, but 6570 // without lambdas that would be overkill. This is still nicer than writing 6571 // out the diag loop 3 times. 6572 if ((OEK == OEK_All) || 6573 (OEK == OEK_NonDeleted && !(*I)->isDeleted()) || 6574 (OEK == OEK_Deleted && (*I)->isDeleted())) 6575 S.Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_overridden_virtual_function); 6576 } 6577 } 6578 6579 /// AddOverriddenMethods - See if a method overrides any in the base classes, 6580 /// and if so, check that it's a valid override and remember it. 6581 bool Sema::AddOverriddenMethods(CXXRecordDecl *DC, CXXMethodDecl *MD) { 6582 // Look for methods in base classes that this method might override. 6583 CXXBasePaths Paths; 6584 FindOverriddenMethodData Data; 6585 Data.Method = MD; 6586 Data.S = this; 6587 bool hasDeletedOverridenMethods = false; 6588 bool hasNonDeletedOverridenMethods = false; 6589 bool AddedAny = false; 6590 if (DC->lookupInBases(&FindOverriddenMethod, &Data, Paths)) { 6591 for (auto *I : Paths.found_decls()) { 6592 if (CXXMethodDecl *OldMD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(I)) { 6593 MD->addOverriddenMethod(OldMD->getCanonicalDecl()); 6594 if (!CheckOverridingFunctionReturnType(MD, OldMD) && 6595 !CheckOverridingFunctionAttributes(MD, OldMD) && 6596 !CheckOverridingFunctionExceptionSpec(MD, OldMD) && 6597 !CheckIfOverriddenFunctionIsMarkedFinal(MD, OldMD)) { 6598 hasDeletedOverridenMethods |= OldMD->isDeleted(); 6599 hasNonDeletedOverridenMethods |= !OldMD->isDeleted(); 6600 AddedAny = true; 6601 } 6602 } 6603 } 6604 } 6605 6606 if (hasDeletedOverridenMethods && !MD->isDeleted()) { 6607 ReportOverrides(*this, diag::err_non_deleted_override, MD, OEK_Deleted); 6608 } 6609 if (hasNonDeletedOverridenMethods && MD->isDeleted()) { 6610 ReportOverrides(*this, diag::err_deleted_override, MD, OEK_NonDeleted); 6611 } 6612 6613 return AddedAny; 6614 } 6615 6616 namespace { 6617 // Struct for holding all of the extra arguments needed by 6618 // DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration to call Sema::ActOnFunctionDeclarator. 6619 struct ActOnFDArgs { 6620 Scope *S; 6621 Declarator &D; 6622 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists; 6623 bool AddToScope; 6624 }; 6625 } 6626 6627 namespace { 6628 6629 // Callback to only accept typo corrections that have a non-zero edit distance. 6630 // Also only accept corrections that have the same parent decl. 6631 class DifferentNameValidatorCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback { 6632 public: 6633 DifferentNameValidatorCCC(ASTContext &Context, FunctionDecl *TypoFD, 6634 CXXRecordDecl *Parent) 6635 : Context(Context), OriginalFD(TypoFD), 6636 ExpectedParent(Parent ? Parent->getCanonicalDecl() : nullptr) {} 6637 6638 bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override { 6639 if (candidate.getEditDistance() == 0) 6640 return false; 6641 6642 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> MismatchedParams; 6643 for (TypoCorrection::const_decl_iterator CDecl = candidate.begin(), 6644 CDeclEnd = candidate.end(); 6645 CDecl != CDeclEnd; ++CDecl) { 6646 FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CDecl); 6647 6648 if (FD && !FD->hasBody() && 6649 hasSimilarParameters(Context, FD, OriginalFD, MismatchedParams)) { 6650 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 6651 CXXRecordDecl *Parent = MD->getParent(); 6652 if (Parent && Parent->getCanonicalDecl() == ExpectedParent) 6653 return true; 6654 } else if (!ExpectedParent) { 6655 return true; 6656 } 6657 } 6658 } 6659 6660 return false; 6661 } 6662 6663 private: 6664 ASTContext &Context; 6665 FunctionDecl *OriginalFD; 6666 CXXRecordDecl *ExpectedParent; 6667 }; 6668 6669 } 6670 6671 /// \brief Generate diagnostics for an invalid function redeclaration. 6672 /// 6673 /// This routine handles generating the diagnostic messages for an invalid 6674 /// function redeclaration, including finding possible similar declarations 6675 /// or performing typo correction if there are no previous declarations with 6676 /// the same name. 6677 /// 6678 /// Returns a NamedDecl iff typo correction was performed and substituting in 6679 /// the new declaration name does not cause new errors. 6680 static NamedDecl *DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration( 6681 Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &Previous, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 6682 ActOnFDArgs &ExtraArgs, bool IsLocalFriend, Scope *S) { 6683 DeclarationName Name = NewFD->getDeclName(); 6684 DeclContext *NewDC = NewFD->getDeclContext(); 6685 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> MismatchedParams; 6686 SmallVector<std::pair<FunctionDecl *, unsigned>, 1> NearMatches; 6687 TypoCorrection Correction; 6688 bool IsDefinition = ExtraArgs.D.isFunctionDefinition(); 6689 unsigned DiagMsg = IsLocalFriend ? diag::err_no_matching_local_friend 6690 : diag::err_member_decl_does_not_match; 6691 LookupResult Prev(SemaRef, Name, NewFD->getLocation(), 6692 IsLocalFriend ? Sema::LookupLocalFriendName 6693 : Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, 6694 Sema::ForRedeclaration); 6695 6696 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 6697 if (IsLocalFriend) 6698 SemaRef.LookupName(Prev, S); 6699 else 6700 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(Prev, NewDC); 6701 assert(!Prev.isAmbiguous() && 6702 "Cannot have an ambiguity in previous-declaration lookup"); 6703 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD); 6704 if (!Prev.empty()) { 6705 for (LookupResult::iterator Func = Prev.begin(), FuncEnd = Prev.end(); 6706 Func != FuncEnd; ++Func) { 6707 FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*Func); 6708 if (FD && 6709 hasSimilarParameters(SemaRef.Context, FD, NewFD, MismatchedParams)) { 6710 // Add 1 to the index so that 0 can mean the mismatch didn't 6711 // involve a parameter 6712 unsigned ParamNum = 6713 MismatchedParams.empty() ? 0 : MismatchedParams.front() + 1; 6714 NearMatches.push_back(std::make_pair(FD, ParamNum)); 6715 } 6716 } 6717 // If the qualified name lookup yielded nothing, try typo correction 6718 } else if ((Correction = SemaRef.CorrectTypo( 6719 Prev.getLookupNameInfo(), Prev.getLookupKind(), S, 6720 &ExtraArgs.D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 6721 llvm::make_unique<DifferentNameValidatorCCC>( 6722 SemaRef.Context, NewFD, MD ? MD->getParent() : nullptr), 6723 Sema::CTK_ErrorRecovery, IsLocalFriend ? nullptr : NewDC))) { 6724 // Set up everything for the call to ActOnFunctionDeclarator 6725 ExtraArgs.D.SetIdentifier(Correction.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(), 6726 ExtraArgs.D.getIdentifierLoc()); 6727 Previous.clear(); 6728 Previous.setLookupName(Correction.getCorrection()); 6729 for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CDecl = Correction.begin(), 6730 CDeclEnd = Correction.end(); 6731 CDecl != CDeclEnd; ++CDecl) { 6732 FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CDecl); 6733 if (FD && !FD->hasBody() && 6734 hasSimilarParameters(SemaRef.Context, FD, NewFD, MismatchedParams)) { 6735 Previous.addDecl(FD); 6736 } 6737 } 6738 bool wasRedeclaration = ExtraArgs.D.isRedeclaration(); 6739 6740 NamedDecl *Result; 6741 // Retry building the function declaration with the new previous 6742 // declarations, and with errors suppressed. 6743 { 6744 // Trap errors. 6745 Sema::SFINAETrap Trap(SemaRef); 6746 6747 // TODO: Refactor ActOnFunctionDeclarator so that we can call only the 6748 // pieces need to verify the typo-corrected C++ declaration and hopefully 6749 // eliminate the need for the parameter pack ExtraArgs. 6750 Result = SemaRef.ActOnFunctionDeclarator( 6751 ExtraArgs.S, ExtraArgs.D, 6752 Correction.getCorrectionDecl()->getDeclContext(), 6753 NewFD->getTypeSourceInfo(), Previous, ExtraArgs.TemplateParamLists, 6754 ExtraArgs.AddToScope); 6755 6756 if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 6757 Result = nullptr; 6758 } 6759 6760 if (Result) { 6761 // Determine which correction we picked. 6762 Decl *Canonical = Result->getCanonicalDecl(); 6763 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Previous.begin(), E = Previous.end(); 6764 I != E; ++I) 6765 if ((*I)->getCanonicalDecl() == Canonical) 6766 Correction.setCorrectionDecl(*I); 6767 6768 SemaRef.diagnoseTypo( 6769 Correction, 6770 SemaRef.PDiag(IsLocalFriend 6771 ? diag::err_no_matching_local_friend_suggest 6772 : diag::err_member_decl_does_not_match_suggest) 6773 << Name << NewDC << IsDefinition); 6774 return Result; 6775 } 6776 6777 // Pretend the typo correction never occurred 6778 ExtraArgs.D.SetIdentifier(Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(), 6779 ExtraArgs.D.getIdentifierLoc()); 6780 ExtraArgs.D.setRedeclaration(wasRedeclaration); 6781 Previous.clear(); 6782 Previous.setLookupName(Name); 6783 } 6784 6785 SemaRef.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), DiagMsg) 6786 << Name << NewDC << IsDefinition << NewFD->getLocation(); 6787 6788 bool NewFDisConst = false; 6789 if (CXXMethodDecl *NewMD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) 6790 NewFDisConst = NewMD->isConst(); 6791 6792 for (SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<FunctionDecl *, unsigned> >::iterator 6793 NearMatch = NearMatches.begin(), NearMatchEnd = NearMatches.end(); 6794 NearMatch != NearMatchEnd; ++NearMatch) { 6795 FunctionDecl *FD = NearMatch->first; 6796 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 6797 bool FDisConst = MD && MD->isConst(); 6798 bool IsMember = MD || !IsLocalFriend; 6799 6800 // FIXME: These notes are poorly worded for the local friend case. 6801 if (unsigned Idx = NearMatch->second) { 6802 ParmVarDecl *FDParam = FD->getParamDecl(Idx-1); 6803 SourceLocation Loc = FDParam->getTypeSpecStartLoc(); 6804 if (Loc.isInvalid()) Loc = FD->getLocation(); 6805 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, IsMember ? diag::note_member_def_close_param_match 6806 : diag::note_local_decl_close_param_match) 6807 << Idx << FDParam->getType() 6808 << NewFD->getParamDecl(Idx - 1)->getType(); 6809 } else if (FDisConst != NewFDisConst) { 6810 SemaRef.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_member_def_close_const_match) 6811 << NewFDisConst << FD->getSourceRange().getEnd(); 6812 } else 6813 SemaRef.Diag(FD->getLocation(), 6814 IsMember ? diag::note_member_def_close_match 6815 : diag::note_local_decl_close_match); 6816 } 6817 return nullptr; 6818 } 6819 6820 static StorageClass getFunctionStorageClass(Sema &SemaRef, Declarator &D) { 6821 switch (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec()) { 6822 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown storage class!"); 6823 case DeclSpec::SCS_auto: 6824 case DeclSpec::SCS_register: 6825 case DeclSpec::SCS_mutable: 6826 SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 6827 diag::err_typecheck_sclass_func); 6828 D.setInvalidType(); 6829 break; 6830 case DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified: break; 6831 case DeclSpec::SCS_extern: 6832 if (D.getDeclSpec().isExternInLinkageSpec()) 6833 return SC_None; 6834 return SC_Extern; 6835 case DeclSpec::SCS_static: { 6836 if (SemaRef.CurContext->getRedeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 6837 // C99 6.7.1p5: 6838 // The declaration of an identifier for a function that has 6839 // block scope shall have no explicit storage-class specifier 6840 // other than extern 6841 // See also (C++ [dcl.stc]p4). 6842 SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 6843 diag::err_static_block_func); 6844 break; 6845 } else 6846 return SC_Static; 6847 } 6848 case DeclSpec::SCS_private_extern: return SC_PrivateExtern; 6849 } 6850 6851 // No explicit storage class has already been returned 6852 return SC_None; 6853 } 6854 6855 static FunctionDecl* CreateNewFunctionDecl(Sema &SemaRef, Declarator &D, 6856 DeclContext *DC, QualType &R, 6857 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 6858 StorageClass SC, 6859 bool &IsVirtualOkay) { 6860 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameForDeclarator(D); 6861 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 6862 6863 FunctionDecl *NewFD = nullptr; 6864 bool isInline = D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified(); 6865 6866 if (!SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6867 // Determine whether the function was written with a 6868 // prototype. This true when: 6869 // - there is a prototype in the declarator, or 6870 // - the type R of the function is some kind of typedef or other reference 6871 // to a type name (which eventually refers to a function type). 6872 bool HasPrototype = 6873 (D.isFunctionDeclarator() && D.getFunctionTypeInfo().hasPrototype) || 6874 (!isa<FunctionType>(R.getTypePtr()) && R->isFunctionProtoType()); 6875 6876 NewFD = FunctionDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, DC, 6877 D.getLocStart(), NameInfo, R, 6878 TInfo, SC, isInline, 6879 HasPrototype, false); 6880 if (D.isInvalidType()) 6881 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 6882 6883 return NewFD; 6884 } 6885 6886 bool isExplicit = D.getDeclSpec().isExplicitSpecified(); 6887 bool isConstexpr = D.getDeclSpec().isConstexprSpecified(); 6888 6889 // Check that the return type is not an abstract class type. 6890 // For record types, this is done by the AbstractClassUsageDiagnoser once 6891 // the class has been completely parsed. 6892 if (!DC->isRecord() && 6893 SemaRef.RequireNonAbstractType( 6894 D.getIdentifierLoc(), R->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), 6895 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, SemaRef.AbstractReturnType)) 6896 D.setInvalidType(); 6897 6898 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName) { 6899 // This is a C++ constructor declaration. 6900 assert(DC->isRecord() && 6901 "Constructors can only be declared in a member context"); 6902 6903 R = SemaRef.CheckConstructorDeclarator(D, R, SC); 6904 return CXXConstructorDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), 6905 D.getLocStart(), NameInfo, 6906 R, TInfo, isExplicit, isInline, 6907 /*isImplicitlyDeclared=*/false, 6908 isConstexpr); 6909 6910 } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) { 6911 // This is a C++ destructor declaration. 6912 if (DC->isRecord()) { 6913 R = SemaRef.CheckDestructorDeclarator(D, R, SC); 6914 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC); 6915 CXXDestructorDecl *NewDD = CXXDestructorDecl::Create( 6916 SemaRef.Context, Record, 6917 D.getLocStart(), 6918 NameInfo, R, TInfo, isInline, 6919 /*isImplicitlyDeclared=*/false); 6920 6921 // If the class is complete, then we now create the implicit exception 6922 // specification. If the class is incomplete or dependent, we can't do 6923 // it yet. 6924 if (SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !Record->isDependentType() && 6925 Record->getDefinition() && !Record->isBeingDefined() && 6926 R->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getExceptionSpecType() == EST_None) { 6927 SemaRef.AdjustDestructorExceptionSpec(Record, NewDD); 6928 } 6929 6930 IsVirtualOkay = true; 6931 return NewDD; 6932 6933 } else { 6934 SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_destructor_not_member); 6935 D.setInvalidType(); 6936 6937 // Create a FunctionDecl to satisfy the function definition parsing 6938 // code path. 6939 return FunctionDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, DC, 6940 D.getLocStart(), 6941 D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name, R, TInfo, 6942 SC, isInline, 6943 /*hasPrototype=*/true, isConstexpr); 6944 } 6945 6946 } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) { 6947 if (!DC->isRecord()) { 6948 SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), 6949 diag::err_conv_function_not_member); 6950 return nullptr; 6951 } 6952 6953 SemaRef.CheckConversionDeclarator(D, R, SC); 6954 IsVirtualOkay = true; 6955 return CXXConversionDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), 6956 D.getLocStart(), NameInfo, 6957 R, TInfo, isInline, isExplicit, 6958 isConstexpr, SourceLocation()); 6959 6960 } else if (DC->isRecord()) { 6961 // If the name of the function is the same as the name of the record, 6962 // then this must be an invalid constructor that has a return type. 6963 // (The parser checks for a return type and makes the declarator a 6964 // constructor if it has no return type). 6965 if (Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() && 6966 Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() == cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getIdentifier()){ 6967 SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_constructor_return_type) 6968 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecTypeLoc()) 6969 << SourceRange(D.getIdentifierLoc()); 6970 return nullptr; 6971 } 6972 6973 // This is a C++ method declaration. 6974 CXXMethodDecl *Ret = CXXMethodDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, 6975 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), 6976 D.getLocStart(), NameInfo, R, 6977 TInfo, SC, isInline, 6978 isConstexpr, SourceLocation()); 6979 IsVirtualOkay = !Ret->isStatic(); 6980 return Ret; 6981 } else { 6982 bool isFriend = 6983 SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified(); 6984 if (!isFriend && SemaRef.CurContext->isRecord()) 6985 return nullptr; 6986 6987 // Determine whether the function was written with a 6988 // prototype. This true when: 6989 // - we're in C++ (where every function has a prototype), 6990 return FunctionDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, DC, 6991 D.getLocStart(), 6992 NameInfo, R, TInfo, SC, isInline, 6993 true/*HasPrototype*/, isConstexpr); 6994 } 6995 } 6996 6997 enum OpenCLParamType { 6998 ValidKernelParam, 6999 PtrPtrKernelParam, 7000 PtrKernelParam, 7001 PrivatePtrKernelParam, 7002 InvalidKernelParam, 7003 RecordKernelParam 7004 }; 7005 7006 static OpenCLParamType getOpenCLKernelParameterType(QualType PT) { 7007 if (PT->isPointerType()) { 7008 QualType PointeeType = PT->getPointeeType(); 7009 if (PointeeType->isPointerType()) 7010 return PtrPtrKernelParam; 7011 return PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == 0 ? PrivatePtrKernelParam 7012 : PtrKernelParam; 7013 } 7014 7015 // TODO: Forbid the other integer types (size_t, ptrdiff_t...) when they can 7016 // be used as builtin types. 7017 7018 if (PT->isImageType()) 7019 return PtrKernelParam; 7020 7021 if (PT->isBooleanType()) 7022 return InvalidKernelParam; 7023 7024 if (PT->isEventT()) 7025 return InvalidKernelParam; 7026 7027 if (PT->isHalfType()) 7028 return InvalidKernelParam; 7029 7030 if (PT->isRecordType()) 7031 return RecordKernelParam; 7032 7033 return ValidKernelParam; 7034 } 7035 7036 static void checkIsValidOpenCLKernelParameter( 7037 Sema &S, 7038 Declarator &D, 7039 ParmVarDecl *Param, 7040 llvm::SmallPtrSetImpl<const Type *> &ValidTypes) { 7041 QualType PT = Param->getType(); 7042 7043 // Cache the valid types we encounter to avoid rechecking structs that are 7044 // used again 7045 if (ValidTypes.count(PT.getTypePtr())) 7046 return; 7047 7048 switch (getOpenCLKernelParameterType(PT)) { 7049 case PtrPtrKernelParam: 7050 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.a: 7051 // A kernel function argument cannot be declared as a 7052 // pointer to a pointer type. 7053 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_ptrptr_kernel_param); 7054 D.setInvalidType(); 7055 return; 7056 7057 case PrivatePtrKernelParam: 7058 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.a: 7059 // A kernel function argument cannot be declared as a 7060 // pointer to the private address space. 7061 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_private_ptr_kernel_param); 7062 D.setInvalidType(); 7063 return; 7064 7065 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.k: 7066 // Arguments to kernel functions in a program cannot be declared with the 7067 // built-in scalar types bool, half, size_t, ptrdiff_t, intptr_t, and 7068 // uintptr_t or a struct and/or union that contain fields declared to be 7069 // one of these built-in scalar types. 7070 7071 case InvalidKernelParam: 7072 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 n: 7073 // A kernel function argument cannot be declared 7074 // of event_t type. 7075 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_kernel_param_type) << PT; 7076 D.setInvalidType(); 7077 return; 7078 7079 case PtrKernelParam: 7080 case ValidKernelParam: 7081 ValidTypes.insert(PT.getTypePtr()); 7082 return; 7083 7084 case RecordKernelParam: 7085 break; 7086 } 7087 7088 // Track nested structs we will inspect 7089 SmallVector<const Decl *, 4> VisitStack; 7090 7091 // Track where we are in the nested structs. Items will migrate from 7092 // VisitStack to HistoryStack as we do the DFS for bad field. 7093 SmallVector<const FieldDecl *, 4> HistoryStack; 7094 HistoryStack.push_back(nullptr); 7095 7096 const RecordDecl *PD = PT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 7097 VisitStack.push_back(PD); 7098 7099 assert(VisitStack.back() && "First decl null?"); 7100 7101 do { 7102 const Decl *Next = VisitStack.pop_back_val(); 7103 if (!Next) { 7104 assert(!HistoryStack.empty()); 7105 // Found a marker, we have gone up a level 7106 if (const FieldDecl *Hist = HistoryStack.pop_back_val()) 7107 ValidTypes.insert(Hist->getType().getTypePtr()); 7108 7109 continue; 7110 } 7111 7112 // Adds everything except the original parameter declaration (which is not a 7113 // field itself) to the history stack. 7114 const RecordDecl *RD; 7115 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(Next)) { 7116 HistoryStack.push_back(Field); 7117 RD = Field->getType()->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl(); 7118 } else { 7119 RD = cast<RecordDecl>(Next); 7120 } 7121 7122 // Add a null marker so we know when we've gone back up a level 7123 VisitStack.push_back(nullptr); 7124 7125 for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) { 7126 QualType QT = FD->getType(); 7127 7128 if (ValidTypes.count(QT.getTypePtr())) 7129 continue; 7130 7131 OpenCLParamType ParamType = getOpenCLKernelParameterType(QT); 7132 if (ParamType == ValidKernelParam) 7133 continue; 7134 7135 if (ParamType == RecordKernelParam) { 7136 VisitStack.push_back(FD); 7137 continue; 7138 } 7139 7140 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.p: 7141 // Arguments to kernel functions that are declared to be a struct or union 7142 // do not allow OpenCL objects to be passed as elements of the struct or 7143 // union. 7144 if (ParamType == PtrKernelParam || ParamType == PtrPtrKernelParam || 7145 ParamType == PrivatePtrKernelParam) { 7146 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), 7147 diag::err_record_with_pointers_kernel_param) 7148 << PT->isUnionType() 7149 << PT; 7150 } else { 7151 S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_kernel_param_type) << PT; 7152 } 7153 7154 S.Diag(PD->getLocation(), diag::note_within_field_of_type) 7155 << PD->getDeclName(); 7156 7157 // We have an error, now let's go back up through history and show where 7158 // the offending field came from 7159 for (ArrayRef<const FieldDecl *>::const_iterator 7160 I = HistoryStack.begin() + 1, 7161 E = HistoryStack.end(); 7162 I != E; ++I) { 7163 const FieldDecl *OuterField = *I; 7164 S.Diag(OuterField->getLocation(), diag::note_within_field_of_type) 7165 << OuterField->getType(); 7166 } 7167 7168 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_illegal_field_declared_here) 7169 << QT->isPointerType() 7170 << QT; 7171 D.setInvalidType(); 7172 return; 7173 } 7174 } while (!VisitStack.empty()); 7175 } 7176 7177 NamedDecl* 7178 Sema::ActOnFunctionDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC, 7179 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous, 7180 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists, 7181 bool &AddToScope) { 7182 QualType R = TInfo->getType(); 7183 7184 assert(R.getTypePtr()->isFunctionType()); 7185 7186 // TODO: consider using NameInfo for diagnostic. 7187 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = GetNameForDeclarator(D); 7188 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 7189 StorageClass SC = getFunctionStorageClass(*this, D); 7190 7191 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 7192 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7193 diag::err_invalid_thread) 7194 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 7195 7196 if (D.isFirstDeclarationOfMember()) 7197 adjustMemberFunctionCC(R, D.isStaticMember()); 7198 7199 bool isFriend = false; 7200 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate = nullptr; 7201 bool isExplicitSpecialization = false; 7202 bool isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = false; 7203 7204 bool isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = false; 7205 bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false; 7206 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgs; 7207 7208 bool isVirtualOkay = false; 7209 7210 DeclContext *OriginalDC = DC; 7211 bool IsLocalExternDecl = adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DC); 7212 7213 FunctionDecl *NewFD = CreateNewFunctionDecl(*this, D, DC, R, TInfo, SC, 7214 isVirtualOkay); 7215 if (!NewFD) return nullptr; 7216 7217 if (OriginalLexicalContext && OriginalLexicalContext->isObjCContainer()) 7218 NewFD->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer(); 7219 7220 // Set the lexical context. If this is a function-scope declaration, or has a 7221 // C++ scope specifier, or is the object of a friend declaration, the lexical 7222 // context will be different from the semantic context. 7223 NewFD->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 7224 7225 if (IsLocalExternDecl) 7226 NewFD->setLocalExternDecl(); 7227 7228 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7229 bool isInline = D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified(); 7230 bool isVirtual = D.getDeclSpec().isVirtualSpecified(); 7231 bool isExplicit = D.getDeclSpec().isExplicitSpecified(); 7232 bool isConstexpr = D.getDeclSpec().isConstexprSpecified(); 7233 isFriend = D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified(); 7234 if (isFriend && !isInline && D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 7235 // C++ [class.friend]p5 7236 // A function can be defined in a friend declaration of a 7237 // class . . . . Such a function is implicitly inline. 7238 NewFD->setImplicitlyInline(); 7239 } 7240 7241 // If this is a method defined in an __interface, and is not a constructor 7242 // or an overloaded operator, then set the pure flag (isVirtual will already 7243 // return true). 7244 if (const CXXRecordDecl *Parent = 7245 dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(NewFD->getDeclContext())) { 7246 if (Parent->isInterface() && cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)->isUserProvided()) 7247 NewFD->setPure(true); 7248 7249 // C++ [class.union]p2 7250 // A union can have member functions, but not virtual functions. 7251 if (isVirtual && Parent->isUnion()) 7252 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), diag::err_virtual_in_union); 7253 } 7254 7255 SetNestedNameSpecifier(NewFD, D); 7256 isExplicitSpecialization = false; 7257 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = false; 7258 if (D.isInvalidType()) 7259 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 7260 7261 // Match up the template parameter lists with the scope specifier, then 7262 // determine whether we have a template or a template specialization. 7263 bool Invalid = false; 7264 if (TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = 7265 MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier( 7266 D.getDeclSpec().getLocStart(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), 7267 D.getCXXScopeSpec(), 7268 D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId 7269 ? D.getName().TemplateId 7270 : nullptr, 7271 TemplateParamLists, isFriend, isExplicitSpecialization, 7272 Invalid)) { 7273 if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) { 7274 // This is a function template 7275 7276 // Check that we can declare a template here. 7277 if (CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParams)) 7278 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 7279 7280 // A destructor cannot be a template. 7281 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) { 7282 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_destructor_template); 7283 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 7284 } 7285 7286 // If we're adding a template to a dependent context, we may need to 7287 // rebuilding some of the types used within the template parameter list, 7288 // now that we know what the current instantiation is. 7289 if (DC->isDependentContext()) { 7290 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, DC); 7291 if (RebuildTemplateParamsInCurrentInstantiation(TemplateParams)) 7292 Invalid = true; 7293 } 7294 7295 7296 FunctionTemplate = FunctionTemplateDecl::Create(Context, DC, 7297 NewFD->getLocation(), 7298 Name, TemplateParams, 7299 NewFD); 7300 FunctionTemplate->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 7301 NewFD->setDescribedFunctionTemplate(FunctionTemplate); 7302 7303 // For source fidelity, store the other template param lists. 7304 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 1) { 7305 NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, 7306 TemplateParamLists.size() - 1, 7307 TemplateParamLists.data()); 7308 } 7309 } else { 7310 // This is a function template specialization. 7311 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = true; 7312 // For source fidelity, store all the template param lists. 7313 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 0) 7314 NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, 7315 TemplateParamLists.size(), 7316 TemplateParamLists.data()); 7317 7318 // C++0x [temp.expl.spec]p20 forbids "template<> friend void foo(int);". 7319 if (isFriend) { 7320 // We want to remove the "template<>", found here. 7321 SourceRange RemoveRange = TemplateParams->getSourceRange(); 7322 7323 // If we remove the template<> and the name is not a 7324 // template-id, we're actually silently creating a problem: 7325 // the friend declaration will refer to an untemplated decl, 7326 // and clearly the user wants a template specialization. So 7327 // we need to insert '<>' after the name. 7328 SourceLocation InsertLoc; 7329 if (D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) { 7330 InsertLoc = D.getName().getSourceRange().getEnd(); 7331 InsertLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(InsertLoc); 7332 } 7333 7334 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_spec_decl_friend) 7335 << Name << RemoveRange 7336 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(RemoveRange) 7337 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, "<>"); 7338 } 7339 } 7340 } 7341 else { 7342 // All template param lists were matched against the scope specifier: 7343 // this is NOT (an explicit specialization of) a template. 7344 if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 0) 7345 // For source fidelity, store all the template param lists. 7346 NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, 7347 TemplateParamLists.size(), 7348 TemplateParamLists.data()); 7349 } 7350 7351 if (Invalid) { 7352 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 7353 if (FunctionTemplate) 7354 FunctionTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 7355 } 7356 7357 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p5: 7358 // The virtual specifier shall only be used in declarations of 7359 // nonstatic class member functions that appear within a 7360 // member-specification of a class declaration; see 10.3. 7361 // 7362 if (isVirtual && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 7363 if (!isVirtualOkay) { 7364 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), 7365 diag::err_virtual_non_function); 7366 } else if (!CurContext->isRecord()) { 7367 // 'virtual' was specified outside of the class. 7368 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), 7369 diag::err_virtual_out_of_class) 7370 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc()); 7371 } else if (NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 7372 // C++ [temp.mem]p3: 7373 // A member function template shall not be virtual. 7374 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), 7375 diag::err_virtual_member_function_template) 7376 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc()); 7377 } else { 7378 // Okay: Add virtual to the method. 7379 NewFD->setVirtualAsWritten(true); 7380 } 7381 7382 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && 7383 NewFD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) 7384 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), diag::err_auto_fn_virtual); 7385 } 7386 7387 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && 7388 (NewFD->isDependentContext() || 7389 (isFriend && CurContext->isDependentContext())) && 7390 NewFD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) { 7391 // If the function template is referenced directly (for instance, as a 7392 // member of the current instantiation), pretend it has a dependent type. 7393 // This is not really justified by the standard, but is the only sane 7394 // thing to do. 7395 // FIXME: For a friend function, we have not marked the function as being 7396 // a friend yet, so 'isDependentContext' on the FD doesn't work. 7397 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = 7398 NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 7399 QualType Result = 7400 SubstAutoType(FPT->getReturnType(), Context.DependentTy); 7401 NewFD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(Result, FPT->getParamTypes(), 7402 FPT->getExtProtoInfo())); 7403 } 7404 7405 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p3: 7406 // The inline specifier shall not appear on a block scope function 7407 // declaration. 7408 if (isInline && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 7409 if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) { 7410 // 'inline' is not allowed on block scope function declaration. 7411 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 7412 diag::err_inline_declaration_block_scope) << Name 7413 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc()); 7414 } 7415 } 7416 7417 // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p6: 7418 // The explicit specifier shall be used only in the declaration of a 7419 // constructor or conversion function within its class definition; 7420 // see 12.3.1 and 12.3.2. 7421 if (isExplicit && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 7422 if (!CurContext->isRecord()) { 7423 // 'explicit' was specified outside of the class. 7424 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc(), 7425 diag::err_explicit_out_of_class) 7426 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc()); 7427 } else if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewFD) && 7428 !isa<CXXConversionDecl>(NewFD)) { 7429 // 'explicit' was specified on a function that wasn't a constructor 7430 // or conversion function. 7431 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc(), 7432 diag::err_explicit_non_ctor_or_conv_function) 7433 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc()); 7434 } 7435 } 7436 7437 if (isConstexpr) { 7438 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p2: constexpr functions and constexpr constructors 7439 // are implicitly inline. 7440 NewFD->setImplicitlyInline(); 7441 7442 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p3: functions declared constexpr are required to 7443 // be either constructors or to return a literal type. Therefore, 7444 // destructors cannot be declared constexpr. 7445 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewFD)) 7446 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_dtor); 7447 } 7448 7449 // If __module_private__ was specified, mark the function accordingly. 7450 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) { 7451 if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) { 7452 SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc 7453 = D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc(); 7454 Diag(ModulePrivateLoc, diag::err_module_private_specialization) 7455 << 0 7456 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ModulePrivateLoc); 7457 } else { 7458 NewFD->setModulePrivate(); 7459 if (FunctionTemplate) 7460 FunctionTemplate->setModulePrivate(); 7461 } 7462 } 7463 7464 if (isFriend) { 7465 if (FunctionTemplate) { 7466 FunctionTemplate->setObjectOfFriendDecl(); 7467 FunctionTemplate->setAccess(AS_public); 7468 } 7469 NewFD->setObjectOfFriendDecl(); 7470 NewFD->setAccess(AS_public); 7471 } 7472 7473 // If a function is defined as defaulted or deleted, mark it as such now. 7474 // FIXME: Does this ever happen? ActOnStartOfFunctionDef forces the function 7475 // definition kind to FDK_Definition. 7476 switch (D.getFunctionDefinitionKind()) { 7477 case FDK_Declaration: 7478 case FDK_Definition: 7479 break; 7480 7481 case FDK_Defaulted: 7482 NewFD->setDefaulted(); 7483 break; 7484 7485 case FDK_Deleted: 7486 NewFD->setDeletedAsWritten(); 7487 break; 7488 } 7489 7490 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && DC == CurContext && 7491 D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 7492 // C++ [class.mfct]p2: 7493 // A member function may be defined (8.4) in its class definition, in 7494 // which case it is an inline member function (7.1.2) 7495 NewFD->setImplicitlyInline(); 7496 } 7497 7498 if (SC == SC_Static && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && 7499 !CurContext->isRecord()) { 7500 // C++ [class.static]p1: 7501 // A data or function member of a class may be declared static 7502 // in a class definition, in which case it is a static member of 7503 // the class. 7504 7505 // Complain about the 'static' specifier if it's on an out-of-line 7506 // member function definition. 7507 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 7508 diag::err_static_out_of_line) 7509 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 7510 } 7511 7512 // C++11 [except.spec]p15: 7513 // A deallocation function with no exception-specification is treated 7514 // as if it were specified with noexcept(true). 7515 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = R->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 7516 if ((Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator() == OO_Delete || 7517 Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_Delete) && 7518 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && FPT && !FPT->hasExceptionSpec()) 7519 NewFD->setType(Context.getFunctionType( 7520 FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), 7521 FPT->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(EST_BasicNoexcept))); 7522 } 7523 7524 // Filter out previous declarations that don't match the scope. 7525 FilterLookupForScope(Previous, OriginalDC, S, shouldConsiderLinkage(NewFD), 7526 D.getCXXScopeSpec().isNotEmpty() || 7527 isExplicitSpecialization || 7528 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization); 7529 7530 // Handle GNU asm-label extension (encoded as an attribute). 7531 if (Expr *E = (Expr*) D.getAsmLabel()) { 7532 // The parser guarantees this is a string. 7533 StringLiteral *SE = cast<StringLiteral>(E); 7534 NewFD->addAttr(::new (Context) AsmLabelAttr(SE->getStrTokenLoc(0), Context, 7535 SE->getString(), 0)); 7536 } else if (!ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.empty() && 7537 isDeclTUScopedExternallyVisible(NewFD)) { 7538 llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*,AsmLabelAttr*>::iterator I = 7539 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.find(NewFD->getIdentifier()); 7540 if (I != ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.end()) { 7541 NewFD->addAttr(I->second); 7542 ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.erase(I); 7543 } 7544 } 7545 7546 // Copy the parameter declarations from the declarator D to the function 7547 // declaration NewFD, if they are available. First scavenge them into Params. 7548 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params; 7549 if (D.isFunctionDeclarator()) { 7550 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = D.getFunctionTypeInfo(); 7551 7552 // Check for C99 6.7.5.3p10 - foo(void) is a non-varargs 7553 // function that takes no arguments, not a function that takes a 7554 // single void argument. 7555 // We let through "const void" here because Sema::GetTypeForDeclarator 7556 // already checks for that case. 7557 if (FTIHasNonVoidParameters(FTI) && FTI.Params[0].Param) { 7558 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FTI.NumParams; i != e; ++i) { 7559 ParmVarDecl *Param = cast<ParmVarDecl>(FTI.Params[i].Param); 7560 assert(Param->getDeclContext() != NewFD && "Was set before ?"); 7561 Param->setDeclContext(NewFD); 7562 Params.push_back(Param); 7563 7564 if (Param->isInvalidDecl()) 7565 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 7566 } 7567 } 7568 7569 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = R->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 7570 // When we're declaring a function with a typedef, typeof, etc as in the 7571 // following example, we'll need to synthesize (unnamed) 7572 // parameters for use in the declaration. 7573 // 7574 // @code 7575 // typedef void fn(int); 7576 // fn f; 7577 // @endcode 7578 7579 // Synthesize a parameter for each argument type. 7580 for (const auto &AI : FT->param_types()) { 7581 ParmVarDecl *Param = 7582 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(NewFD, D.getIdentifierLoc(), AI); 7583 Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size()); 7584 Params.push_back(Param); 7585 } 7586 } else { 7587 assert(R->isFunctionNoProtoType() && NewFD->getNumParams() == 0 && 7588 "Should not need args for typedef of non-prototype fn"); 7589 } 7590 7591 // Finally, we know we have the right number of parameters, install them. 7592 NewFD->setParams(Params); 7593 7594 // Find all anonymous symbols defined during the declaration of this function 7595 // and add to NewFD. This lets us track decls such 'enum Y' in: 7596 // 7597 // void f(enum Y {AA} x) {} 7598 // 7599 // which would otherwise incorrectly end up in the translation unit scope. 7600 NewFD->setDeclsInPrototypeScope(DeclsInPrototypeScope); 7601 DeclsInPrototypeScope.clear(); 7602 7603 if (D.getDeclSpec().isNoreturnSpecified()) 7604 NewFD->addAttr( 7605 ::new(Context) C11NoReturnAttr(D.getDeclSpec().getNoreturnSpecLoc(), 7606 Context, 0)); 7607 7608 // Functions returning a variably modified type violate C99 6.7.5.2p2 7609 // because all functions have linkage. 7610 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 7611 NewFD->getReturnType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 7612 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_func_decl); 7613 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 7614 } 7615 7616 // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if #pragma code_seg is active. 7617 if (CodeSegStack.CurrentValue && D.isFunctionDefinition() && 7618 !NewFD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 7619 NewFD->addAttr( 7620 SectionAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate, 7621 CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(), 7622 CodeSegStack.CurrentPragmaLocation)); 7623 if (UnifySection(CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(), 7624 ASTContext::PSF_Implicit | ASTContext::PSF_Execute | 7625 ASTContext::PSF_Read, 7626 NewFD)) 7627 NewFD->dropAttr<SectionAttr>(); 7628 } 7629 7630 // Handle attributes. 7631 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewFD, D); 7632 7633 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 7634 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5: Using an address space qualifier in a function return 7635 // type declaration will generate a compilation error. 7636 unsigned AddressSpace = NewFD->getReturnType().getAddressSpace(); 7637 if (AddressSpace == LangAS::opencl_local || 7638 AddressSpace == LangAS::opencl_global || 7639 AddressSpace == LangAS::opencl_constant) { 7640 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 7641 diag::err_opencl_return_value_with_address_space); 7642 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 7643 } 7644 } 7645 7646 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7647 // Perform semantic checking on the function declaration. 7648 bool isExplicitSpecialization=false; 7649 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMain()) 7650 CheckMain(NewFD, D.getDeclSpec()); 7651 7652 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 7653 CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(NewFD); 7654 7655 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 7656 D.setRedeclaration(CheckFunctionDeclaration(S, NewFD, Previous, 7657 isExplicitSpecialization)); 7658 else if (!Previous.empty()) 7659 // Recover gracefully from an invalid redeclaration. 7660 D.setRedeclaration(true); 7661 assert((NewFD->isInvalidDecl() || !D.isRedeclaration() || 7662 Previous.getResultKind() != LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) && 7663 "previous declaration set still overloaded"); 7664 7665 // Diagnose no-prototype function declarations with calling conventions that 7666 // don't support variadic calls. Only do this in C and do it after merging 7667 // possibly prototyped redeclarations. 7668 const FunctionType *FT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 7669 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FT) && !D.isFunctionDefinition()) { 7670 CallingConv CC = FT->getExtInfo().getCC(); 7671 if (!supportsVariadicCall(CC)) { 7672 // Windows system headers sometimes accidentally use stdcall without 7673 // (void) parameters, so we relax this to a warning. 7674 int DiagID = 7675 CC == CC_X86StdCall ? diag::warn_cconv_knr : diag::err_cconv_knr; 7676 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), DiagID) 7677 << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(CC); 7678 } 7679 } 7680 } else { 7681 // C++11 [replacement.functions]p3: 7682 // The program's definitions shall not be specified as inline. 7683 // 7684 // N.B. We diagnose declarations instead of definitions per LWG issue 2340. 7685 // 7686 // Suppress the diagnostic if the function is __attribute__((used)), since 7687 // that forces an external definition to be emitted. 7688 if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified() && 7689 NewFD->isReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction() && 7690 !NewFD->hasAttr<UsedAttr>()) 7691 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), 7692 diag::ext_operator_new_delete_declared_inline) 7693 << NewFD->getDeclName(); 7694 7695 // If the declarator is a template-id, translate the parser's template 7696 // argument list into our AST format. 7697 if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) { 7698 TemplateIdAnnotation *TemplateId = D.getName().TemplateId; 7699 TemplateArgs.setLAngleLoc(TemplateId->LAngleLoc); 7700 TemplateArgs.setRAngleLoc(TemplateId->RAngleLoc); 7701 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(), 7702 TemplateId->NumArgs); 7703 translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, 7704 TemplateArgs); 7705 7706 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = true; 7707 7708 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 7709 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false; 7710 } else if (FunctionTemplate) { 7711 // Function template with explicit template arguments. 7712 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_function_template_partial_spec) 7713 << SourceRange(TemplateId->LAngleLoc, TemplateId->RAngleLoc); 7714 7715 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false; 7716 } else { 7717 assert((isFunctionTemplateSpecialization || 7718 D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) && 7719 "should have a 'template<>' for this decl"); 7720 // "friend void foo<>(int);" is an implicit specialization decl. 7721 isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = true; 7722 } 7723 } else if (isFriend && isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) { 7724 // This combination is only possible in a recovery case; the user 7725 // wrote something like: 7726 // template <> friend void foo(int); 7727 // which we're recovering from as if the user had written: 7728 // friend void foo<>(int); 7729 // Go ahead and fake up a template id. 7730 HasExplicitTemplateArgs = true; 7731 TemplateArgs.setLAngleLoc(D.getIdentifierLoc()); 7732 TemplateArgs.setRAngleLoc(D.getIdentifierLoc()); 7733 } 7734 7735 // If it's a friend (and only if it's a friend), it's possible 7736 // that either the specialized function type or the specialized 7737 // template is dependent, and therefore matching will fail. In 7738 // this case, don't check the specialization yet. 7739 bool InstantiationDependent = false; 7740 if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization && isFriend && 7741 (NewFD->getType()->isDependentType() || DC->isDependentContext() || 7742 TemplateSpecializationType::anyDependentTemplateArguments( 7743 TemplateArgs.getArgumentArray(), TemplateArgs.size(), 7744 InstantiationDependent))) { 7745 assert(HasExplicitTemplateArgs && 7746 "friend function specialization without template args"); 7747 if (CheckDependentFunctionTemplateSpecialization(NewFD, TemplateArgs, 7748 Previous)) 7749 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 7750 } else if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) { 7751 if (CurContext->isDependentContext() && CurContext->isRecord() 7752 && !isFriend) { 7753 isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = true; 7754 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt ? 7755 diag::ext_function_specialization_in_class : 7756 diag::err_function_specialization_in_class) 7757 << NewFD->getDeclName(); 7758 } else if (CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization(NewFD, 7759 (HasExplicitTemplateArgs ? &TemplateArgs 7760 : nullptr), 7761 Previous)) 7762 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 7763 7764 // C++ [dcl.stc]p1: 7765 // A storage-class-specifier shall not be specified in an explicit 7766 // specialization (14.7.3) 7767 FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *Info = 7768 NewFD->getTemplateSpecializationInfo(); 7769 if (Info && SC != SC_None) { 7770 if (SC != Info->getTemplate()->getTemplatedDecl()->getStorageClass()) 7771 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 7772 diag::err_explicit_specialization_inconsistent_storage_class) 7773 << SC 7774 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 7775 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 7776 7777 else 7778 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 7779 diag::ext_explicit_specialization_storage_class) 7780 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 7781 D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 7782 } 7783 7784 } else if (isExplicitSpecialization && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) { 7785 if (CheckMemberSpecialization(NewFD, Previous)) 7786 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 7787 } 7788 7789 // Perform semantic checking on the function declaration. 7790 if (!isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) { 7791 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMain()) 7792 CheckMain(NewFD, D.getDeclSpec()); 7793 7794 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 7795 CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(NewFD); 7796 7797 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 7798 D.setRedeclaration(CheckFunctionDeclaration(S, NewFD, Previous, 7799 isExplicitSpecialization)); 7800 else if (!Previous.empty()) 7801 // Recover gracefully from an invalid redeclaration. 7802 D.setRedeclaration(true); 7803 } 7804 7805 assert((NewFD->isInvalidDecl() || !D.isRedeclaration() || 7806 Previous.getResultKind() != LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) && 7807 "previous declaration set still overloaded"); 7808 7809 NamedDecl *PrincipalDecl = (FunctionTemplate 7810 ? cast<NamedDecl>(FunctionTemplate) 7811 : NewFD); 7812 7813 if (isFriend && D.isRedeclaration()) { 7814 AccessSpecifier Access = AS_public; 7815 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 7816 Access = NewFD->getPreviousDecl()->getAccess(); 7817 7818 NewFD->setAccess(Access); 7819 if (FunctionTemplate) FunctionTemplate->setAccess(Access); 7820 } 7821 7822 if (NewFD->isOverloadedOperator() && !DC->isRecord() && 7823 PrincipalDecl->isInIdentifierNamespace(Decl::IDNS_Ordinary)) 7824 PrincipalDecl->setNonMemberOperator(); 7825 7826 // If we have a function template, check the template parameter 7827 // list. This will check and merge default template arguments. 7828 if (FunctionTemplate) { 7829 FunctionTemplateDecl *PrevTemplate = 7830 FunctionTemplate->getPreviousDecl(); 7831 CheckTemplateParameterList(FunctionTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 7832 PrevTemplate ? PrevTemplate->getTemplateParameters() 7833 : nullptr, 7834 D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified() 7835 ? (D.isFunctionDefinition() 7836 ? TPC_FriendFunctionTemplateDefinition 7837 : TPC_FriendFunctionTemplate) 7838 : (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet() && 7839 DC && DC->isRecord() && 7840 DC->isDependentContext()) 7841 ? TPC_ClassTemplateMember 7842 : TPC_FunctionTemplate); 7843 } 7844 7845 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) { 7846 // Ignore all the rest of this. 7847 } else if (!D.isRedeclaration()) { 7848 struct ActOnFDArgs ExtraArgs = { S, D, TemplateParamLists, 7849 AddToScope }; 7850 // Fake up an access specifier if it's supposed to be a class member. 7851 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(NewFD->getDeclContext())) 7852 NewFD->setAccess(AS_public); 7853 7854 // Qualified decls generally require a previous declaration. 7855 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 7856 // ...with the major exception of templated-scope or 7857 // dependent-scope friend declarations. 7858 7859 // TODO: we currently also suppress this check in dependent 7860 // contexts because (1) the parameter depth will be off when 7861 // matching friend templates and (2) we might actually be 7862 // selecting a friend based on a dependent factor. But there 7863 // are situations where these conditions don't apply and we 7864 // can actually do this check immediately. 7865 if (isFriend && 7866 (TemplateParamLists.size() || 7867 D.getCXXScopeSpec().getScopeRep()->isDependent() || 7868 CurContext->isDependentContext())) { 7869 // ignore these 7870 } else { 7871 // The user tried to provide an out-of-line definition for a 7872 // function that is a member of a class or namespace, but there 7873 // was no such member function declared (C++ [class.mfct]p2, 7874 // C++ [namespace.memdef]p2). For example: 7875 // 7876 // class X { 7877 // void f() const; 7878 // }; 7879 // 7880 // void X::f() { } // ill-formed 7881 // 7882 // Complain about this problem, and attempt to suggest close 7883 // matches (e.g., those that differ only in cv-qualifiers and 7884 // whether the parameter types are references). 7885 7886 if (NamedDecl *Result = DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration( 7887 *this, Previous, NewFD, ExtraArgs, false, nullptr)) { 7888 AddToScope = ExtraArgs.AddToScope; 7889 return Result; 7890 } 7891 } 7892 7893 // Unqualified local friend declarations are required to resolve 7894 // to something. 7895 } else if (isFriend && cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext)->isLocalClass()) { 7896 if (NamedDecl *Result = DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration( 7897 *this, Previous, NewFD, ExtraArgs, true, S)) { 7898 AddToScope = ExtraArgs.AddToScope; 7899 return Result; 7900 } 7901 } 7902 7903 } else if (!D.isFunctionDefinition() && 7904 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && NewFD->isOutOfLine() && 7905 !isFriend && !isFunctionTemplateSpecialization && 7906 !isExplicitSpecialization) { 7907 // An out-of-line member function declaration must also be a 7908 // definition (C++ [class.mfct]p2). 7909 // Note that this is not the case for explicit specializations of 7910 // function templates or member functions of class templates, per 7911 // C++ [temp.expl.spec]p2. We also allow these declarations as an 7912 // extension for compatibility with old SWIG code which likes to 7913 // generate them. 7914 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::ext_out_of_line_declaration) 7915 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 7916 } 7917 } 7918 7919 ProcessPragmaWeak(S, NewFD); 7920 checkAttributesAfterMerging(*this, *NewFD); 7921 7922 AddKnownFunctionAttributes(NewFD); 7923 7924 if (NewFD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() && 7925 !NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 7926 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), 7927 diag::err_attribute_overloadable_no_prototype) 7928 << NewFD; 7929 7930 // Turn this into a variadic function with no parameters. 7931 const FunctionType *FT = NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 7932 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI( 7933 Context.getDefaultCallingConvention(true, false)); 7934 EPI.Variadic = true; 7935 EPI.ExtInfo = FT->getExtInfo(); 7936 7937 QualType R = Context.getFunctionType(FT->getReturnType(), None, EPI); 7938 NewFD->setType(R); 7939 } 7940 7941 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, and this isn't a class 7942 // member, set the visibility of this function. 7943 if (!DC->isRecord() && NewFD->isExternallyVisible()) 7944 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(NewFD); 7945 7946 // If there's a #pragma clang arc_cf_code_audited in scope, consider 7947 // marking the function. 7948 AddCFAuditedAttribute(NewFD); 7949 7950 // If this is a function definition, check if we have to apply optnone due to 7951 // a pragma. 7952 if(D.isFunctionDefinition()) 7953 AddRangeBasedOptnone(NewFD); 7954 7955 // If this is the first declaration of an extern C variable, update 7956 // the map of such variables. 7957 if (NewFD->isFirstDecl() && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 7958 isIncompleteDeclExternC(*this, NewFD)) 7959 RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NewFD, S); 7960 7961 // Set this FunctionDecl's range up to the right paren. 7962 NewFD->setRangeEnd(D.getSourceRange().getEnd()); 7963 7964 if (D.isRedeclaration() && !Previous.empty()) { 7965 checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration( 7966 *this, dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl()), NewFD, 7967 isExplicitSpecialization || isFunctionTemplateSpecialization); 7968 } 7969 7970 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7971 if (FunctionTemplate) { 7972 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 7973 FunctionTemplate->setInvalidDecl(); 7974 return FunctionTemplate; 7975 } 7976 } 7977 7978 if (NewFD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) { 7979 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 static is invalid for kernel functions. 7980 if ((getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion >= 120) 7981 && (SC == SC_Static)) { 7982 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_static_kernel); 7983 D.setInvalidType(); 7984 } 7985 7986 // OpenCL v1.2, s6.9 -- Kernels can only have return type void. 7987 if (!NewFD->getReturnType()->isVoidType()) { 7988 SourceRange RTRange = NewFD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 7989 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_expected_kernel_void_return_type) 7990 << (RTRange.isValid() ? FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "void") 7991 : FixItHint()); 7992 D.setInvalidType(); 7993 } 7994 7995 llvm::SmallPtrSet<const Type *, 16> ValidTypes; 7996 for (auto Param : NewFD->params()) 7997 checkIsValidOpenCLKernelParameter(*this, D, Param, ValidTypes); 7998 } 7999 8000 MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(NewFD); 8001 8002 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 8003 if (IdentifierInfo *II = NewFD->getIdentifier()) 8004 if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && 8005 NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) { 8006 if (II->isStr("cudaConfigureCall")) { 8007 if (!R->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType()->isScalarType()) 8008 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_config_scalar_return); 8009 8010 Context.setcudaConfigureCallDecl(NewFD); 8011 } 8012 } 8013 8014 // Here we have an function template explicit specialization at class scope. 8015 // The actually specialization will be postponed to template instatiation 8016 // time via the ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl node. 8017 if (isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) { 8018 ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl *NewSpec = 8019 ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl::Create( 8020 Context, CurContext, SourceLocation(), 8021 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD), 8022 HasExplicitTemplateArgs, TemplateArgs); 8023 CurContext->addDecl(NewSpec); 8024 AddToScope = false; 8025 } 8026 8027 return NewFD; 8028 } 8029 8030 /// \brief Perform semantic checking of a new function declaration. 8031 /// 8032 /// Performs semantic analysis of the new function declaration 8033 /// NewFD. This routine performs all semantic checking that does not 8034 /// require the actual declarator involved in the declaration, and is 8035 /// used both for the declaration of functions as they are parsed 8036 /// (called via ActOnDeclarator) and for the declaration of functions 8037 /// that have been instantiated via C++ template instantiation (called 8038 /// via InstantiateDecl). 8039 /// 8040 /// \param IsExplicitSpecialization whether this new function declaration is 8041 /// an explicit specialization of the previous declaration. 8042 /// 8043 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error. 8044 /// 8045 /// \returns true if the function declaration is a redeclaration. 8046 bool Sema::CheckFunctionDeclaration(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *NewFD, 8047 LookupResult &Previous, 8048 bool IsExplicitSpecialization) { 8049 assert(!NewFD->getReturnType()->isVariablyModifiedType() && 8050 "Variably modified return types are not handled here"); 8051 8052 // Determine whether the type of this function should be merged with 8053 // a previous visible declaration. This never happens for functions in C++, 8054 // and always happens in C if the previous declaration was visible. 8055 bool MergeTypeWithPrevious = !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 8056 !Previous.isShadowed(); 8057 8058 // Filter out any non-conflicting previous declarations. 8059 filterNonConflictingPreviousDecls(*this, NewFD, Previous); 8060 8061 bool Redeclaration = false; 8062 NamedDecl *OldDecl = nullptr; 8063 8064 // Merge or overload the declaration with an existing declaration of 8065 // the same name, if appropriate. 8066 if (!Previous.empty()) { 8067 // Determine whether NewFD is an overload of PrevDecl or 8068 // a declaration that requires merging. If it's an overload, 8069 // there's no more work to do here; we'll just add the new 8070 // function to the scope. 8071 if (!AllowOverloadingOfFunction(Previous, Context)) { 8072 NamedDecl *Candidate = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 8073 if (shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(Candidate, NewFD)) { 8074 Redeclaration = true; 8075 OldDecl = Candidate; 8076 } 8077 } else { 8078 switch (CheckOverload(S, NewFD, Previous, OldDecl, 8079 /*NewIsUsingDecl*/ false)) { 8080 case Ovl_Match: 8081 Redeclaration = true; 8082 break; 8083 8084 case Ovl_NonFunction: 8085 Redeclaration = true; 8086 break; 8087 8088 case Ovl_Overload: 8089 Redeclaration = false; 8090 break; 8091 } 8092 8093 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !NewFD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) { 8094 // If a function name is overloadable in C, then every function 8095 // with that name must be marked "overloadable". 8096 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_overloadable_missing) 8097 << Redeclaration << NewFD; 8098 NamedDecl *OverloadedDecl = nullptr; 8099 if (Redeclaration) 8100 OverloadedDecl = OldDecl; 8101 else if (!Previous.empty()) 8102 OverloadedDecl = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 8103 if (OverloadedDecl) 8104 Diag(OverloadedDecl->getLocation(), 8105 diag::note_attribute_overloadable_prev_overload); 8106 NewFD->addAttr(OverloadableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context)); 8107 } 8108 } 8109 } 8110 8111 // Check for a previous extern "C" declaration with this name. 8112 if (!Redeclaration && 8113 checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(*this, NewFD, Previous)) { 8114 filterNonConflictingPreviousDecls(*this, NewFD, Previous); 8115 if (!Previous.empty()) { 8116 // This is an extern "C" declaration with the same name as a previous 8117 // declaration, and thus redeclares that entity... 8118 Redeclaration = true; 8119 OldDecl = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 8120 MergeTypeWithPrevious = false; 8121 8122 // ... except in the presence of __attribute__((overloadable)). 8123 if (OldDecl->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) { 8124 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !NewFD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) { 8125 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_overloadable_missing) 8126 << Redeclaration << NewFD; 8127 Diag(Previous.getFoundDecl()->getLocation(), 8128 diag::note_attribute_overloadable_prev_overload); 8129 NewFD->addAttr(OverloadableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context)); 8130 } 8131 if (IsOverload(NewFD, cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl), false)) { 8132 Redeclaration = false; 8133 OldDecl = nullptr; 8134 } 8135 } 8136 } 8137 } 8138 8139 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p8: 8140 // A constexpr specifier for a non-static member function that is not 8141 // a constructor declares that member function to be const. 8142 // 8143 // This needs to be delayed until we know whether this is an out-of-line 8144 // definition of a static member function. 8145 // 8146 // This rule is not present in C++1y, so we produce a backwards 8147 // compatibility warning whenever it happens in C++11. 8148 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD); 8149 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && MD && MD->isConstexpr() && 8150 !MD->isStatic() && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) && 8151 (MD->getTypeQualifiers() & Qualifiers::Const) == 0) { 8152 CXXMethodDecl *OldMD = nullptr; 8153 if (OldDecl) 8154 OldMD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(OldDecl->getAsFunction()); 8155 if (!OldMD || !OldMD->isStatic()) { 8156 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = 8157 MD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 8158 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 8159 EPI.TypeQuals |= Qualifiers::Const; 8160 MD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), 8161 FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI)); 8162 8163 // Warn that we did this, if we're not performing template instantiation. 8164 // In that case, we'll have warned already when the template was defined. 8165 if (ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) { 8166 SourceLocation AddConstLoc; 8167 if (FunctionTypeLoc FTL = MD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc() 8168 .IgnoreParens().getAs<FunctionTypeLoc>()) 8169 AddConstLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(FTL.getRParenLoc()); 8170 8171 Diag(MD->getLocation(), diag::warn_cxx14_compat_constexpr_not_const) 8172 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(AddConstLoc, " const"); 8173 } 8174 } 8175 } 8176 8177 if (Redeclaration) { 8178 // NewFD and OldDecl represent declarations that need to be 8179 // merged. 8180 if (MergeFunctionDecl(NewFD, OldDecl, S, MergeTypeWithPrevious)) { 8181 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 8182 return Redeclaration; 8183 } 8184 8185 Previous.clear(); 8186 Previous.addDecl(OldDecl); 8187 8188 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplateDecl 8189 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldDecl)) { 8190 NewFD->setPreviousDeclaration(OldTemplateDecl->getTemplatedDecl()); 8191 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplateDecl 8192 = NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 8193 assert(NewTemplateDecl && "Template/non-template mismatch"); 8194 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method 8195 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewTemplateDecl->getTemplatedDecl())) { 8196 Method->setAccess(OldTemplateDecl->getAccess()); 8197 NewTemplateDecl->setAccess(OldTemplateDecl->getAccess()); 8198 } 8199 8200 // If this is an explicit specialization of a member that is a function 8201 // template, mark it as a member specialization. 8202 if (IsExplicitSpecialization && 8203 NewTemplateDecl->getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()) { 8204 NewTemplateDecl->setMemberSpecialization(); 8205 assert(OldTemplateDecl->isMemberSpecialization()); 8206 } 8207 8208 } else { 8209 // This needs to happen first so that 'inline' propagates. 8210 NewFD->setPreviousDeclaration(cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl)); 8211 8212 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) 8213 NewFD->setAccess(OldDecl->getAccess()); 8214 } 8215 } 8216 8217 // Semantic checking for this function declaration (in isolation). 8218 8219 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8220 // C++-specific checks. 8221 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewFD)) { 8222 CheckConstructor(Constructor); 8223 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = 8224 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewFD)) { 8225 CXXRecordDecl *Record = Destructor->getParent(); 8226 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Record); 8227 8228 // FIXME: Shouldn't we be able to perform this check even when the class 8229 // type is dependent? Both gcc and edg can handle that. 8230 if (!ClassType->isDependentType()) { 8231 DeclarationName Name 8232 = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName( 8233 Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType)); 8234 if (NewFD->getDeclName() != Name) { 8235 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_destructor_name); 8236 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 8237 return Redeclaration; 8238 } 8239 } 8240 } else if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion 8241 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(NewFD)) { 8242 ActOnConversionDeclarator(Conversion); 8243 } 8244 8245 // Find any virtual functions that this function overrides. 8246 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) { 8247 if (!Method->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization() && 8248 !Method->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 8249 Method->isCanonicalDecl()) { 8250 if (AddOverriddenMethods(Method->getParent(), Method)) { 8251 // If the function was marked as "static", we have a problem. 8252 if (NewFD->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) { 8253 ReportOverrides(*this, diag::err_static_overrides_virtual, Method); 8254 } 8255 } 8256 } 8257 8258 if (Method->isStatic()) 8259 checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionType(Method); 8260 } 8261 8262 // Extra checking for C++ overloaded operators (C++ [over.oper]). 8263 if (NewFD->isOverloadedOperator() && 8264 CheckOverloadedOperatorDeclaration(NewFD)) { 8265 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 8266 return Redeclaration; 8267 } 8268 8269 // Extra checking for C++0x literal operators (C++0x [over.literal]). 8270 if (NewFD->getLiteralIdentifier() && 8271 CheckLiteralOperatorDeclaration(NewFD)) { 8272 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 8273 return Redeclaration; 8274 } 8275 8276 // In C++, check default arguments now that we have merged decls. Unless 8277 // the lexical context is the class, because in this case this is done 8278 // during delayed parsing anyway. 8279 if (!CurContext->isRecord()) 8280 CheckCXXDefaultArguments(NewFD); 8281 8282 // If this function declares a builtin function, check the type of this 8283 // declaration against the expected type for the builtin. 8284 if (unsigned BuiltinID = NewFD->getBuiltinID()) { 8285 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error; 8286 LookupPredefedObjCSuperType(*this, S, NewFD->getIdentifier()); 8287 QualType T = Context.GetBuiltinType(BuiltinID, Error); 8288 if (!T.isNull() && !Context.hasSameType(T, NewFD->getType())) { 8289 // The type of this function differs from the type of the builtin, 8290 // so forget about the builtin entirely. 8291 Context.BuiltinInfo.ForgetBuiltin(BuiltinID, Context.Idents); 8292 } 8293 } 8294 8295 // If this function is declared as being extern "C", then check to see if 8296 // the function returns a UDT (class, struct, or union type) that is not C 8297 // compatible, and if it does, warn the user. 8298 // But, issue any diagnostic on the first declaration only. 8299 if (Previous.empty() && NewFD->isExternC()) { 8300 QualType R = NewFD->getReturnType(); 8301 if (R->isIncompleteType() && !R->isVoidType()) 8302 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_udt_incomplete) 8303 << NewFD << R; 8304 else if (!R.isPODType(Context) && !R->isVoidType() && 8305 !R->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 8306 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_udt) << NewFD << R; 8307 } 8308 } 8309 return Redeclaration; 8310 } 8311 8312 void Sema::CheckMain(FunctionDecl* FD, const DeclSpec& DS) { 8313 // C++11 [basic.start.main]p3: 8314 // A program that [...] declares main to be inline, static or 8315 // constexpr is ill-formed. 8316 // C11 6.7.4p4: In a hosted environment, no function specifier(s) shall 8317 // appear in a declaration of main. 8318 // static main is not an error under C99, but we should warn about it. 8319 // We accept _Noreturn main as an extension. 8320 if (FD->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) 8321 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 8322 ? diag::err_static_main : diag::warn_static_main) 8323 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc()); 8324 if (FD->isInlineSpecified()) 8325 Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_main) 8326 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getInlineSpecLoc()); 8327 if (DS.isNoreturnSpecified()) { 8328 SourceLocation NoreturnLoc = DS.getNoreturnSpecLoc(); 8329 SourceRange NoreturnRange(NoreturnLoc, getLocForEndOfToken(NoreturnLoc)); 8330 Diag(NoreturnLoc, diag::ext_noreturn_main); 8331 Diag(NoreturnLoc, diag::note_main_remove_noreturn) 8332 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(NoreturnRange); 8333 } 8334 if (FD->isConstexpr()) { 8335 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_main) 8336 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc()); 8337 FD->setConstexpr(false); 8338 } 8339 8340 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 8341 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_no_main) 8342 << FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>(); 8343 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 8344 return; 8345 } 8346 8347 QualType T = FD->getType(); 8348 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "function decl is not of function type"); 8349 const FunctionType* FT = T->castAs<FunctionType>(); 8350 8351 if (getLangOpts().GNUMode && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8352 // In C with GNU extensions we allow main() to have non-integer return 8353 // type, but we should warn about the extension, and we disable the 8354 // implicit-return-zero rule. 8355 8356 // GCC in C mode accepts qualified 'int'. 8357 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FT->getReturnType(), Context.IntTy)) 8358 FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true); 8359 else { 8360 Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::ext_main_returns_nonint); 8361 SourceRange RTRange = FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 8362 if (RTRange.isValid()) 8363 Diag(RTRange.getBegin(), diag::note_main_change_return_type) 8364 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "int"); 8365 } 8366 } else { 8367 // In C and C++, main magically returns 0 if you fall off the end; 8368 // set the flag which tells us that. 8369 // This is C++ [basic.start.main]p5 and C99 5.1.2.2.3. 8370 8371 // All the standards say that main() should return 'int'. 8372 if (Context.hasSameType(FT->getReturnType(), Context.IntTy)) 8373 FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true); 8374 else { 8375 // Otherwise, this is just a flat-out error. 8376 SourceRange RTRange = FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 8377 Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::err_main_returns_nonint) 8378 << (RTRange.isValid() ? FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "int") 8379 : FixItHint()); 8380 FD->setInvalidDecl(true); 8381 } 8382 } 8383 8384 // Treat protoless main() as nullary. 8385 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FT)) return; 8386 8387 const FunctionProtoType* FTP = cast<const FunctionProtoType>(FT); 8388 unsigned nparams = FTP->getNumParams(); 8389 assert(FD->getNumParams() == nparams); 8390 8391 bool HasExtraParameters = (nparams > 3); 8392 8393 if (FTP->isVariadic()) { 8394 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_variadic_main); 8395 // FIXME: if we had information about the location of the ellipsis, we 8396 // could add a FixIt hint to remove it as a parameter. 8397 } 8398 8399 // Darwin passes an undocumented fourth argument of type char**. If 8400 // other platforms start sprouting these, the logic below will start 8401 // getting shifty. 8402 if (nparams == 4 && Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isOSDarwin()) 8403 HasExtraParameters = false; 8404 8405 if (HasExtraParameters) { 8406 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_main_surplus_args) << nparams; 8407 FD->setInvalidDecl(true); 8408 nparams = 3; 8409 } 8410 8411 // FIXME: a lot of the following diagnostics would be improved 8412 // if we had some location information about types. 8413 8414 QualType CharPP = 8415 Context.getPointerType(Context.getPointerType(Context.CharTy)); 8416 QualType Expected[] = { Context.IntTy, CharPP, CharPP, CharPP }; 8417 8418 for (unsigned i = 0; i < nparams; ++i) { 8419 QualType AT = FTP->getParamType(i); 8420 8421 bool mismatch = true; 8422 8423 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(AT, Expected[i])) 8424 mismatch = false; 8425 else if (Expected[i] == CharPP) { 8426 // As an extension, the following forms are okay: 8427 // char const ** 8428 // char const * const * 8429 // char * const * 8430 8431 QualifierCollector qs; 8432 const PointerType* PT; 8433 if ((PT = qs.strip(AT)->getAs<PointerType>()) && 8434 (PT = qs.strip(PT->getPointeeType())->getAs<PointerType>()) && 8435 Context.hasSameType(QualType(qs.strip(PT->getPointeeType()), 0), 8436 Context.CharTy)) { 8437 qs.removeConst(); 8438 mismatch = !qs.empty(); 8439 } 8440 } 8441 8442 if (mismatch) { 8443 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_main_arg_wrong) << i << Expected[i]; 8444 // TODO: suggest replacing given type with expected type 8445 FD->setInvalidDecl(true); 8446 } 8447 } 8448 8449 if (nparams == 1 && !FD->isInvalidDecl()) { 8450 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_main_one_arg); 8451 } 8452 8453 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 8454 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_mainlike_template_decl) << FD; 8455 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 8456 } 8457 } 8458 8459 void Sema::CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(FunctionDecl *FD) { 8460 QualType T = FD->getType(); 8461 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "function decl is not of function type"); 8462 const FunctionType *FT = T->castAs<FunctionType>(); 8463 8464 // Set an implicit return of 'zero' if the function can return some integral, 8465 // enumeration, pointer or nullptr type. 8466 if (FT->getReturnType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() || 8467 FT->getReturnType()->isAnyPointerType() || 8468 FT->getReturnType()->isNullPtrType()) 8469 // DllMain is exempt because a return value of zero means it failed. 8470 if (FD->getName() != "DllMain") 8471 FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true); 8472 8473 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) { 8474 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_mainlike_template_decl) << FD; 8475 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 8476 } 8477 } 8478 8479 bool Sema::CheckForConstantInitializer(Expr *Init, QualType DclT) { 8480 // FIXME: Need strict checking. In C89, we need to check for 8481 // any assignment, increment, decrement, function-calls, or 8482 // commas outside of a sizeof. In C99, it's the same list, 8483 // except that the aforementioned are allowed in unevaluated 8484 // expressions. Everything else falls under the 8485 // "may accept other forms of constant expressions" exception. 8486 // (We never end up here for C++, so the constant expression 8487 // rules there don't matter.) 8488 const Expr *Culprit; 8489 if (Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, false, &Culprit)) 8490 return false; 8491 Diag(Culprit->getExprLoc(), diag::err_init_element_not_constant) 8492 << Culprit->getSourceRange(); 8493 return true; 8494 } 8495 8496 namespace { 8497 // Visits an initialization expression to see if OrigDecl is evaluated in 8498 // its own initialization and throws a warning if it does. 8499 class SelfReferenceChecker 8500 : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<SelfReferenceChecker> { 8501 Sema &S; 8502 Decl *OrigDecl; 8503 bool isRecordType; 8504 bool isPODType; 8505 bool isReferenceType; 8506 8507 bool isInitList; 8508 llvm::SmallVector<unsigned, 4> InitFieldIndex; 8509 public: 8510 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<SelfReferenceChecker> Inherited; 8511 8512 SelfReferenceChecker(Sema &S, Decl *OrigDecl) : Inherited(S.Context), 8513 S(S), OrigDecl(OrigDecl) { 8514 isPODType = false; 8515 isRecordType = false; 8516 isReferenceType = false; 8517 isInitList = false; 8518 if (ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(OrigDecl)) { 8519 isPODType = VD->getType().isPODType(S.Context); 8520 isRecordType = VD->getType()->isRecordType(); 8521 isReferenceType = VD->getType()->isReferenceType(); 8522 } 8523 } 8524 8525 // For most expressions, just call the visitor. For initializer lists, 8526 // track the index of the field being initialized since fields are 8527 // initialized in order allowing use of previously initialized fields. 8528 void CheckExpr(Expr *E) { 8529 InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(E); 8530 if (!InitList) { 8531 Visit(E); 8532 return; 8533 } 8534 8535 // Track and increment the index here. 8536 isInitList = true; 8537 InitFieldIndex.push_back(0); 8538 for (auto Child : InitList->children()) { 8539 CheckExpr(cast<Expr>(Child)); 8540 ++InitFieldIndex.back(); 8541 } 8542 InitFieldIndex.pop_back(); 8543 } 8544 8545 // Returns true if MemberExpr is checked and no futher checking is needed. 8546 // Returns false if additional checking is required. 8547 bool CheckInitListMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E, bool CheckReference) { 8548 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Fields; 8549 Expr *Base = E; 8550 bool ReferenceField = false; 8551 8552 // Get the field memebers used. 8553 while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) { 8554 FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()); 8555 if (!FD) 8556 return false; 8557 Fields.push_back(FD); 8558 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) 8559 ReferenceField = true; 8560 Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 8561 } 8562 8563 // Keep checking only if the base Decl is the same. 8564 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base); 8565 if (!DRE || DRE->getDecl() != OrigDecl) 8566 return false; 8567 8568 // A reference field can be bound to an unininitialized field. 8569 if (CheckReference && !ReferenceField) 8570 return true; 8571 8572 // Convert FieldDecls to their index number. 8573 llvm::SmallVector<unsigned, 4> UsedFieldIndex; 8574 for (auto I = Fields.rbegin(), E = Fields.rend(); I != E; ++I) { 8575 UsedFieldIndex.push_back((*I)->getFieldIndex()); 8576 } 8577 8578 // See if a warning is needed by checking the first difference in index 8579 // numbers. If field being used has index less than the field being 8580 // initialized, then the use is safe. 8581 for (auto UsedIter = UsedFieldIndex.begin(), 8582 UsedEnd = UsedFieldIndex.end(), 8583 OrigIter = InitFieldIndex.begin(), 8584 OrigEnd = InitFieldIndex.end(); 8585 UsedIter != UsedEnd && OrigIter != OrigEnd; ++UsedIter, ++OrigIter) { 8586 if (*UsedIter < *OrigIter) 8587 return true; 8588 if (*UsedIter > *OrigIter) 8589 break; 8590 } 8591 8592 // TODO: Add a different warning which will print the field names. 8593 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 8594 return true; 8595 } 8596 8597 // For most expressions, the cast is directly above the DeclRefExpr. 8598 // For conditional operators, the cast can be outside the conditional 8599 // operator if both expressions are DeclRefExpr's. 8600 void HandleValue(Expr *E) { 8601 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 8602 if (DeclRefExpr* DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 8603 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 8604 return; 8605 } 8606 8607 if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(E)) { 8608 Visit(CO->getCond()); 8609 HandleValue(CO->getTrueExpr()); 8610 HandleValue(CO->getFalseExpr()); 8611 return; 8612 } 8613 8614 if (BinaryConditionalOperator *BCO = 8615 dyn_cast<BinaryConditionalOperator>(E)) { 8616 Visit(BCO->getCond()); 8617 HandleValue(BCO->getFalseExpr()); 8618 return; 8619 } 8620 8621 if (OpaqueValueExpr *OVE = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(E)) { 8622 HandleValue(OVE->getSourceExpr()); 8623 return; 8624 } 8625 8626 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) { 8627 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_Comma) { 8628 Visit(BO->getLHS()); 8629 HandleValue(BO->getRHS()); 8630 return; 8631 } 8632 } 8633 8634 if (isa<MemberExpr>(E)) { 8635 if (isInitList) { 8636 if (CheckInitListMemberExpr(cast<MemberExpr>(E), 8637 false /*CheckReference*/)) 8638 return; 8639 } 8640 8641 Expr *Base = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 8642 while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) { 8643 // Check for static member variables and don't warn on them. 8644 if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) 8645 return; 8646 Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 8647 } 8648 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base)) 8649 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 8650 return; 8651 } 8652 8653 Visit(E); 8654 } 8655 8656 // Reference types not handled in HandleValue are handled here since all 8657 // uses of references are bad, not just r-value uses. 8658 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 8659 if (isReferenceType) 8660 HandleDeclRefExpr(E); 8661 } 8662 8663 void VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) { 8664 if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) { 8665 HandleValue(E->getSubExpr()); 8666 return; 8667 } 8668 8669 Inherited::VisitImplicitCastExpr(E); 8670 } 8671 8672 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 8673 if (isInitList) { 8674 if (CheckInitListMemberExpr(E, true /*CheckReference*/)) 8675 return; 8676 } 8677 8678 // Don't warn on arrays since they can be treated as pointers. 8679 if (E->getType()->canDecayToPointerType()) return; 8680 8681 // Warn when a non-static method call is followed by non-static member 8682 // field accesses, which is followed by a DeclRefExpr. 8683 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getMemberDecl()); 8684 bool Warn = (MD && !MD->isStatic()); 8685 Expr *Base = E->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 8686 while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) { 8687 if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) 8688 Warn = false; 8689 Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 8690 } 8691 8692 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base)) { 8693 if (Warn) 8694 HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE); 8695 return; 8696 } 8697 8698 // The base of a MemberExpr is not a MemberExpr or a DeclRefExpr. 8699 // Visit that expression. 8700 Visit(Base); 8701 } 8702 8703 void VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(CXXOperatorCallExpr *E) { 8704 Expr *Callee = E->getCallee(); 8705 8706 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(Callee)) 8707 return Inherited::VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(E); 8708 8709 Visit(Callee); 8710 for (auto Arg: E->arguments()) 8711 HandleValue(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 8712 } 8713 8714 void VisitUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator *E) { 8715 // For POD record types, addresses of its own members are well-defined. 8716 if (E->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && isRecordType && 8717 isa<MemberExpr>(E->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens())) { 8718 if (!isPODType) 8719 HandleValue(E->getSubExpr()); 8720 return; 8721 } 8722 8723 if (E->isIncrementDecrementOp()) { 8724 HandleValue(E->getSubExpr()); 8725 return; 8726 } 8727 8728 Inherited::VisitUnaryOperator(E); 8729 } 8730 8731 void VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) { return; } 8732 8733 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) { 8734 if (E->getConstructor()->isCopyConstructor()) { 8735 Expr *ArgExpr = E->getArg(0); 8736 if (InitListExpr *ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(ArgExpr)) 8737 if (ILE->getNumInits() == 1) 8738 ArgExpr = ILE->getInit(0); 8739 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(ArgExpr)) 8740 if (ICE->getCastKind() == CK_NoOp) 8741 ArgExpr = ICE->getSubExpr(); 8742 HandleValue(ArgExpr); 8743 return; 8744 } 8745 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E); 8746 } 8747 8748 void VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) { 8749 // Treat std::move as a use. 8750 if (E->getNumArgs() == 1) { 8751 if (FunctionDecl *FD = E->getDirectCallee()) { 8752 if (FD->isInStdNamespace() && FD->getIdentifier() && 8753 FD->getIdentifier()->isStr("move")) { 8754 HandleValue(E->getArg(0)); 8755 return; 8756 } 8757 } 8758 } 8759 8760 Inherited::VisitCallExpr(E); 8761 } 8762 8763 void VisitBinaryOperator(BinaryOperator *E) { 8764 if (E->isCompoundAssignmentOp()) { 8765 HandleValue(E->getLHS()); 8766 Visit(E->getRHS()); 8767 return; 8768 } 8769 8770 Inherited::VisitBinaryOperator(E); 8771 } 8772 8773 // A custom visitor for BinaryConditionalOperator is needed because the 8774 // regular visitor would check the condition and true expression separately 8775 // but both point to the same place giving duplicate diagnostics. 8776 void VisitBinaryConditionalOperator(BinaryConditionalOperator *E) { 8777 Visit(E->getCond()); 8778 Visit(E->getFalseExpr()); 8779 } 8780 8781 void HandleDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *DRE) { 8782 Decl* ReferenceDecl = DRE->getDecl(); 8783 if (OrigDecl != ReferenceDecl) return; 8784 unsigned diag; 8785 if (isReferenceType) { 8786 diag = diag::warn_uninit_self_reference_in_reference_init; 8787 } else if (cast<VarDecl>(OrigDecl)->isStaticLocal()) { 8788 diag = diag::warn_static_self_reference_in_init; 8789 } else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(OrigDecl->getDeclContext()) || 8790 isa<NamespaceDecl>(OrigDecl->getDeclContext()) || 8791 DRE->getDecl()->getType()->isRecordType()) { 8792 diag = diag::warn_uninit_self_reference_in_init; 8793 } else { 8794 // Local variables will be handled by the CFG analysis. 8795 return; 8796 } 8797 8798 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(DRE->getLocStart(), DRE, 8799 S.PDiag(diag) 8800 << DRE->getNameInfo().getName() 8801 << OrigDecl->getLocation() 8802 << DRE->getSourceRange()); 8803 } 8804 }; 8805 8806 /// CheckSelfReference - Warns if OrigDecl is used in expression E. 8807 static void CheckSelfReference(Sema &S, Decl* OrigDecl, Expr *E, 8808 bool DirectInit) { 8809 // Parameters arguments are occassionially constructed with itself, 8810 // for instance, in recursive functions. Skip them. 8811 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(OrigDecl)) 8812 return; 8813 8814 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 8815 8816 // Skip checking T a = a where T is not a record or reference type. 8817 // Doing so is a way to silence uninitialized warnings. 8818 if (!DirectInit && !cast<VarDecl>(OrigDecl)->getType()->isRecordType()) 8819 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) 8820 if (ICE->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) 8821 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(ICE->getSubExpr())) 8822 if (DRE->getDecl() == OrigDecl) 8823 return; 8824 8825 SelfReferenceChecker(S, OrigDecl).CheckExpr(E); 8826 } 8827 } 8828 8829 /// AddInitializerToDecl - Adds the initializer Init to the 8830 /// declaration dcl. If DirectInit is true, this is C++ direct 8831 /// initialization rather than copy initialization. 8832 void Sema::AddInitializerToDecl(Decl *RealDecl, Expr *Init, 8833 bool DirectInit, bool TypeMayContainAuto) { 8834 // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Just ignore 8835 // the initializer. 8836 if (!RealDecl || RealDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 8837 CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Init, dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(RealDecl)); 8838 return; 8839 } 8840 8841 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(RealDecl)) { 8842 // Pure-specifiers are handled in ActOnPureSpecifier. 8843 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::err_member_function_initialization) 8844 << Method->getDeclName() << Init->getSourceRange(); 8845 Method->setInvalidDecl(); 8846 return; 8847 } 8848 8849 VarDecl *VDecl = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(RealDecl); 8850 if (!VDecl) { 8851 assert(!isa<FieldDecl>(RealDecl) && "field init shouldn't get here"); 8852 Diag(RealDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_illegal_initializer); 8853 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 8854 return; 8855 } 8856 ParenListExpr *CXXDirectInit = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(Init); 8857 8858 // C++11 [decl.spec.auto]p6. Deduce the type which 'auto' stands in for. 8859 if (TypeMayContainAuto && VDecl->getType()->isUndeducedType()) { 8860 // Attempt typo correction early so that the type of the init expression can 8861 // be deduced based on the chosen correction:if the original init contains a 8862 // TypoExpr. 8863 ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Init, VDecl); 8864 if (!Res.isUsable()) { 8865 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 8866 return; 8867 } 8868 8869 if (Res.get() != Init) { 8870 Init = Res.get(); 8871 if (CXXDirectInit) 8872 CXXDirectInit = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(Init); 8873 } 8874 8875 Expr *DeduceInit = Init; 8876 // Initializer could be a C++ direct-initializer. Deduction only works if it 8877 // contains exactly one expression. 8878 if (CXXDirectInit) { 8879 if (CXXDirectInit->getNumExprs() == 0) { 8880 // It isn't possible to write this directly, but it is possible to 8881 // end up in this situation with "auto x(some_pack...);" 8882 Diag(CXXDirectInit->getLocStart(), 8883 VDecl->isInitCapture() ? diag::err_init_capture_no_expression 8884 : diag::err_auto_var_init_no_expression) 8885 << VDecl->getDeclName() << VDecl->getType() 8886 << VDecl->getSourceRange(); 8887 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 8888 return; 8889 } else if (CXXDirectInit->getNumExprs() > 1) { 8890 Diag(CXXDirectInit->getExpr(1)->getLocStart(), 8891 VDecl->isInitCapture() 8892 ? diag::err_init_capture_multiple_expressions 8893 : diag::err_auto_var_init_multiple_expressions) 8894 << VDecl->getDeclName() << VDecl->getType() 8895 << VDecl->getSourceRange(); 8896 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 8897 return; 8898 } else { 8899 DeduceInit = CXXDirectInit->getExpr(0); 8900 if (isa<InitListExpr>(DeduceInit)) 8901 Diag(CXXDirectInit->getLocStart(), 8902 diag::err_auto_var_init_paren_braces) 8903 << VDecl->getDeclName() << VDecl->getType() 8904 << VDecl->getSourceRange(); 8905 } 8906 } 8907 8908 // Expressions default to 'id' when we're in a debugger. 8909 bool DefaultedToAuto = false; 8910 if (getLangOpts().DebuggerCastResultToId && 8911 Init->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 8912 ExprResult Result = forceUnknownAnyToType(Init, Context.getObjCIdType()); 8913 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 8914 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 8915 return; 8916 } 8917 Init = Result.get(); 8918 DefaultedToAuto = true; 8919 } 8920 8921 QualType DeducedType; 8922 if (DeduceAutoType(VDecl->getTypeSourceInfo(), DeduceInit, DeducedType) == 8923 DAR_Failed) 8924 DiagnoseAutoDeductionFailure(VDecl, DeduceInit); 8925 if (DeducedType.isNull()) { 8926 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 8927 return; 8928 } 8929 VDecl->setType(DeducedType); 8930 assert(VDecl->isLinkageValid()); 8931 8932 // In ARC, infer lifetime. 8933 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(VDecl)) 8934 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 8935 8936 // Warn if we deduced 'id'. 'auto' usually implies type-safety, but using 8937 // 'id' instead of a specific object type prevents most of our usual checks. 8938 // We only want to warn outside of template instantiations, though: 8939 // inside a template, the 'id' could have come from a parameter. 8940 if (ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() && !DefaultedToAuto && 8941 DeducedType->isObjCIdType()) { 8942 SourceLocation Loc = 8943 VDecl->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(); 8944 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_auto_var_is_id) 8945 << VDecl->getDeclName() << DeduceInit->getSourceRange(); 8946 } 8947 8948 // If this is a redeclaration, check that the type we just deduced matches 8949 // the previously declared type. 8950 if (VarDecl *Old = VDecl->getPreviousDecl()) { 8951 // We never need to merge the type, because we cannot form an incomplete 8952 // array of auto, nor deduce such a type. 8953 MergeVarDeclTypes(VDecl, Old, /*MergeTypeWithPrevious*/false); 8954 } 8955 8956 // Check the deduced type is valid for a variable declaration. 8957 CheckVariableDeclarationType(VDecl); 8958 if (VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 8959 return; 8960 8961 // If all looks well, warn if this is a case that will change meaning when 8962 // we implement N3922. 8963 if (DirectInit && !CXXDirectInit && isa<InitListExpr>(Init)) { 8964 Diag(Init->getLocStart(), 8965 diag::warn_auto_var_direct_list_init) 8966 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Init->getLocStart(), "="); 8967 } 8968 } 8969 8970 // dllimport cannot be used on variable definitions. 8971 if (VDecl->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() && !VDecl->isStaticDataMember()) { 8972 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dllimport_data_definition); 8973 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 8974 return; 8975 } 8976 8977 if (VDecl->isLocalVarDecl() && VDecl->hasExternalStorage()) { 8978 // C99 6.7.8p5. C++ has no such restriction, but that is a defect. 8979 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_block_extern_cant_init); 8980 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 8981 return; 8982 } 8983 8984 if (!VDecl->getType()->isDependentType()) { 8985 // A definition must end up with a complete type, which means it must be 8986 // complete with the restriction that an array type might be completed by 8987 // the initializer; note that later code assumes this restriction. 8988 QualType BaseDeclType = VDecl->getType(); 8989 if (const ArrayType *Array = Context.getAsIncompleteArrayType(BaseDeclType)) 8990 BaseDeclType = Array->getElementType(); 8991 if (RequireCompleteType(VDecl->getLocation(), BaseDeclType, 8992 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 8993 RealDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 8994 return; 8995 } 8996 8997 // The variable can not have an abstract class type. 8998 if (RequireNonAbstractType(VDecl->getLocation(), VDecl->getType(), 8999 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 9000 AbstractVariableType)) 9001 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 9002 } 9003 9004 VarDecl *Def; 9005 if ((Def = VDecl->getDefinition()) && Def != VDecl) { 9006 NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr; 9007 if (!hasVisibleDefinition(Def, &Hidden) && 9008 (VDecl->getFormalLinkage() == InternalLinkage || 9009 VDecl->getDescribedVarTemplate() || 9010 VDecl->getNumTemplateParameterLists() || 9011 VDecl->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())) { 9012 // The previous definition is hidden, and multiple definitions are 9013 // permitted (in separate TUs). Form another definition of it. 9014 } else { 9015 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) 9016 << VDecl->getDeclName(); 9017 Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 9018 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 9019 return; 9020 } 9021 } 9022 9023 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9024 // C++ [class.static.data]p4 9025 // If a static data member is of const integral or const 9026 // enumeration type, its declaration in the class definition can 9027 // specify a constant-initializer which shall be an integral 9028 // constant expression (5.19). In that case, the member can appear 9029 // in integral constant expressions. The member shall still be 9030 // defined in a namespace scope if it is used in the program and the 9031 // namespace scope definition shall not contain an initializer. 9032 // 9033 // We already performed a redefinition check above, but for static 9034 // data members we also need to check whether there was an in-class 9035 // declaration with an initializer. 9036 if (VDecl->isStaticDataMember() && VDecl->getCanonicalDecl()->hasInit()) { 9037 Diag(Init->getExprLoc(), diag::err_static_data_member_reinitialization) 9038 << VDecl->getDeclName(); 9039 Diag(VDecl->getCanonicalDecl()->getInit()->getExprLoc(), 9040 diag::note_previous_initializer) 9041 << 0; 9042 return; 9043 } 9044 9045 if (VDecl->hasLocalStorage()) 9046 getCurFunction()->setHasBranchProtectedScope(); 9047 9048 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(Init, UPPC_Initializer)) { 9049 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 9050 return; 9051 } 9052 } 9053 9054 // OpenCL 1.1 6.5.2: "Variables allocated in the __local address space inside 9055 // a kernel function cannot be initialized." 9056 if (VDecl->getStorageClass() == SC_OpenCLWorkGroupLocal) { 9057 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_local_cant_init); 9058 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 9059 return; 9060 } 9061 9062 // Get the decls type and save a reference for later, since 9063 // CheckInitializerTypes may change it. 9064 QualType DclT = VDecl->getType(), SavT = DclT; 9065 9066 // Expressions default to 'id' when we're in a debugger 9067 // and we are assigning it to a variable of Objective-C pointer type. 9068 if (getLangOpts().DebuggerCastResultToId && DclT->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 9069 Init->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 9070 ExprResult Result = forceUnknownAnyToType(Init, Context.getObjCIdType()); 9071 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 9072 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 9073 return; 9074 } 9075 Init = Result.get(); 9076 } 9077 9078 // Perform the initialization. 9079 if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 9080 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(VDecl); 9081 InitializationKind Kind 9082 = DirectInit ? 9083 CXXDirectInit ? InitializationKind::CreateDirect(VDecl->getLocation(), 9084 Init->getLocStart(), 9085 Init->getLocEnd()) 9086 : InitializationKind::CreateDirectList( 9087 VDecl->getLocation()) 9088 : InitializationKind::CreateCopy(VDecl->getLocation(), 9089 Init->getLocStart()); 9090 9091 MultiExprArg Args = Init; 9092 if (CXXDirectInit) 9093 Args = MultiExprArg(CXXDirectInit->getExprs(), 9094 CXXDirectInit->getNumExprs()); 9095 9096 // Try to correct any TypoExprs in the initialization arguments. 9097 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < Args.size(); ++Idx) { 9098 ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr( 9099 Args[Idx], VDecl, [this, Entity, Kind](Expr *E) { 9100 InitializationSequence Init(*this, Entity, Kind, MultiExprArg(E)); 9101 return Init.Failed() ? ExprError() : E; 9102 }); 9103 if (Res.isInvalid()) { 9104 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 9105 } else if (Res.get() != Args[Idx]) { 9106 Args[Idx] = Res.get(); 9107 } 9108 } 9109 if (VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 9110 return; 9111 9112 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, Args); 9113 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, Args, &DclT); 9114 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 9115 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 9116 return; 9117 } 9118 9119 Init = Result.getAs<Expr>(); 9120 } 9121 9122 // Check for self-references within variable initializers. 9123 // Variables declared within a function/method body (except for references) 9124 // are handled by a dataflow analysis. 9125 if (!VDecl->hasLocalStorage() || VDecl->getType()->isRecordType() || 9126 VDecl->getType()->isReferenceType()) { 9127 CheckSelfReference(*this, RealDecl, Init, DirectInit); 9128 } 9129 9130 // If the type changed, it means we had an incomplete type that was 9131 // completed by the initializer. For example: 9132 // int ary[] = { 1, 3, 5 }; 9133 // "ary" transitions from an IncompleteArrayType to a ConstantArrayType. 9134 if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl() && (DclT != SavT)) 9135 VDecl->setType(DclT); 9136 9137 if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 9138 checkUnsafeAssigns(VDecl->getLocation(), VDecl->getType(), Init); 9139 9140 if (VDecl->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 9141 checkRetainCycles(VDecl, Init); 9142 9143 // It is safe to assign a weak reference into a strong variable. 9144 // Although this code can still have problems: 9145 // id x = self.weakProp; 9146 // id y = self.weakProp; 9147 // we do not warn to warn spuriously when 'x' and 'y' are on separate 9148 // paths through the function. This should be revisited if 9149 // -Wrepeated-use-of-weak is made flow-sensitive. 9150 if (VDecl->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong && 9151 !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, 9152 Init->getLocStart())) 9153 getCurFunction()->markSafeWeakUse(Init); 9154 } 9155 9156 // The initialization is usually a full-expression. 9157 // 9158 // FIXME: If this is a braced initialization of an aggregate, it is not 9159 // an expression, and each individual field initializer is a separate 9160 // full-expression. For instance, in: 9161 // 9162 // struct Temp { ~Temp(); }; 9163 // struct S { S(Temp); }; 9164 // struct T { S a, b; } t = { Temp(), Temp() } 9165 // 9166 // we should destroy the first Temp before constructing the second. 9167 ExprResult Result = ActOnFinishFullExpr(Init, VDecl->getLocation(), 9168 false, 9169 VDecl->isConstexpr()); 9170 if (Result.isInvalid()) { 9171 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 9172 return; 9173 } 9174 Init = Result.get(); 9175 9176 // Attach the initializer to the decl. 9177 VDecl->setInit(Init); 9178 9179 if (VDecl->isLocalVarDecl()) { 9180 // C99 6.7.8p4: All the expressions in an initializer for an object that has 9181 // static storage duration shall be constant expressions or string literals. 9182 // C++ does not have this restriction. 9183 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) { 9184 const Expr *Culprit; 9185 if (VDecl->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) 9186 CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT); 9187 // C89 is stricter than C99 for non-static aggregate types. 9188 // C89 6.5.7p3: All the expressions [...] in an initializer list 9189 // for an object that has aggregate or union type shall be 9190 // constant expressions. 9191 else if (!getLangOpts().C99 && VDecl->getType()->isAggregateType() && 9192 isa<InitListExpr>(Init) && 9193 !Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, false, &Culprit)) 9194 Diag(Culprit->getExprLoc(), 9195 diag::ext_aggregate_init_not_constant) 9196 << Culprit->getSourceRange(); 9197 } 9198 } else if (VDecl->isStaticDataMember() && 9199 VDecl->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord()) { 9200 // This is an in-class initialization for a static data member, e.g., 9201 // 9202 // struct S { 9203 // static const int value = 17; 9204 // }; 9205 9206 // C++ [class.mem]p4: 9207 // A member-declarator can contain a constant-initializer only 9208 // if it declares a static member (9.4) of const integral or 9209 // const enumeration type, see 9.4.2. 9210 // 9211 // C++11 [class.static.data]p3: 9212 // If a non-volatile const static data member is of integral or 9213 // enumeration type, its declaration in the class definition can 9214 // specify a brace-or-equal-initializer in which every initalizer-clause 9215 // that is an assignment-expression is a constant expression. A static 9216 // data member of literal type can be declared in the class definition 9217 // with the constexpr specifier; if so, its declaration shall specify a 9218 // brace-or-equal-initializer in which every initializer-clause that is 9219 // an assignment-expression is a constant expression. 9220 9221 // Do nothing on dependent types. 9222 if (DclT->isDependentType()) { 9223 9224 // Allow any 'static constexpr' members, whether or not they are of literal 9225 // type. We separately check that every constexpr variable is of literal 9226 // type. 9227 } else if (VDecl->isConstexpr()) { 9228 9229 // Require constness. 9230 } else if (!DclT.isConstQualified()) { 9231 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_const) 9232 << Init->getSourceRange(); 9233 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 9234 9235 // We allow integer constant expressions in all cases. 9236 } else if (DclT->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) { 9237 // Check whether the expression is a constant expression. 9238 SourceLocation Loc; 9239 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && DclT.isVolatileQualified()) 9240 // In C++11, a non-constexpr const static data member with an 9241 // in-class initializer cannot be volatile. 9242 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_volatile); 9243 else if (Init->isValueDependent()) 9244 ; // Nothing to check. 9245 else if (Init->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context, &Loc)) 9246 ; // Ok, it's an ICE! 9247 else if (Init->isEvaluatable(Context)) { 9248 // If we can constant fold the initializer through heroics, accept it, 9249 // but report this as a use of an extension for -pedantic. 9250 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_in_class_initializer_non_constant) 9251 << Init->getSourceRange(); 9252 } else { 9253 // Otherwise, this is some crazy unknown case. Report the issue at the 9254 // location provided by the isIntegerConstantExpr failed check. 9255 Diag(Loc, diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_constant) 9256 << Init->getSourceRange(); 9257 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 9258 } 9259 9260 // We allow foldable floating-point constants as an extension. 9261 } else if (DclT->isFloatingType()) { // also permits complex, which is ok 9262 // In C++98, this is a GNU extension. In C++11, it is not, but we support 9263 // it anyway and provide a fixit to add the 'constexpr'. 9264 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 9265 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), 9266 diag::ext_in_class_initializer_float_type_cxx11) 9267 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange(); 9268 Diag(VDecl->getLocStart(), 9269 diag::note_in_class_initializer_float_type_cxx11) 9270 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VDecl->getLocStart(), "constexpr "); 9271 } else { 9272 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::ext_in_class_initializer_float_type) 9273 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange(); 9274 9275 if (!Init->isValueDependent() && !Init->isEvaluatable(Context)) { 9276 Diag(Init->getExprLoc(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_constant) 9277 << Init->getSourceRange(); 9278 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 9279 } 9280 } 9281 9282 // Suggest adding 'constexpr' in C++11 for literal types. 9283 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && DclT->isLiteralType(Context)) { 9284 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_literal_type) 9285 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange() 9286 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VDecl->getLocStart(), "constexpr "); 9287 VDecl->setConstexpr(true); 9288 9289 } else { 9290 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_bad_type) 9291 << DclT << Init->getSourceRange(); 9292 VDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 9293 } 9294 } else if (VDecl->isFileVarDecl()) { 9295 if (VDecl->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern && 9296 (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || 9297 !(Context.getBaseElementType(VDecl->getType()).isConstQualified() || 9298 VDecl->isExternC())) && 9299 !isTemplateInstantiation(VDecl->getTemplateSpecializationKind())) 9300 Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::warn_extern_init); 9301 9302 // C99 6.7.8p4. All file scoped initializers need to be constant. 9303 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 9304 CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT); 9305 } 9306 9307 // We will represent direct-initialization similarly to copy-initialization: 9308 // int x(1); -as-> int x = 1; 9309 // ClassType x(a,b,c); -as-> ClassType x = ClassType(a,b,c); 9310 // 9311 // Clients that want to distinguish between the two forms, can check for 9312 // direct initializer using VarDecl::getInitStyle(). 9313 // A major benefit is that clients that don't particularly care about which 9314 // exactly form was it (like the CodeGen) can handle both cases without 9315 // special case code. 9316 9317 // C++ 8.5p11: 9318 // The form of initialization (using parentheses or '=') is generally 9319 // insignificant, but does matter when the entity being initialized has a 9320 // class type. 9321 if (CXXDirectInit) { 9322 assert(DirectInit && "Call-style initializer must be direct init."); 9323 VDecl->setInitStyle(VarDecl::CallInit); 9324 } else if (DirectInit) { 9325 // This must be list-initialization. No other way is direct-initialization. 9326 VDecl->setInitStyle(VarDecl::ListInit); 9327 } 9328 9329 CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VDecl); 9330 } 9331 9332 /// ActOnInitializerError - Given that there was an error parsing an 9333 /// initializer for the given declaration, try to return to some form 9334 /// of sanity. 9335 void Sema::ActOnInitializerError(Decl *D) { 9336 // Our main concern here is re-establishing invariants like "a 9337 // variable's type is either dependent or complete". 9338 if (!D || D->isInvalidDecl()) return; 9339 9340 VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D); 9341 if (!VD) return; 9342 9343 // Auto types are meaningless if we can't make sense of the initializer. 9344 if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D)) { 9345 D->setInvalidDecl(); 9346 return; 9347 } 9348 9349 QualType Ty = VD->getType(); 9350 if (Ty->isDependentType()) return; 9351 9352 // Require a complete type. 9353 if (RequireCompleteType(VD->getLocation(), 9354 Context.getBaseElementType(Ty), 9355 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 9356 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 9357 return; 9358 } 9359 9360 // Require a non-abstract type. 9361 if (RequireNonAbstractType(VD->getLocation(), Ty, 9362 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 9363 AbstractVariableType)) { 9364 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 9365 return; 9366 } 9367 9368 // Don't bother complaining about constructors or destructors, 9369 // though. 9370 } 9371 9372 void Sema::ActOnUninitializedDecl(Decl *RealDecl, 9373 bool TypeMayContainAuto) { 9374 // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Just ignore it. 9375 if (!RealDecl) 9376 return; 9377 9378 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(RealDecl)) { 9379 QualType Type = Var->getType(); 9380 9381 // C++11 [dcl.spec.auto]p3 9382 if (TypeMayContainAuto && Type->getContainedAutoType()) { 9383 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_auto_var_requires_init) 9384 << Var->getDeclName() << Type; 9385 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 9386 return; 9387 } 9388 9389 // C++11 [class.static.data]p3: A static data member can be declared with 9390 // the constexpr specifier; if so, its declaration shall specify 9391 // a brace-or-equal-initializer. 9392 // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p1: The constexpr specifier shall be applied only to 9393 // the definition of a variable [...] or the declaration of a static data 9394 // member. 9395 if (Var->isConstexpr() && !Var->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 9396 if (Var->isStaticDataMember()) 9397 Diag(Var->getLocation(), 9398 diag::err_constexpr_static_mem_var_requires_init) 9399 << Var->getDeclName(); 9400 else 9401 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr_var_decl); 9402 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 9403 return; 9404 } 9405 9406 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.3: variables declared in the constant address space must 9407 // be initialized. 9408 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && 9409 Var->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant && 9410 Var->getStorageClass() != SC_Extern && !Var->getInit()) { 9411 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_constant_no_init); 9412 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 9413 return; 9414 } 9415 9416 switch (Var->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 9417 case VarDecl::Definition: 9418 if (!Var->isStaticDataMember() || !Var->getAnyInitializer()) 9419 break; 9420 9421 // We have an out-of-line definition of a static data member 9422 // that has an in-class initializer, so we type-check this like 9423 // a declaration. 9424 // 9425 // Fall through 9426 9427 case VarDecl::DeclarationOnly: 9428 // It's only a declaration. 9429 9430 // Block scope. C99 6.7p7: If an identifier for an object is 9431 // declared with no linkage (C99 6.2.2p6), the type for the 9432 // object shall be complete. 9433 if (!Type->isDependentType() && Var->isLocalVarDecl() && 9434 !Var->hasLinkage() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() && 9435 RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 9436 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) 9437 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 9438 9439 // Make sure that the type is not abstract. 9440 if (!Type->isDependentType() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() && 9441 RequireNonAbstractType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 9442 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 9443 AbstractVariableType)) 9444 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 9445 if (!Type->isDependentType() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() && 9446 Var->getStorageClass() == SC_PrivateExtern) { 9447 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::warn_private_extern); 9448 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_private_extern); 9449 } 9450 9451 return; 9452 9453 case VarDecl::TentativeDefinition: 9454 // File scope. C99 6.9.2p2: A declaration of an identifier for an 9455 // object that has file scope without an initializer, and without a 9456 // storage-class specifier or with the storage-class specifier "static", 9457 // constitutes a tentative definition. Note: A tentative definition with 9458 // external linkage is valid (C99 6.2.2p5). 9459 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl()) { 9460 if (const IncompleteArrayType *ArrayT 9461 = Context.getAsIncompleteArrayType(Type)) { 9462 if (RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), 9463 ArrayT->getElementType(), 9464 diag::err_illegal_decl_array_incomplete_type)) 9465 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 9466 } else if (Var->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) { 9467 // C99 6.9.2p3: If the declaration of an identifier for an object is 9468 // a tentative definition and has internal linkage (C99 6.2.2p3), the 9469 // declared type shall not be an incomplete type. 9470 // NOTE: code such as the following 9471 // static struct s; 9472 // struct s { int a; }; 9473 // is accepted by gcc. Hence here we issue a warning instead of 9474 // an error and we do not invalidate the static declaration. 9475 // NOTE: to avoid multiple warnings, only check the first declaration. 9476 if (Var->isFirstDecl()) 9477 RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 9478 diag::ext_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type); 9479 } 9480 } 9481 9482 // Record the tentative definition; we're done. 9483 if (!Var->isInvalidDecl()) 9484 TentativeDefinitions.push_back(Var); 9485 return; 9486 } 9487 9488 // Provide a specific diagnostic for uninitialized variable 9489 // definitions with incomplete array type. 9490 if (Type->isIncompleteArrayType()) { 9491 Diag(Var->getLocation(), 9492 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_array_needs_initializer); 9493 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 9494 return; 9495 } 9496 9497 // Provide a specific diagnostic for uninitialized variable 9498 // definitions with reference type. 9499 if (Type->isReferenceType()) { 9500 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_reference_var_requires_init) 9501 << Var->getDeclName() 9502 << SourceRange(Var->getLocation(), Var->getLocation()); 9503 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 9504 return; 9505 } 9506 9507 // Do not attempt to type-check the default initializer for a 9508 // variable with dependent type. 9509 if (Type->isDependentType()) 9510 return; 9511 9512 if (Var->isInvalidDecl()) 9513 return; 9514 9515 if (!Var->hasAttr<AliasAttr>()) { 9516 if (RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), 9517 Context.getBaseElementType(Type), 9518 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) { 9519 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 9520 return; 9521 } 9522 } else { 9523 return; 9524 } 9525 9526 // The variable can not have an abstract class type. 9527 if (RequireNonAbstractType(Var->getLocation(), Type, 9528 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 9529 AbstractVariableType)) { 9530 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 9531 return; 9532 } 9533 9534 // Check for jumps past the implicit initializer. C++0x 9535 // clarifies that this applies to a "variable with automatic 9536 // storage duration", not a "local variable". 9537 // C++11 [stmt.dcl]p3 9538 // A program that jumps from a point where a variable with automatic 9539 // storage duration is not in scope to a point where it is in scope is 9540 // ill-formed unless the variable has scalar type, class type with a 9541 // trivial default constructor and a trivial destructor, a cv-qualified 9542 // version of one of these types, or an array of one of the preceding 9543 // types and is declared without an initializer. 9544 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Var->hasLocalStorage()) { 9545 if (const RecordType *Record 9546 = Context.getBaseElementType(Type)->getAs<RecordType>()) { 9547 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl()); 9548 // Mark the function for further checking even if the looser rules of 9549 // C++11 do not require such checks, so that we can diagnose 9550 // incompatibilities with C++98. 9551 if (!CXXRecord->isPOD()) 9552 getCurFunction()->setHasBranchProtectedScope(); 9553 } 9554 } 9555 9556 // C++03 [dcl.init]p9: 9557 // If no initializer is specified for an object, and the 9558 // object is of (possibly cv-qualified) non-POD class type (or 9559 // array thereof), the object shall be default-initialized; if 9560 // the object is of const-qualified type, the underlying class 9561 // type shall have a user-declared default 9562 // constructor. Otherwise, if no initializer is specified for 9563 // a non- static object, the object and its subobjects, if 9564 // any, have an indeterminate initial value); if the object 9565 // or any of its subobjects are of const-qualified type, the 9566 // program is ill-formed. 9567 // C++0x [dcl.init]p11: 9568 // If no initializer is specified for an object, the object is 9569 // default-initialized; [...]. 9570 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(Var); 9571 InitializationKind Kind 9572 = InitializationKind::CreateDefault(Var->getLocation()); 9573 9574 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, None); 9575 ExprResult Init = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, None); 9576 if (Init.isInvalid()) 9577 Var->setInvalidDecl(); 9578 else if (Init.get()) { 9579 Var->setInit(MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Init.get())); 9580 // This is important for template substitution. 9581 Var->setInitStyle(VarDecl::CallInit); 9582 } 9583 9584 CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(Var); 9585 } 9586 } 9587 9588 void Sema::ActOnCXXForRangeDecl(Decl *D) { 9589 VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D); 9590 if (!VD) { 9591 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::err_for_range_decl_must_be_var); 9592 D->setInvalidDecl(); 9593 return; 9594 } 9595 9596 VD->setCXXForRangeDecl(true); 9597 9598 // for-range-declaration cannot be given a storage class specifier. 9599 int Error = -1; 9600 switch (VD->getStorageClass()) { 9601 case SC_None: 9602 break; 9603 case SC_Extern: 9604 Error = 0; 9605 break; 9606 case SC_Static: 9607 Error = 1; 9608 break; 9609 case SC_PrivateExtern: 9610 Error = 2; 9611 break; 9612 case SC_Auto: 9613 Error = 3; 9614 break; 9615 case SC_Register: 9616 Error = 4; 9617 break; 9618 case SC_OpenCLWorkGroupLocal: 9619 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected storage class"); 9620 } 9621 if (Error != -1) { 9622 Diag(VD->getOuterLocStart(), diag::err_for_range_storage_class) 9623 << VD->getDeclName() << Error; 9624 D->setInvalidDecl(); 9625 } 9626 } 9627 9628 StmtResult 9629 Sema::ActOnCXXForRangeIdentifier(Scope *S, SourceLocation IdentLoc, 9630 IdentifierInfo *Ident, 9631 ParsedAttributes &Attrs, 9632 SourceLocation AttrEnd) { 9633 // C++1y [stmt.iter]p1: 9634 // A range-based for statement of the form 9635 // for ( for-range-identifier : for-range-initializer ) statement 9636 // is equivalent to 9637 // for ( auto&& for-range-identifier : for-range-initializer ) statement 9638 DeclSpec DS(Attrs.getPool().getFactory()); 9639 9640 const char *PrevSpec; 9641 unsigned DiagID; 9642 DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_auto, IdentLoc, PrevSpec, DiagID, 9643 getPrintingPolicy()); 9644 9645 Declarator D(DS, Declarator::ForContext); 9646 D.SetIdentifier(Ident, IdentLoc); 9647 D.takeAttributes(Attrs, AttrEnd); 9648 9649 ParsedAttributes EmptyAttrs(Attrs.getPool().getFactory()); 9650 D.AddTypeInfo(DeclaratorChunk::getReference(0, IdentLoc, /*lvalue*/false), 9651 EmptyAttrs, IdentLoc); 9652 Decl *Var = ActOnDeclarator(S, D); 9653 cast<VarDecl>(Var)->setCXXForRangeDecl(true); 9654 FinalizeDeclaration(Var); 9655 return ActOnDeclStmt(FinalizeDeclaratorGroup(S, DS, Var), IdentLoc, 9656 AttrEnd.isValid() ? AttrEnd : IdentLoc); 9657 } 9658 9659 void Sema::CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *var) { 9660 if (var->isInvalidDecl()) return; 9661 9662 // In ARC, don't allow jumps past the implicit initialization of a 9663 // local retaining variable. 9664 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 9665 var->hasLocalStorage()) { 9666 switch (var->getType().getObjCLifetime()) { 9667 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: 9668 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone: 9669 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing: 9670 break; 9671 9672 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak: 9673 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong: 9674 getCurFunction()->setHasBranchProtectedScope(); 9675 break; 9676 } 9677 } 9678 9679 // Warn about externally-visible variables being defined without a 9680 // prior declaration. We only want to do this for global 9681 // declarations, but we also specifically need to avoid doing it for 9682 // class members because the linkage of an anonymous class can 9683 // change if it's later given a typedef name. 9684 if (var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 9685 var->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext() && 9686 var->isExternallyVisible() && var->hasLinkage() && 9687 !getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_missing_variable_declarations, 9688 var->getLocation())) { 9689 // Find a previous declaration that's not a definition. 9690 VarDecl *prev = var->getPreviousDecl(); 9691 while (prev && prev->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) 9692 prev = prev->getPreviousDecl(); 9693 9694 if (!prev) 9695 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::warn_missing_variable_declarations) << var; 9696 } 9697 9698 if (var->getTLSKind() == VarDecl::TLS_Static) { 9699 const Expr *Culprit; 9700 if (var->getType().isDestructedType()) { 9701 // GNU C++98 edits for __thread, [basic.start.term]p3: 9702 // The type of an object with thread storage duration shall not 9703 // have a non-trivial destructor. 9704 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_nontrivial_dtor); 9705 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 9706 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_use_thread_local); 9707 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && var->hasInit() && 9708 !var->getInit()->isConstantInitializer( 9709 Context, var->getType()->isReferenceType(), &Culprit)) { 9710 // GNU C++98 edits for __thread, [basic.start.init]p4: 9711 // An object of thread storage duration shall not require dynamic 9712 // initialization. 9713 // FIXME: Need strict checking here. 9714 Diag(Culprit->getExprLoc(), diag::err_thread_dynamic_init) 9715 << Culprit->getSourceRange(); 9716 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 9717 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_use_thread_local); 9718 } 9719 9720 } 9721 9722 // Apply section attributes and pragmas to global variables. 9723 bool GlobalStorage = var->hasGlobalStorage(); 9724 if (GlobalStorage && var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() && 9725 ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) { 9726 PragmaStack<StringLiteral *> *Stack = nullptr; 9727 int SectionFlags = ASTContext::PSF_Implicit | ASTContext::PSF_Read; 9728 if (var->getType().isConstQualified()) 9729 Stack = &ConstSegStack; 9730 else if (!var->getInit()) { 9731 Stack = &BSSSegStack; 9732 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write; 9733 } else { 9734 Stack = &DataSegStack; 9735 SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write; 9736 } 9737 if (Stack->CurrentValue && !var->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) { 9738 var->addAttr(SectionAttr::CreateImplicit( 9739 Context, SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate, 9740 Stack->CurrentValue->getString(), Stack->CurrentPragmaLocation)); 9741 } 9742 if (const SectionAttr *SA = var->getAttr<SectionAttr>()) 9743 if (UnifySection(SA->getName(), SectionFlags, var)) 9744 var->dropAttr<SectionAttr>(); 9745 9746 // Apply the init_seg attribute if this has an initializer. If the 9747 // initializer turns out to not be dynamic, we'll end up ignoring this 9748 // attribute. 9749 if (CurInitSeg && var->getInit()) 9750 var->addAttr(InitSegAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, CurInitSeg->getString(), 9751 CurInitSegLoc)); 9752 } 9753 9754 // All the following checks are C++ only. 9755 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) return; 9756 9757 QualType type = var->getType(); 9758 if (type->isDependentType()) return; 9759 9760 // __block variables might require us to capture a copy-initializer. 9761 if (var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 9762 // It's currently invalid to ever have a __block variable with an 9763 // array type; should we diagnose that here? 9764 9765 // Regardless, we don't want to ignore array nesting when 9766 // constructing this copy. 9767 if (type->isStructureOrClassType()) { 9768 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext scope(*this, PotentiallyEvaluated); 9769 SourceLocation poi = var->getLocation(); 9770 Expr *varRef =new (Context) DeclRefExpr(var, false, type, VK_LValue, poi); 9771 ExprResult result 9772 = PerformMoveOrCopyInitialization( 9773 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(poi, type, false), 9774 var, var->getType(), varRef, /*AllowNRVO=*/true); 9775 if (!result.isInvalid()) { 9776 result = MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(result); 9777 Expr *init = result.getAs<Expr>(); 9778 Context.setBlockVarCopyInits(var, init); 9779 } 9780 } 9781 } 9782 9783 Expr *Init = var->getInit(); 9784 bool IsGlobal = GlobalStorage && !var->isStaticLocal(); 9785 QualType baseType = Context.getBaseElementType(type); 9786 9787 if (!var->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext() && 9788 Init && !Init->isValueDependent()) { 9789 if (IsGlobal && !var->isConstexpr() && 9790 !getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_global_constructor, 9791 var->getLocation())) { 9792 // Warn about globals which don't have a constant initializer. Don't 9793 // warn about globals with a non-trivial destructor because we already 9794 // warned about them. 9795 CXXRecordDecl *RD = baseType->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 9796 if (!(RD && !RD->hasTrivialDestructor()) && 9797 !Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, baseType->isReferenceType())) 9798 Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::warn_global_constructor) 9799 << Init->getSourceRange(); 9800 } 9801 9802 if (var->isConstexpr()) { 9803 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 9804 if (!var->evaluateValue(Notes) || !var->isInitICE()) { 9805 SourceLocation DiagLoc = var->getLocation(); 9806 // If the note doesn't add any useful information other than a source 9807 // location, fold it into the primary diagnostic. 9808 if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == 9809 diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) { 9810 DiagLoc = Notes[0].first; 9811 Notes.clear(); 9812 } 9813 Diag(DiagLoc, diag::err_constexpr_var_requires_const_init) 9814 << var << Init->getSourceRange(); 9815 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I) 9816 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 9817 } 9818 } else if (var->isUsableInConstantExpressions(Context)) { 9819 // Check whether the initializer of a const variable of integral or 9820 // enumeration type is an ICE now, since we can't tell whether it was 9821 // initialized by a constant expression if we check later. 9822 var->checkInitIsICE(); 9823 } 9824 } 9825 9826 // Require the destructor. 9827 if (const RecordType *recordType = baseType->getAs<RecordType>()) 9828 FinalizeVarWithDestructor(var, recordType); 9829 } 9830 9831 /// \brief Determines if a variable's alignment is dependent. 9832 static bool hasDependentAlignment(VarDecl *VD) { 9833 if (VD->getType()->isDependentType()) 9834 return true; 9835 for (auto *I : VD->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) 9836 if (I->isAlignmentDependent()) 9837 return true; 9838 return false; 9839 } 9840 9841 /// FinalizeDeclaration - called by ParseDeclarationAfterDeclarator to perform 9842 /// any semantic actions necessary after any initializer has been attached. 9843 void 9844 Sema::FinalizeDeclaration(Decl *ThisDecl) { 9845 // Note that we are no longer parsing the initializer for this declaration. 9846 ParsingInitForAutoVars.erase(ThisDecl); 9847 9848 VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(ThisDecl); 9849 if (!VD) 9850 return; 9851 9852 checkAttributesAfterMerging(*this, *VD); 9853 9854 // Perform TLS alignment check here after attributes attached to the variable 9855 // which may affect the alignment have been processed. Only perform the check 9856 // if the target has a maximum TLS alignment (zero means no constraints). 9857 if (unsigned MaxAlign = Context.getTargetInfo().getMaxTLSAlign()) { 9858 // Protect the check so that it's not performed on dependent types and 9859 // dependent alignments (we can't determine the alignment in that case). 9860 if (VD->getTLSKind() && !hasDependentAlignment(VD)) { 9861 CharUnits MaxAlignChars = Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(MaxAlign); 9862 if (Context.getDeclAlign(VD) > MaxAlignChars) { 9863 Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::err_tls_var_aligned_over_maximum) 9864 << (unsigned)Context.getDeclAlign(VD).getQuantity() << VD 9865 << (unsigned)MaxAlignChars.getQuantity(); 9866 } 9867 } 9868 } 9869 9870 // Static locals inherit dll attributes from their function. 9871 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) { 9872 if (FunctionDecl *FD = 9873 dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod())) { 9874 if (Attr *A = getDLLAttr(FD)) { 9875 auto *NewAttr = cast<InheritableAttr>(A->clone(getASTContext())); 9876 NewAttr->setInherited(true); 9877 VD->addAttr(NewAttr); 9878 } 9879 } 9880 } 9881 9882 // Grab the dllimport or dllexport attribute off of the VarDecl. 9883 const InheritableAttr *DLLAttr = getDLLAttr(VD); 9884 9885 // Imported static data members cannot be defined out-of-line. 9886 if (const auto *IA = dyn_cast_or_null<DLLImportAttr>(DLLAttr)) { 9887 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && VD->isOutOfLine() && 9888 VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 9889 // We allow definitions of dllimport class template static data members 9890 // with a warning. 9891 CXXRecordDecl *Context = 9892 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(VD->getFirstDecl()->getDeclContext()); 9893 bool IsClassTemplateMember = 9894 isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Context) || 9895 Context->getDescribedClassTemplate(); 9896 9897 Diag(VD->getLocation(), 9898 IsClassTemplateMember 9899 ? diag::warn_attribute_dllimport_static_field_definition 9900 : diag::err_attribute_dllimport_static_field_definition); 9901 Diag(IA->getLocation(), diag::note_attribute); 9902 if (!IsClassTemplateMember) 9903 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 9904 } 9905 } 9906 9907 // dllimport/dllexport variables cannot be thread local, their TLS index 9908 // isn't exported with the variable. 9909 if (DLLAttr && VD->getTLSKind()) { 9910 Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dll_thread_local) << VD 9911 << DLLAttr; 9912 VD->setInvalidDecl(); 9913 } 9914 9915 if (UsedAttr *Attr = VD->getAttr<UsedAttr>()) { 9916 if (!Attr->isInherited() && !VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) { 9917 Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_ignored) << Attr; 9918 VD->dropAttr<UsedAttr>(); 9919 } 9920 } 9921 9922 const DeclContext *DC = VD->getDeclContext(); 9923 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, and this isn't a class 9924 // member, set the visibility of this variable. 9925 if (DC->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext() && VD->isExternallyVisible()) 9926 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(VD); 9927 9928 // FIXME: Warn on unused templates. 9929 if (VD->isFileVarDecl() && !VD->getDescribedVarTemplate() && 9930 !isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD)) 9931 MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(VD); 9932 9933 // Now we have parsed the initializer and can update the table of magic 9934 // tag values. 9935 if (!VD->hasAttr<TypeTagForDatatypeAttr>() || 9936 !VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) 9937 return; 9938 9939 for (const auto *I : ThisDecl->specific_attrs<TypeTagForDatatypeAttr>()) { 9940 const Expr *MagicValueExpr = VD->getInit(); 9941 if (!MagicValueExpr) { 9942 continue; 9943 } 9944 llvm::APSInt MagicValueInt; 9945 if (!MagicValueExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(MagicValueInt, Context)) { 9946 Diag(I->getRange().getBegin(), 9947 diag::err_type_tag_for_datatype_not_ice) 9948 << LangOpts.CPlusPlus << MagicValueExpr->getSourceRange(); 9949 continue; 9950 } 9951 if (MagicValueInt.getActiveBits() > 64) { 9952 Diag(I->getRange().getBegin(), 9953 diag::err_type_tag_for_datatype_too_large) 9954 << LangOpts.CPlusPlus << MagicValueExpr->getSourceRange(); 9955 continue; 9956 } 9957 uint64_t MagicValue = MagicValueInt.getZExtValue(); 9958 RegisterTypeTagForDatatype(I->getArgumentKind(), 9959 MagicValue, 9960 I->getMatchingCType(), 9961 I->getLayoutCompatible(), 9962 I->getMustBeNull()); 9963 } 9964 } 9965 9966 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy Sema::FinalizeDeclaratorGroup(Scope *S, const DeclSpec &DS, 9967 ArrayRef<Decl *> Group) { 9968 SmallVector<Decl*, 8> Decls; 9969 9970 if (DS.isTypeSpecOwned()) 9971 Decls.push_back(DS.getRepAsDecl()); 9972 9973 DeclaratorDecl *FirstDeclaratorInGroup = nullptr; 9974 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Group.size(); i != e; ++i) 9975 if (Decl *D = Group[i]) { 9976 if (DeclaratorDecl *DD = dyn_cast<DeclaratorDecl>(D)) 9977 if (!FirstDeclaratorInGroup) 9978 FirstDeclaratorInGroup = DD; 9979 Decls.push_back(D); 9980 } 9981 9982 if (DeclSpec::isDeclRep(DS.getTypeSpecType())) { 9983 if (TagDecl *Tag = dyn_cast_or_null<TagDecl>(DS.getRepAsDecl())) { 9984 handleTagNumbering(Tag, S); 9985 if (!Tag->hasNameForLinkage() && !Tag->hasDeclaratorForAnonDecl()) 9986 Tag->setDeclaratorForAnonDecl(FirstDeclaratorInGroup); 9987 } 9988 } 9989 9990 return BuildDeclaratorGroup(Decls, DS.containsPlaceholderType()); 9991 } 9992 9993 /// BuildDeclaratorGroup - convert a list of declarations into a declaration 9994 /// group, performing any necessary semantic checking. 9995 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy 9996 Sema::BuildDeclaratorGroup(MutableArrayRef<Decl *> Group, 9997 bool TypeMayContainAuto) { 9998 // C++0x [dcl.spec.auto]p7: 9999 // If the type deduced for the template parameter U is not the same in each 10000 // deduction, the program is ill-formed. 10001 // FIXME: When initializer-list support is added, a distinction is needed 10002 // between the deduced type U and the deduced type which 'auto' stands for. 10003 // auto a = 0, b = { 1, 2, 3 }; 10004 // is legal because the deduced type U is 'int' in both cases. 10005 if (TypeMayContainAuto && Group.size() > 1) { 10006 QualType Deduced; 10007 CanQualType DeducedCanon; 10008 VarDecl *DeducedDecl = nullptr; 10009 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Group.size(); i != e; ++i) { 10010 if (VarDecl *D = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Group[i])) { 10011 AutoType *AT = D->getType()->getContainedAutoType(); 10012 // Don't reissue diagnostics when instantiating a template. 10013 if (AT && D->isInvalidDecl()) 10014 break; 10015 QualType U = AT ? AT->getDeducedType() : QualType(); 10016 if (!U.isNull()) { 10017 CanQualType UCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(U); 10018 if (Deduced.isNull()) { 10019 Deduced = U; 10020 DeducedCanon = UCanon; 10021 DeducedDecl = D; 10022 } else if (DeducedCanon != UCanon) { 10023 Diag(D->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 10024 diag::err_auto_different_deductions) 10025 << (AT->isDecltypeAuto() ? 1 : 0) 10026 << Deduced << DeducedDecl->getDeclName() 10027 << U << D->getDeclName() 10028 << DeducedDecl->getInit()->getSourceRange() 10029 << D->getInit()->getSourceRange(); 10030 D->setInvalidDecl(); 10031 break; 10032 } 10033 } 10034 } 10035 } 10036 } 10037 10038 ActOnDocumentableDecls(Group); 10039 10040 return DeclGroupPtrTy::make( 10041 DeclGroupRef::Create(Context, Group.data(), Group.size())); 10042 } 10043 10044 void Sema::ActOnDocumentableDecl(Decl *D) { 10045 ActOnDocumentableDecls(D); 10046 } 10047 10048 void Sema::ActOnDocumentableDecls(ArrayRef<Decl *> Group) { 10049 // Don't parse the comment if Doxygen diagnostics are ignored. 10050 if (Group.empty() || !Group[0]) 10051 return; 10052 10053 if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_doc_param_not_found, 10054 Group[0]->getLocation()) && 10055 Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_unknown_comment_command_name, 10056 Group[0]->getLocation())) 10057 return; 10058 10059 if (Group.size() >= 2) { 10060 // This is a decl group. Normally it will contain only declarations 10061 // produced from declarator list. But in case we have any definitions or 10062 // additional declaration references: 10063 // 'typedef struct S {} S;' 10064 // 'typedef struct S *S;' 10065 // 'struct S *pS;' 10066 // FinalizeDeclaratorGroup adds these as separate declarations. 10067 Decl *MaybeTagDecl = Group[0]; 10068 if (MaybeTagDecl && isa<TagDecl>(MaybeTagDecl)) { 10069 Group = Group.slice(1); 10070 } 10071 } 10072 10073 // See if there are any new comments that are not attached to a decl. 10074 ArrayRef<RawComment *> Comments = Context.getRawCommentList().getComments(); 10075 if (!Comments.empty() && 10076 !Comments.back()->isAttached()) { 10077 // There is at least one comment that not attached to a decl. 10078 // Maybe it should be attached to one of these decls? 10079 // 10080 // Note that this way we pick up not only comments that precede the 10081 // declaration, but also comments that *follow* the declaration -- thanks to 10082 // the lookahead in the lexer: we've consumed the semicolon and looked 10083 // ahead through comments. 10084 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Group.size(); i != e; ++i) 10085 Context.getCommentForDecl(Group[i], &PP); 10086 } 10087 } 10088 10089 /// ActOnParamDeclarator - Called from Parser::ParseFunctionDeclarator() 10090 /// to introduce parameters into function prototype scope. 10091 Decl *Sema::ActOnParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) { 10092 const DeclSpec &DS = D.getDeclSpec(); 10093 10094 // Verify C99 6.7.5.3p2: The only SCS allowed is 'register'. 10095 10096 // C++03 [dcl.stc]p2 also permits 'auto'. 10097 StorageClass SC = SC_None; 10098 if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_register) { 10099 SC = SC_Register; 10100 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 10101 DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_auto) { 10102 SC = SC_Auto; 10103 } else if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified) { 10104 Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), 10105 diag::err_invalid_storage_class_in_func_decl); 10106 D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearStorageClassSpecs(); 10107 } 10108 10109 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = DS.getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 10110 Diag(DS.getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_thread) 10111 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 10112 if (DS.isConstexprSpecified()) 10113 Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr) 10114 << 0; 10115 10116 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(DS); 10117 10118 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 10119 QualType parmDeclType = TInfo->getType(); 10120 10121 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10122 // Check that there are no default arguments inside the type of this 10123 // parameter. 10124 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 10125 10126 // Parameter declarators cannot be qualified (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1). 10127 if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) { 10128 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_qualified_param_declarator) 10129 << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange(); 10130 D.getCXXScopeSpec().clear(); 10131 } 10132 } 10133 10134 // Ensure we have a valid name 10135 IdentifierInfo *II = nullptr; 10136 if (D.hasName()) { 10137 II = D.getIdentifier(); 10138 if (!II) { 10139 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_parameter_name) 10140 << GetNameForDeclarator(D).getName(); 10141 D.setInvalidType(true); 10142 } 10143 } 10144 10145 // Check for redeclaration of parameters, e.g. int foo(int x, int x); 10146 if (II) { 10147 LookupResult R(*this, II, D.getIdentifierLoc(), LookupOrdinaryName, 10148 ForRedeclaration); 10149 LookupName(R, S); 10150 if (R.isSingleResult()) { 10151 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getFoundDecl(); 10152 if (PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) { 10153 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 10154 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), PrevDecl); 10155 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 10156 PrevDecl = nullptr; 10157 } else if (S->isDeclScope(PrevDecl)) { 10158 Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_param_redefinition) << II; 10159 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 10160 10161 // Recover by removing the name 10162 II = nullptr; 10163 D.SetIdentifier(nullptr, D.getIdentifierLoc()); 10164 D.setInvalidType(true); 10165 } 10166 } 10167 } 10168 10169 // Temporarily put parameter variables in the translation unit, not 10170 // the enclosing context. This prevents them from accidentally 10171 // looking like class members in C++. 10172 ParmVarDecl *New = CheckParameter(Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(), 10173 D.getLocStart(), 10174 D.getIdentifierLoc(), II, 10175 parmDeclType, TInfo, 10176 SC); 10177 10178 if (D.isInvalidType()) 10179 New->setInvalidDecl(); 10180 10181 assert(S->isFunctionPrototypeScope()); 10182 assert(S->getFunctionPrototypeDepth() >= 1); 10183 New->setScopeInfo(S->getFunctionPrototypeDepth() - 1, 10184 S->getNextFunctionPrototypeIndex()); 10185 10186 // Add the parameter declaration into this scope. 10187 S->AddDecl(New); 10188 if (II) 10189 IdResolver.AddDecl(New); 10190 10191 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, New, D); 10192 10193 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) 10194 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local) 10195 << 1 << New->getDeclName() 10196 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()) 10197 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 10198 10199 if (New->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) { 10200 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_nonlocal); 10201 } 10202 return New; 10203 } 10204 10205 /// \brief Synthesizes a variable for a parameter arising from a 10206 /// typedef. 10207 ParmVarDecl *Sema::BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(DeclContext *DC, 10208 SourceLocation Loc, 10209 QualType T) { 10210 /* FIXME: setting StartLoc == Loc. 10211 Would it be worth to modify callers so as to provide proper source 10212 location for the unnamed parameters, embedding the parameter's type? */ 10213 ParmVarDecl *Param = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, DC, Loc, Loc, nullptr, 10214 T, Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc), 10215 SC_None, nullptr); 10216 Param->setImplicit(); 10217 return Param; 10218 } 10219 10220 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedParameters(ParmVarDecl * const *Param, 10221 ParmVarDecl * const *ParamEnd) { 10222 // Don't diagnose unused-parameter errors in template instantiations; we 10223 // will already have done so in the template itself. 10224 if (!ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) 10225 return; 10226 10227 for (; Param != ParamEnd; ++Param) { 10228 if (!(*Param)->isReferenced() && (*Param)->getDeclName() && 10229 !(*Param)->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) { 10230 Diag((*Param)->getLocation(), diag::warn_unused_parameter) 10231 << (*Param)->getDeclName(); 10232 } 10233 } 10234 } 10235 10236 void Sema::DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(ParmVarDecl * const *Param, 10237 ParmVarDecl * const *ParamEnd, 10238 QualType ReturnTy, 10239 NamedDecl *D) { 10240 if (LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy == 0) // No check. 10241 return; 10242 10243 // Warn if the return value is pass-by-value and larger than the specified 10244 // threshold. 10245 if (!ReturnTy->isDependentType() && ReturnTy.isPODType(Context)) { 10246 unsigned Size = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(ReturnTy).getQuantity(); 10247 if (Size > LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy) 10248 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_size) 10249 << D->getDeclName() << Size; 10250 } 10251 10252 // Warn if any parameter is pass-by-value and larger than the specified 10253 // threshold. 10254 for (; Param != ParamEnd; ++Param) { 10255 QualType T = (*Param)->getType(); 10256 if (T->isDependentType() || !T.isPODType(Context)) 10257 continue; 10258 unsigned Size = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(T).getQuantity(); 10259 if (Size > LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy) 10260 Diag((*Param)->getLocation(), diag::warn_parameter_size) 10261 << (*Param)->getDeclName() << Size; 10262 } 10263 } 10264 10265 ParmVarDecl *Sema::CheckParameter(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation StartLoc, 10266 SourceLocation NameLoc, IdentifierInfo *Name, 10267 QualType T, TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo, 10268 StorageClass SC) { 10269 // In ARC, infer a lifetime qualifier for appropriate parameter types. 10270 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 10271 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None && 10272 T->isObjCLifetimeType()) { 10273 10274 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime; 10275 10276 // Special cases for arrays: 10277 // - if it's const, use __unsafe_unretained 10278 // - otherwise, it's an error 10279 if (T->isArrayType()) { 10280 if (!T.isConstQualified()) { 10281 DelayedDiagnostics.add( 10282 sema::DelayedDiagnostic::makeForbiddenType( 10283 NameLoc, diag::err_arc_array_param_no_ownership, T, false)); 10284 } 10285 lifetime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone; 10286 } else { 10287 lifetime = T->getObjCARCImplicitLifetime(); 10288 } 10289 T = Context.getLifetimeQualifiedType(T, lifetime); 10290 } 10291 10292 ParmVarDecl *New = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, DC, StartLoc, NameLoc, Name, 10293 Context.getAdjustedParameterType(T), 10294 TSInfo, SC, nullptr); 10295 10296 // Parameters can not be abstract class types. 10297 // For record types, this is done by the AbstractClassUsageDiagnoser once 10298 // the class has been completely parsed. 10299 if (!CurContext->isRecord() && 10300 RequireNonAbstractType(NameLoc, T, diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 10301 AbstractParamType)) 10302 New->setInvalidDecl(); 10303 10304 // Parameter declarators cannot be interface types. All ObjC objects are 10305 // passed by reference. 10306 if (T->isObjCObjectType()) { 10307 SourceLocation TypeEndLoc = TSInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocEnd(); 10308 Diag(NameLoc, 10309 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 1 << T 10310 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(TypeEndLoc, "*"); 10311 T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T); 10312 New->setType(T); 10313 } 10314 10315 // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S6.7.3: "The type of an object with automatic storage 10316 // duration shall not be qualified by an address-space qualifier." 10317 // Since all parameters have automatic store duration, they can not have 10318 // an address space. 10319 if (T.getAddressSpace() != 0) { 10320 // OpenCL allows function arguments declared to be an array of a type 10321 // to be qualified with an address space. 10322 if (!(getLangOpts().OpenCL && T->isArrayType())) { 10323 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_arg_with_address_space); 10324 New->setInvalidDecl(); 10325 } 10326 } 10327 10328 return New; 10329 } 10330 10331 void Sema::ActOnFinishKNRParamDeclarations(Scope *S, Declarator &D, 10332 SourceLocation LocAfterDecls) { 10333 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = D.getFunctionTypeInfo(); 10334 10335 // Verify 6.9.1p6: 'every identifier in the identifier list shall be declared' 10336 // for a K&R function. 10337 if (!FTI.hasPrototype) { 10338 for (int i = FTI.NumParams; i != 0; /* decrement in loop */) { 10339 --i; 10340 if (FTI.Params[i].Param == nullptr) { 10341 SmallString<256> Code; 10342 llvm::raw_svector_ostream(Code) 10343 << " int " << FTI.Params[i].Ident->getName() << ";\n"; 10344 Diag(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, diag::ext_param_not_declared) 10345 << FTI.Params[i].Ident 10346 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LocAfterDecls, Code); 10347 10348 // Implicitly declare the argument as type 'int' for lack of a better 10349 // type. 10350 AttributeFactory attrs; 10351 DeclSpec DS(attrs); 10352 const char* PrevSpec; // unused 10353 unsigned DiagID; // unused 10354 DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_int, FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, PrevSpec, 10355 DiagID, Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 10356 // Use the identifier location for the type source range. 10357 DS.SetRangeStart(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc); 10358 DS.SetRangeEnd(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc); 10359 Declarator ParamD(DS, Declarator::KNRTypeListContext); 10360 ParamD.SetIdentifier(FTI.Params[i].Ident, FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc); 10361 FTI.Params[i].Param = ActOnParamDeclarator(S, ParamD); 10362 } 10363 } 10364 } 10365 } 10366 10367 Decl *Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(Scope *FnBodyScope, Declarator &D) { 10368 assert(getCurFunctionDecl() == nullptr && "Function parsing confused"); 10369 assert(D.isFunctionDeclarator() && "Not a function declarator!"); 10370 Scope *ParentScope = FnBodyScope->getParent(); 10371 10372 D.setFunctionDefinitionKind(FDK_Definition); 10373 Decl *DP = HandleDeclarator(ParentScope, D, MultiTemplateParamsArg()); 10374 return ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(FnBodyScope, DP); 10375 } 10376 10377 void Sema::ActOnFinishInlineMethodDef(CXXMethodDecl *D) { 10378 Consumer.HandleInlineMethodDefinition(D); 10379 } 10380 10381 static bool ShouldWarnAboutMissingPrototype(const FunctionDecl *FD, 10382 const FunctionDecl*& PossibleZeroParamPrototype) { 10383 // Don't warn about invalid declarations. 10384 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) 10385 return false; 10386 10387 // Or declarations that aren't global. 10388 if (!FD->isGlobal()) 10389 return false; 10390 10391 // Don't warn about C++ member functions. 10392 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) 10393 return false; 10394 10395 // Don't warn about 'main'. 10396 if (FD->isMain()) 10397 return false; 10398 10399 // Don't warn about inline functions. 10400 if (FD->isInlined()) 10401 return false; 10402 10403 // Don't warn about function templates. 10404 if (FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) 10405 return false; 10406 10407 // Don't warn about function template specializations. 10408 if (FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 10409 return false; 10410 10411 // Don't warn for OpenCL kernels. 10412 if (FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) 10413 return false; 10414 10415 // Don't warn on explicitly deleted functions. 10416 if (FD->isDeleted()) 10417 return false; 10418 10419 bool MissingPrototype = true; 10420 for (const FunctionDecl *Prev = FD->getPreviousDecl(); 10421 Prev; Prev = Prev->getPreviousDecl()) { 10422 // Ignore any declarations that occur in function or method 10423 // scope, because they aren't visible from the header. 10424 if (Prev->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 10425 continue; 10426 10427 MissingPrototype = !Prev->getType()->isFunctionProtoType(); 10428 if (FD->getNumParams() == 0) 10429 PossibleZeroParamPrototype = Prev; 10430 break; 10431 } 10432 10433 return MissingPrototype; 10434 } 10435 10436 void 10437 Sema::CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FunctionDecl *FD, 10438 const FunctionDecl *EffectiveDefinition) { 10439 // Don't complain if we're in GNU89 mode and the previous definition 10440 // was an extern inline function. 10441 const FunctionDecl *Definition = EffectiveDefinition; 10442 if (!Definition) 10443 if (!FD->isDefined(Definition)) 10444 return; 10445 10446 if (canRedefineFunction(Definition, getLangOpts())) 10447 return; 10448 10449 // If we don't have a visible definition of the function, and it's inline or 10450 // a template, it's OK to form another definition of it. 10451 // 10452 // FIXME: Should we skip the body of the function and use the old definition 10453 // in this case? That may be necessary for functions that return local types 10454 // through a deduced return type, or instantiate templates with local types. 10455 if (!hasVisibleDefinition(Definition) && 10456 (Definition->getFormalLinkage() == InternalLinkage || 10457 Definition->isInlined() || 10458 Definition->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() || 10459 Definition->getNumTemplateParameterLists())) 10460 return; 10461 10462 if (getLangOpts().GNUMode && Definition->isInlineSpecified() && 10463 Definition->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern) 10464 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_extern_inline) 10465 << FD->getDeclName() << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 10466 else 10467 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << FD->getDeclName(); 10468 10469 Diag(Definition->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 10470 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 10471 } 10472 10473 10474 static void RebuildLambdaScopeInfo(CXXMethodDecl *CallOperator, 10475 Sema &S) { 10476 CXXRecordDecl *const LambdaClass = CallOperator->getParent(); 10477 10478 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = S.PushLambdaScope(); 10479 LSI->CallOperator = CallOperator; 10480 LSI->Lambda = LambdaClass; 10481 LSI->ReturnType = CallOperator->getReturnType(); 10482 const LambdaCaptureDefault LCD = LambdaClass->getLambdaCaptureDefault(); 10483 10484 if (LCD == LCD_None) 10485 LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None; 10486 else if (LCD == LCD_ByCopy) 10487 LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByval; 10488 else if (LCD == LCD_ByRef) 10489 LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByref; 10490 DeclarationNameInfo DNI = CallOperator->getNameInfo(); 10491 10492 LSI->IntroducerRange = DNI.getCXXOperatorNameRange(); 10493 LSI->Mutable = !CallOperator->isConst(); 10494 10495 // Add the captures to the LSI so they can be noted as already 10496 // captured within tryCaptureVar. 10497 auto I = LambdaClass->field_begin(); 10498 for (const auto &C : LambdaClass->captures()) { 10499 if (C.capturesVariable()) { 10500 VarDecl *VD = C.getCapturedVar(); 10501 if (VD->isInitCapture()) 10502 S.CurrentInstantiationScope->InstantiatedLocal(VD, VD); 10503 QualType CaptureType = VD->getType(); 10504 const bool ByRef = C.getCaptureKind() == LCK_ByRef; 10505 LSI->addCapture(VD, /*IsBlock*/false, ByRef, 10506 /*RefersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture*/true, C.getLocation(), 10507 /*EllipsisLoc*/C.isPackExpansion() 10508 ? C.getEllipsisLoc() : SourceLocation(), 10509 CaptureType, /*Expr*/ nullptr); 10510 10511 } else if (C.capturesThis()) { 10512 LSI->addThisCapture(/*Nested*/ false, C.getLocation(), 10513 S.getCurrentThisType(), /*Expr*/ nullptr); 10514 } else { 10515 LSI->addVLATypeCapture(C.getLocation(), I->getType()); 10516 } 10517 ++I; 10518 } 10519 } 10520 10521 Decl *Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(Scope *FnBodyScope, Decl *D) { 10522 // Clear the last template instantiation error context. 10523 LastTemplateInstantiationErrorContext = ActiveTemplateInstantiation(); 10524 10525 if (!D) 10526 return D; 10527 FunctionDecl *FD = nullptr; 10528 10529 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 10530 FD = FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(); 10531 else 10532 FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 10533 // If we are instantiating a generic lambda call operator, push 10534 // a LambdaScopeInfo onto the function stack. But use the information 10535 // that's already been calculated (ActOnLambdaExpr) to prime the current 10536 // LambdaScopeInfo. 10537 // When the template operator is being specialized, the LambdaScopeInfo, 10538 // has to be properly restored so that tryCaptureVariable doesn't try 10539 // and capture any new variables. In addition when calculating potential 10540 // captures during transformation of nested lambdas, it is necessary to 10541 // have the LSI properly restored. 10542 if (isGenericLambdaCallOperatorSpecialization(FD)) { 10543 assert(ActiveTemplateInstantiations.size() && 10544 "There should be an active template instantiation on the stack " 10545 "when instantiating a generic lambda!"); 10546 RebuildLambdaScopeInfo(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D), *this); 10547 } 10548 else 10549 // Enter a new function scope 10550 PushFunctionScope(); 10551 10552 // See if this is a redefinition. 10553 if (!FD->isLateTemplateParsed()) 10554 CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FD); 10555 10556 // Builtin functions cannot be defined. 10557 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID()) { 10558 if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID) && 10559 !Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedRuntimeFunction(BuiltinID)) { 10560 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_builtin_definition) << FD; 10561 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 10562 } 10563 } 10564 10565 // The return type of a function definition must be complete 10566 // (C99 6.9.1p3, C++ [dcl.fct]p6). 10567 QualType ResultType = FD->getReturnType(); 10568 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() && !ResultType->isVoidType() && 10569 !FD->isInvalidDecl() && 10570 RequireCompleteType(FD->getLocation(), ResultType, 10571 diag::err_func_def_incomplete_result)) 10572 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 10573 10574 if (FnBodyScope) 10575 PushDeclContext(FnBodyScope, FD); 10576 10577 // Check the validity of our function parameters 10578 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(FD->param_begin(), FD->param_end(), 10579 /*CheckParameterNames=*/true); 10580 10581 // Introduce our parameters into the function scope 10582 for (auto Param : FD->params()) { 10583 Param->setOwningFunction(FD); 10584 10585 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack. 10586 if (Param->getIdentifier() && FnBodyScope) { 10587 CheckShadow(FnBodyScope, Param); 10588 10589 PushOnScopeChains(Param, FnBodyScope); 10590 } 10591 } 10592 10593 // If we had any tags defined in the function prototype, 10594 // introduce them into the function scope. 10595 if (FnBodyScope) { 10596 for (ArrayRef<NamedDecl *>::iterator 10597 I = FD->getDeclsInPrototypeScope().begin(), 10598 E = FD->getDeclsInPrototypeScope().end(); 10599 I != E; ++I) { 10600 NamedDecl *D = *I; 10601 10602 // Some of these decls (like enums) may have been pinned to the 10603 // translation unit for lack of a real context earlier. If so, remove 10604 // from the translation unit and reattach to the current context. 10605 if (D->getLexicalDeclContext() == Context.getTranslationUnitDecl()) { 10606 // Is the decl actually in the context? 10607 for (const auto *DI : Context.getTranslationUnitDecl()->decls()) { 10608 if (DI == D) { 10609 Context.getTranslationUnitDecl()->removeDecl(D); 10610 break; 10611 } 10612 } 10613 // Either way, reassign the lexical decl context to our FunctionDecl. 10614 D->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 10615 } 10616 10617 // If the decl has a non-null name, make accessible in the current scope. 10618 if (!D->getName().empty()) 10619 PushOnScopeChains(D, FnBodyScope, /*AddToContext=*/false); 10620 10621 // Similarly, dive into enums and fish their constants out, making them 10622 // accessible in this scope. 10623 if (auto *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) { 10624 for (auto *EI : ED->enumerators()) 10625 PushOnScopeChains(EI, FnBodyScope, /*AddToContext=*/false); 10626 } 10627 } 10628 } 10629 10630 // Ensure that the function's exception specification is instantiated. 10631 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 10632 ResolveExceptionSpec(D->getLocation(), FPT); 10633 10634 // dllimport cannot be applied to non-inline function definitions. 10635 if (FD->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() && !FD->isInlined() && 10636 !FD->isTemplateInstantiation()) { 10637 assert(!FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()); 10638 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dllimport_function_definition); 10639 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 10640 return D; 10641 } 10642 // We want to attach documentation to original Decl (which might be 10643 // a function template). 10644 ActOnDocumentableDecl(D); 10645 if (getCurLexicalContext()->isObjCContainer() && 10646 getCurLexicalContext()->getDeclKind() != Decl::ObjCCategoryImpl && 10647 getCurLexicalContext()->getDeclKind() != Decl::ObjCImplementation) 10648 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_function_def_in_objc_container); 10649 10650 return D; 10651 } 10652 10653 /// \brief Given the set of return statements within a function body, 10654 /// compute the variables that are subject to the named return value 10655 /// optimization. 10656 /// 10657 /// Each of the variables that is subject to the named return value 10658 /// optimization will be marked as NRVO variables in the AST, and any 10659 /// return statement that has a marked NRVO variable as its NRVO candidate can 10660 /// use the named return value optimization. 10661 /// 10662 /// This function applies a very simplistic algorithm for NRVO: if every return 10663 /// statement in the scope of a variable has the same NRVO candidate, that 10664 /// candidate is an NRVO variable. 10665 void Sema::computeNRVO(Stmt *Body, FunctionScopeInfo *Scope) { 10666 ReturnStmt **Returns = Scope->Returns.data(); 10667 10668 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Scope->Returns.size(); I != E; ++I) { 10669 if (const VarDecl *NRVOCandidate = Returns[I]->getNRVOCandidate()) { 10670 if (!NRVOCandidate->isNRVOVariable()) 10671 Returns[I]->setNRVOCandidate(nullptr); 10672 } 10673 } 10674 } 10675 10676 bool Sema::canDelayFunctionBody(const Declarator &D) { 10677 // We can't delay parsing the body of a constexpr function template (yet). 10678 if (D.getDeclSpec().isConstexprSpecified()) 10679 return false; 10680 10681 // We can't delay parsing the body of a function template with a deduced 10682 // return type (yet). 10683 if (D.getDeclSpec().containsPlaceholderType()) { 10684 // If the placeholder introduces a non-deduced trailing return type, 10685 // we can still delay parsing it. 10686 if (D.getNumTypeObjects()) { 10687 const auto &Outer = D.getTypeObject(D.getNumTypeObjects() - 1); 10688 if (Outer.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function && 10689 Outer.Fun.hasTrailingReturnType()) { 10690 QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Outer.Fun.getTrailingReturnType()); 10691 return Ty.isNull() || !Ty->isUndeducedType(); 10692 } 10693 } 10694 return false; 10695 } 10696 10697 return true; 10698 } 10699 10700 bool Sema::canSkipFunctionBody(Decl *D) { 10701 // We cannot skip the body of a function (or function template) which is 10702 // constexpr, since we may need to evaluate its body in order to parse the 10703 // rest of the file. 10704 // We cannot skip the body of a function with an undeduced return type, 10705 // because any callers of that function need to know the type. 10706 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = D->getAsFunction()) 10707 if (FD->isConstexpr() || FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) 10708 return false; 10709 return Consumer.shouldSkipFunctionBody(D); 10710 } 10711 10712 Decl *Sema::ActOnSkippedFunctionBody(Decl *Decl) { 10713 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(Decl)) 10714 FD->setHasSkippedBody(); 10715 else if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCMethodDecl>(Decl)) 10716 MD->setHasSkippedBody(); 10717 return ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl, nullptr); 10718 } 10719 10720 Decl *Sema::ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl *D, Stmt *BodyArg) { 10721 return ActOnFinishFunctionBody(D, BodyArg, false); 10722 } 10723 10724 Decl *Sema::ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl *dcl, Stmt *Body, 10725 bool IsInstantiation) { 10726 FunctionDecl *FD = dcl ? dcl->getAsFunction() : nullptr; 10727 10728 sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy WP = AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy(); 10729 sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy *ActivePolicy = nullptr; 10730 10731 if (FD) { 10732 FD->setBody(Body); 10733 10734 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && !FD->isInvalidDecl() && Body && 10735 !FD->isDependentContext() && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) { 10736 // If the function has a deduced result type but contains no 'return' 10737 // statements, the result type as written must be exactly 'auto', and 10738 // the deduced result type is 'void'. 10739 if (!FD->getReturnType()->getAs<AutoType>()) { 10740 Diag(dcl->getLocation(), diag::err_auto_fn_no_return_but_not_auto) 10741 << FD->getReturnType(); 10742 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 10743 } else { 10744 // Substitute 'void' for the 'auto' in the type. 10745 TypeLoc ResultType = getReturnTypeLoc(FD); 10746 Context.adjustDeducedFunctionResultType( 10747 FD, SubstAutoType(ResultType.getType(), Context.VoidTy)); 10748 } 10749 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && isLambdaCallOperator(FD)) { 10750 auto *LSI = getCurLambda(); 10751 if (LSI->HasImplicitReturnType) { 10752 deduceClosureReturnType(*LSI); 10753 10754 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p4: 10755 // [...] if there are no return statements in the compound-statement 10756 // [the deduced type is] the type void 10757 QualType RetType = 10758 LSI->ReturnType.isNull() ? Context.VoidTy : LSI->ReturnType; 10759 10760 // Update the return type to the deduced type. 10761 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = 10762 FD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 10763 FD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(RetType, Proto->getParamTypes(), 10764 Proto->getExtProtoInfo())); 10765 } 10766 } 10767 10768 // The only way to be included in UndefinedButUsed is if there is an 10769 // ODR use before the definition. Avoid the expensive map lookup if this 10770 // is the first declaration. 10771 if (!FD->isFirstDecl() && FD->getPreviousDecl()->isUsed()) { 10772 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible()) 10773 UndefinedButUsed.erase(FD); 10774 else if (FD->isInlined() && 10775 !LangOpts.GNUInline && 10776 (!FD->getPreviousDecl()->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>())) 10777 UndefinedButUsed.erase(FD); 10778 } 10779 10780 // If the function implicitly returns zero (like 'main') or is naked, 10781 // don't complain about missing return statements. 10782 if (FD->hasImplicitReturnZero() || FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>()) 10783 WP.disableCheckFallThrough(); 10784 10785 // MSVC permits the use of pure specifier (=0) on function definition, 10786 // defined at class scope, warn about this non-standard construct. 10787 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FD->isPure() && FD->isCanonicalDecl()) 10788 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_pure_function_definition); 10789 10790 if (!FD->isInvalidDecl()) { 10791 // Don't diagnose unused parameters of defaulted or deleted functions. 10792 if (!FD->isDeleted() && !FD->isDefaulted()) 10793 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(FD->param_begin(), FD->param_end()); 10794 DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(FD->param_begin(), FD->param_end(), 10795 FD->getReturnType(), FD); 10796 10797 // If this is a structor, we need a vtable. 10798 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)) 10799 MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), Constructor->getParent()); 10800 else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(FD)) 10801 MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), Destructor->getParent()); 10802 10803 // Try to apply the named return value optimization. We have to check 10804 // if we can do this here because lambdas keep return statements around 10805 // to deduce an implicit return type. 10806 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && FD->getReturnType()->isRecordType() && 10807 !FD->isDependentContext()) 10808 computeNRVO(Body, getCurFunction()); 10809 } 10810 10811 // GNU warning -Wmissing-prototypes: 10812 // Warn if a global function is defined without a previous 10813 // prototype declaration. This warning is issued even if the 10814 // definition itself provides a prototype. The aim is to detect 10815 // global functions that fail to be declared in header files. 10816 const FunctionDecl *PossibleZeroParamPrototype = nullptr; 10817 if (ShouldWarnAboutMissingPrototype(FD, PossibleZeroParamPrototype)) { 10818 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_missing_prototype) << FD; 10819 10820 if (PossibleZeroParamPrototype) { 10821 // We found a declaration that is not a prototype, 10822 // but that could be a zero-parameter prototype 10823 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = 10824 PossibleZeroParamPrototype->getTypeSourceInfo()) { 10825 TypeLoc TL = TI->getTypeLoc(); 10826 if (FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc FTL = TL.getAs<FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc>()) 10827 Diag(PossibleZeroParamPrototype->getLocation(), 10828 diag::note_declaration_not_a_prototype) 10829 << PossibleZeroParamPrototype 10830 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FTL.getRParenLoc(), "void"); 10831 } 10832 } 10833 } 10834 10835 if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) { 10836 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunction; 10837 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && (MD = MD->getCanonicalDecl()) && 10838 MD->isVirtual() && 10839 (KeyFunction = Context.getCurrentKeyFunction(MD->getParent())) && 10840 MD == KeyFunction->getCanonicalDecl()) { 10841 // Update the key-function state if necessary for this ABI. 10842 if (FD->isInlined() && 10843 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) { 10844 Context.setNonKeyFunction(MD); 10845 10846 // If the newly-chosen key function is already defined, then we 10847 // need to mark the vtable as used retroactively. 10848 KeyFunction = Context.getCurrentKeyFunction(MD->getParent()); 10849 const FunctionDecl *Definition; 10850 if (KeyFunction && KeyFunction->isDefined(Definition)) 10851 MarkVTableUsed(Definition->getLocation(), MD->getParent(), true); 10852 } else { 10853 // We just defined they key function; mark the vtable as used. 10854 MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), MD->getParent(), true); 10855 } 10856 } 10857 } 10858 10859 assert((FD == getCurFunctionDecl() || getCurLambda()->CallOperator == FD) && 10860 "Function parsing confused"); 10861 } else if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCMethodDecl>(dcl)) { 10862 assert(MD == getCurMethodDecl() && "Method parsing confused"); 10863 MD->setBody(Body); 10864 if (!MD->isInvalidDecl()) { 10865 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(MD->param_begin(), MD->param_end()); 10866 DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(MD->param_begin(), MD->param_end(), 10867 MD->getReturnType(), MD); 10868 10869 if (Body) 10870 computeNRVO(Body, getCurFunction()); 10871 } 10872 if (getCurFunction()->ObjCShouldCallSuper) { 10873 Diag(MD->getLocEnd(), diag::warn_objc_missing_super_call) 10874 << MD->getSelector().getAsString(); 10875 getCurFunction()->ObjCShouldCallSuper = false; 10876 } 10877 if (getCurFunction()->ObjCWarnForNoDesignatedInitChain) { 10878 const ObjCMethodDecl *InitMethod = nullptr; 10879 bool isDesignated = 10880 MD->isDesignatedInitializerForTheInterface(&InitMethod); 10881 assert(isDesignated && InitMethod); 10882 (void)isDesignated; 10883 10884 auto superIsNSObject = [&](const ObjCMethodDecl *MD) { 10885 auto IFace = MD->getClassInterface(); 10886 if (!IFace) 10887 return false; 10888 auto SuperD = IFace->getSuperClass(); 10889 if (!SuperD) 10890 return false; 10891 return SuperD->getIdentifier() == 10892 NSAPIObj->getNSClassId(NSAPI::ClassId_NSObject); 10893 }; 10894 // Don't issue this warning for unavailable inits or direct subclasses 10895 // of NSObject. 10896 if (!MD->isUnavailable() && !superIsNSObject(MD)) { 10897 Diag(MD->getLocation(), 10898 diag::warn_objc_designated_init_missing_super_call); 10899 Diag(InitMethod->getLocation(), 10900 diag::note_objc_designated_init_marked_here); 10901 } 10902 getCurFunction()->ObjCWarnForNoDesignatedInitChain = false; 10903 } 10904 if (getCurFunction()->ObjCWarnForNoInitDelegation) { 10905 // Don't issue this warning for unavaialable inits. 10906 if (!MD->isUnavailable()) 10907 Diag(MD->getLocation(), 10908 diag::warn_objc_secondary_init_missing_init_call); 10909 getCurFunction()->ObjCWarnForNoInitDelegation = false; 10910 } 10911 } else { 10912 return nullptr; 10913 } 10914 10915 assert(!getCurFunction()->ObjCShouldCallSuper && 10916 "This should only be set for ObjC methods, which should have been " 10917 "handled in the block above."); 10918 10919 // Verify and clean out per-function state. 10920 if (Body && (!FD || !FD->isDefaulted())) { 10921 // C++ constructors that have function-try-blocks can't have return 10922 // statements in the handlers of that block. (C++ [except.handle]p14) 10923 // Verify this. 10924 if (FD && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD) && isa<CXXTryStmt>(Body)) 10925 DiagnoseReturnInConstructorExceptionHandler(cast<CXXTryStmt>(Body)); 10926 10927 // Verify that gotos and switch cases don't jump into scopes illegally. 10928 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && 10929 !PP.isCodeCompletionEnabled()) 10930 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(Body); 10931 10932 if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(dcl)) { 10933 if (!Destructor->getParent()->isDependentType()) 10934 CheckDestructor(Destructor); 10935 10936 MarkBaseAndMemberDestructorsReferenced(Destructor->getLocation(), 10937 Destructor->getParent()); 10938 } 10939 10940 // If any errors have occurred, clear out any temporaries that may have 10941 // been leftover. This ensures that these temporaries won't be picked up for 10942 // deletion in some later function. 10943 if (getDiagnostics().hasErrorOccurred() || 10944 getDiagnostics().getSuppressAllDiagnostics()) { 10945 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 10946 } 10947 if (!getDiagnostics().hasUncompilableErrorOccurred() && 10948 !isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) { 10949 // Since the body is valid, issue any analysis-based warnings that are 10950 // enabled. 10951 ActivePolicy = &WP; 10952 } 10953 10954 if (!IsInstantiation && FD && FD->isConstexpr() && !FD->isInvalidDecl() && 10955 (!CheckConstexprFunctionDecl(FD) || 10956 !CheckConstexprFunctionBody(FD, Body))) 10957 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 10958 10959 if (FD && FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>()) { 10960 for (const Stmt *S : Body->children()) { 10961 if (!isa<AsmStmt>(S) && !isa<NullStmt>(S)) { 10962 Diag(S->getLocStart(), diag::err_non_asm_stmt_in_naked_function); 10963 Diag(FD->getAttr<NakedAttr>()->getLocation(), diag::note_attribute); 10964 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 10965 break; 10966 } 10967 } 10968 } 10969 10970 assert(ExprCleanupObjects.size() == 10971 ExprEvalContexts.back().NumCleanupObjects && 10972 "Leftover temporaries in function"); 10973 assert(!ExprNeedsCleanups && "Unaccounted cleanups in function"); 10974 assert(MaybeODRUseExprs.empty() && 10975 "Leftover expressions for odr-use checking"); 10976 } 10977 10978 if (!IsInstantiation) 10979 PopDeclContext(); 10980 10981 PopFunctionScopeInfo(ActivePolicy, dcl); 10982 // If any errors have occurred, clear out any temporaries that may have 10983 // been leftover. This ensures that these temporaries won't be picked up for 10984 // deletion in some later function. 10985 if (getDiagnostics().hasErrorOccurred()) { 10986 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 10987 } 10988 10989 return dcl; 10990 } 10991 10992 10993 /// When we finish delayed parsing of an attribute, we must attach it to the 10994 /// relevant Decl. 10995 void Sema::ActOnFinishDelayedAttribute(Scope *S, Decl *D, 10996 ParsedAttributes &Attrs) { 10997 // Always attach attributes to the underlying decl. 10998 if (TemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) 10999 D = TD->getTemplatedDecl(); 11000 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, D, Attrs.getList()); 11001 11002 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) 11003 if (Method->isStatic()) 11004 checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionAttributes(Method); 11005 } 11006 11007 11008 /// ImplicitlyDefineFunction - An undeclared identifier was used in a function 11009 /// call, forming a call to an implicitly defined function (per C99 6.5.1p2). 11010 NamedDecl *Sema::ImplicitlyDefineFunction(SourceLocation Loc, 11011 IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S) { 11012 // Before we produce a declaration for an implicitly defined 11013 // function, see whether there was a locally-scoped declaration of 11014 // this name as a function or variable. If so, use that 11015 // (non-visible) declaration, and complain about it. 11016 if (NamedDecl *ExternCPrev = findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(&II)) { 11017 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_use_out_of_scope_declaration) << ExternCPrev; 11018 Diag(ExternCPrev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 11019 return ExternCPrev; 11020 } 11021 11022 // Extension in C99. Legal in C90, but warn about it. 11023 unsigned diag_id; 11024 if (II.getName().startswith("__builtin_")) 11025 diag_id = diag::warn_builtin_unknown; 11026 else if (getLangOpts().C99) 11027 diag_id = diag::ext_implicit_function_decl; 11028 else 11029 diag_id = diag::warn_implicit_function_decl; 11030 Diag(Loc, diag_id) << &II; 11031 11032 // Because typo correction is expensive, only do it if the implicit 11033 // function declaration is going to be treated as an error. 11034 if (Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag_id, Loc) >= DiagnosticsEngine::Error) { 11035 TypoCorrection Corrected; 11036 if (S && 11037 (Corrected = CorrectTypo( 11038 DeclarationNameInfo(&II, Loc), LookupOrdinaryName, S, nullptr, 11039 llvm::make_unique<DeclFilterCCC<FunctionDecl>>(), CTK_NonError))) 11040 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diag::note_function_suggestion), 11041 /*ErrorRecovery*/false); 11042 } 11043 11044 // Set a Declarator for the implicit definition: int foo(); 11045 const char *Dummy; 11046 AttributeFactory attrFactory; 11047 DeclSpec DS(attrFactory); 11048 unsigned DiagID; 11049 bool Error = DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_int, Loc, Dummy, DiagID, 11050 Context.getPrintingPolicy()); 11051 (void)Error; // Silence warning. 11052 assert(!Error && "Error setting up implicit decl!"); 11053 SourceLocation NoLoc; 11054 Declarator D(DS, Declarator::BlockContext); 11055 D.AddTypeInfo(DeclaratorChunk::getFunction(/*HasProto=*/false, 11056 /*IsAmbiguous=*/false, 11057 /*LParenLoc=*/NoLoc, 11058 /*Params=*/nullptr, 11059 /*NumParams=*/0, 11060 /*EllipsisLoc=*/NoLoc, 11061 /*RParenLoc=*/NoLoc, 11062 /*TypeQuals=*/0, 11063 /*RefQualifierIsLvalueRef=*/true, 11064 /*RefQualifierLoc=*/NoLoc, 11065 /*ConstQualifierLoc=*/NoLoc, 11066 /*VolatileQualifierLoc=*/NoLoc, 11067 /*RestrictQualifierLoc=*/NoLoc, 11068 /*MutableLoc=*/NoLoc, 11069 EST_None, 11070 /*ESpecLoc=*/NoLoc, 11071 /*Exceptions=*/nullptr, 11072 /*ExceptionRanges=*/nullptr, 11073 /*NumExceptions=*/0, 11074 /*NoexceptExpr=*/nullptr, 11075 /*ExceptionSpecTokens=*/nullptr, 11076 Loc, Loc, D), 11077 DS.getAttributes(), 11078 SourceLocation()); 11079 D.SetIdentifier(&II, Loc); 11080 11081 // Insert this function into translation-unit scope. 11082 11083 DeclContext *PrevDC = CurContext; 11084 CurContext = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(); 11085 11086 FunctionDecl *FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(ActOnDeclarator(TUScope, D)); 11087 FD->setImplicit(); 11088 11089 CurContext = PrevDC; 11090 11091 AddKnownFunctionAttributes(FD); 11092 11093 return FD; 11094 } 11095 11096 /// \brief Adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on 11097 /// the declaration of this function. 11098 /// 11099 /// These attributes can apply both to implicitly-declared builtins 11100 /// (like __builtin___printf_chk) or to library-declared functions 11101 /// like NSLog or printf. 11102 /// 11103 /// We need to check for duplicate attributes both here and where user-written 11104 /// attributes are applied to declarations. 11105 void Sema::AddKnownFunctionAttributes(FunctionDecl *FD) { 11106 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) 11107 return; 11108 11109 // If this is a built-in function, map its builtin attributes to 11110 // actual attributes. 11111 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID()) { 11112 // Handle printf-formatting attributes. 11113 unsigned FormatIdx; 11114 bool HasVAListArg; 11115 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPrintfLike(BuiltinID, FormatIdx, HasVAListArg)) { 11116 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) { 11117 const char *fmt = "printf"; 11118 unsigned int NumParams = FD->getNumParams(); 11119 if (FormatIdx < NumParams && // NumParams may be 0 (e.g. vfprintf) 11120 FD->getParamDecl(FormatIdx)->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 11121 fmt = "NSString"; 11122 FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 11123 &Context.Idents.get(fmt), 11124 FormatIdx+1, 11125 HasVAListArg ? 0 : FormatIdx+2, 11126 FD->getLocation())); 11127 } 11128 } 11129 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isScanfLike(BuiltinID, FormatIdx, 11130 HasVAListArg)) { 11131 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) 11132 FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 11133 &Context.Idents.get("scanf"), 11134 FormatIdx+1, 11135 HasVAListArg ? 0 : FormatIdx+2, 11136 FD->getLocation())); 11137 } 11138 11139 // Mark const if we don't care about errno and that is the only 11140 // thing preventing the function from being const. This allows 11141 // IRgen to use LLVM intrinsics for such functions. 11142 if (!getLangOpts().MathErrno && 11143 Context.BuiltinInfo.isConstWithoutErrno(BuiltinID)) { 11144 if (!FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>()) 11145 FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 11146 } 11147 11148 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isReturnsTwice(BuiltinID) && 11149 !FD->hasAttr<ReturnsTwiceAttr>()) 11150 FD->addAttr(ReturnsTwiceAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 11151 FD->getLocation())); 11152 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isNoThrow(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<NoThrowAttr>()) 11153 FD->addAttr(NoThrowAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 11154 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isConst(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>()) 11155 FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation())); 11156 } 11157 11158 IdentifierInfo *Name = FD->getIdentifier(); 11159 if (!Name) 11160 return; 11161 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 11162 FD->getDeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) || 11163 (isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(FD->getDeclContext()) && 11164 cast<LinkageSpecDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getLanguage() == 11165 LinkageSpecDecl::lang_c)) { 11166 // Okay: this could be a libc/libm/Objective-C function we know 11167 // about. 11168 } else 11169 return; 11170 11171 if (Name->isStr("asprintf") || Name->isStr("vasprintf")) { 11172 // FIXME: asprintf and vasprintf aren't C99 functions. Should they be 11173 // target-specific builtins, perhaps? 11174 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) 11175 FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 11176 &Context.Idents.get("printf"), 2, 11177 Name->isStr("vasprintf") ? 0 : 3, 11178 FD->getLocation())); 11179 } 11180 11181 if (Name->isStr("__CFStringMakeConstantString")) { 11182 // We already have a __builtin___CFStringMakeConstantString, 11183 // but builds that use -fno-constant-cfstrings don't go through that. 11184 if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatArgAttr>()) 11185 FD->addAttr(FormatArgAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 1, 11186 FD->getLocation())); 11187 } 11188 } 11189 11190 TypedefDecl *Sema::ParseTypedefDecl(Scope *S, Declarator &D, QualType T, 11191 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) { 11192 assert(D.getIdentifier() && "Wrong callback for declspec without declarator"); 11193 assert(!T.isNull() && "GetTypeForDeclarator() returned null type"); 11194 11195 if (!TInfo) { 11196 assert(D.isInvalidType() && "no declarator info for valid type"); 11197 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T); 11198 } 11199 11200 // Scope manipulation handled by caller. 11201 TypedefDecl *NewTD = TypedefDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, 11202 D.getLocStart(), 11203 D.getIdentifierLoc(), 11204 D.getIdentifier(), 11205 TInfo); 11206 11207 // Bail out immediately if we have an invalid declaration. 11208 if (D.isInvalidType()) { 11209 NewTD->setInvalidDecl(); 11210 return NewTD; 11211 } 11212 11213 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) { 11214 if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 11215 Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local) 11216 << 2 << NewTD->getDeclName() 11217 << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()) 11218 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc()); 11219 else 11220 NewTD->setModulePrivate(); 11221 } 11222 11223 // C++ [dcl.typedef]p8: 11224 // If the typedef declaration defines an unnamed class (or 11225 // enum), the first typedef-name declared by the declaration 11226 // to be that class type (or enum type) is used to denote the 11227 // class type (or enum type) for linkage purposes only. 11228 // We need to check whether the type was declared in the declaration. 11229 switch (D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecType()) { 11230 case TST_enum: 11231 case TST_struct: 11232 case TST_interface: 11233 case TST_union: 11234 case TST_class: { 11235 TagDecl *tagFromDeclSpec = cast<TagDecl>(D.getDeclSpec().getRepAsDecl()); 11236 setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(tagFromDeclSpec, NewTD); 11237 break; 11238 } 11239 11240 default: 11241 break; 11242 } 11243 11244 return NewTD; 11245 } 11246 11247 11248 /// \brief Check that this is a valid underlying type for an enum declaration. 11249 bool Sema::CheckEnumUnderlyingType(TypeSourceInfo *TI) { 11250 SourceLocation UnderlyingLoc = TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(); 11251 QualType T = TI->getType(); 11252 11253 if (T->isDependentType()) 11254 return false; 11255 11256 if (const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 11257 if (BT->isInteger()) 11258 return false; 11259 11260 Diag(UnderlyingLoc, diag::err_enum_invalid_underlying) << T; 11261 return true; 11262 } 11263 11264 /// Check whether this is a valid redeclaration of a previous enumeration. 11265 /// \return true if the redeclaration was invalid. 11266 bool Sema::CheckEnumRedeclaration(SourceLocation EnumLoc, bool IsScoped, 11267 QualType EnumUnderlyingTy, 11268 const EnumDecl *Prev) { 11269 bool IsFixed = !EnumUnderlyingTy.isNull(); 11270 11271 if (IsScoped != Prev->isScoped()) { 11272 Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_scoped_mismatch) 11273 << Prev->isScoped(); 11274 Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 11275 return true; 11276 } 11277 11278 if (IsFixed && Prev->isFixed()) { 11279 if (!EnumUnderlyingTy->isDependentType() && 11280 !Prev->getIntegerType()->isDependentType() && 11281 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(EnumUnderlyingTy, 11282 Prev->getIntegerType())) { 11283 // TODO: Highlight the underlying type of the redeclaration. 11284 Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_type_mismatch) 11285 << EnumUnderlyingTy << Prev->getIntegerType(); 11286 Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration) 11287 << Prev->getIntegerTypeRange(); 11288 return true; 11289 } 11290 } else if (IsFixed != Prev->isFixed()) { 11291 Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_fixed_mismatch) 11292 << Prev->isFixed(); 11293 Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 11294 return true; 11295 } 11296 11297 return false; 11298 } 11299 11300 /// \brief Get diagnostic %select index for tag kind for 11301 /// redeclaration diagnostic message. 11302 /// WARNING: Indexes apply to particular diagnostics only! 11303 /// 11304 /// \returns diagnostic %select index. 11305 static unsigned getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(TagTypeKind Tag) { 11306 switch (Tag) { 11307 case TTK_Struct: return 0; 11308 case TTK_Interface: return 1; 11309 case TTK_Class: return 2; 11310 default: llvm_unreachable("Invalid tag kind for redecl diagnostic!"); 11311 } 11312 } 11313 11314 /// \brief Determine if tag kind is a class-key compatible with 11315 /// class for redeclaration (class, struct, or __interface). 11316 /// 11317 /// \returns true iff the tag kind is compatible. 11318 static bool isClassCompatTagKind(TagTypeKind Tag) 11319 { 11320 return Tag == TTK_Struct || Tag == TTK_Class || Tag == TTK_Interface; 11321 } 11322 11323 /// \brief Determine whether a tag with a given kind is acceptable 11324 /// as a redeclaration of the given tag declaration. 11325 /// 11326 /// \returns true if the new tag kind is acceptable, false otherwise. 11327 bool Sema::isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(const TagDecl *Previous, 11328 TagTypeKind NewTag, bool isDefinition, 11329 SourceLocation NewTagLoc, 11330 const IdentifierInfo *Name) { 11331 // C++ [dcl.type.elab]p3: 11332 // The class-key or enum keyword present in the 11333 // elaborated-type-specifier shall agree in kind with the 11334 // declaration to which the name in the elaborated-type-specifier 11335 // refers. This rule also applies to the form of 11336 // elaborated-type-specifier that declares a class-name or 11337 // friend class since it can be construed as referring to the 11338 // definition of the class. Thus, in any 11339 // elaborated-type-specifier, the enum keyword shall be used to 11340 // refer to an enumeration (7.2), the union class-key shall be 11341 // used to refer to a union (clause 9), and either the class or 11342 // struct class-key shall be used to refer to a class (clause 9) 11343 // declared using the class or struct class-key. 11344 TagTypeKind OldTag = Previous->getTagKind(); 11345 if (!isDefinition || !isClassCompatTagKind(NewTag)) 11346 if (OldTag == NewTag) 11347 return true; 11348 11349 if (isClassCompatTagKind(OldTag) && isClassCompatTagKind(NewTag)) { 11350 // Warn about the struct/class tag mismatch. 11351 bool isTemplate = false; 11352 if (const CXXRecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Previous)) 11353 isTemplate = Record->getDescribedClassTemplate(); 11354 11355 if (!ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) { 11356 // In a template instantiation, do not offer fix-its for tag mismatches 11357 // since they usually mess up the template instead of fixing the problem. 11358 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch) 11359 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name 11360 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(OldTag); 11361 return true; 11362 } 11363 11364 if (isDefinition) { 11365 // On definitions, check previous tags and issue a fix-it for each 11366 // one that doesn't match the current tag. 11367 if (Previous->getDefinition()) { 11368 // Don't suggest fix-its for redefinitions. 11369 return true; 11370 } 11371 11372 bool previousMismatch = false; 11373 for (auto I : Previous->redecls()) { 11374 if (I->getTagKind() != NewTag) { 11375 if (!previousMismatch) { 11376 previousMismatch = true; 11377 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_previous_tag_mismatch) 11378 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name 11379 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(I->getTagKind()); 11380 } 11381 Diag(I->getInnerLocStart(), diag::note_struct_class_suggestion) 11382 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) 11383 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(I->getInnerLocStart(), 11384 TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(NewTag)); 11385 } 11386 } 11387 return true; 11388 } 11389 11390 // Check for a previous definition. If current tag and definition 11391 // are same type, do nothing. If no definition, but disagree with 11392 // with previous tag type, give a warning, but no fix-it. 11393 const TagDecl *Redecl = Previous->getDefinition() ? 11394 Previous->getDefinition() : Previous; 11395 if (Redecl->getTagKind() == NewTag) { 11396 return true; 11397 } 11398 11399 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch) 11400 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name 11401 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(OldTag); 11402 Diag(Redecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_use); 11403 11404 // If there is a previous definition, suggest a fix-it. 11405 if (Previous->getDefinition()) { 11406 Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::note_struct_class_suggestion) 11407 << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(Redecl->getTagKind()) 11408 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(NewTagLoc), 11409 TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(Redecl->getTagKind())); 11410 } 11411 11412 return true; 11413 } 11414 return false; 11415 } 11416 11417 /// Add a minimal nested name specifier fixit hint to allow lookup of a tag name 11418 /// from an outer enclosing namespace or file scope inside a friend declaration. 11419 /// This should provide the commented out code in the following snippet: 11420 /// namespace N { 11421 /// struct X; 11422 /// namespace M { 11423 /// struct Y { friend struct /*N::*/ X; }; 11424 /// } 11425 /// } 11426 static FixItHint createFriendTagNNSFixIt(Sema &SemaRef, NamedDecl *ND, Scope *S, 11427 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 11428 // While the decl is in a namespace, do repeated lookup of that name and see 11429 // if we get the same namespace back. If we do not, continue until 11430 // translation unit scope, at which point we have a fully qualified NNS. 11431 SmallVector<IdentifierInfo *, 4> Namespaces; 11432 DeclContext *DC = ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 11433 for (; !DC->isTranslationUnit(); DC = DC->getParent()) { 11434 // This tag should be declared in a namespace, which can only be enclosed by 11435 // other namespaces. Bail if there's an anonymous namespace in the chain. 11436 NamespaceDecl *Namespace = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(DC); 11437 if (!Namespace || Namespace->isAnonymousNamespace()) 11438 return FixItHint(); 11439 IdentifierInfo *II = Namespace->getIdentifier(); 11440 Namespaces.push_back(II); 11441 NamedDecl *Lookup = SemaRef.LookupSingleName( 11442 S, II, NameLoc, Sema::LookupNestedNameSpecifierName); 11443 if (Lookup == Namespace) 11444 break; 11445 } 11446 11447 // Once we have all the namespaces, reverse them to go outermost first, and 11448 // build an NNS. 11449 SmallString<64> Insertion; 11450 llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Insertion); 11451 if (DC->isTranslationUnit()) 11452 OS << "::"; 11453 std::reverse(Namespaces.begin(), Namespaces.end()); 11454 for (auto *II : Namespaces) 11455 OS << II->getName() << "::"; 11456 OS.flush(); 11457 return FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NameLoc, Insertion); 11458 } 11459 11460 /// \brief Determine whether a tag originally declared in context \p OldDC can 11461 /// be redeclared with an unqualfied name in \p NewDC (assuming name lookup 11462 /// found a declaration in \p OldDC as a previous decl, perhaps through a 11463 /// using-declaration). 11464 static bool isAcceptableTagRedeclContext(Sema &S, DeclContext *OldDC, 11465 DeclContext *NewDC) { 11466 OldDC = OldDC->getRedeclContext(); 11467 NewDC = NewDC->getRedeclContext(); 11468 11469 if (OldDC->Equals(NewDC)) 11470 return true; 11471 11472 // In MSVC mode, we allow a redeclaration if the contexts are related (either 11473 // encloses the other). 11474 if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 11475 (OldDC->Encloses(NewDC) || NewDC->Encloses(OldDC))) 11476 return true; 11477 11478 return false; 11479 } 11480 11481 /// \brief This is invoked when we see 'struct foo' or 'struct {'. In the 11482 /// former case, Name will be non-null. In the later case, Name will be null. 11483 /// TagSpec indicates what kind of tag this is. TUK indicates whether this is a 11484 /// reference/declaration/definition of a tag. 11485 /// 11486 /// \param IsTypeSpecifier \c true if this is a type-specifier (or 11487 /// trailing-type-specifier) other than one in an alias-declaration. 11488 /// 11489 /// \param SkipBody If non-null, will be set to indicate if the caller should 11490 /// skip the definition of this tag and treat it as if it were a declaration. 11491 Decl *Sema::ActOnTag(Scope *S, unsigned TagSpec, TagUseKind TUK, 11492 SourceLocation KWLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 11493 IdentifierInfo *Name, SourceLocation NameLoc, 11494 AttributeList *Attr, AccessSpecifier AS, 11495 SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc, 11496 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists, 11497 bool &OwnedDecl, bool &IsDependent, 11498 SourceLocation ScopedEnumKWLoc, 11499 bool ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, 11500 TypeResult UnderlyingType, 11501 bool IsTypeSpecifier, SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) { 11502 // If this is not a definition, it must have a name. 11503 IdentifierInfo *OrigName = Name; 11504 assert((Name != nullptr || TUK == TUK_Definition) && 11505 "Nameless record must be a definition!"); 11506 assert(TemplateParameterLists.size() == 0 || TUK != TUK_Reference); 11507 11508 OwnedDecl = false; 11509 TagTypeKind Kind = TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindForTypeSpec(TagSpec); 11510 bool ScopedEnum = ScopedEnumKWLoc.isValid(); 11511 11512 // FIXME: Check explicit specializations more carefully. 11513 bool isExplicitSpecialization = false; 11514 bool Invalid = false; 11515 11516 // We only need to do this matching if we have template parameters 11517 // or a scope specifier, which also conveniently avoids this work 11518 // for non-C++ cases. 11519 if (TemplateParameterLists.size() > 0 || 11520 (SS.isNotEmpty() && TUK != TUK_Reference)) { 11521 if (TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = 11522 MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier( 11523 KWLoc, NameLoc, SS, nullptr, TemplateParameterLists, 11524 TUK == TUK_Friend, isExplicitSpecialization, Invalid)) { 11525 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 11526 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_enum_template); 11527 return nullptr; 11528 } 11529 11530 if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) { 11531 // This is a declaration or definition of a class template (which may 11532 // be a member of another template). 11533 11534 if (Invalid) 11535 return nullptr; 11536 11537 OwnedDecl = false; 11538 DeclResult Result = CheckClassTemplate(S, TagSpec, TUK, KWLoc, 11539 SS, Name, NameLoc, Attr, 11540 TemplateParams, AS, 11541 ModulePrivateLoc, 11542 /*FriendLoc*/SourceLocation(), 11543 TemplateParameterLists.size()-1, 11544 TemplateParameterLists.data(), 11545 SkipBody); 11546 return Result.get(); 11547 } else { 11548 // The "template<>" header is extraneous. 11549 Diag(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), diag::err_template_tag_noparams) 11550 << TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(Kind) << Name; 11551 isExplicitSpecialization = true; 11552 } 11553 } 11554 } 11555 11556 // Figure out the underlying type if this a enum declaration. We need to do 11557 // this early, because it's needed to detect if this is an incompatible 11558 // redeclaration. 11559 llvm::PointerUnion<const Type*, TypeSourceInfo*> EnumUnderlying; 11560 11561 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 11562 if (UnderlyingType.isInvalid() || (!UnderlyingType.get() && ScopedEnum)) 11563 // No underlying type explicitly specified, or we failed to parse the 11564 // type, default to int. 11565 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 11566 else if (UnderlyingType.get()) { 11567 // C++0x 7.2p2: The type-specifier-seq of an enum-base shall name an 11568 // integral type; any cv-qualification is ignored. 11569 TypeSourceInfo *TI = nullptr; 11570 GetTypeFromParser(UnderlyingType.get(), &TI); 11571 EnumUnderlying = TI; 11572 11573 if (CheckEnumUnderlyingType(TI)) 11574 // Recover by falling back to int. 11575 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 11576 11577 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TI, 11578 UPPC_FixedUnderlyingType)) 11579 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 11580 11581 } else if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 11582 // Microsoft enums are always of int type. 11583 EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr(); 11584 } 11585 11586 DeclContext *SearchDC = CurContext; 11587 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 11588 bool isStdBadAlloc = false; 11589 11590 RedeclarationKind Redecl = ForRedeclaration; 11591 if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) 11592 Redecl = NotForRedeclaration; 11593 11594 LookupResult Previous(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupTagName, Redecl); 11595 if (Name && SS.isNotEmpty()) { 11596 // We have a nested-name tag ('struct foo::bar'). 11597 11598 // Check for invalid 'foo::'. 11599 if (SS.isInvalid()) { 11600 Name = nullptr; 11601 goto CreateNewDecl; 11602 } 11603 11604 // If this is a friend or a reference to a class in a dependent 11605 // context, don't try to make a decl for it. 11606 if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) { 11607 DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false); 11608 if (!DC) { 11609 IsDependent = true; 11610 return nullptr; 11611 } 11612 } else { 11613 DC = computeDeclContext(SS, true); 11614 if (!DC) { 11615 Diag(SS.getRange().getBegin(), diag::err_dependent_nested_name_spec) 11616 << SS.getRange(); 11617 return nullptr; 11618 } 11619 } 11620 11621 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) 11622 return nullptr; 11623 11624 SearchDC = DC; 11625 // Look-up name inside 'foo::'. 11626 LookupQualifiedName(Previous, DC); 11627 11628 if (Previous.isAmbiguous()) 11629 return nullptr; 11630 11631 if (Previous.empty()) { 11632 // Name lookup did not find anything. However, if the 11633 // nested-name-specifier refers to the current instantiation, 11634 // and that current instantiation has any dependent base 11635 // classes, we might find something at instantiation time: treat 11636 // this as a dependent elaborated-type-specifier. 11637 // But this only makes any sense for reference-like lookups. 11638 if (Previous.wasNotFoundInCurrentInstantiation() && 11639 (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend)) { 11640 IsDependent = true; 11641 return nullptr; 11642 } 11643 11644 // A tag 'foo::bar' must already exist. 11645 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_not_tag_in_scope) 11646 << Kind << Name << DC << SS.getRange(); 11647 Name = nullptr; 11648 Invalid = true; 11649 goto CreateNewDecl; 11650 } 11651 } else if (Name) { 11652 // C++14 [class.mem]p14: 11653 // If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a 11654 // name different from T: 11655 // -- every member of class T that is itself a type 11656 if (TUK != TUK_Reference && TUK != TUK_Friend && 11657 DiagnoseClassNameShadow(SearchDC, DeclarationNameInfo(Name, NameLoc))) 11658 return nullptr; 11659 11660 // If this is a named struct, check to see if there was a previous forward 11661 // declaration or definition. 11662 // FIXME: We're looking into outer scopes here, even when we 11663 // shouldn't be. Doing so can result in ambiguities that we 11664 // shouldn't be diagnosing. 11665 LookupName(Previous, S); 11666 11667 // When declaring or defining a tag, ignore ambiguities introduced 11668 // by types using'ed into this scope. 11669 if (Previous.isAmbiguous() && 11670 (TUK == TUK_Definition || TUK == TUK_Declaration)) { 11671 LookupResult::Filter F = Previous.makeFilter(); 11672 while (F.hasNext()) { 11673 NamedDecl *ND = F.next(); 11674 if (ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext() != SearchDC) 11675 F.erase(); 11676 } 11677 F.done(); 11678 } 11679 11680 // C++11 [namespace.memdef]p3: 11681 // If the name in a friend declaration is neither qualified nor 11682 // a template-id and the declaration is a function or an 11683 // elaborated-type-specifier, the lookup to determine whether 11684 // the entity has been previously declared shall not consider 11685 // any scopes outside the innermost enclosing namespace. 11686 // 11687 // MSVC doesn't implement the above rule for types, so a friend tag 11688 // declaration may be a redeclaration of a type declared in an enclosing 11689 // scope. They do implement this rule for friend functions. 11690 // 11691 // Does it matter that this should be by scope instead of by 11692 // semantic context? 11693 if (!Previous.empty() && TUK == TUK_Friend) { 11694 DeclContext *EnclosingNS = SearchDC->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 11695 LookupResult::Filter F = Previous.makeFilter(); 11696 bool FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace = false; 11697 while (F.hasNext()) { 11698 NamedDecl *ND = F.next(); 11699 DeclContext *DC = ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 11700 if (DC->isFileContext() && 11701 !EnclosingNS->Encloses(ND->getDeclContext())) { 11702 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 11703 FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace = true; 11704 else 11705 F.erase(); 11706 } 11707 } 11708 F.done(); 11709 11710 // Diagnose this MSVC extension in the easy case where lookup would have 11711 // unambiguously found something outside the enclosing namespace. 11712 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace) { 11713 NamedDecl *ND = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 11714 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_friend_tag_redecl_outside_namespace) 11715 << createFriendTagNNSFixIt(*this, ND, S, NameLoc); 11716 } 11717 } 11718 11719 // Note: there used to be some attempt at recovery here. 11720 if (Previous.isAmbiguous()) 11721 return nullptr; 11722 11723 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && TUK != TUK_Reference) { 11724 // FIXME: This makes sure that we ignore the contexts associated 11725 // with C structs, unions, and enums when looking for a matching 11726 // tag declaration or definition. See the similar lookup tweak 11727 // in Sema::LookupName; is there a better way to deal with this? 11728 while (isa<RecordDecl>(SearchDC) || isa<EnumDecl>(SearchDC)) 11729 SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent(); 11730 } 11731 } 11732 11733 if (Previous.isSingleResult() && 11734 Previous.getFoundDecl()->isTemplateParameter()) { 11735 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 11736 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(NameLoc, Previous.getFoundDecl()); 11737 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 11738 Previous.clear(); 11739 } 11740 11741 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Name && DC && StdNamespace && 11742 DC->Equals(getStdNamespace()) && Name->isStr("bad_alloc")) { 11743 // This is a declaration of or a reference to "std::bad_alloc". 11744 isStdBadAlloc = true; 11745 11746 if (Previous.empty() && StdBadAlloc) { 11747 // std::bad_alloc has been implicitly declared (but made invisible to 11748 // name lookup). Fill in this implicit declaration as the previous 11749 // declaration, so that the declarations get chained appropriately. 11750 Previous.addDecl(getStdBadAlloc()); 11751 } 11752 } 11753 11754 // If we didn't find a previous declaration, and this is a reference 11755 // (or friend reference), move to the correct scope. In C++, we 11756 // also need to do a redeclaration lookup there, just in case 11757 // there's a shadow friend decl. 11758 if (Name && Previous.empty() && 11759 (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend)) { 11760 if (Invalid) goto CreateNewDecl; 11761 assert(SS.isEmpty()); 11762 11763 if (TUK == TUK_Reference) { 11764 // C++ [basic.scope.pdecl]p5: 11765 // -- for an elaborated-type-specifier of the form 11766 // 11767 // class-key identifier 11768 // 11769 // if the elaborated-type-specifier is used in the 11770 // decl-specifier-seq or parameter-declaration-clause of a 11771 // function defined in namespace scope, the identifier is 11772 // declared as a class-name in the namespace that contains 11773 // the declaration; otherwise, except as a friend 11774 // declaration, the identifier is declared in the smallest 11775 // non-class, non-function-prototype scope that contains the 11776 // declaration. 11777 // 11778 // C99 6.7.2.3p8 has a similar (but not identical!) provision for 11779 // C structs and unions. 11780 // 11781 // It is an error in C++ to declare (rather than define) an enum 11782 // type, including via an elaborated type specifier. We'll 11783 // diagnose that later; for now, declare the enum in the same 11784 // scope as we would have picked for any other tag type. 11785 // 11786 // GNU C also supports this behavior as part of its incomplete 11787 // enum types extension, while GNU C++ does not. 11788 // 11789 // Find the context where we'll be declaring the tag. 11790 // FIXME: We would like to maintain the current DeclContext as the 11791 // lexical context, 11792 while (!SearchDC->isFileContext() && !SearchDC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 11793 SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent(); 11794 11795 // Find the scope where we'll be declaring the tag. 11796 while (S->isClassScope() || 11797 (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 11798 S->isFunctionPrototypeScope()) || 11799 ((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0) || 11800 (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext())) 11801 S = S->getParent(); 11802 } else { 11803 assert(TUK == TUK_Friend); 11804 // C++ [namespace.memdef]p3: 11805 // If a friend declaration in a non-local class first declares a 11806 // class or function, the friend class or function is a member of 11807 // the innermost enclosing namespace. 11808 SearchDC = SearchDC->getEnclosingNamespaceContext(); 11809 } 11810 11811 // In C++, we need to do a redeclaration lookup to properly 11812 // diagnose some problems. 11813 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11814 Previous.setRedeclarationKind(ForRedeclaration); 11815 LookupQualifiedName(Previous, SearchDC); 11816 } 11817 } 11818 11819 // If we have a known previous declaration to use, then use it. 11820 if (Previous.empty() && SkipBody && SkipBody->Previous) 11821 Previous.addDecl(SkipBody->Previous); 11822 11823 if (!Previous.empty()) { 11824 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = Previous.getFoundDecl(); 11825 NamedDecl *DirectPrevDecl = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 11826 11827 // It's okay to have a tag decl in the same scope as a typedef 11828 // which hides a tag decl in the same scope. Finding this 11829 // insanity with a redeclaration lookup can only actually happen 11830 // in C++. 11831 // 11832 // This is also okay for elaborated-type-specifiers, which is 11833 // technically forbidden by the current standard but which is 11834 // okay according to the likely resolution of an open issue; 11835 // see http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#407 11836 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11837 if (TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 11838 if (const TagType *TT = TD->getUnderlyingType()->getAs<TagType>()) { 11839 TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl(); 11840 if (Tag->getDeclName() == Name && 11841 Tag->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext() 11842 ->Equals(TD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) { 11843 PrevDecl = Tag; 11844 Previous.clear(); 11845 Previous.addDecl(Tag); 11846 Previous.resolveKind(); 11847 } 11848 } 11849 } 11850 } 11851 11852 // If this is a redeclaration of a using shadow declaration, it must 11853 // declare a tag in the same context. In MSVC mode, we allow a 11854 // redefinition if either context is within the other. 11855 if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(DirectPrevDecl)) { 11856 auto *OldTag = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(PrevDecl); 11857 if (SS.isEmpty() && TUK != TUK_Reference && TUK != TUK_Friend && 11858 isDeclInScope(Shadow, SearchDC, S, isExplicitSpecialization) && 11859 !(OldTag && isAcceptableTagRedeclContext( 11860 *this, OldTag->getDeclContext(), SearchDC))) { 11861 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_using_decl_conflict_reverse); 11862 Diag(Shadow->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), 11863 diag::note_using_decl_target); 11864 Diag(Shadow->getUsingDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) 11865 << 0; 11866 // Recover by ignoring the old declaration. 11867 Previous.clear(); 11868 goto CreateNewDecl; 11869 } 11870 } 11871 11872 if (TagDecl *PrevTagDecl = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 11873 // If this is a use of a previous tag, or if the tag is already declared 11874 // in the same scope (so that the definition/declaration completes or 11875 // rementions the tag), reuse the decl. 11876 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend || 11877 isDeclInScope(DirectPrevDecl, SearchDC, S, 11878 SS.isNotEmpty() || isExplicitSpecialization)) { 11879 // Make sure that this wasn't declared as an enum and now used as a 11880 // struct or something similar. 11881 if (!isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(PrevTagDecl, Kind, 11882 TUK == TUK_Definition, KWLoc, 11883 Name)) { 11884 bool SafeToContinue 11885 = (PrevTagDecl->getTagKind() != TTK_Enum && 11886 Kind != TTK_Enum); 11887 if (SafeToContinue) 11888 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_use_with_wrong_tag) 11889 << Name 11890 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(KWLoc), 11891 PrevTagDecl->getKindName()); 11892 else 11893 Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_use_with_wrong_tag) << Name; 11894 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_use); 11895 11896 if (SafeToContinue) 11897 Kind = PrevTagDecl->getTagKind(); 11898 else { 11899 // Recover by making this an anonymous redefinition. 11900 Name = nullptr; 11901 Previous.clear(); 11902 Invalid = true; 11903 } 11904 } 11905 11906 if (Kind == TTK_Enum && PrevTagDecl->getTagKind() == TTK_Enum) { 11907 const EnumDecl *PrevEnum = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevTagDecl); 11908 11909 // If this is an elaborated-type-specifier for a scoped enumeration, 11910 // the 'class' keyword is not necessary and not permitted. 11911 if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) { 11912 if (ScopedEnum) 11913 Diag(ScopedEnumKWLoc, diag::err_enum_class_reference) 11914 << PrevEnum->isScoped() 11915 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ScopedEnumKWLoc); 11916 return PrevTagDecl; 11917 } 11918 11919 QualType EnumUnderlyingTy; 11920 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo*>()) 11921 EnumUnderlyingTy = TI->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 11922 else if (const Type *T = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<const Type*>()) 11923 EnumUnderlyingTy = QualType(T, 0); 11924 11925 // All conflicts with previous declarations are recovered by 11926 // returning the previous declaration, unless this is a definition, 11927 // in which case we want the caller to bail out. 11928 if (CheckEnumRedeclaration(NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc, 11929 ScopedEnum, EnumUnderlyingTy, PrevEnum)) 11930 return TUK == TUK_Declaration ? PrevTagDecl : nullptr; 11931 } 11932 11933 // C++11 [class.mem]p1: 11934 // A member shall not be declared twice in the member-specification, 11935 // except that a nested class or member class template can be declared 11936 // and then later defined. 11937 if (TUK == TUK_Declaration && PrevDecl->isCXXClassMember() && 11938 S->isDeclScope(PrevDecl)) { 11939 Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_member_redeclared); 11940 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 11941 } 11942 11943 if (!Invalid) { 11944 // If this is a use, just return the declaration we found, unless 11945 // we have attributes. 11946 11947 // FIXME: In the future, return a variant or some other clue 11948 // for the consumer of this Decl to know it doesn't own it. 11949 // For our current ASTs this shouldn't be a problem, but will 11950 // need to be changed with DeclGroups. 11951 if (!Attr && 11952 ((TUK == TUK_Reference && 11953 (!PrevTagDecl->getFriendObjectKind() || getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt)) 11954 || TUK == TUK_Friend)) 11955 return PrevTagDecl; 11956 11957 // Diagnose attempts to redefine a tag. 11958 if (TUK == TUK_Definition) { 11959 if (NamedDecl *Def = PrevTagDecl->getDefinition()) { 11960 // If we're defining a specialization and the previous definition 11961 // is from an implicit instantiation, don't emit an error 11962 // here; we'll catch this in the general case below. 11963 bool IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = false; 11964 if (isExplicitSpecialization) { 11965 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Def)) 11966 IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = 11967 RD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != 11968 TSK_ExplicitSpecialization; 11969 else if (EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Def)) 11970 IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = 11971 ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != 11972 TSK_ExplicitSpecialization; 11973 } 11974 11975 NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr; 11976 if (SkipBody && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 11977 !hasVisibleDefinition(Def, &Hidden)) { 11978 // There is a definition of this tag, but it is not visible. We 11979 // explicitly make use of C++'s one definition rule here, and 11980 // assume that this definition is identical to the hidden one 11981 // we already have. Make the existing definition visible and 11982 // use it in place of this one. 11983 SkipBody->ShouldSkip = true; 11984 makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Hidden, KWLoc); 11985 return Def; 11986 } else if (!IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation) { 11987 // A redeclaration in function prototype scope in C isn't 11988 // visible elsewhere, so merely issue a warning. 11989 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && S->containedInPrototypeScope()) 11990 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_redefinition_in_param_list) << Name; 11991 else 11992 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_redefinition) << Name; 11993 Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 11994 // If this is a redefinition, recover by making this 11995 // struct be anonymous, which will make any later 11996 // references get the previous definition. 11997 Name = nullptr; 11998 Previous.clear(); 11999 Invalid = true; 12000 } 12001 } else { 12002 // If the type is currently being defined, complain 12003 // about a nested redefinition. 12004 auto *TD = Context.getTagDeclType(PrevTagDecl)->getAsTagDecl(); 12005 if (TD->isBeingDefined()) { 12006 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_nested_redefinition) << Name; 12007 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), 12008 diag::note_previous_definition); 12009 Name = nullptr; 12010 Previous.clear(); 12011 Invalid = true; 12012 } 12013 } 12014 12015 // Okay, this is definition of a previously declared or referenced 12016 // tag. We're going to create a new Decl for it. 12017 } 12018 12019 // Okay, we're going to make a redeclaration. If this is some kind 12020 // of reference, make sure we build the redeclaration in the same DC 12021 // as the original, and ignore the current access specifier. 12022 if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) { 12023 SearchDC = PrevTagDecl->getDeclContext(); 12024 AS = AS_none; 12025 } 12026 } 12027 // If we get here we have (another) forward declaration or we 12028 // have a definition. Just create a new decl. 12029 12030 } else { 12031 // If we get here, this is a definition of a new tag type in a nested 12032 // scope, e.g. "struct foo; void bar() { struct foo; }", just create a 12033 // new decl/type. We set PrevDecl to NULL so that the entities 12034 // have distinct types. 12035 Previous.clear(); 12036 } 12037 // If we get here, we're going to create a new Decl. If PrevDecl 12038 // is non-NULL, it's a definition of the tag declared by 12039 // PrevDecl. If it's NULL, we have a new definition. 12040 12041 12042 // Otherwise, PrevDecl is not a tag, but was found with tag 12043 // lookup. This is only actually possible in C++, where a few 12044 // things like templates still live in the tag namespace. 12045 } else { 12046 // Use a better diagnostic if an elaborated-type-specifier 12047 // found the wrong kind of type on the first 12048 // (non-redeclaration) lookup. 12049 if ((TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) && 12050 !Previous.isForRedeclaration()) { 12051 unsigned Kind = 0; 12052 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(PrevDecl)) Kind = 1; 12053 else if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(PrevDecl)) Kind = 2; 12054 else if (isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(PrevDecl)) Kind = 3; 12055 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_reference_non_tag) << Kind; 12056 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 12057 Invalid = true; 12058 12059 // Otherwise, only diagnose if the declaration is in scope. 12060 } else if (!isDeclInScope(DirectPrevDecl, SearchDC, S, 12061 SS.isNotEmpty() || isExplicitSpecialization)) { 12062 // do nothing 12063 12064 // Diagnose implicit declarations introduced by elaborated types. 12065 } else if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) { 12066 unsigned Kind = 0; 12067 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(PrevDecl)) Kind = 1; 12068 else if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(PrevDecl)) Kind = 2; 12069 else if (isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(PrevDecl)) Kind = 3; 12070 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_reference_conflict) << Kind; 12071 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << PrevDecl; 12072 Invalid = true; 12073 12074 // Otherwise it's a declaration. Call out a particularly common 12075 // case here. 12076 } else if (TypedefNameDecl *TND = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 12077 unsigned Kind = 0; 12078 if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(PrevDecl)) Kind = 1; 12079 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_definition_of_typedef) 12080 << Name << Kind << TND->getUnderlyingType(); 12081 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << PrevDecl; 12082 Invalid = true; 12083 12084 // Otherwise, diagnose. 12085 } else { 12086 // The tag name clashes with something else in the target scope, 12087 // issue an error and recover by making this tag be anonymous. 12088 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) << Name; 12089 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 12090 Name = nullptr; 12091 Invalid = true; 12092 } 12093 12094 // The existing declaration isn't relevant to us; we're in a 12095 // new scope, so clear out the previous declaration. 12096 Previous.clear(); 12097 } 12098 } 12099 12100 CreateNewDecl: 12101 12102 TagDecl *PrevDecl = nullptr; 12103 if (Previous.isSingleResult()) 12104 PrevDecl = cast<TagDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()); 12105 12106 // If there is an identifier, use the location of the identifier as the 12107 // location of the decl, otherwise use the location of the struct/union 12108 // keyword. 12109 SourceLocation Loc = NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc; 12110 12111 // Otherwise, create a new declaration. If there is a previous 12112 // declaration of the same entity, the two will be linked via 12113 // PrevDecl. 12114 TagDecl *New; 12115 12116 bool IsForwardReference = false; 12117 if (Kind == TTK_Enum) { 12118 // FIXME: Tag decls should be chained to any simultaneous vardecls, e.g.: 12119 // enum X { A, B, C } D; D should chain to X. 12120 New = EnumDecl::Create(Context, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 12121 cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(PrevDecl), ScopedEnum, 12122 ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, !EnumUnderlying.isNull()); 12123 // If this is an undefined enum, warn. 12124 if (TUK != TUK_Definition && !Invalid) { 12125 TagDecl *Def; 12126 if ((getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 || getLangOpts().ObjC2) && 12127 cast<EnumDecl>(New)->isFixed()) { 12128 // C++0x: 7.2p2: opaque-enum-declaration. 12129 // Conflicts are diagnosed above. Do nothing. 12130 } 12131 else if (PrevDecl && (Def = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevDecl)->getDefinition())) { 12132 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_forward_ref_enum_def) 12133 << New; 12134 Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 12135 } else { 12136 unsigned DiagID = diag::ext_forward_ref_enum; 12137 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 12138 DiagID = diag::ext_ms_forward_ref_enum; 12139 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 12140 DiagID = diag::err_forward_ref_enum; 12141 Diag(Loc, DiagID); 12142 12143 // If this is a forward-declared reference to an enumeration, make a 12144 // note of it; we won't actually be introducing the declaration into 12145 // the declaration context. 12146 if (TUK == TUK_Reference) 12147 IsForwardReference = true; 12148 } 12149 } 12150 12151 if (EnumUnderlying) { 12152 EnumDecl *ED = cast<EnumDecl>(New); 12153 if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo*>()) 12154 ED->setIntegerTypeSourceInfo(TI); 12155 else 12156 ED->setIntegerType(QualType(EnumUnderlying.get<const Type*>(), 0)); 12157 ED->setPromotionType(ED->getIntegerType()); 12158 } 12159 12160 } else { 12161 // struct/union/class 12162 12163 // FIXME: Tag decls should be chained to any simultaneous vardecls, e.g.: 12164 // struct X { int A; } D; D should chain to X. 12165 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12166 // FIXME: Look for a way to use RecordDecl for simple structs. 12167 New = CXXRecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 12168 cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(PrevDecl)); 12169 12170 if (isStdBadAlloc && (!StdBadAlloc || getStdBadAlloc()->isImplicit())) 12171 StdBadAlloc = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(New); 12172 } else 12173 New = RecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, 12174 cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(PrevDecl)); 12175 } 12176 12177 // C++11 [dcl.type]p3: 12178 // A type-specifier-seq shall not define a class or enumeration [...]. 12179 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && IsTypeSpecifier && TUK == TUK_Definition) { 12180 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_type_defined_in_type_specifier) 12181 << Context.getTagDeclType(New); 12182 Invalid = true; 12183 } 12184 12185 // Maybe add qualifier info. 12186 if (SS.isNotEmpty()) { 12187 if (SS.isSet()) { 12188 // If this is either a declaration or a definition, check the 12189 // nested-name-specifier against the current context. We don't do this 12190 // for explicit specializations, because they have similar checking 12191 // (with more specific diagnostics) in the call to 12192 // CheckMemberSpecialization, below. 12193 if (!isExplicitSpecialization && 12194 (TUK == TUK_Definition || TUK == TUK_Declaration) && 12195 diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(SS, DC, OrigName, Loc)) 12196 Invalid = true; 12197 12198 New->setQualifierInfo(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 12199 if (TemplateParameterLists.size() > 0) { 12200 New->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, 12201 TemplateParameterLists.size(), 12202 TemplateParameterLists.data()); 12203 } 12204 } 12205 else 12206 Invalid = true; 12207 } 12208 12209 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) { 12210 // Add alignment attributes if necessary; these attributes are checked when 12211 // the ASTContext lays out the structure. 12212 // 12213 // It is important for implementing the correct semantics that this 12214 // happen here (in act on tag decl). The #pragma pack stack is 12215 // maintained as a result of parser callbacks which can occur at 12216 // many points during the parsing of a struct declaration (because 12217 // the #pragma tokens are effectively skipped over during the 12218 // parsing of the struct). 12219 if (TUK == TUK_Definition) { 12220 AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord(RD); 12221 AddMsStructLayoutForRecord(RD); 12222 } 12223 } 12224 12225 if (ModulePrivateLoc.isValid()) { 12226 if (isExplicitSpecialization) 12227 Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization) 12228 << 2 12229 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ModulePrivateLoc); 12230 // __module_private__ does not apply to local classes. However, we only 12231 // diagnose this as an error when the declaration specifiers are 12232 // freestanding. Here, we just ignore the __module_private__. 12233 else if (!SearchDC->isFunctionOrMethod()) 12234 New->setModulePrivate(); 12235 } 12236 12237 // If this is a specialization of a member class (of a class template), 12238 // check the specialization. 12239 if (isExplicitSpecialization && CheckMemberSpecialization(New, Previous)) 12240 Invalid = true; 12241 12242 // If we're declaring or defining a tag in function prototype scope in C, 12243 // note that this type can only be used within the function and add it to 12244 // the list of decls to inject into the function definition scope. 12245 if ((Name || Kind == TTK_Enum) && 12246 getNonFieldDeclScope(S)->isFunctionPrototypeScope()) { 12247 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12248 // C++ [dcl.fct]p6: 12249 // Types shall not be defined in return or parameter types. 12250 if (TUK == TUK_Definition && !IsTypeSpecifier) { 12251 Diag(Loc, diag::err_type_defined_in_param_type) 12252 << Name; 12253 Invalid = true; 12254 } 12255 } else { 12256 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_decl_in_param_list) << Context.getTagDeclType(New); 12257 } 12258 DeclsInPrototypeScope.push_back(New); 12259 } 12260 12261 if (Invalid) 12262 New->setInvalidDecl(); 12263 12264 if (Attr) 12265 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, New, Attr); 12266 12267 // Set the lexical context. If the tag has a C++ scope specifier, the 12268 // lexical context will be different from the semantic context. 12269 New->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext); 12270 12271 // Mark this as a friend decl if applicable. 12272 // In Microsoft mode, a friend declaration also acts as a forward 12273 // declaration so we always pass true to setObjectOfFriendDecl to make 12274 // the tag name visible. 12275 if (TUK == TUK_Friend) 12276 New->setObjectOfFriendDecl(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat); 12277 12278 // Set the access specifier. 12279 if (!Invalid && SearchDC->isRecord()) 12280 SetMemberAccessSpecifier(New, PrevDecl, AS); 12281 12282 if (TUK == TUK_Definition) 12283 New->startDefinition(); 12284 12285 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack. 12286 if (TUK == TUK_Friend) { 12287 // We might be replacing an existing declaration in the lookup tables; 12288 // if so, borrow its access specifier. 12289 if (PrevDecl) 12290 New->setAccess(PrevDecl->getAccess()); 12291 12292 DeclContext *DC = New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext(); 12293 DC->makeDeclVisibleInContext(New); 12294 if (Name) // can be null along some error paths 12295 if (Scope *EnclosingScope = getScopeForDeclContext(S, DC)) 12296 PushOnScopeChains(New, EnclosingScope, /* AddToContext = */ false); 12297 } else if (Name) { 12298 S = getNonFieldDeclScope(S); 12299 PushOnScopeChains(New, S, !IsForwardReference); 12300 if (IsForwardReference) 12301 SearchDC->makeDeclVisibleInContext(New); 12302 12303 } else { 12304 CurContext->addDecl(New); 12305 } 12306 12307 // If this is the C FILE type, notify the AST context. 12308 if (IdentifierInfo *II = New->getIdentifier()) 12309 if (!New->isInvalidDecl() && 12310 New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() && 12311 II->isStr("FILE")) 12312 Context.setFILEDecl(New); 12313 12314 if (PrevDecl) 12315 mergeDeclAttributes(New, PrevDecl); 12316 12317 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, set the visibility of this 12318 // record. 12319 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(New); 12320 12321 OwnedDecl = true; 12322 // In C++, don't return an invalid declaration. We can't recover well from 12323 // the cases where we make the type anonymous. 12324 return (Invalid && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) ? nullptr : New; 12325 } 12326 12327 void Sema::ActOnTagStartDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagD) { 12328 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 12329 TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 12330 12331 // Enter the tag context. 12332 PushDeclContext(S, Tag); 12333 12334 ActOnDocumentableDecl(TagD); 12335 12336 // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, set the visibility of this 12337 // record. 12338 AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(Tag); 12339 } 12340 12341 Decl *Sema::ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition(Decl *IDecl) { 12342 assert(isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(IDecl) && 12343 "ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition - Not ObjCContainerDecl"); 12344 DeclContext *OCD = cast<DeclContext>(IDecl); 12345 assert(getContainingDC(OCD) == CurContext && 12346 "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one."); 12347 CurContext = OCD; 12348 return IDecl; 12349 } 12350 12351 void Sema::ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, 12352 SourceLocation FinalLoc, 12353 bool IsFinalSpelledSealed, 12354 SourceLocation LBraceLoc) { 12355 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 12356 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TagD); 12357 12358 FieldCollector->StartClass(); 12359 12360 if (!Record->getIdentifier()) 12361 return; 12362 12363 if (FinalLoc.isValid()) 12364 Record->addAttr(new (Context) 12365 FinalAttr(FinalLoc, Context, IsFinalSpelledSealed)); 12366 12367 // C++ [class]p2: 12368 // [...] The class-name is also inserted into the scope of the 12369 // class itself; this is known as the injected-class-name. For 12370 // purposes of access checking, the injected-class-name is treated 12371 // as if it were a public member name. 12372 CXXRecordDecl *InjectedClassName 12373 = CXXRecordDecl::Create(Context, Record->getTagKind(), CurContext, 12374 Record->getLocStart(), Record->getLocation(), 12375 Record->getIdentifier(), 12376 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr, 12377 /*DelayTypeCreation=*/true); 12378 Context.getTypeDeclType(InjectedClassName, Record); 12379 InjectedClassName->setImplicit(); 12380 InjectedClassName->setAccess(AS_public); 12381 if (ClassTemplateDecl *Template = Record->getDescribedClassTemplate()) 12382 InjectedClassName->setDescribedClassTemplate(Template); 12383 PushOnScopeChains(InjectedClassName, S); 12384 assert(InjectedClassName->isInjectedClassName() && 12385 "Broken injected-class-name"); 12386 } 12387 12388 void Sema::ActOnTagFinishDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, 12389 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) { 12390 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 12391 TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 12392 Tag->setRBraceLoc(RBraceLoc); 12393 12394 // Make sure we "complete" the definition even it is invalid. 12395 if (Tag->isBeingDefined()) { 12396 assert(Tag->isInvalidDecl() && "We should already have completed it"); 12397 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag)) 12398 RD->completeDefinition(); 12399 } 12400 12401 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) 12402 FieldCollector->FinishClass(); 12403 12404 // Exit this scope of this tag's definition. 12405 PopDeclContext(); 12406 12407 if (getCurLexicalContext()->isObjCContainer() && 12408 Tag->getDeclContext()->isFileContext()) 12409 Tag->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer(); 12410 12411 // Notify the consumer that we've defined a tag. 12412 if (!Tag->isInvalidDecl()) 12413 Consumer.HandleTagDeclDefinition(Tag); 12414 } 12415 12416 void Sema::ActOnObjCContainerFinishDefinition() { 12417 // Exit this scope of this interface definition. 12418 PopDeclContext(); 12419 } 12420 12421 void Sema::ActOnObjCTemporaryExitContainerContext(DeclContext *DC) { 12422 assert(DC == CurContext && "Mismatch of container contexts"); 12423 OriginalLexicalContext = DC; 12424 ActOnObjCContainerFinishDefinition(); 12425 } 12426 12427 void Sema::ActOnObjCReenterContainerContext(DeclContext *DC) { 12428 ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition(cast<Decl>(DC)); 12429 OriginalLexicalContext = nullptr; 12430 } 12431 12432 void Sema::ActOnTagDefinitionError(Scope *S, Decl *TagD) { 12433 AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD); 12434 TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD); 12435 Tag->setInvalidDecl(); 12436 12437 // Make sure we "complete" the definition even it is invalid. 12438 if (Tag->isBeingDefined()) { 12439 if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag)) 12440 RD->completeDefinition(); 12441 } 12442 12443 // We're undoing ActOnTagStartDefinition here, not 12444 // ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations, so we don't have to mess with 12445 // the FieldCollector. 12446 12447 PopDeclContext(); 12448 } 12449 12450 // Note that FieldName may be null for anonymous bitfields. 12451 ExprResult Sema::VerifyBitField(SourceLocation FieldLoc, 12452 IdentifierInfo *FieldName, 12453 QualType FieldTy, bool IsMsStruct, 12454 Expr *BitWidth, bool *ZeroWidth) { 12455 // Default to true; that shouldn't confuse checks for emptiness 12456 if (ZeroWidth) 12457 *ZeroWidth = true; 12458 12459 // C99 6.7.2.1p4 - verify the field type. 12460 // C++ 9.6p3: A bit-field shall have integral or enumeration type. 12461 if (!FieldTy->isDependentType() && !FieldTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) { 12462 // Handle incomplete types with specific error. 12463 if (RequireCompleteType(FieldLoc, FieldTy, diag::err_field_incomplete)) 12464 return ExprError(); 12465 if (FieldName) 12466 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_not_integral_type_bitfield) 12467 << FieldName << FieldTy << BitWidth->getSourceRange(); 12468 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_not_integral_type_anon_bitfield) 12469 << FieldTy << BitWidth->getSourceRange(); 12470 } else if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(const_cast<Expr *>(BitWidth), 12471 UPPC_BitFieldWidth)) 12472 return ExprError(); 12473 12474 // If the bit-width is type- or value-dependent, don't try to check 12475 // it now. 12476 if (BitWidth->isValueDependent() || BitWidth->isTypeDependent()) 12477 return BitWidth; 12478 12479 llvm::APSInt Value; 12480 ExprResult ICE = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(BitWidth, &Value); 12481 if (ICE.isInvalid()) 12482 return ICE; 12483 BitWidth = ICE.get(); 12484 12485 if (Value != 0 && ZeroWidth) 12486 *ZeroWidth = false; 12487 12488 // Zero-width bitfield is ok for anonymous field. 12489 if (Value == 0 && FieldName) 12490 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_has_zero_width) << FieldName; 12491 12492 if (Value.isSigned() && Value.isNegative()) { 12493 if (FieldName) 12494 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_has_negative_width) 12495 << FieldName << Value.toString(10); 12496 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_anon_bitfield_has_negative_width) 12497 << Value.toString(10); 12498 } 12499 12500 if (!FieldTy->isDependentType()) { 12501 uint64_t TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(FieldTy); 12502 if (Value.getZExtValue() > TypeSize) { 12503 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || IsMsStruct || 12504 Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) { 12505 if (FieldName) 12506 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_size) 12507 << FieldName << (unsigned)Value.getZExtValue() 12508 << (unsigned)TypeSize; 12509 12510 return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_anon_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_size) 12511 << (unsigned)Value.getZExtValue() << (unsigned)TypeSize; 12512 } 12513 12514 if (FieldName) 12515 Diag(FieldLoc, diag::warn_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_size) 12516 << FieldName << (unsigned)Value.getZExtValue() 12517 << (unsigned)TypeSize; 12518 else 12519 Diag(FieldLoc, diag::warn_anon_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_size) 12520 << (unsigned)Value.getZExtValue() << (unsigned)TypeSize; 12521 } 12522 } 12523 12524 return BitWidth; 12525 } 12526 12527 /// ActOnField - Each field of a C struct/union is passed into this in order 12528 /// to create a FieldDecl object for it. 12529 Decl *Sema::ActOnField(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, SourceLocation DeclStart, 12530 Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth) { 12531 FieldDecl *Res = HandleField(S, cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(TagD), 12532 DeclStart, D, static_cast<Expr*>(BitfieldWidth), 12533 /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit, AS_public); 12534 return Res; 12535 } 12536 12537 /// HandleField - Analyze a field of a C struct or a C++ data member. 12538 /// 12539 FieldDecl *Sema::HandleField(Scope *S, RecordDecl *Record, 12540 SourceLocation DeclStart, 12541 Declarator &D, Expr *BitWidth, 12542 InClassInitStyle InitStyle, 12543 AccessSpecifier AS) { 12544 IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier(); 12545 SourceLocation Loc = DeclStart; 12546 if (II) Loc = D.getIdentifierLoc(); 12547 12548 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 12549 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 12550 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12551 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 12552 12553 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getIdentifierLoc(), TInfo, 12554 UPPC_DataMemberType)) { 12555 D.setInvalidType(); 12556 T = Context.IntTy; 12557 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc); 12558 } 12559 } 12560 12561 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces. 12562 if (T.getQualifiers().hasAddressSpace()) { 12563 Diag(Loc, diag::err_field_with_address_space); 12564 D.setInvalidType(); 12565 } 12566 12567 // OpenCL 1.2 spec, s6.9 r: 12568 // The event type cannot be used to declare a structure or union field. 12569 if (LangOpts.OpenCL && T->isEventT()) { 12570 Diag(Loc, diag::err_event_t_struct_field); 12571 D.setInvalidType(); 12572 } 12573 12574 DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec()); 12575 12576 if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) 12577 Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), 12578 diag::err_invalid_thread) 12579 << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS); 12580 12581 // Check to see if this name was declared as a member previously 12582 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = nullptr; 12583 LookupResult Previous(*this, II, Loc, LookupMemberName, ForRedeclaration); 12584 LookupName(Previous, S); 12585 switch (Previous.getResultKind()) { 12586 case LookupResult::Found: 12587 case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue: 12588 PrevDecl = Previous.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>(); 12589 break; 12590 12591 case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded: 12592 PrevDecl = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(); 12593 break; 12594 12595 case LookupResult::NotFound: 12596 case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: 12597 case LookupResult::Ambiguous: 12598 break; 12599 } 12600 Previous.suppressDiagnostics(); 12601 12602 if (PrevDecl && PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) { 12603 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 12604 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), PrevDecl); 12605 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 12606 PrevDecl = nullptr; 12607 } 12608 12609 if (PrevDecl && !isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, Record, S)) 12610 PrevDecl = nullptr; 12611 12612 bool Mutable 12613 = (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable); 12614 SourceLocation TSSL = D.getLocStart(); 12615 FieldDecl *NewFD 12616 = CheckFieldDecl(II, T, TInfo, Record, Loc, Mutable, BitWidth, InitStyle, 12617 TSSL, AS, PrevDecl, &D); 12618 12619 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) 12620 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 12621 12622 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) 12623 NewFD->setModulePrivate(); 12624 12625 if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && PrevDecl) { 12626 // Don't introduce NewFD into scope; there's already something 12627 // with the same name in the same scope. 12628 } else if (II) { 12629 PushOnScopeChains(NewFD, S); 12630 } else 12631 Record->addDecl(NewFD); 12632 12633 return NewFD; 12634 } 12635 12636 /// \brief Build a new FieldDecl and check its well-formedness. 12637 /// 12638 /// This routine builds a new FieldDecl given the fields name, type, 12639 /// record, etc. \p PrevDecl should refer to any previous declaration 12640 /// with the same name and in the same scope as the field to be 12641 /// created. 12642 /// 12643 /// \returns a new FieldDecl. 12644 /// 12645 /// \todo The Declarator argument is a hack. It will be removed once 12646 FieldDecl *Sema::CheckFieldDecl(DeclarationName Name, QualType T, 12647 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 12648 RecordDecl *Record, SourceLocation Loc, 12649 bool Mutable, Expr *BitWidth, 12650 InClassInitStyle InitStyle, 12651 SourceLocation TSSL, 12652 AccessSpecifier AS, NamedDecl *PrevDecl, 12653 Declarator *D) { 12654 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 12655 bool InvalidDecl = false; 12656 if (D) InvalidDecl = D->isInvalidType(); 12657 12658 // If we receive a broken type, recover by assuming 'int' and 12659 // marking this declaration as invalid. 12660 if (T.isNull()) { 12661 InvalidDecl = true; 12662 T = Context.IntTy; 12663 } 12664 12665 QualType EltTy = Context.getBaseElementType(T); 12666 if (!EltTy->isDependentType()) { 12667 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, EltTy, diag::err_field_incomplete)) { 12668 // Fields of incomplete type force their record to be invalid. 12669 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 12670 InvalidDecl = true; 12671 } else { 12672 NamedDecl *Def; 12673 EltTy->isIncompleteType(&Def); 12674 if (Def && Def->isInvalidDecl()) { 12675 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 12676 InvalidDecl = true; 12677 } 12678 } 12679 } 12680 12681 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.c: bitfields are not supported. 12682 if (BitWidth && getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 12683 Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_bitfields); 12684 InvalidDecl = true; 12685 } 12686 12687 // C99 6.7.2.1p8: A member of a structure or union may have any type other 12688 // than a variably modified type. 12689 if (!InvalidDecl && T->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 12690 bool SizeIsNegative; 12691 llvm::APSInt Oversized; 12692 12693 TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = 12694 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TInfo, Context, 12695 SizeIsNegative, 12696 Oversized); 12697 if (FixedTInfo) { 12698 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_illegal_constant_array_size); 12699 TInfo = FixedTInfo; 12700 T = FixedTInfo->getType(); 12701 } else { 12702 if (SizeIsNegative) 12703 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_negative_array_size); 12704 else if (Oversized.getBoolValue()) 12705 Diag(Loc, diag::err_array_too_large) 12706 << Oversized.toString(10); 12707 else 12708 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_field_variable_size); 12709 InvalidDecl = true; 12710 } 12711 } 12712 12713 // Fields can not have abstract class types 12714 if (!InvalidDecl && RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, T, 12715 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 12716 AbstractFieldType)) 12717 InvalidDecl = true; 12718 12719 bool ZeroWidth = false; 12720 if (InvalidDecl) 12721 BitWidth = nullptr; 12722 // If this is declared as a bit-field, check the bit-field. 12723 if (BitWidth) { 12724 BitWidth = VerifyBitField(Loc, II, T, Record->isMsStruct(Context), BitWidth, 12725 &ZeroWidth).get(); 12726 if (!BitWidth) { 12727 InvalidDecl = true; 12728 BitWidth = nullptr; 12729 ZeroWidth = false; 12730 } 12731 } 12732 12733 // Check that 'mutable' is consistent with the type of the declaration. 12734 if (!InvalidDecl && Mutable) { 12735 unsigned DiagID = 0; 12736 if (T->isReferenceType()) 12737 DiagID = getLangOpts().MSVCCompat ? diag::ext_mutable_reference 12738 : diag::err_mutable_reference; 12739 else if (T.isConstQualified()) 12740 DiagID = diag::err_mutable_const; 12741 12742 if (DiagID) { 12743 SourceLocation ErrLoc = Loc; 12744 if (D && D->getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc().isValid()) 12745 ErrLoc = D->getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(); 12746 Diag(ErrLoc, DiagID); 12747 if (DiagID != diag::ext_mutable_reference) { 12748 Mutable = false; 12749 InvalidDecl = true; 12750 } 12751 } 12752 } 12753 12754 // C++11 [class.union]p8 (DR1460): 12755 // At most one variant member of a union may have a 12756 // brace-or-equal-initializer. 12757 if (InitStyle != ICIS_NoInit) 12758 checkDuplicateDefaultInit(*this, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record), Loc); 12759 12760 FieldDecl *NewFD = FieldDecl::Create(Context, Record, TSSL, Loc, II, T, TInfo, 12761 BitWidth, Mutable, InitStyle); 12762 if (InvalidDecl) 12763 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 12764 12765 if (PrevDecl && !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 12766 Diag(Loc, diag::err_duplicate_member) << II; 12767 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 12768 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 12769 } 12770 12771 if (!InvalidDecl && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12772 if (Record->isUnion()) { 12773 if (const RecordType *RT = EltTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 12774 CXXRecordDecl* RDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()); 12775 if (RDecl->getDefinition()) { 12776 // C++ [class.union]p1: An object of a class with a non-trivial 12777 // constructor, a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial 12778 // destructor, or a non-trivial copy assignment operator 12779 // cannot be a member of a union, nor can an array of such 12780 // objects. 12781 if (CheckNontrivialField(NewFD)) 12782 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 12783 } 12784 } 12785 12786 // C++ [class.union]p1: If a union contains a member of reference type, 12787 // the program is ill-formed, except when compiling with MSVC extensions 12788 // enabled. 12789 if (EltTy->isReferenceType()) { 12790 Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt ? 12791 diag::ext_union_member_of_reference_type : 12792 diag::err_union_member_of_reference_type) 12793 << NewFD->getDeclName() << EltTy; 12794 if (!getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) 12795 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 12796 } 12797 } 12798 } 12799 12800 // FIXME: We need to pass in the attributes given an AST 12801 // representation, not a parser representation. 12802 if (D) { 12803 // FIXME: The current scope is almost... but not entirely... correct here. 12804 ProcessDeclAttributes(getCurScope(), NewFD, *D); 12805 12806 if (NewFD->hasAttrs()) 12807 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(NewFD); 12808 } 12809 12810 // In auto-retain/release, infer strong retension for fields of 12811 // retainable type. 12812 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewFD)) 12813 NewFD->setInvalidDecl(); 12814 12815 if (T.isObjCGCWeak()) 12816 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_attribute_weak_on_field); 12817 12818 NewFD->setAccess(AS); 12819 return NewFD; 12820 } 12821 12822 bool Sema::CheckNontrivialField(FieldDecl *FD) { 12823 assert(FD); 12824 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "valid check only for C++"); 12825 12826 if (FD->isInvalidDecl() || FD->getType()->isDependentType()) 12827 return false; 12828 12829 QualType EltTy = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType()); 12830 if (const RecordType *RT = EltTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 12831 CXXRecordDecl *RDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()); 12832 if (RDecl->getDefinition()) { 12833 // We check for copy constructors before constructors 12834 // because otherwise we'll never get complaints about 12835 // copy constructors. 12836 12837 CXXSpecialMember member = CXXInvalid; 12838 // We're required to check for any non-trivial constructors. Since the 12839 // implicit default constructor is suppressed if there are any 12840 // user-declared constructors, we just need to check that there is a 12841 // trivial default constructor and a trivial copy constructor. (We don't 12842 // worry about move constructors here, since this is a C++98 check.) 12843 if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialCopyConstructor()) 12844 member = CXXCopyConstructor; 12845 else if (!RDecl->hasTrivialDefaultConstructor()) 12846 member = CXXDefaultConstructor; 12847 else if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialCopyAssignment()) 12848 member = CXXCopyAssignment; 12849 else if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialDestructor()) 12850 member = CXXDestructor; 12851 12852 if (member != CXXInvalid) { 12853 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && 12854 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && RDecl->hasObjectMember()) { 12855 // Objective-C++ ARC: it is an error to have a non-trivial field of 12856 // a union. However, system headers in Objective-C programs 12857 // occasionally have Objective-C lifetime objects within unions, 12858 // and rather than cause the program to fail, we make those 12859 // members unavailable. 12860 SourceLocation Loc = FD->getLocation(); 12861 if (getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(Loc)) { 12862 if (!FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) 12863 FD->addAttr(UnavailableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 12864 "this system field has retaining ownership", 12865 Loc)); 12866 return false; 12867 } 12868 } 12869 12870 Diag(FD->getLocation(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? 12871 diag::warn_cxx98_compat_nontrivial_union_or_anon_struct_member : 12872 diag::err_illegal_union_or_anon_struct_member) 12873 << (int)FD->getParent()->isUnion() << FD->getDeclName() << member; 12874 DiagnoseNontrivial(RDecl, member); 12875 return !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11; 12876 } 12877 } 12878 } 12879 12880 return false; 12881 } 12882 12883 /// TranslateIvarVisibility - Translate visibility from a token ID to an 12884 /// AST enum value. 12885 static ObjCIvarDecl::AccessControl 12886 TranslateIvarVisibility(tok::ObjCKeywordKind ivarVisibility) { 12887 switch (ivarVisibility) { 12888 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown visitibility kind"); 12889 case tok::objc_private: return ObjCIvarDecl::Private; 12890 case tok::objc_public: return ObjCIvarDecl::Public; 12891 case tok::objc_protected: return ObjCIvarDecl::Protected; 12892 case tok::objc_package: return ObjCIvarDecl::Package; 12893 } 12894 } 12895 12896 /// ActOnIvar - Each ivar field of an objective-c class is passed into this 12897 /// in order to create an IvarDecl object for it. 12898 Decl *Sema::ActOnIvar(Scope *S, 12899 SourceLocation DeclStart, 12900 Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth, 12901 tok::ObjCKeywordKind Visibility) { 12902 12903 IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier(); 12904 Expr *BitWidth = (Expr*)BitfieldWidth; 12905 SourceLocation Loc = DeclStart; 12906 if (II) Loc = D.getIdentifierLoc(); 12907 12908 // FIXME: Unnamed fields can be handled in various different ways, for 12909 // example, unnamed unions inject all members into the struct namespace! 12910 12911 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S); 12912 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 12913 12914 if (BitWidth) { 12915 // 6.7.2.1p3, 6.7.2.1p4 12916 BitWidth = VerifyBitField(Loc, II, T, /*IsMsStruct*/false, BitWidth).get(); 12917 if (!BitWidth) 12918 D.setInvalidType(); 12919 } else { 12920 // Not a bitfield. 12921 12922 // validate II. 12923 12924 } 12925 if (T->isReferenceType()) { 12926 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ivar_reference_type); 12927 D.setInvalidType(); 12928 } 12929 // C99 6.7.2.1p8: A member of a structure or union may have any type other 12930 // than a variably modified type. 12931 else if (T->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 12932 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_ivar_variable_size); 12933 D.setInvalidType(); 12934 } 12935 12936 // Get the visibility (access control) for this ivar. 12937 ObjCIvarDecl::AccessControl ac = 12938 Visibility != tok::objc_not_keyword ? TranslateIvarVisibility(Visibility) 12939 : ObjCIvarDecl::None; 12940 // Must set ivar's DeclContext to its enclosing interface. 12941 ObjCContainerDecl *EnclosingDecl = cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext); 12942 if (!EnclosingDecl || EnclosingDecl->isInvalidDecl()) 12943 return nullptr; 12944 ObjCContainerDecl *EnclosingContext; 12945 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPDecl = 12946 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 12947 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile()) { 12948 // Case of ivar declared in an implementation. Context is that of its class. 12949 EnclosingContext = IMPDecl->getClassInterface(); 12950 assert(EnclosingContext && "Implementation has no class interface!"); 12951 } 12952 else 12953 EnclosingContext = EnclosingDecl; 12954 } else { 12955 if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl = 12956 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 12957 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile() || !CDecl->IsClassExtension()) { 12958 Diag(Loc, diag::err_misplaced_ivar) << CDecl->IsClassExtension(); 12959 return nullptr; 12960 } 12961 } 12962 EnclosingContext = EnclosingDecl; 12963 } 12964 12965 // Construct the decl. 12966 ObjCIvarDecl *NewID = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(Context, EnclosingContext, 12967 DeclStart, Loc, II, T, 12968 TInfo, ac, (Expr *)BitfieldWidth); 12969 12970 if (II) { 12971 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(S, II, Loc, LookupMemberName, 12972 ForRedeclaration); 12973 if (PrevDecl && isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, EnclosingContext, S) 12974 && !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) { 12975 Diag(Loc, diag::err_duplicate_member) << II; 12976 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 12977 NewID->setInvalidDecl(); 12978 } 12979 } 12980 12981 // Process attributes attached to the ivar. 12982 ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewID, D); 12983 12984 if (D.isInvalidType()) 12985 NewID->setInvalidDecl(); 12986 12987 // In ARC, infer 'retaining' for ivars of retainable type. 12988 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewID)) 12989 NewID->setInvalidDecl(); 12990 12991 if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) 12992 NewID->setModulePrivate(); 12993 12994 if (II) { 12995 // FIXME: When interfaces are DeclContexts, we'll need to add 12996 // these to the interface. 12997 S->AddDecl(NewID); 12998 IdResolver.AddDecl(NewID); 12999 } 13000 13001 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isNonFragile() && 13002 !NewID->isInvalidDecl() && isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) 13003 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivars_in_interface); 13004 13005 return NewID; 13006 } 13007 13008 /// ActOnLastBitfield - This routine handles synthesized bitfields rules for 13009 /// class and class extensions. For every class \@interface and class 13010 /// extension \@interface, if the last ivar is a bitfield of any type, 13011 /// then add an implicit `char :0` ivar to the end of that interface. 13012 void Sema::ActOnLastBitfield(SourceLocation DeclLoc, 13013 SmallVectorImpl<Decl *> &AllIvarDecls) { 13014 if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile() || AllIvarDecls.empty()) 13015 return; 13016 13017 Decl *ivarDecl = AllIvarDecls[AllIvarDecls.size()-1]; 13018 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(ivarDecl); 13019 13020 if (!Ivar->isBitField() || Ivar->getBitWidthValue(Context) == 0) 13021 return; 13022 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CurContext); 13023 if (!ID) { 13024 if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CurContext)) { 13025 if (!CD->IsClassExtension()) 13026 return; 13027 } 13028 // No need to add this to end of @implementation. 13029 else 13030 return; 13031 } 13032 // All conditions are met. Add a new bitfield to the tail end of ivars. 13033 llvm::APInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), 0); 13034 Expr * BW = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, DeclLoc); 13035 13036 Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(Context, cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext), 13037 DeclLoc, DeclLoc, nullptr, 13038 Context.CharTy, 13039 Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(Context.CharTy, 13040 DeclLoc), 13041 ObjCIvarDecl::Private, BW, 13042 true); 13043 AllIvarDecls.push_back(Ivar); 13044 } 13045 13046 void Sema::ActOnFields(Scope *S, SourceLocation RecLoc, Decl *EnclosingDecl, 13047 ArrayRef<Decl *> Fields, SourceLocation LBrac, 13048 SourceLocation RBrac, AttributeList *Attr) { 13049 assert(EnclosingDecl && "missing record or interface decl"); 13050 13051 // If this is an Objective-C @implementation or category and we have 13052 // new fields here we should reset the layout of the interface since 13053 // it will now change. 13054 if (!Fields.empty() && isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 13055 ObjCContainerDecl *DC = cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl); 13056 switch (DC->getKind()) { 13057 default: break; 13058 case Decl::ObjCCategory: 13059 Context.ResetObjCLayout(cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(DC)->getClassInterface()); 13060 break; 13061 case Decl::ObjCImplementation: 13062 Context. 13063 ResetObjCLayout(cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(DC)->getClassInterface()); 13064 break; 13065 } 13066 } 13067 13068 RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(EnclosingDecl); 13069 13070 // Start counting up the number of named members; make sure to include 13071 // members of anonymous structs and unions in the total. 13072 unsigned NumNamedMembers = 0; 13073 if (Record) { 13074 for (const auto *I : Record->decls()) { 13075 if (const auto *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(I)) 13076 if (IFD->getDeclName()) 13077 ++NumNamedMembers; 13078 } 13079 } 13080 13081 // Verify that all the fields are okay. 13082 SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 32> RecFields; 13083 13084 bool ARCErrReported = false; 13085 for (ArrayRef<Decl *>::iterator i = Fields.begin(), end = Fields.end(); 13086 i != end; ++i) { 13087 FieldDecl *FD = cast<FieldDecl>(*i); 13088 13089 // Get the type for the field. 13090 const Type *FDTy = FD->getType().getTypePtr(); 13091 13092 if (!FD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) { 13093 // Remember all fields written by the user. 13094 RecFields.push_back(FD); 13095 } 13096 13097 // If the field is already invalid for some reason, don't emit more 13098 // diagnostics about it. 13099 if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) { 13100 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 13101 continue; 13102 } 13103 13104 // C99 6.7.2.1p2: 13105 // A structure or union shall not contain a member with 13106 // incomplete or function type (hence, a structure shall not 13107 // contain an instance of itself, but may contain a pointer to 13108 // an instance of itself), except that the last member of a 13109 // structure with more than one named member may have incomplete 13110 // array type; such a structure (and any union containing, 13111 // possibly recursively, a member that is such a structure) 13112 // shall not be a member of a structure or an element of an 13113 // array. 13114 if (FDTy->isFunctionType()) { 13115 // Field declared as a function. 13116 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_field_declared_as_function) 13117 << FD->getDeclName(); 13118 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 13119 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 13120 continue; 13121 } else if (FDTy->isIncompleteArrayType() && Record && 13122 ((i + 1 == Fields.end() && !Record->isUnion()) || 13123 ((getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt || 13124 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) && 13125 (i + 1 == Fields.end() || Record->isUnion())))) { 13126 // Flexible array member. 13127 // Microsoft and g++ is more permissive regarding flexible array. 13128 // It will accept flexible array in union and also 13129 // as the sole element of a struct/class. 13130 unsigned DiagID = 0; 13131 if (Record->isUnion()) 13132 DiagID = getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt 13133 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_union_ms 13134 : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 13135 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_union_gnu 13136 : diag::err_flexible_array_union; 13137 else if (Fields.size() == 1) 13138 DiagID = getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt 13139 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_empty_aggregate_ms 13140 : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 13141 ? diag::ext_flexible_array_empty_aggregate_gnu 13142 : NumNamedMembers < 1 13143 ? diag::err_flexible_array_empty_aggregate 13144 : 0; 13145 13146 if (DiagID) 13147 Diag(FD->getLocation(), DiagID) << FD->getDeclName() 13148 << Record->getTagKind(); 13149 // While the layout of types that contain virtual bases is not specified 13150 // by the C++ standard, both the Itanium and Microsoft C++ ABIs place 13151 // virtual bases after the derived members. This would make a flexible 13152 // array member declared at the end of an object not adjacent to the end 13153 // of the type. 13154 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record)) 13155 if (RD->getNumVBases() != 0) 13156 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_virtual_base) 13157 << FD->getDeclName() << Record->getTagKind(); 13158 if (!getLangOpts().C99) 13159 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_c99_flexible_array_member) 13160 << FD->getDeclName() << Record->getTagKind(); 13161 13162 // If the element type has a non-trivial destructor, we would not 13163 // implicitly destroy the elements, so disallow it for now. 13164 // 13165 // FIXME: GCC allows this. We should probably either implicitly delete 13166 // the destructor of the containing class, or just allow this. 13167 QualType BaseElem = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType()); 13168 if (!BaseElem->isDependentType() && BaseElem.isDestructedType()) { 13169 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_has_nontrivial_dtor) 13170 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType(); 13171 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 13172 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 13173 continue; 13174 } 13175 // Okay, we have a legal flexible array member at the end of the struct. 13176 Record->setHasFlexibleArrayMember(true); 13177 } else if (!FDTy->isDependentType() && 13178 RequireCompleteType(FD->getLocation(), FD->getType(), 13179 diag::err_field_incomplete)) { 13180 // Incomplete type 13181 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 13182 EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl(); 13183 continue; 13184 } else if (const RecordType *FDTTy = FDTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 13185 if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) { 13186 // A type which contains a flexible array member is considered to be a 13187 // flexible array member. 13188 Record->setHasFlexibleArrayMember(true); 13189 if (!Record->isUnion()) { 13190 // If this is a struct/class and this is not the last element, reject 13191 // it. Note that GCC supports variable sized arrays in the middle of 13192 // structures. 13193 if (i + 1 != Fields.end()) 13194 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_variable_sized_type_in_struct) 13195 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType(); 13196 else { 13197 // We support flexible arrays at the end of structs in 13198 // other structs as an extension. 13199 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_flexible_array_in_struct) 13200 << FD->getDeclName(); 13201 } 13202 } 13203 } 13204 if (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl) && 13205 RequireNonAbstractType(FD->getLocation(), FD->getType(), 13206 diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, 13207 AbstractIvarType)) { 13208 // Ivars can not have abstract class types 13209 FD->setInvalidDecl(); 13210 } 13211 if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasObjectMember()) 13212 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 13213 if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasVolatileMember()) 13214 Record->setHasVolatileMember(true); 13215 } else if (FDTy->isObjCObjectType()) { 13216 /// A field cannot be an Objective-c object 13217 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_statically_allocated_object) 13218 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FD->getLocation(), "*"); 13219 QualType T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(FD->getType()); 13220 FD->setType(T); 13221 } else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && Record && !ARCErrReported && 13222 (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || Record->isUnion())) { 13223 // It's an error in ARC if a field has lifetime. 13224 // We don't want to report this in a system header, though, 13225 // so we just make the field unavailable. 13226 // FIXME: that's really not sufficient; we need to make the type 13227 // itself invalid to, say, initialize or copy. 13228 QualType T = FD->getType(); 13229 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = T.getObjCLifetime(); 13230 if (lifetime && lifetime != Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone) { 13231 SourceLocation loc = FD->getLocation(); 13232 if (getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(loc)) { 13233 if (!FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) { 13234 FD->addAttr(UnavailableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, 13235 "this system field has retaining ownership", 13236 loc)); 13237 } 13238 } else { 13239 Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_arc_objc_object_in_tag) 13240 << T->isBlockPointerType() << Record->getTagKind(); 13241 } 13242 ARCErrReported = true; 13243 } 13244 } else if (getLangOpts().ObjC1 && 13245 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC && 13246 Record && !Record->hasObjectMember()) { 13247 if (FD->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 13248 FD->getType().isObjCGCStrong()) 13249 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 13250 else if (Context.getAsArrayType(FD->getType())) { 13251 QualType BaseType = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType()); 13252 if (BaseType->isRecordType() && 13253 BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->hasObjectMember()) 13254 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 13255 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 13256 BaseType.isObjCGCStrong()) 13257 Record->setHasObjectMember(true); 13258 } 13259 } 13260 if (Record && FD->getType().isVolatileQualified()) 13261 Record->setHasVolatileMember(true); 13262 // Keep track of the number of named members. 13263 if (FD->getIdentifier()) 13264 ++NumNamedMembers; 13265 } 13266 13267 // Okay, we successfully defined 'Record'. 13268 if (Record) { 13269 bool Completed = false; 13270 if (CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record)) { 13271 if (!CXXRecord->isInvalidDecl()) { 13272 // Set access bits correctly on the directly-declared conversions. 13273 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator 13274 I = CXXRecord->conversion_begin(), 13275 E = CXXRecord->conversion_end(); I != E; ++I) 13276 I.setAccess((*I)->getAccess()); 13277 13278 if (!CXXRecord->isDependentType()) { 13279 if (CXXRecord->hasUserDeclaredDestructor()) { 13280 // Adjust user-defined destructor exception spec. 13281 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 13282 AdjustDestructorExceptionSpec(CXXRecord, 13283 CXXRecord->getDestructor()); 13284 } 13285 13286 // Add any implicitly-declared members to this class. 13287 AddImplicitlyDeclaredMembersToClass(CXXRecord); 13288 13289 // If we have virtual base classes, we may end up finding multiple 13290 // final overriders for a given virtual function. Check for this 13291 // problem now. 13292 if (CXXRecord->getNumVBases()) { 13293 CXXFinalOverriderMap FinalOverriders; 13294 CXXRecord->getFinalOverriders(FinalOverriders); 13295 13296 for (CXXFinalOverriderMap::iterator M = FinalOverriders.begin(), 13297 MEnd = FinalOverriders.end(); 13298 M != MEnd; ++M) { 13299 for (OverridingMethods::iterator SO = M->second.begin(), 13300 SOEnd = M->second.end(); 13301 SO != SOEnd; ++SO) { 13302 assert(SO->second.size() > 0 && 13303 "Virtual function without overridding functions?"); 13304 if (SO->second.size() == 1) 13305 continue; 13306 13307 // C++ [class.virtual]p2: 13308 // In a derived class, if a virtual member function of a base 13309 // class subobject has more than one final overrider the 13310 // program is ill-formed. 13311 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_multiple_final_overriders) 13312 << (const NamedDecl *)M->first << Record; 13313 Diag(M->first->getLocation(), 13314 diag::note_overridden_virtual_function); 13315 for (OverridingMethods::overriding_iterator 13316 OM = SO->second.begin(), 13317 OMEnd = SO->second.end(); 13318 OM != OMEnd; ++OM) 13319 Diag(OM->Method->getLocation(), diag::note_final_overrider) 13320 << (const NamedDecl *)M->first << OM->Method->getParent(); 13321 13322 Record->setInvalidDecl(); 13323 } 13324 } 13325 CXXRecord->completeDefinition(&FinalOverriders); 13326 Completed = true; 13327 } 13328 } 13329 } 13330 } 13331 13332 if (!Completed) 13333 Record->completeDefinition(); 13334 13335 if (Record->hasAttrs()) { 13336 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(Record); 13337 13338 if (const MSInheritanceAttr *IA = Record->getAttr<MSInheritanceAttr>()) 13339 checkMSInheritanceAttrOnDefinition(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record), 13340 IA->getRange(), IA->getBestCase(), 13341 IA->getSemanticSpelling()); 13342 } 13343 13344 // Check if the structure/union declaration is a type that can have zero 13345 // size in C. For C this is a language extension, for C++ it may cause 13346 // compatibility problems. 13347 bool CheckForZeroSize; 13348 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 13349 CheckForZeroSize = true; 13350 } else { 13351 // For C++ filter out types that cannot be referenced in C code. 13352 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record); 13353 CheckForZeroSize = 13354 CXXRecord->getLexicalDeclContext()->isExternCContext() && 13355 !CXXRecord->isDependentType() && 13356 CXXRecord->isCLike(); 13357 } 13358 if (CheckForZeroSize) { 13359 bool ZeroSize = true; 13360 bool IsEmpty = true; 13361 unsigned NonBitFields = 0; 13362 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator I = Record->field_begin(), 13363 E = Record->field_end(); 13364 (NonBitFields == 0 || ZeroSize) && I != E; ++I) { 13365 IsEmpty = false; 13366 if (I->isUnnamedBitfield()) { 13367 if (I->getBitWidthValue(Context) > 0) 13368 ZeroSize = false; 13369 } else { 13370 ++NonBitFields; 13371 QualType FieldType = I->getType(); 13372 if (FieldType->isIncompleteType() || 13373 !Context.getTypeSizeInChars(FieldType).isZero()) 13374 ZeroSize = false; 13375 } 13376 } 13377 13378 // Empty structs are an extension in C (C99 6.7.2.1p7). They are 13379 // allowed in C++, but warn if its declaration is inside 13380 // extern "C" block. 13381 if (ZeroSize) { 13382 Diag(RecLoc, getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? 13383 diag::warn_zero_size_struct_union_in_extern_c : 13384 diag::warn_zero_size_struct_union_compat) 13385 << IsEmpty << Record->isUnion() << (NonBitFields > 1); 13386 } 13387 13388 // Structs without named members are extension in C (C99 6.7.2.1p7), 13389 // but are accepted by GCC. 13390 if (NonBitFields == 0 && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 13391 Diag(RecLoc, IsEmpty ? diag::ext_empty_struct_union : 13392 diag::ext_no_named_members_in_struct_union) 13393 << Record->isUnion(); 13394 } 13395 } 13396 } else { 13397 ObjCIvarDecl **ClsFields = 13398 reinterpret_cast<ObjCIvarDecl**>(RecFields.data()); 13399 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 13400 ID->setEndOfDefinitionLoc(RBrac); 13401 // Add ivar's to class's DeclContext. 13402 for (unsigned i = 0, e = RecFields.size(); i != e; ++i) { 13403 ClsFields[i]->setLexicalDeclContext(ID); 13404 ID->addDecl(ClsFields[i]); 13405 } 13406 // Must enforce the rule that ivars in the base classes may not be 13407 // duplicates. 13408 if (ID->getSuperClass()) 13409 DiagnoseDuplicateIvars(ID, ID->getSuperClass()); 13410 } else if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPDecl = 13411 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 13412 assert(IMPDecl && "ActOnFields - missing ObjCImplementationDecl"); 13413 for (unsigned I = 0, N = RecFields.size(); I != N; ++I) 13414 // Ivar declared in @implementation never belongs to the implementation. 13415 // Only it is in implementation's lexical context. 13416 ClsFields[I]->setLexicalDeclContext(IMPDecl); 13417 CheckImplementationIvars(IMPDecl, ClsFields, RecFields.size(), RBrac); 13418 IMPDecl->setIvarLBraceLoc(LBrac); 13419 IMPDecl->setIvarRBraceLoc(RBrac); 13420 } else if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl = 13421 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) { 13422 // case of ivars in class extension; all other cases have been 13423 // reported as errors elsewhere. 13424 // FIXME. Class extension does not have a LocEnd field. 13425 // CDecl->setLocEnd(RBrac); 13426 // Add ivar's to class extension's DeclContext. 13427 // Diagnose redeclaration of private ivars. 13428 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CDecl->getClassInterface(); 13429 for (unsigned i = 0, e = RecFields.size(); i != e; ++i) { 13430 if (IDecl) { 13431 if (const ObjCIvarDecl *ClsIvar = 13432 IDecl->getIvarDecl(ClsFields[i]->getIdentifier())) { 13433 Diag(ClsFields[i]->getLocation(), 13434 diag::err_duplicate_ivar_declaration); 13435 Diag(ClsIvar->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 13436 continue; 13437 } 13438 for (const auto *Ext : IDecl->known_extensions()) { 13439 if (const ObjCIvarDecl *ClsExtIvar 13440 = Ext->getIvarDecl(ClsFields[i]->getIdentifier())) { 13441 Diag(ClsFields[i]->getLocation(), 13442 diag::err_duplicate_ivar_declaration); 13443 Diag(ClsExtIvar->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 13444 continue; 13445 } 13446 } 13447 } 13448 ClsFields[i]->setLexicalDeclContext(CDecl); 13449 CDecl->addDecl(ClsFields[i]); 13450 } 13451 CDecl->setIvarLBraceLoc(LBrac); 13452 CDecl->setIvarRBraceLoc(RBrac); 13453 } 13454 } 13455 13456 if (Attr) 13457 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, Record, Attr); 13458 } 13459 13460 /// \brief Determine whether the given integral value is representable within 13461 /// the given type T. 13462 static bool isRepresentableIntegerValue(ASTContext &Context, 13463 llvm::APSInt &Value, 13464 QualType T) { 13465 assert(T->isIntegralType(Context) && "Integral type required!"); 13466 unsigned BitWidth = Context.getIntWidth(T); 13467 13468 if (Value.isUnsigned() || Value.isNonNegative()) { 13469 if (T->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()) 13470 --BitWidth; 13471 return Value.getActiveBits() <= BitWidth; 13472 } 13473 return Value.getMinSignedBits() <= BitWidth; 13474 } 13475 13476 // \brief Given an integral type, return the next larger integral type 13477 // (or a NULL type of no such type exists). 13478 static QualType getNextLargerIntegralType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T) { 13479 // FIXME: Int128/UInt128 support, which also needs to be introduced into 13480 // enum checking below. 13481 assert(T->isIntegralType(Context) && "Integral type required!"); 13482 const unsigned NumTypes = 4; 13483 QualType SignedIntegralTypes[NumTypes] = { 13484 Context.ShortTy, Context.IntTy, Context.LongTy, Context.LongLongTy 13485 }; 13486 QualType UnsignedIntegralTypes[NumTypes] = { 13487 Context.UnsignedShortTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy, 13488 Context.UnsignedLongLongTy 13489 }; 13490 13491 unsigned BitWidth = Context.getTypeSize(T); 13492 QualType *Types = T->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()? SignedIntegralTypes 13493 : UnsignedIntegralTypes; 13494 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumTypes; ++I) 13495 if (Context.getTypeSize(Types[I]) > BitWidth) 13496 return Types[I]; 13497 13498 return QualType(); 13499 } 13500 13501 EnumConstantDecl *Sema::CheckEnumConstant(EnumDecl *Enum, 13502 EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst, 13503 SourceLocation IdLoc, 13504 IdentifierInfo *Id, 13505 Expr *Val) { 13506 unsigned IntWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 13507 llvm::APSInt EnumVal(IntWidth); 13508 QualType EltTy; 13509 13510 if (Val && DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(Val, UPPC_EnumeratorValue)) 13511 Val = nullptr; 13512 13513 if (Val) 13514 Val = DefaultLvalueConversion(Val).get(); 13515 13516 if (Val) { 13517 if (Enum->isDependentType() || Val->isTypeDependent()) 13518 EltTy = Context.DependentTy; 13519 else { 13520 SourceLocation ExpLoc; 13521 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && Enum->isFixed() && 13522 !getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) { 13523 // C++11 [dcl.enum]p5: If the underlying type is fixed, [...] the 13524 // constant-expression in the enumerator-definition shall be a converted 13525 // constant expression of the underlying type. 13526 EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType(); 13527 ExprResult Converted = 13528 CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Val, EltTy, EnumVal, 13529 CCEK_Enumerator); 13530 if (Converted.isInvalid()) 13531 Val = nullptr; 13532 else 13533 Val = Converted.get(); 13534 } else if (!Val->isValueDependent() && 13535 !(Val = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Val, 13536 &EnumVal).get())) { 13537 // C99 6.7.2.2p2: Make sure we have an integer constant expression. 13538 } else { 13539 if (Enum->isFixed()) { 13540 EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType(); 13541 13542 // In Obj-C and Microsoft mode, require the enumeration value to be 13543 // representable in the underlying type of the enumeration. In C++11, 13544 // we perform a non-narrowing conversion as part of converted constant 13545 // expression checking. 13546 if (!isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, EltTy)) { 13547 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) { 13548 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enumerator_too_large) << EltTy; 13549 Val = ImpCastExprToType(Val, EltTy, CK_IntegralCast).get(); 13550 } else 13551 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_enumerator_too_large) << EltTy; 13552 } else 13553 Val = ImpCastExprToType(Val, EltTy, CK_IntegralCast).get(); 13554 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 13555 // C++11 [dcl.enum]p5: 13556 // If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator 13557 // is the type of its initializing value: 13558 // - If an initializer is specified for an enumerator, the 13559 // initializing value has the same type as the expression. 13560 EltTy = Val->getType(); 13561 } else { 13562 // C99 6.7.2.2p2: 13563 // The expression that defines the value of an enumeration constant 13564 // shall be an integer constant expression that has a value 13565 // representable as an int. 13566 13567 // Complain if the value is not representable in an int. 13568 if (!isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, Context.IntTy)) 13569 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enum_value_not_int) 13570 << EnumVal.toString(10) << Val->getSourceRange() 13571 << (EnumVal.isUnsigned() || EnumVal.isNonNegative()); 13572 else if (!Context.hasSameType(Val->getType(), Context.IntTy)) { 13573 // Force the type of the expression to 'int'. 13574 Val = ImpCastExprToType(Val, Context.IntTy, CK_IntegralCast).get(); 13575 } 13576 EltTy = Val->getType(); 13577 } 13578 } 13579 } 13580 } 13581 13582 if (!Val) { 13583 if (Enum->isDependentType()) 13584 EltTy = Context.DependentTy; 13585 else if (!LastEnumConst) { 13586 // C++0x [dcl.enum]p5: 13587 // If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator 13588 // is the type of its initializing value: 13589 // - If no initializer is specified for the first enumerator, the 13590 // initializing value has an unspecified integral type. 13591 // 13592 // GCC uses 'int' for its unspecified integral type, as does 13593 // C99 6.7.2.2p3. 13594 if (Enum->isFixed()) { 13595 EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType(); 13596 } 13597 else { 13598 EltTy = Context.IntTy; 13599 } 13600 } else { 13601 // Assign the last value + 1. 13602 EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal(); 13603 ++EnumVal; 13604 EltTy = LastEnumConst->getType(); 13605 13606 // Check for overflow on increment. 13607 if (EnumVal < LastEnumConst->getInitVal()) { 13608 // C++0x [dcl.enum]p5: 13609 // If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator 13610 // is the type of its initializing value: 13611 // 13612 // - Otherwise the type of the initializing value is the same as 13613 // the type of the initializing value of the preceding enumerator 13614 // unless the incremented value is not representable in that type, 13615 // in which case the type is an unspecified integral type 13616 // sufficient to contain the incremented value. If no such type 13617 // exists, the program is ill-formed. 13618 QualType T = getNextLargerIntegralType(Context, EltTy); 13619 if (T.isNull() || Enum->isFixed()) { 13620 // There is no integral type larger enough to represent this 13621 // value. Complain, then allow the value to wrap around. 13622 EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal(); 13623 EnumVal = EnumVal.zext(EnumVal.getBitWidth() * 2); 13624 ++EnumVal; 13625 if (Enum->isFixed()) 13626 // When the underlying type is fixed, this is ill-formed. 13627 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_enumerator_wrapped) 13628 << EnumVal.toString(10) 13629 << EltTy; 13630 else 13631 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enumerator_increment_too_large) 13632 << EnumVal.toString(10); 13633 } else { 13634 EltTy = T; 13635 } 13636 13637 // Retrieve the last enumerator's value, extent that type to the 13638 // type that is supposed to be large enough to represent the incremented 13639 // value, then increment. 13640 EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal(); 13641 EnumVal.setIsSigned(EltTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()); 13642 EnumVal = EnumVal.zextOrTrunc(Context.getIntWidth(EltTy)); 13643 ++EnumVal; 13644 13645 // If we're not in C++, diagnose the overflow of enumerator values, 13646 // which in C99 means that the enumerator value is not representable in 13647 // an int (C99 6.7.2.2p2). However, we support GCC's extension that 13648 // permits enumerator values that are representable in some larger 13649 // integral type. 13650 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !T.isNull()) 13651 Diag(IdLoc, diag::warn_enum_value_overflow); 13652 } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 13653 !isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, EltTy)) { 13654 // Enforce C99 6.7.2.2p2 even when we compute the next value. 13655 Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enum_value_not_int) 13656 << EnumVal.toString(10) << 1; 13657 } 13658 } 13659 } 13660 13661 if (!EltTy->isDependentType()) { 13662 // Make the enumerator value match the signedness and size of the 13663 // enumerator's type. 13664 EnumVal = EnumVal.extOrTrunc(Context.getIntWidth(EltTy)); 13665 EnumVal.setIsSigned(EltTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()); 13666 } 13667 13668 return EnumConstantDecl::Create(Context, Enum, IdLoc, Id, EltTy, 13669 Val, EnumVal); 13670 } 13671 13672 Sema::SkipBodyInfo Sema::shouldSkipAnonEnumBody(Scope *S, IdentifierInfo *II, 13673 SourceLocation IILoc) { 13674 if (!(getLangOpts().Modules || getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) || 13675 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 13676 return SkipBodyInfo(); 13677 13678 // We have an anonymous enum definition. Look up the first enumerator to 13679 // determine if we should merge the definition with an existing one and 13680 // skip the body. 13681 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(S, II, IILoc, LookupOrdinaryName, 13682 ForRedeclaration); 13683 auto *PrevECD = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(PrevDecl); 13684 NamedDecl *Hidden; 13685 if (PrevECD && 13686 !hasVisibleDefinition(cast<NamedDecl>(PrevECD->getDeclContext()), 13687 &Hidden)) { 13688 SkipBodyInfo Skip; 13689 Skip.Previous = Hidden; 13690 return Skip; 13691 } 13692 13693 return SkipBodyInfo(); 13694 } 13695 13696 Decl *Sema::ActOnEnumConstant(Scope *S, Decl *theEnumDecl, Decl *lastEnumConst, 13697 SourceLocation IdLoc, IdentifierInfo *Id, 13698 AttributeList *Attr, 13699 SourceLocation EqualLoc, Expr *Val) { 13700 EnumDecl *TheEnumDecl = cast<EnumDecl>(theEnumDecl); 13701 EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst = 13702 cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(lastEnumConst); 13703 13704 // The scope passed in may not be a decl scope. Zip up the scope tree until 13705 // we find one that is. 13706 S = getNonFieldDeclScope(S); 13707 13708 // Verify that there isn't already something declared with this name in this 13709 // scope. 13710 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(S, Id, IdLoc, LookupOrdinaryName, 13711 ForRedeclaration); 13712 if (PrevDecl && PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) { 13713 // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter. 13714 DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(IdLoc, PrevDecl); 13715 // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration. 13716 PrevDecl = nullptr; 13717 } 13718 13719 if (PrevDecl) { 13720 // When in C++, we may get a TagDecl with the same name; in this case the 13721 // enum constant will 'hide' the tag. 13722 assert((getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) && 13723 "Received TagDecl when not in C++!"); 13724 if (!isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl) && isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, CurContext, S)) { 13725 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(PrevDecl)) 13726 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_redefinition_of_enumerator) << Id; 13727 else 13728 Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_redefinition) << Id; 13729 Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition); 13730 return nullptr; 13731 } 13732 } 13733 13734 // C++ [class.mem]p15: 13735 // If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a name 13736 // different from T: 13737 // - every enumerator of every member of class T that is an unscoped 13738 // enumerated type 13739 if (!TheEnumDecl->isScoped()) 13740 DiagnoseClassNameShadow(TheEnumDecl->getDeclContext(), 13741 DeclarationNameInfo(Id, IdLoc)); 13742 13743 EnumConstantDecl *New = 13744 CheckEnumConstant(TheEnumDecl, LastEnumConst, IdLoc, Id, Val); 13745 13746 if (New) { 13747 // Process attributes. 13748 if (Attr) ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, New, Attr); 13749 13750 // Register this decl in the current scope stack. 13751 New->setAccess(TheEnumDecl->getAccess()); 13752 PushOnScopeChains(New, S); 13753 } 13754 13755 ActOnDocumentableDecl(New); 13756 13757 return New; 13758 } 13759 13760 // Returns true when the enum initial expression does not trigger the 13761 // duplicate enum warning. A few common cases are exempted as follows: 13762 // Element2 = Element1 13763 // Element2 = Element1 + 1 13764 // Element2 = Element1 - 1 13765 // Where Element2 and Element1 are from the same enum. 13766 static bool ValidDuplicateEnum(EnumConstantDecl *ECD, EnumDecl *Enum) { 13767 Expr *InitExpr = ECD->getInitExpr(); 13768 if (!InitExpr) 13769 return true; 13770 InitExpr = InitExpr->IgnoreImpCasts(); 13771 13772 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(InitExpr)) { 13773 if (!BO->isAdditiveOp()) 13774 return true; 13775 IntegerLiteral *IL = dyn_cast<IntegerLiteral>(BO->getRHS()); 13776 if (!IL) 13777 return true; 13778 if (IL->getValue() != 1) 13779 return true; 13780 13781 InitExpr = BO->getLHS(); 13782 } 13783 13784 // This checks if the elements are from the same enum. 13785 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(InitExpr); 13786 if (!DRE) 13787 return true; 13788 13789 EnumConstantDecl *EnumConstant = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 13790 if (!EnumConstant) 13791 return true; 13792 13793 if (cast<EnumDecl>(TagDecl::castFromDeclContext(ECD->getDeclContext())) != 13794 Enum) 13795 return true; 13796 13797 return false; 13798 } 13799 13800 struct DupKey { 13801 int64_t val; 13802 bool isTombstoneOrEmptyKey; 13803 DupKey(int64_t val, bool isTombstoneOrEmptyKey) 13804 : val(val), isTombstoneOrEmptyKey(isTombstoneOrEmptyKey) {} 13805 }; 13806 13807 static DupKey GetDupKey(const llvm::APSInt& Val) { 13808 return DupKey(Val.isSigned() ? Val.getSExtValue() : Val.getZExtValue(), 13809 false); 13810 } 13811 13812 struct DenseMapInfoDupKey { 13813 static DupKey getEmptyKey() { return DupKey(0, true); } 13814 static DupKey getTombstoneKey() { return DupKey(1, true); } 13815 static unsigned getHashValue(const DupKey Key) { 13816 return (unsigned)(Key.val * 37); 13817 } 13818 static bool isEqual(const DupKey& LHS, const DupKey& RHS) { 13819 return LHS.isTombstoneOrEmptyKey == RHS.isTombstoneOrEmptyKey && 13820 LHS.val == RHS.val; 13821 } 13822 }; 13823 13824 // Emits a warning when an element is implicitly set a value that 13825 // a previous element has already been set to. 13826 static void CheckForDuplicateEnumValues(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Decl *> Elements, 13827 EnumDecl *Enum, 13828 QualType EnumType) { 13829 if (S.Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_duplicate_enum_values, Enum->getLocation())) 13830 return; 13831 // Avoid anonymous enums 13832 if (!Enum->getIdentifier()) 13833 return; 13834 13835 // Only check for small enums. 13836 if (Enum->getNumPositiveBits() > 63 || Enum->getNumNegativeBits() > 64) 13837 return; 13838 13839 typedef SmallVector<EnumConstantDecl *, 3> ECDVector; 13840 typedef SmallVector<ECDVector *, 3> DuplicatesVector; 13841 13842 typedef llvm::PointerUnion<EnumConstantDecl*, ECDVector*> DeclOrVector; 13843 typedef llvm::DenseMap<DupKey, DeclOrVector, DenseMapInfoDupKey> 13844 ValueToVectorMap; 13845 13846 DuplicatesVector DupVector; 13847 ValueToVectorMap EnumMap; 13848 13849 // Populate the EnumMap with all values represented by enum constants without 13850 // an initialier. 13851 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) { 13852 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]); 13853 13854 // Null EnumConstantDecl means a previous diagnostic has been emitted for 13855 // this constant. Skip this enum since it may be ill-formed. 13856 if (!ECD) { 13857 return; 13858 } 13859 13860 if (ECD->getInitExpr()) 13861 continue; 13862 13863 DupKey Key = GetDupKey(ECD->getInitVal()); 13864 DeclOrVector &Entry = EnumMap[Key]; 13865 13866 // First time encountering this value. 13867 if (Entry.isNull()) 13868 Entry = ECD; 13869 } 13870 13871 // Create vectors for any values that has duplicates. 13872 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) { 13873 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]); 13874 if (!ValidDuplicateEnum(ECD, Enum)) 13875 continue; 13876 13877 DupKey Key = GetDupKey(ECD->getInitVal()); 13878 13879 DeclOrVector& Entry = EnumMap[Key]; 13880 if (Entry.isNull()) 13881 continue; 13882 13883 if (EnumConstantDecl *D = Entry.dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl*>()) { 13884 // Ensure constants are different. 13885 if (D == ECD) 13886 continue; 13887 13888 // Create new vector and push values onto it. 13889 ECDVector *Vec = new ECDVector(); 13890 Vec->push_back(D); 13891 Vec->push_back(ECD); 13892 13893 // Update entry to point to the duplicates vector. 13894 Entry = Vec; 13895 13896 // Store the vector somewhere we can consult later for quick emission of 13897 // diagnostics. 13898 DupVector.push_back(Vec); 13899 continue; 13900 } 13901 13902 ECDVector *Vec = Entry.get<ECDVector*>(); 13903 // Make sure constants are not added more than once. 13904 if (*Vec->begin() == ECD) 13905 continue; 13906 13907 Vec->push_back(ECD); 13908 } 13909 13910 // Emit diagnostics. 13911 for (DuplicatesVector::iterator DupVectorIter = DupVector.begin(), 13912 DupVectorEnd = DupVector.end(); 13913 DupVectorIter != DupVectorEnd; ++DupVectorIter) { 13914 ECDVector *Vec = *DupVectorIter; 13915 assert(Vec->size() > 1 && "ECDVector should have at least 2 elements."); 13916 13917 // Emit warning for one enum constant. 13918 ECDVector::iterator I = Vec->begin(); 13919 S.Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::warn_duplicate_enum_values) 13920 << (*I)->getName() << (*I)->getInitVal().toString(10) 13921 << (*I)->getSourceRange(); 13922 ++I; 13923 13924 // Emit one note for each of the remaining enum constants with 13925 // the same value. 13926 for (ECDVector::iterator E = Vec->end(); I != E; ++I) 13927 S.Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_duplicate_element) 13928 << (*I)->getName() << (*I)->getInitVal().toString(10) 13929 << (*I)->getSourceRange(); 13930 delete Vec; 13931 } 13932 } 13933 13934 bool 13935 Sema::IsValueInFlagEnum(const EnumDecl *ED, const llvm::APInt &Val, 13936 bool AllowMask) const { 13937 FlagEnumAttr *FEAttr = ED->getAttr<FlagEnumAttr>(); 13938 assert(FEAttr && "looking for value in non-flag enum"); 13939 13940 llvm::APInt FlagMask = ~FEAttr->getFlagBits(); 13941 unsigned Width = FlagMask.getBitWidth(); 13942 13943 // We will try a zero-extended value for the regular check first. 13944 llvm::APInt ExtVal = Val.zextOrSelf(Width); 13945 13946 // A value is in a flag enum if either its bits are a subset of the enum's 13947 // flag bits (the first condition) or we are allowing masks and the same is 13948 // true of its complement (the second condition). When masks are allowed, we 13949 // allow the common idiom of ~(enum1 | enum2) to be a valid enum value. 13950 // 13951 // While it's true that any value could be used as a mask, the assumption is 13952 // that a mask will have all of the insignificant bits set. Anything else is 13953 // likely a logic error. 13954 if (!(FlagMask & ExtVal)) 13955 return true; 13956 13957 if (AllowMask) { 13958 // Try a one-extended value instead. This can happen if the enum is wider 13959 // than the constant used, in C with extensions to allow for wider enums. 13960 // The mask will still have the correct behaviour, so we give the user the 13961 // benefit of the doubt. 13962 // 13963 // FIXME: This heuristic can cause weird results if the enum was extended 13964 // to a larger type and is signed, because then bit-masks of smaller types 13965 // that get extended will fall out of range (e.g. ~0x1u). We currently don't 13966 // detect that case and will get a false positive for it. In most cases, 13967 // though, it can be fixed by making it a signed type (e.g. ~0x1), so it may 13968 // be fine just to accept this as a warning. 13969 ExtVal |= llvm::APInt::getHighBitsSet(Width, Width - Val.getBitWidth()); 13970 if (!(FlagMask & ~ExtVal)) 13971 return true; 13972 } 13973 13974 return false; 13975 } 13976 13977 void Sema::ActOnEnumBody(SourceLocation EnumLoc, SourceLocation LBraceLoc, 13978 SourceLocation RBraceLoc, Decl *EnumDeclX, 13979 ArrayRef<Decl *> Elements, 13980 Scope *S, AttributeList *Attr) { 13981 EnumDecl *Enum = cast<EnumDecl>(EnumDeclX); 13982 QualType EnumType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Enum); 13983 13984 if (Attr) 13985 ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, Enum, Attr); 13986 13987 if (Enum->isDependentType()) { 13988 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) { 13989 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = 13990 cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]); 13991 if (!ECD) continue; 13992 13993 ECD->setType(EnumType); 13994 } 13995 13996 Enum->completeDefinition(Context.DependentTy, Context.DependentTy, 0, 0); 13997 return; 13998 } 13999 14000 // TODO: If the result value doesn't fit in an int, it must be a long or long 14001 // long value. ISO C does not support this, but GCC does as an extension, 14002 // emit a warning. 14003 unsigned IntWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 14004 unsigned CharWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getCharWidth(); 14005 unsigned ShortWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getShortWidth(); 14006 14007 // Verify that all the values are okay, compute the size of the values, and 14008 // reverse the list. 14009 unsigned NumNegativeBits = 0; 14010 unsigned NumPositiveBits = 0; 14011 14012 // Keep track of whether all elements have type int. 14013 bool AllElementsInt = true; 14014 14015 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) { 14016 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = 14017 cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]); 14018 if (!ECD) continue; // Already issued a diagnostic. 14019 14020 const llvm::APSInt &InitVal = ECD->getInitVal(); 14021 14022 // Keep track of the size of positive and negative values. 14023 if (InitVal.isUnsigned() || InitVal.isNonNegative()) 14024 NumPositiveBits = std::max(NumPositiveBits, 14025 (unsigned)InitVal.getActiveBits()); 14026 else 14027 NumNegativeBits = std::max(NumNegativeBits, 14028 (unsigned)InitVal.getMinSignedBits()); 14029 14030 // Keep track of whether every enum element has type int (very commmon). 14031 if (AllElementsInt) 14032 AllElementsInt = ECD->getType() == Context.IntTy; 14033 } 14034 14035 // Figure out the type that should be used for this enum. 14036 QualType BestType; 14037 unsigned BestWidth; 14038 14039 // C++0x N3000 [conv.prom]p3: 14040 // An rvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying 14041 // type is not fixed can be converted to an rvalue of the first 14042 // of the following types that can represent all the values of 14043 // the enumeration: int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long 14044 // int, long long int, or unsigned long long int. 14045 // C99 6.4.4.3p2: 14046 // An identifier declared as an enumeration constant has type int. 14047 // The C99 rule is modified by a gcc extension 14048 QualType BestPromotionType; 14049 14050 bool Packed = Enum->hasAttr<PackedAttr>(); 14051 // -fshort-enums is the equivalent to specifying the packed attribute on all 14052 // enum definitions. 14053 if (LangOpts.ShortEnums) 14054 Packed = true; 14055 14056 if (Enum->isFixed()) { 14057 BestType = Enum->getIntegerType(); 14058 if (BestType->isPromotableIntegerType()) 14059 BestPromotionType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(BestType); 14060 else 14061 BestPromotionType = BestType; 14062 14063 BestWidth = Context.getIntWidth(BestType); 14064 } 14065 else if (NumNegativeBits) { 14066 // If there is a negative value, figure out the smallest integer type (of 14067 // int/long/longlong) that fits. 14068 // If it's packed, check also if it fits a char or a short. 14069 if (Packed && NumNegativeBits <= CharWidth && NumPositiveBits < CharWidth) { 14070 BestType = Context.SignedCharTy; 14071 BestWidth = CharWidth; 14072 } else if (Packed && NumNegativeBits <= ShortWidth && 14073 NumPositiveBits < ShortWidth) { 14074 BestType = Context.ShortTy; 14075 BestWidth = ShortWidth; 14076 } else if (NumNegativeBits <= IntWidth && NumPositiveBits < IntWidth) { 14077 BestType = Context.IntTy; 14078 BestWidth = IntWidth; 14079 } else { 14080 BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth(); 14081 14082 if (NumNegativeBits <= BestWidth && NumPositiveBits < BestWidth) { 14083 BestType = Context.LongTy; 14084 } else { 14085 BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 14086 14087 if (NumNegativeBits > BestWidth || NumPositiveBits >= BestWidth) 14088 Diag(Enum->getLocation(), diag::ext_enum_too_large); 14089 BestType = Context.LongLongTy; 14090 } 14091 } 14092 BestPromotionType = (BestWidth <= IntWidth ? Context.IntTy : BestType); 14093 } else { 14094 // If there is no negative value, figure out the smallest type that fits 14095 // all of the enumerator values. 14096 // If it's packed, check also if it fits a char or a short. 14097 if (Packed && NumPositiveBits <= CharWidth) { 14098 BestType = Context.UnsignedCharTy; 14099 BestPromotionType = Context.IntTy; 14100 BestWidth = CharWidth; 14101 } else if (Packed && NumPositiveBits <= ShortWidth) { 14102 BestType = Context.UnsignedShortTy; 14103 BestPromotionType = Context.IntTy; 14104 BestWidth = ShortWidth; 14105 } else if (NumPositiveBits <= IntWidth) { 14106 BestType = Context.UnsignedIntTy; 14107 BestWidth = IntWidth; 14108 BestPromotionType 14109 = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 14110 ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy; 14111 } else if (NumPositiveBits <= 14112 (BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth())) { 14113 BestType = Context.UnsignedLongTy; 14114 BestPromotionType 14115 = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 14116 ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy; 14117 } else { 14118 BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 14119 assert(NumPositiveBits <= BestWidth && 14120 "How could an initializer get larger than ULL?"); 14121 BestType = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 14122 BestPromotionType 14123 = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 14124 ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy; 14125 } 14126 } 14127 14128 FlagEnumAttr *FEAttr = Enum->getAttr<FlagEnumAttr>(); 14129 if (FEAttr) 14130 FEAttr->getFlagBits() = llvm::APInt(BestWidth, 0); 14131 14132 // Loop over all of the enumerator constants, changing their types to match 14133 // the type of the enum if needed. If we have a flag type, we also prepare the 14134 // FlagBits cache. 14135 for (auto *D : Elements) { 14136 auto *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(D); 14137 if (!ECD) continue; // Already issued a diagnostic. 14138 14139 // Standard C says the enumerators have int type, but we allow, as an 14140 // extension, the enumerators to be larger than int size. If each 14141 // enumerator value fits in an int, type it as an int, otherwise type it the 14142 // same as the enumerator decl itself. This means that in "enum { X = 1U }" 14143 // that X has type 'int', not 'unsigned'. 14144 14145 // Determine whether the value fits into an int. 14146 llvm::APSInt InitVal = ECD->getInitVal(); 14147 14148 // If it fits into an integer type, force it. Otherwise force it to match 14149 // the enum decl type. 14150 QualType NewTy; 14151 unsigned NewWidth; 14152 bool NewSign; 14153 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 14154 !Enum->isFixed() && 14155 isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, InitVal, Context.IntTy)) { 14156 NewTy = Context.IntTy; 14157 NewWidth = IntWidth; 14158 NewSign = true; 14159 } else if (ECD->getType() == BestType) { 14160 // Already the right type! 14161 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 14162 // C++ [dcl.enum]p4: Following the closing brace of an 14163 // enum-specifier, each enumerator has the type of its 14164 // enumeration. 14165 ECD->setType(EnumType); 14166 goto flagbits; 14167 } else { 14168 NewTy = BestType; 14169 NewWidth = BestWidth; 14170 NewSign = BestType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 14171 } 14172 14173 // Adjust the APSInt value. 14174 InitVal = InitVal.extOrTrunc(NewWidth); 14175 InitVal.setIsSigned(NewSign); 14176 ECD->setInitVal(InitVal); 14177 14178 // Adjust the Expr initializer and type. 14179 if (ECD->getInitExpr() && 14180 !Context.hasSameType(NewTy, ECD->getInitExpr()->getType())) 14181 ECD->setInitExpr(ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, NewTy, 14182 CK_IntegralCast, 14183 ECD->getInitExpr(), 14184 /*base paths*/ nullptr, 14185 VK_RValue)); 14186 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 14187 // C++ [dcl.enum]p4: Following the closing brace of an 14188 // enum-specifier, each enumerator has the type of its 14189 // enumeration. 14190 ECD->setType(EnumType); 14191 else 14192 ECD->setType(NewTy); 14193 14194 flagbits: 14195 // Check to see if we have a constant with exactly one bit set. Note that x 14196 // & (x - 1) will be nonzero if and only if x has more than one bit set. 14197 if (FEAttr) { 14198 llvm::APInt ExtVal = InitVal.zextOrSelf(BestWidth); 14199 if (ExtVal != 0 && !(ExtVal & (ExtVal - 1))) { 14200 FEAttr->getFlagBits() |= ExtVal; 14201 } 14202 } 14203 } 14204 14205 if (FEAttr) { 14206 for (Decl *D : Elements) { 14207 EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(D); 14208 if (!ECD) continue; // Already issued a diagnostic. 14209 14210 llvm::APSInt InitVal = ECD->getInitVal(); 14211 if (InitVal != 0 && !IsValueInFlagEnum(Enum, InitVal, true)) 14212 Diag(ECD->getLocation(), diag::warn_flag_enum_constant_out_of_range) 14213 << ECD << Enum; 14214 } 14215 } 14216 14217 14218 14219 Enum->completeDefinition(BestType, BestPromotionType, 14220 NumPositiveBits, NumNegativeBits); 14221 14222 CheckForDuplicateEnumValues(*this, Elements, Enum, EnumType); 14223 14224 // Now that the enum type is defined, ensure it's not been underaligned. 14225 if (Enum->hasAttrs()) 14226 CheckAlignasUnderalignment(Enum); 14227 } 14228 14229 Decl *Sema::ActOnFileScopeAsmDecl(Expr *expr, 14230 SourceLocation StartLoc, 14231 SourceLocation EndLoc) { 14232 StringLiteral *AsmString = cast<StringLiteral>(expr); 14233 14234 FileScopeAsmDecl *New = FileScopeAsmDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, 14235 AsmString, StartLoc, 14236 EndLoc); 14237 CurContext->addDecl(New); 14238 return New; 14239 } 14240 14241 static void checkModuleImportContext(Sema &S, Module *M, 14242 SourceLocation ImportLoc, 14243 DeclContext *DC) { 14244 if (auto *LSD = dyn_cast<LinkageSpecDecl>(DC)) { 14245 switch (LSD->getLanguage()) { 14246 case LinkageSpecDecl::lang_c: 14247 if (!M->IsExternC) { 14248 S.Diag(ImportLoc, diag::err_module_import_in_extern_c) 14249 << M->getFullModuleName(); 14250 S.Diag(LSD->getLocStart(), diag::note_module_import_in_extern_c); 14251 return; 14252 } 14253 break; 14254 case LinkageSpecDecl::lang_cxx: 14255 break; 14256 } 14257 DC = LSD->getParent(); 14258 } 14259 14260 while (isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(DC)) 14261 DC = DC->getParent(); 14262 if (!isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(DC)) { 14263 S.Diag(ImportLoc, diag::err_module_import_not_at_top_level) 14264 << M->getFullModuleName() << DC; 14265 S.Diag(cast<Decl>(DC)->getLocStart(), 14266 diag::note_module_import_not_at_top_level) 14267 << DC; 14268 } 14269 } 14270 14271 DeclResult Sema::ActOnModuleImport(SourceLocation AtLoc, 14272 SourceLocation ImportLoc, 14273 ModuleIdPath Path) { 14274 Module *Mod = 14275 getModuleLoader().loadModule(ImportLoc, Path, Module::AllVisible, 14276 /*IsIncludeDirective=*/false); 14277 if (!Mod) 14278 return true; 14279 14280 VisibleModules.setVisible(Mod, ImportLoc); 14281 14282 checkModuleImportContext(*this, Mod, ImportLoc, CurContext); 14283 14284 // FIXME: we should support importing a submodule within a different submodule 14285 // of the same top-level module. Until we do, make it an error rather than 14286 // silently ignoring the import. 14287 if (Mod->getTopLevelModuleName() == getLangOpts().CurrentModule) 14288 Diag(ImportLoc, diag::err_module_self_import) 14289 << Mod->getFullModuleName() << getLangOpts().CurrentModule; 14290 else if (Mod->getTopLevelModuleName() == getLangOpts().ImplementationOfModule) 14291 Diag(ImportLoc, diag::err_module_import_in_implementation) 14292 << Mod->getFullModuleName() << getLangOpts().ImplementationOfModule; 14293 14294 SmallVector<SourceLocation, 2> IdentifierLocs; 14295 Module *ModCheck = Mod; 14296 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Path.size(); I != N; ++I) { 14297 // If we've run out of module parents, just drop the remaining identifiers. 14298 // We need the length to be consistent. 14299 if (!ModCheck) 14300 break; 14301 ModCheck = ModCheck->Parent; 14302 14303 IdentifierLocs.push_back(Path[I].second); 14304 } 14305 14306 ImportDecl *Import = ImportDecl::Create(Context, 14307 Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(), 14308 AtLoc.isValid()? AtLoc : ImportLoc, 14309 Mod, IdentifierLocs); 14310 Context.getTranslationUnitDecl()->addDecl(Import); 14311 return Import; 14312 } 14313 14314 void Sema::ActOnModuleInclude(SourceLocation DirectiveLoc, Module *Mod) { 14315 checkModuleImportContext(*this, Mod, DirectiveLoc, CurContext); 14316 14317 // Determine whether we're in the #include buffer for a module. The #includes 14318 // in that buffer do not qualify as module imports; they're just an 14319 // implementation detail of us building the module. 14320 // 14321 // FIXME: Should we even get ActOnModuleInclude calls for those? 14322 bool IsInModuleIncludes = 14323 TUKind == TU_Module && 14324 getSourceManager().isWrittenInMainFile(DirectiveLoc); 14325 14326 // If this module import was due to an inclusion directive, create an 14327 // implicit import declaration to capture it in the AST. 14328 if (!IsInModuleIncludes) { 14329 TranslationUnitDecl *TU = getASTContext().getTranslationUnitDecl(); 14330 ImportDecl *ImportD = ImportDecl::CreateImplicit(getASTContext(), TU, 14331 DirectiveLoc, Mod, 14332 DirectiveLoc); 14333 TU->addDecl(ImportD); 14334 Consumer.HandleImplicitImportDecl(ImportD); 14335 } 14336 14337 getModuleLoader().makeModuleVisible(Mod, Module::AllVisible, DirectiveLoc); 14338 VisibleModules.setVisible(Mod, DirectiveLoc); 14339 } 14340 14341 void Sema::ActOnModuleBegin(SourceLocation DirectiveLoc, Module *Mod) { 14342 checkModuleImportContext(*this, Mod, DirectiveLoc, CurContext); 14343 14344 if (getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) 14345 VisibleModulesStack.push_back(std::move(VisibleModules)); 14346 VisibleModules.setVisible(Mod, DirectiveLoc); 14347 } 14348 14349 void Sema::ActOnModuleEnd(SourceLocation DirectiveLoc, Module *Mod) { 14350 checkModuleImportContext(*this, Mod, DirectiveLoc, CurContext); 14351 14352 if (getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) { 14353 VisibleModules = std::move(VisibleModulesStack.back()); 14354 VisibleModulesStack.pop_back(); 14355 VisibleModules.setVisible(Mod, DirectiveLoc); 14356 } 14357 } 14358 14359 void Sema::createImplicitModuleImportForErrorRecovery(SourceLocation Loc, 14360 Module *Mod) { 14361 // Bail if we're not allowed to implicitly import a module here. 14362 if (isSFINAEContext() || !getLangOpts().ModulesErrorRecovery) 14363 return; 14364 14365 // Create the implicit import declaration. 14366 TranslationUnitDecl *TU = getASTContext().getTranslationUnitDecl(); 14367 ImportDecl *ImportD = ImportDecl::CreateImplicit(getASTContext(), TU, 14368 Loc, Mod, Loc); 14369 TU->addDecl(ImportD); 14370 Consumer.HandleImplicitImportDecl(ImportD); 14371 14372 // Make the module visible. 14373 getModuleLoader().makeModuleVisible(Mod, Module::AllVisible, Loc); 14374 VisibleModules.setVisible(Mod, Loc); 14375 } 14376 14377 void Sema::ActOnPragmaRedefineExtname(IdentifierInfo* Name, 14378 IdentifierInfo* AliasName, 14379 SourceLocation PragmaLoc, 14380 SourceLocation NameLoc, 14381 SourceLocation AliasNameLoc) { 14382 NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Name, NameLoc, 14383 LookupOrdinaryName); 14384 AsmLabelAttr *Attr = 14385 AsmLabelAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, AliasName->getName(), AliasNameLoc); 14386 14387 // If a declaration that: 14388 // 1) declares a function or a variable 14389 // 2) has external linkage 14390 // already exists, add a label attribute to it. 14391 if (PrevDecl && 14392 (isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) || isa<VarDecl>(PrevDecl)) && 14393 PrevDecl->hasExternalFormalLinkage()) 14394 PrevDecl->addAttr(Attr); 14395 // Otherwise, add a label atttibute to ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers. 14396 else 14397 (void)ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.insert(std::make_pair(Name, Attr)); 14398 } 14399 14400 void Sema::ActOnPragmaWeakID(IdentifierInfo* Name, 14401 SourceLocation PragmaLoc, 14402 SourceLocation NameLoc) { 14403 Decl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 14404 14405 if (PrevDecl) { 14406 PrevDecl->addAttr(WeakAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, PragmaLoc)); 14407 } else { 14408 (void)WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers.insert( 14409 std::pair<IdentifierInfo*,WeakInfo> 14410 (Name, WeakInfo((IdentifierInfo*)nullptr, NameLoc))); 14411 } 14412 } 14413 14414 void Sema::ActOnPragmaWeakAlias(IdentifierInfo* Name, 14415 IdentifierInfo* AliasName, 14416 SourceLocation PragmaLoc, 14417 SourceLocation NameLoc, 14418 SourceLocation AliasNameLoc) { 14419 Decl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, AliasName, AliasNameLoc, 14420 LookupOrdinaryName); 14421 WeakInfo W = WeakInfo(Name, NameLoc); 14422 14423 if (PrevDecl) { 14424 if (!PrevDecl->hasAttr<AliasAttr>()) 14425 if (NamedDecl *ND = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(PrevDecl)) 14426 DeclApplyPragmaWeak(TUScope, ND, W); 14427 } else { 14428 (void)WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers.insert( 14429 std::pair<IdentifierInfo*,WeakInfo>(AliasName, W)); 14430 } 14431 } 14432 14433 Decl *Sema::getObjCDeclContext() const { 14434 return (dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext)); 14435 } 14436 14437 AvailabilityResult Sema::getCurContextAvailability() const { 14438 const Decl *D = cast_or_null<Decl>(getCurObjCLexicalContext()); 14439 if (!D) 14440 return AR_Available; 14441 14442 // If we are within an Objective-C method, we should consult 14443 // both the availability of the method as well as the 14444 // enclosing class. If the class is (say) deprecated, 14445 // the entire method is considered deprecated from the 14446 // purpose of checking if the current context is deprecated. 14447 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) { 14448 AvailabilityResult R = MD->getAvailability(); 14449 if (R != AR_Available) 14450 return R; 14451 D = MD->getClassInterface(); 14452 } 14453 // If we are within an Objective-c @implementation, it 14454 // gets the same availability context as the @interface. 14455 else if (const ObjCImplementationDecl *ID = 14456 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(D)) { 14457 D = ID->getClassInterface(); 14458 } 14459 // Recover from user error. 14460 return D ? D->getAvailability() : AR_Available; 14461 } 14462